Manual PDF
Manual PDF
Manual PDF
Dynamics NAV is a business management solution for small and mid-sized organizations that automates and
streamlines business processes and helps you manage your business. Highly adaptable and rich with features,
Dynamics NAV enables companies to manage their business, including finance, manufacturing, sales, shipping,
project management, services, and more. Companies can easily add functionality that is relevant to the region
of operation, and that is customized to support even highly specialized industries.
Dynamics NAV is fast to implement, easy to configure, and simplicity guides innovations in product design,
development, implementation, and usability. In this section, you can find information about using Dynamics
NAV in your company. And if you are a partner or customer looking at extending the functionality, you will find
relevant links under Development and Administration.
Previous Versions
If you are looking for online content for Microsoft Dynamics NAV 2016 and earlier versions of Dynamics NAV,
this is available in the Previous Versions section of the Docs site.
Direct links:
Microsoft Dynamics NAV 2016
Microsoft Dynamics NAV 2015
Microsoft Dynamics NAV 2013 R2
Microsoft Dynamics NAV 2013
Microsoft Dynamics NAV 2009 R2
Microsoft Dynamics NAV 2009
See Also
Working with Dynamics NAV
Setting Up Dynamics NAV
Finance
Customizing Dynamics NAV Using Extensions
Using Dynamics NAV as my Business Inbox in Outlook
Getting Dynamics NAV on Your Mobile Device
Dynamics 365 documentation
roadmap.dynamics.com
Get Started with Microsoft Dynamics NAV
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Dynamics NAV is a business management solution for small and mid-sized organizations that automates and
streamlines business processes and helps you manage your business. The demonstration company contains
sample data, but you can create your own sales documents, for example, or set up a bank account.
See Also
Working with Dynamics NAV
Setting Up Dynamics NAV
Finance
Customizing Dynamics NAV Using Extensions
Using Dynamics NAV as my Business Inbox in Outlook
Getting Dynamics NAV on Your Mobile Device
Changing the Role Center
Minimum Requirements for Using Dynamics NAV
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Before you access Dynamics NAV, we recommend that you verify that your computer or mobile device meets or
exceeds the minimum system requirements for the product. This article lists the requirements.
Browsers
Chrome for Windows and Firefox for Windows: Dynamics NAV is designed to work with the current version of
these desktop browsers.
Safari: Dynamics NAV is designed to work with the current version of Safari on OSX.
Microsoft Edge: Dynamics NAV is designed to work with the current version of Microsoft Edge.
Internet Explorer: Dynamics NAV is designed to work with Internet Explorer 11 (build 11.0.9600.17239) for
Windows 10 and for Windows 8.1 (32-bit and 64-bit versions). We recommend that you upgrade to the latest
version of Internet Explorer supported for your version of Windows.
Mobile devices
Windows: Dynamics NAV for Windows can be installed on devices with at least 1GB of RAM and Windows 10
Phone, Home, Pro, Enterprise, or Education (32-bit and 64-bit editions).
iOS: Dynamics NAV for iPad and iPhone requires iOS 9.0 or later.
Android: Dynamics NAV for Android tablet and Android phone can be installed on devices with at least 1GB of
RAM and Android 5.0 or higher.
Device size: Dynamics NAV is supported on smartphones with a minimum screen size of 4” and tablets with a
minimum screen size of 7”.
Outlook
Outlook applications: To use Dynamics NAV as your business inbox in Outlook, you will need Outlook 2013 or
later, Outlook Web App, OWA for iPhone, OWA for iPad, or OWA for Android.
Browsers: When using Dynamics NAV as your business inbox in the Outlook Web App (OWA), the add-in requires
that your computer is running one of the listed supported browsers that are listed earlier in this article.
Platforms: When using the Dynamics NAV Outlook Add-In in OWA for iPhone, OWA for iPad, and OWA for
Android, the add-in requires that your mobile device is running one of the listed supported mobile devices for
Dynamics NAV.
See Also
Welcome to Microsoft Dynamics NAV
Frequently Asked Questions
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
This section contains answers to frequently asked questions about signing up for and using Microsoft Dynamics
NAV.
See Also
Welcome to Microsoft Dynamics NAV
Using Dynamics NAV as Your Business Inbox in Outlook
Using Dynamics NAV without Outlook
How to: Change the Role Center
Working with Dynamics NAV
Business Functionality
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Dynamics NAV provides functionality for common business processes in small and mid-sized companies, mainly
within wholesale and professional services. However, more complex processes, such as assembly, manufacturing,
service, and directed warehouse management are also supported.
Dynamics NAV includes standard configurations for most business processes, but you can change the
configuration to suit your business' needs. From your Home page, you can access assisted setup guides that help
you configure certain scenarios and add features to Dynamics NAV. Several areas of business functionality must
be set up manually. For more information, see Setting Up Dynamics NAV.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Make and collect payments, manage your cash flow, defer Finance
income and revenue, prepare year-end closing, and manage
fixed assets.
Create jobs and schedule resources for project, manage job Project Management
budgets, monitor progress, and track machine and employee
hours.
Manage and support your sales efforts and focus your Relationship Management
interactions on preferred customers and contacts.
Put sellable items together in simple steps to make a new Assembly Management
item, such as a kit.
TO SEE
Ensure an effective flow of goods that are received and Warehouse Management
shipped.
Schedule service calls and set up service orders, and track Service Management
repair parts and supplies.
Enable users to exchange data with external sources during Exchanging Data Electronically
daily tasks, such as sending/receiving electronic documents,
importing/exporting bank files, and updating currency
exchange rates.
See Also
Setting Up Dynamics NAV
Welcome to Microsoft Dynamics NAV
Working with Dynamics NAV
Troubleshooting Self-Service Sign-Up
8/13/2018 • 3 minutes to read • Edit Online
Signing up for Dynamics NAV is easy and can be done very quickly. You can create a free account even if you are
an existing organization. This article addresses issues that you may have during signup.
Troubleshooting
In many cases, registering for Dynamics NAV can be achieved by following the sign-up process. However, there
are several reasons why you may not be able to complete self-service signup. The table below summarizes some
of the most common reasons you may not be able to complete signup and ways you can workaround these issues.
For Office 365 email addresses that are not registered in the Dynamics NAV currently only supports Office 365 US
United States, you receive a message like the following during registered email accounts.
signup:
Personal email addresses such as nancy@gmail.com are not Dynamics NAV does not support email addresses provided by
supported. You receive a message like the following during consumer email services or telecommunications providers. To
signup: complete signup, try again using an email address assigned by
your work or school. If you still cannot sign up and are willing
You entered a personal email address: Please enter your to complete a more advanced setup process, you can register
work email address so we can securely store your for a new Office 365 trial subscription and use that email
company's data. address to sign up.
or
That looks like a personal email address. Enter your
work address so we can connect you with others in your
company. And don’t worry. We won’t share your address
with anyone.
.gov or .mil email addresses You receive a message like the Dynamics NAV does not support .gov or .mil addresses at this
following during signup: time.
Self-service signup is not enabled. You receive a message like Your organization’s IT administrator has disabled self-service
the following during signup: signup for Dynamics NAV. To complete signup, contact your IT
administrator and ask them to follow the instructions on the
We can't finish signing you up. Your IT department has page below to allow existing users to sign up for Dynamics
turned off signup for Dynamics NAV. Contact them to NAV and to allow new users to join your existing tenant. You
complete signup. may also experience this problem if you signed up for Office
or 365 through a partner.
That looks like a personal email address. Enter your
work address so we can connect you with others in your
company. And don’t worry. We won’t share your address
with anyone.
Email address is not an Office 365 ID. You receive a message Your organization uses IDs to sign in to Office 365 and other
like the following during signup: Microsoft services that are different than your email address.
For example, your email address might be
We can't find you at contoso.com. Do you use a different Nancy.Smith@contoso.com but your ID is
ID at work or school? Try signing in with that, and if it nancys@contoso.com. To complete signup, use the ID that
doesn't work, contact your IT department. your organization has assigned to for signing in to Office 365
or other Microsoft services. If you do not know what this is,
contact your IT administrator. If you still cannot sign up and
are able to complete a more advanced setup process, you can
register for a new Office 365 trial subscription and use that
email address to sign up.
See Also
Welcome to Microsoft Dynamics NAV
Working with Dynamics NAV
Importing Business Data from Other Finance Systems
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
When you sign up for Dynamics NAV, you can choose to create an empty company so that you can upload your
own data and to test your new Dynamics NAV company. Depending on the finance solution that your business
uses today, you can transfer information about customers, vendors, inventory, and bank accounts.
From Home, you can start an assisted setup guide that helps you transfer the business data from an Excel file or
from other formats. The type of files you can upload depends on the extensions that are available. For example,
you can migrate data from QuickBooks because Dynamics NAV includes an extension that handles the conversion
from QuickBooks. If you want to migrate data from other finance solutions, you must either check if an extension
is available for that solution or import from Excel.
Dynamics NAV includes templates for accounts, customers, vendors, and inventory items that you can choose to
apply when you import your data.
NOTE
Working with configuration packages is advanced functionality, and we recommend that you contact your administrator. For
more information, see Importing Data from Legacy Accounting Software using a Configuration Package.
See Also
Finance
Importing Data from Legacy Accounting Software using a Configuration Package
QuickBooks Desktop Data Migration
QuickBooks Online Data Migration
Dynamics GP Data Migration
Customizing Dynamics NAV Using Extensions
Setting Up Dynamics NAV
Getting Dynamics NAV on Your Mobile Device
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Access your Dynamics NAV data from your mobile device. You can navigate through your business data, use
features such as send to Excel or Office 365, view up-to-date charts and KPIs, email sales quotes and invoices, and
shoot and attach pictures with your camera. Follow the steps below to download the app and get started.
See Also
Welcome to Microsoft Dynamics NAV
Working with Dynamics NAV
Synchronize Contacts in Dynamics NAV with Contacts
in Microsoft Outlook
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
You can see the same contacts in Dynamics NAV as you see in Outlook if you set up contact synchronization. For
example, if you are a sales person, you might do some of your work in Outlook and some of your work in
Dynamics NAV. If the contacts are the same in both places, your work is more straightforward.
A dedicated folder in Outlook makes contacts easy to find, and you can set a filter to synchronize only the contacts
from Dynamics NAV that you want to see in Outlook. Once the contact synchronization is set up, you can start
synchronization manually or set up an automatic synchronization that will keep the contacts in sync on a scheduled
basis.
Set Up Synchronization
You set up how you want to synchronize contacts with Outlook in the Exchange Sync. Setup window in
Dynamics NAV. As a prerequisite, your user profile in Dynamics NAV must specify your Office 365 email account.
You can check this in the Office 365 Authentication section of your user profile in the Users list.
Then, in the Exchange Sync. Setup window, you can validate that the connection to Exchange is working and then
set up contact synchronization. Open the Contact Sync. Setup window and start the synchronization. Optionally,
set a filter for which contacts to synchronize between Dynamics NAV and Outlook. For example, you can set a filter
on name, type, company, or similar. You can also change the default name of the folder that the contacts will
synchronize to in Outlook. The default name is Dynamics NAV.
Once this synchronization has been set up, any changes to that you make to the contact in either Outlook or in
Dynamics NAV is synchronized to the other.
Each of your coworkers can also set up their own Exchange synchronization and set their own filter on which
contacts to synchronize.
Synchronize Contacts
If you are used to working with contacts in Dynamics NAV, then you will find it easy to start the synchronization
manually whenever it suits you from the Contacts list. Simply choose the Sync with Office 365 action, and then
decide if you want to change the filter that you have set up. When you choose the OK button, the synchronization
starts immediately, and the latest changes are applied to your contacts in Outlook.
In the Contacts list, you can synchronize contacts in two ways:
Sync with Office 365
This action synchronizes all changes from Dynamics NAV to Office 365 since the previous synchronization,
based on the last modified date. Any new contacts from Office 365 will be synchronized back to Dynamics
NAV as well. This is typically faster than doing a full sync.
Full Sync with Office 365
This action synchronizes all contacts in both directions regardless of the last sync date and last modified
date.
In both cases, contacts are only synchronized from Outlook if they have the required fields filled in. The required
fields to synchronize to Office 365 are Name, Email address and they must be of type Person. Dynamics NAV is
the master of the contact information, so the Dynamics NAV contact information will be saved in the event of
duplicates.
In Outlook, the contacts from Dynamics NAV are shown in a folder under Other contacts in the People view. If
you are not familiar with the People view in Outlook, then you can get to it from the navigation options in the
bottom left corner of Outlook.
See Also
Getting Started
Finance
Sales
Purchasing
Using contacts (People) in Outlook on the web
Using Dynamics NAV as your Business Inbox in
Outlook
4/16/2018 • 4 minutes to read • Edit Online
Dynamics NAV introduces the ability to manage business interactions with your customers and vendors, directly
in Microsoft Outlook. With the Dynamics NAV Outlook add-ins, you can see financial data related to customers
and vendors, as well as create and send financial documents, such as quotes and invoices.
See Also
Welcome to Dynamics NAV
Finance
Sales
Purchasing
Using Dynamics NAV without Outlook
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Dynamics NAV has deep integration with Office 365, and you can use Dynamics NAV as your business inbox in
Outlook. But if you do not have Outlook, you can work with Dynamics NAV in the browser or on your mobile
device.
Sending Email
You can send documents such as invoices as email using your business email address. From your Home page, you
can access an assisted setup guide that helps you set up email. If you do not use an Office 365 email account, you
must specify technical information about your mail server. If you do not have this information available, please
contact your IT support staff.
See Also
Welcome to Dynamics NAV
Using Dynamics NAV as your Business Inbox in Outlook
Getting Dynamics NAV on my Mobile Device
How to: Send Documents by Email
Enabling Your Business Data for Power BI
8/13/2018 • 5 minutes to read • Edit Online
Getting insights into your Dynamics NAV data is easy with Power BI and the Dynamics NAV content packs. Power
BI retrieves your data and then builds an out-of-the-box dashboard and reports based on that data.
Microsoft has published the following content packs:
APP DESCRIPTION
Microsoft Dynamics NAV Provides a dashboard with key financial data over time, such
as earnings versus expenses, operating margin, and cash cycle.
Microsoft Dynamics 365 for Sales Provides a dashboard with key data about sales opportunities
and contacts.
Microsoft Dynamics 365 for Sales Provides a dashboard with key data about sales and inventory.
NOTE
You can also build your own reports and dashboards in Power BI based on your Dynamics NAV data. For more information,
see Connecting Your Business Data to Power BI.
OData Feed URL The OData URL so Power BI can access data from your
company, such as
https://mybusiness.financials.dynamics.com:7048/MS/ODataV
4/Company('My%2Business').
User name Your name as it displays for your account in Dynamics NAV,
such as John Smith.
Password This is the web service access key for your user account in
Dynamics NAV.
This means that you must get 2 pieces of information from Dynamics NAV: The OData URL and the web service
access key for your user account.
Getting the URL
When you add Dynamics NAV to Power BI, you must specify a URL so Power BI can access data from your
company. On the connection page, the URL is referred to as the OData Feed URL, and it must have the following
format:
https://mybusiness.financials.dynamics.com:7048/MS/ODataV4/Company('CRONUS%20US')
In this example, mybusiness is the name of your Dynamics NAV service, and CRONUS US is the name of the
demonstration company with %20 representing the space in the name.
To get the URL, in Dynamics NAV, search for and open the Web Services window. This window lists the web
services that are currently available, and you can copy the link from the OData URL field for one of the default
OData web services.
Getting the user name and the web service access key
In order to use data from Dynamics NAV in Power BI, in the Connect to Dynamics NAV window, you must
specify a user name and a password. The user name is your name as it displays for your account in Dynamics NAV
so that Power BI can log in to Dynamics NAV. The password is the web service access key that is set up for your
user account in Dynamics NAV.
To find this information, in Dynamics NAV, search for the Users window, and then open the card for your user
account. On the General FastTab, copy the content of the User Name field, and on the Web Service Access
FastTab, copy the contents of the Web Service Access Key field. If the Web Service Access Key field is blank, in
the ribbon, choose Change Web Service Access Key, choose the Key Never Expires field, and then choose the
OK button. You can then copy the key.
Troubleshooting
The Power BI dashboard relies on the published web services that are listed above, and it will show data from the
demonstration company or your own company if you import data from your current finance solution. However, if
something goes wrong, this section provides a workaround for the most typical issues.
"Parameter validation failed, please make sure all parameters are valid"
If you see this error after you enter your Dynamics NAV URL, make sure the following requirements are satisfied:
The URL follows exactly this pattern:
https://mybusiness.financials.dynamics.com:7048/MS/ODataV4/Company('CRONUS%20US')
Delete any text after the company name in parenthesis
Make sure there are no trailing forward slash at the end of the URL.
Make sure that it is a secure connection as indicated by the URL starting with https.
"Login failed"
If you get a "login failed" error when you log in to the dashboard, using your Dynamics NAV credentials, then this
can be caused by one of the following issues:
The account you are using does not have permissions to read the Dynamics NAV data from your account.
Verify your user account in Dynamics NAV, and make sure that you have used the right web service access
key as the password, and then try again.
The Dynamics NAV instance that you are trying to connect to does not have a valid SSL certificate. In this
case you'll see a more detailed error message ("unable to establish trusted SSL relationship").
NOTE
Self-signed certificates are not supported.
"Oops"
If you see an "Oops" error dialog after you pass the authentication dialog, this is most frequently caused by a
problem connecting to the data for the content pack.
Verify that the URL follows the pattern that was specified earlier:
https://mybusiness.financials.dynamics.com:7048/MS/ODataV4/Company('CRONUS%20US')
A common mistake is to specify the full URL for a specific web service:
https://mybusiness.financials.dynamics.com:7048/MS/ODataV4/Company('CRONUS%20US')/powerbifinance
You can make your Dynamics NAV data available as a data source in Power BI and build powerful reports of the
state of your business.
NOTE
You must have a valid account with Dynamics NAV and with Power BI. Also, you must download Power BI Desktop.
NOTE
If there are other authentication options available in the left hand navigation, choose Basic.
4. Enter your username and password. You can find this information in the Users window in Dynamics NAV.
Use the Web Access Key as your password.
For example, your username is ADMIN, and the web service access key that serves as your password is
EgzeUFQ9Uv0o5O0lUMyqCzo1ueUW9yRF3SsLU=.
5. Choose the Connection button to continue. The Power BI wizard shows a list of Dynamics NAV data
sources. These data source represent all the web services that you have published from your Dynamics
NAV.
Alternatively, create a new web service URL in Dynamics NAV by using the Create Data Set action in the
Web Services page, using the Set Up Reporting Assisted Setup guide, or by choosing the Edit in Excel
action in any lists.
6. Specify the data you want to add to your data model, and then choose the Load button.
7. Repeat the previous steps to add additional Dynamics NAV data to your Power BI data model.
NOTE
Once you have successfully connected to Dynamics NAV, you will not be prompted again for the OData URL,
username, or password.
Once the data is loaded it will appear in the right navigation on the page. At this point, you have successfully
connected to your Dynamics NAV data and are ready to begin building your Power BI report. For more
information, see the Power BI documentation.
See Also
Business Intelligence
Welcome to Microsoft Dynamics NAV
Importing Business Data from Other Finance Systems
Setting Up Dynamics NAV
Finance
Customizing Dynamics NAV Using Extensions
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
You can customize Dynamics NAV by installing extensions that add functionality, change behavior, or give you
access to online services. For example, Microsoft offers an extension that provides integration with PayPal
Payments Standard, and several that make it easy to import data from other finance apps.
You manage the extensions in the Extension Management window. You can access this window from Home.
Alternatively, choose the Search for Page or Report icon in the top right corner, enter Extension, and then
choose the related link.
NOTE
If you think you should have access to an extension but you cannot find its functionality, check the Extension Management
window - if the extension is not listed there, you can install it as described in the following section.
Installing an Extension
In the Extension Management window, you can see the extensions that are currently available, and are either
installed or ready to be installed.
NOTE
Extensions might need to be published before they are available in the list. Typically, this is something a Microsoft Partner
helps with. For more information, see How to: Publish and Install an Extension v2.0.
If you choose an extension, you can read about what the extension does, and you can access Help for the extension
to learn more. When you choose to install an extension, you must agree to the terms of use.
When you install an extension, you might have to set it up, such as specifying an account for use with the PayPal
Payments Standard extension. Other extensions simply add fields to an existing page, or they add a new page, for
example.
If you uninstall an extension, and you then change your mind, you can install it again. When you uninstall an
extension that you have been using, the data is preserved so that if you install the extension again, your data is still
available.
All extensions are tested before they are made available to you, but we recommend that you access the links that
are provided with each extension to learn more about the extension before you choose to install it.
Microsoft provides the following extensions:
C5 2012 Data Migration (DK)
Ceridian Payroll
Image Analyzer
Microsoft Pay
PayPal Payments Standard
QuickBooks Data Migration
Quickbooks Payroll File Import
Sales and Inventory Forecast
See Also
How to: Enable Customer Payment Through PayPal
Migrating Business Data from Other Finance Systems
Dynamics NAV Extensions by Other Providers
Welcome to Microsoft Dynamics NAV
Working with Microsoft
Dynamics NAV
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
When performing business tasks, you interact with data in different ways,
such as creating records and entering data, sorting and filtering data,
writing notes, and outputting data to other applications.
For example, you can adjust the size and position of any window, expand
the width of columns and increase the height of column headers, and
change the sorting of data in columns. And if you want to use the
horizontal scroll bar to view all columns on a list page or on document
lines, you will see that there is a vertical freeze pane to restrict some
columns from scrolling.
The following table lists some of the general functionality with links to
topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Use Search to look for a specific page Using Search for Page or Report
or report.
Change how you view lists of, for Displaying Lists in Different Ways
example, customers, vendors, or items.
Modify the colored indicator on cues. How to: Set Up a Colored Indicator on
Cues
Change the Role Center, and the How to: Change the Role Center
related Home page, to fit your role.
Get reports to show data from specific Entering Date Ranges in Dynamics NAV
date ranges.
See Also
General Business Functionality
Customizing Dynamics NAV
Using Search for Page or Report
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
You can find pages and reports by choosing the Search for Page or Report field in the top right corner of the
address bar.
If you use Dynamics NAV in a browser, look for the Search for Page or Report icon instead.
When you start typing characters, a drop-down list shows page names containing the character(s) you type. The
drop-down list changes as you type more characters, and you can select the correct page from the list when it is
displayed. The second column in the drop-down list shows the navigation paths to the found pages. There is also a
link that enables you to search the help for the characters that you typed.
NOTE
The Search for Page or Report function does not search through data, such as customer names, addresses, or
transactions. Instead, you can search for data in list pages by choosing the magnifier symbol in the right corner of the list
header. The search applies only to the list you are viewing. For more information, see Entering Criteria in Filters.
See Also
Work with Dynamics NAV
Changing Basic Settings
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
In the My Settings window, you can see and change basic settings for Dynamics NAV.
Role Center
The Role Center represents the Home page, a starting page that is designed for the needs of the role. On the
Home page, you have an overview of the business. To the left you see a navigation bar that gives you easy access
to customers, vendors, items, and so on.
In the center you find the Activities tiles. Activities show current data and can be chooseed or tapped for easy
access to the selected document. The Key Performance Indicators can be set up to display a selected chart for a
visual representation of, for example, cash flow or income and expenses.
You can also build up a list of Favorite Customers on the Home page for accounts that you do business with often
or need to pay special attention to. Use the arrows to collapse part of the page and make more room to show
specific data. At the top of the Home page you will find all of the actions that can be applied to the current content.
This too can be collapsed and you only need to choose or tap within the collapsed area to view it again.
The default Role Center is Business Manager, but you can select another Role Center that fits your needs better.
For more information, see How to: Change the Role Center.
Company
A company functions as a container for data in Dynamics NAV. There can be multiple companies in a database,
but only one can be selected at a time.
The default company is called CRONUS and contains demonstration data only.
TIP
If you want to display a different name for your company in the application (such as on the Home page), set the Name field
on the Company Information page or the Display Name field on the Companies page.
Work Date
The default work date is usually today's date. You may have to temporarily change the work date to be able to
perform tasks, such as completing transactions for a date that is not the current date.
TIP
Type w to quickly enter the work date in a date field. Write t to quickly enter the current date in the date field.
IMPORTANT
The work date is only changed until you close the company or until the date changes. If you open a different company or
open the same company the next day and still have to use a different work date, then you must set the work date again.
Region
The Region setting determines how dates, times, numbers, and currencies are shown or formatted.
See Also
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Change the Role Center
Customizing Dynamics NAV
How to: Change the Role Center
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
The Home page is your main point of entry into Dynamics NAV. Here you can get an overview of the daily work
tasks and their status. Tasks that you perform often are accessed through the tiles in the content area, the
navigation pane on the left, and through actions in the ribbon.
The content on the Home page is based on the selected Role Center. The standard Role Center for Dynamics NAV
is Business Manager, but you can change this and choose between a number of Role Centers.
See Also
Welcome to Dynamics NAV
Working with Dynamics NAV
Customizing Dynamics NAV
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
There are different ways to customize the application to give you and your colleagues access to the features,
functionality, and data that you need most, in a manner that bests suits your daily work. This table outlines who
typically performs each customization type, and who the customizations affect.
Permissions-based IT Pro, developer Show or hide user All users in all Removing Elements
interface elements companies. from the User
based on the license Interface According
or the user's to Permissions
permissions to the
underlying tables. All
elements, fields,
actions, and page
parts, can be
removed from the
user’s view.
Install an extension Administrator Extensions are like All users in all Customizing Using
small applications companies. Extensions
that add functionality,
change behavior,
provide access to
new online services,
and more. For
example, Microsoft
provides an extension
that provides
integration with
PayPal Payments
Standard.
Configuration Administrator Customize the user All users of a profile. Configuring the User
interface for multiple Interface for Users
users by
adding/removing
user interface
elements based on
permissions, or by
customizing a profile
that the users are
assigned to (using
the same
personlaization
features available to
users).
Personalizing the Any user Change the layout User only. Personalizing
Workspace and content of your Workspaces
pages.
See Also
Working with Dynamics NAV
Letting Dynamics NAV Suggest Values
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Dynamics NAV can help you complete tasks quicker and more correctly by prefilling fields or complete lines with
data that you would otherwise have to calculate and enter yourself. Although such automatic data entry is always
correct, you can change it afterwards if you want to.
Functionality that enters field values for you is typically offered for tasks where you enter large volumes of
transactional data and want to avoid errors and save time. This topic contains a selection of such functionality.
More sections will be added in future updates of Dynamics NAV.
See Also
Working with Dynamics NAV
Finance
Working with Reports
4/16/2018 • 3 minutes to read • Edit Online
A report gathers information based on a specified set of criteria, and organizes and presents the information in an
easy-to-read, printable format. There are many reports that you can access throughout the application. The reports
typically provide information relative to the context of the page you are on. For example, the Customer page
includes reports for the top 10 customers and the sales statistics, and more.
You can find reports in the Reports tab on selected pages, or you can use search to find reports by name. When
you open a report, you are presented with a page that let's you specify information (options and filters) that
determines want to include in the report. For example, depending on the report, you can specify a date range, a
specific record such as a customer, or sorting order.
Previewing a report
Choose Preview to see the report in the Internet browser. Point to an area of the report to show the menu bar.
.
Use the menu bar to:
Move through pages
Zoom in and out
Resize to fit the window
Select text
You can copy text from a report, and then paste it somewhere else, like a page in Dynamics NAV or
Microsoft Word. Using a mouse, for example, you press and hold where you want to start, and then move
the mouse to select one or more words, sentences, or paragraphs. You can then press the right mouse
button, and select Copy. You can the paste the selected text where ever you want it.
Pan the document
You can move the visible area of the report in any direction so you can view other areas or the report. This is
helpful when you have zoomed in to see details. Using your mouse, for example, press and hold the mouse
button anywhere in the report preview, and then move your mouse.
Download to a PDF file on your computer or network.
Saving a Report
You can save a report to a PDF document, Microsoft Word document, or Microsoft Excel document by choosing
Send to, and then making your selection.
Printing a Report
When you want to print a report you have to download the report as a PDF, Word, or Excel document first by
choosing Send to. Now, you can either open the report document right-away and print it, or save it and print it
later.
NOTE
As an administrator, you can create and manage the saved settings for reports for all users. For more information, see
Managing Saved Settings on Reports.
See Also
Specify Printer Selection for Reports
Managing Report and Document Layouts
Working with Dynamics NAV
Language and Locale
7/13/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Dynamics NAV is supported in a number of markets and available in the languages that those markets require.
This is a result of support for multiple languages at runtime in combination with support for legal requirements in
the supported markets. This means that Dynamics NAV can present itself in different languages. You can change
the language that is used to display texts, and the change is immediate, once you have been automatically signed
out and in again. The setting applies to you and not to everyone else in your company.
For example, if you are Canadian, you can see the user interface in English and in French, but it is still the Canadian
version of Dynamics NAV in all other aspects. It is not the same as, say, Dynamics NAV in the United Kingdom.
Changing the texts that are stored as application data is not part of the multilanguage capability. This is an
application design issue. Examples of such texts are the names of items in the inventory or the comments for a
customer. In other words, these types of text are not translated.
NOTE
Dynamics NAV only supports a single character set for data. Therefore some characters may not be supported in your
tenant, and you may experience problems when retrieving data that was entered using a different character set. For instance,
your tenant may support only English and Russian characters and if you enter data in a different language, it may not be
stored correctly. You should contact your system administrator to make sure you understand which languages are supported
for your Dynamics NAV.
IMPORTANT
When you change the locale, you will see a long list of languages and locales. However, only the locale setting is used in the
current version of Dynamics NAV.
To change the locale, go to the My Settings window. For more information, see Changing Basic Settings.
See Also
Languages of the Docs
Changing Basic Settings
Welcome to Microsoft Dynamics NAV
Languages of the Dynamics NAV Docs
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
The Help content for the core functionality in Dynamics NAV publishes to the Microsoft Docs site and available in
a number of different languages. If you access the docs from inside Dynamics NAV, the content will display in your
language. If a particular page is not available in your language yet, it will be shown in English.
NOTE
The list shows all languages that are supported by the Microsoft Docs site. Dynamics NAV is available in a limited number of
countries/regions, but the Help content is made available in more languages. However, the Help content is not available in all
languages that the Microsoft Docs site supports.
See Also
Language and Locale
Welcome to Microsoft Dynamics NAV
Accessibility and Keyboard Shortcuts in Dynamics
NAV
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
This topic provides information about the features that make Dynamics NAV readily available to people with
disabilities. Dynamics NAV supports the following accessibility features:
Keyboard shortcuts
For more information, see Keyboard Shortcuts in Microsoft Dynamics NAV Web client and Keyboard
Shortcuts Microsoft Dynamics NAV Windows client.
Navigation
Headings
Alternative text for images and links
Support for common assistive technologies
Navigation
You can navigate between the tabs and actions in the ribbon, elements in the navigation pane, and other controls
on Dynamics NAV pages and reports using the keyboard. To move the focus from one tab, action, or control to
another, press the Tab key to move forward. Press Shift+Tab to move backward.
By using the tab order, you can also switch between the main browser window and dialog boxes that request
confirmation, for example, or the login window.
Headings
The HTML source for Dynamics NAV content uses tags to help users of assistive technology to understand the
structure and content of the page. For example, on list pages, the columns are defined in TH tags and the column
headings are set with TITLE attribute inside the tag. Captions for elements, such as FastTabs, FactBoxes, and fields
are included in heading tags (H1, H2, H3, and H4).
Assistive Technologies
Dynamics NAV supports various assistive technologies, such as high contrast, screen readers, and voice
recognition software. Some assistive technologies may not work well with certain elements in Dynamics NAV
pages.
Dynamics NAV includes standard configurations for most business processes, but you can change the
configuration to suit the needs of company.
For example, your chart of accounts is prefilled with a number of posting accounts ready for use. You can, of
course, change the chart of accounts to suit your needs. For more information, see Finance.
From your Home page, you can access assisted setup guides that help you configure certain scenarios and add
features to Dynamics NAV. For information about how to access all assisted and manual setup windows, see
Getting Ready for Doing Business.
Some functionality, either general or for specific business processes, can be set up manually in addition to the
assisted setup. The following lists some of functionality that can you can set up manually.
TO SEE
Set up your own and your vendors' bank accounts and Setting Up Banking
enable services for importing and exporting bank files.
Configure the rules and values that define your company's Setting Up Sales
sales policies, register new customers, and set up how you
communicate with customers.
Configure the rules and values that define your company's Setting Up Purchasing
purchasing policies, register new vendors, and prioritize your
vendors for payment processing.
Configure the rules and values that define the company's Setting Up Inventory
inventory policies, set up locations if you keep inventory in
multiple warehouses, and categorize your items to improve
searching and sorting .
Set up resources, time sheets, and jobs to manage projects. Setting Up Project Management
Configure how to insure, maintain, and depreciate fixed Setting Up Fixed Assets
assets, and how you record the costs of fixed assets in your
company books.
Define the general rules and values for warehouse processes Setting Up Warehouse Management
and the specific handling at each location.
Prepare production BOMs and routings to define how end Setting Up Manufacturing
items are produced, and prepare machine or work centers to
perform the required operations.
Set up unique identification codes for records, such as cards, Creating Number Series
documents, and journal lines, to track them in the system.
TO SEE
Set up the SMTP Mail Setup window to send and receive How to: Set up Email
emails from documents within Dynamics NAV.
Some areas require you to be an administrator in your Dynamics NAV subscription. For more information, see
Setup and Administration in Dynamics NAV.
See Also
Finance
Sales
Purchasing
Inventory
Project Management
Fixed Assets
Assembly Management
Manufacturing
Warehouse Management
Working with Dynamics NAV
Setup and Administration in Dynamics NAV
Welcome to Dynamics NAV
Setup and Administration in Dynamics NAV
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Central administration tasks are usually performed by one role in the company. The scope of these tasks can
depend on the company's size and the administrator's job responsibilities. These tasks can include managing
database synchronization of job and email queues, setting up users, customizing the user interface, and managing
encryption keys.
Entering the correct setup values from the start is important to the success of any new business software.
Dynamics NAV includes a number of setup guides that help you set up core data. For more information, see
Setting Up Dynamics NAV.
A super user or an administrator can set up the Data Exchange Framework to enable users to export and import
data in bank and payroll files, for example for various cash management processes.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Add users, manage permissions and access to data, assign Users, Profiles, and Role Centers in Dynamics NAV
roles.
Track all direct modifications that users make to data in the Logging Changes in Dynamics NAV
database to identify the origin of errors and data changes.
Support your setup decisions with recommendations for Set Up Complex Application Areas Using Best Practices
selected fields that are known to potentially cause the
solution to be inefficient if set up incorrectly
Expose pages, codeunits, and queries as web services. How to: Publish a Web Service
Set up an SMTP server to enable e-mail communication in How to: Set Up Email Manually or Using the Assisted Setup
and out of Dynamics NAV
Enter single or recurring requests to run reports or codeunits. Use Job Queues to Schedule Tasks
See Also
Business Functionality
General Business Functionality
Working with Dynamics NAV
Welcome to Dynamics NAV
Logging Changes in Dynamics NAV
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
You can enable the change log in Dynamics NAV so you have a history of activities. The log is based on changes
that are made to data in the tables that you track. In the change log, entries are chronologically ordered and show
changes that are made to the fields on the specified tables. The change log collects all changes that are made to the
table.
See Also
Changing Basic Settings
Sorting
Using Search for Page or Report
How to: Manage Users and Permissions
Working with Dynamics NAV
Users, Profiles, and Role Centers
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
The people in your company who have access to Dynamics NAV are all assigned a profile that gives them access to
a Role Center. As an administrator, you can assign and change profiles in Dynamics NAV, and you can add and
remove users as part of your Dynamics NAV subscription.
Adding Users
To add users in Dynamics NAV, your company's Office 365 administrator must first create the users in the Office
365 Admin Center. For more information, see How to: Manage Users and Permissions.
Profiles
Profiles are collections of Dynamics NAV users who share the same Role Center. A Role Center is a type of page
on which you can place different parts. Each part is a container in which you can host other pages or pre-defined
system parts, such as an Outlook part or parts for adding tasks, notifications, or notes. For more information, see
Managing Profiles.
See Also
How to: Manage Users and Permissions
Customizing the User Interface
How to: Manage Users and Permissions
7/13/2018 • 6 minutes to read • Edit Online
If you get a new employee, your company's system administrator or IT pro has to add them to your Dynamics
NAV. Then, you can assign them access to the relevant parts of the product based on their work area by assigning
user groups and permissions.
Permission sets define which database objects, and thereby which UI elements, users have access to, and in which
companies.
A permission set is a collection of permissions for specific objects in the database. All users must be assigned one
or more permission sets before they can access Dynamics NAV. A number of predefined permission sets are
provided by default. You can use these permission sets as already defined, modify the default permission sets, or
create additional permission sets.
You can add users to user groups. This makes it easier to assign the same permission sets to multiple users.
Administrators can use the User Setup window to define periods of time during which specified users are able to
post, and also specify if the system logs the amount of time users are logged on.
1. Choose the icon, enter User Groups, and then choose the related link.
2. Alternatively, in the Users window, choose the User Groups action.
3. In the User Groups window, select an existing user group that you want to copy, and then choose the
Copy User Group action.
4. In the New User Group Code field, specify the name of the new user group, and then choose the OK
button.
As an alternative to copying, you can choose the New action to create a new line for an empty user group,
which you then fill in manually.
5. To add new or additional users, in the User Group window, choose the User Group Members action.
6. In the User Group Members window, on a new line, fill in the fields as necessary by selecting from
existing users.
7. To add new or additional permission sets, in the User Group window, choose the User Group Permission
Sets action.
8. In the User Group Permission Sets window, on a new line, fill in the fields as necessary by selecting from
existing permission sets.
OPTION DESCRIPTION
Blank Specifies that the permission type is not granted for the
object.
Indirect permission to a table means that you cannot open the table and read from it, but you can view the
data in the table through another object, such as a page, that you have direct permission to access. For
more information, see the “Example - Indirect Permission” section in this topic.
8. In the Security Filter field, enter a filter that you want to apply to the permission by selecting the field on
which you want to limit a user's access.
For example, if you want to create a security filter so that a user can view only sales with a specific
salesperson code, you choose the field number for the Salesperson Code field. Then, in the Field Filter
field, you enter the value of the that you want to use to limit access. For example, to limit a user's access to
only Annette Hill's sales, enter AH.
9. Repeat steps 7 and 8 to add permissions for additional objects to the permission set.
To create or modify permission sets by recording your actions
1. Choose the icon, enter Users, and then choose the related link.
2. In the Users window, choose the Permission Sets action.
3. In the Permission Sets window, choose the New Action.
4. On a new line, fill in the fields as necessary.
5. Choose the Permissions action.
6. In the Permissions window, choose the Start action.
A recording process starts to capture all your actions in the user interface.
7. Go to the various windows and activities in Dynamics NAV that you want users with this permission set to
access. You must carry out the tasks that you want to record permissions for.
8. When you want to finish the recording, return to the Permissions window, and then choose the Stop
action.
9. Choose the Yes button to add the recorded permissions to the new permission set.
10. For each object in the recorded list, specify if users are able to insert, modify, or delete records in the
recorded tables. See step 7 in the "To create or modify permission sets manually" section.
Example - Indirect Permission
You can assign an indirect permission to use an object only through another object. For example, a user can have
permission to run codeunit 80, Sales-Post. The Sales-Post codeunit performs many tasks, including modifying
table 37, Sales Line. When the user posts a sales document, the Sales-Post codeunit, Dynamics NAV checks if
the user has permission to modify the Sales Line table. If not, the codeunit cannot complete its tasks, and the
user receives an error message. If so, the codeunit runs successfully.
However, the user does not need to have full access to the Sales Line table to run the codeunit. If the user has
indirect permission to the Sales Line table, then the Sales-Post codeunit runs successfully. When a user has
indirect permission, that user can only modify the Sales Line table by running the Sales-Post codeunit or
another object that has permission to modify the Sales Line table. The user can only modify the Sales Line table
when doing so from supported application areas. The user cannot run the feature inadvertently or maliciously by
other methods.
1. Choose the icon, enter User Setup, and then choose the related link.
2. In the User Setup window opens, choose the New action.
3. In the User ID field, enter the ID of a user, or choose the field to see all current Windows users in the system.
4. Fill in the fields as necessary.
See Also
Getting Ready for Doing Business
Setup and Administration in Dynamics NAV
Welcome to Dynamics NAV
Working with Dynamics NAV
Creating Microsoft Dynamics NAV Users
Use Job Queues to Schedule Tasks
8/13/2018 • 5 minutes to read • Edit Online
Job queues in Dynamics NAV enables users to schedule and run specific reports and codeunits. You can set jobs to
run one time, or on a recurring basis. For example, you might want to run the Salesperson - Sales Statistics
report weekly, to track sales by salesperson each week, or you might want to run the Process Service E -mail
Queue codeunit daily, to make sure pending email messages to customers regarding their service orders are sent
out in a timely manner.
NOTE
When you schedule a document for posting and the posting process begins, the posting routine is automatically configured
to time out within two hours if the posting routine stops responding for any reason.
You set up this use of the job queue in the Sales & Receivables Setup window or the Purchases & Payables
window, respectively. On the Background Posting FastTab, you choose the Post Documents via Job Queue
check box and then fill in the relevant information. Here you can also use the Job Queue Category Code field to
run all job queue entries with that code. For example, you can use a SalesPost category that filters to all sales
orders that match any job queue that has the same category code.
IMPORTANT
If you set up a job that will post and print documents, and the printer displays a dialog box, such as a request for credentials
or a warning about low printer ink, your document is posted but not printed. The corresponding job queue entry eventually
times out and the Status field is set to Error. Accordingly, we recommend that you do not use a printer setup that requires
interaction with the display of printer dialog boxes in conjunction with background posting.
Security
Job queue entries run based on permissions. Those permissions must allow the execution of the report or
codeunit.
When a job queue is activated manually, it is run with the credentials of the user. When a job queue is activated as a
scheduled task, it is run with the credentials of the server instance. When a job is run, it is run with the credentials
of the job queue that activates it. However, the user who created that job queue entry must also have permissions.
When a job is “run in user session” (such as during background posting), it is run with the credentials of the user
who created that job.
IMPORTANT
If you use the SUPER permissions set that comes with Dynamics NAV, you and your users have permissions to run all
objects. In this case, access for each user is only limited by permissions for data.
See Also
Setup and Administration in Dynamics NAV
Setting Up Dynamics NAV
How to: Publish a Web Service
8/13/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Web services are a lightweight way to make application functionality available to a variety of external systems and
users. Dynamics NAV includes an number of objects that are exposed as web services by default due to integration
with other Microsoft services, but you can also add other web services.
You can set up a web service in the Windows client or in the Web client. You must then publish the web service so
that it is available to service requests over the network. Users can discover web services by pointing a browser at
the server location and requesting a list of available services. When you publish a web service, it is immediately
available over the network for authenticated users. All authorized users can access metadata for web services, but
only users who have sufficient permissions can access actual data.
NOTE
Codeunit and Page are valid types for SOAP web services. Page and Query are valid types for OData web services.
Also, if the database contains multiple companies, you can choose an object ID that is specific to one of the
companies.
Finally, the service name is visible to consumers of your web service and is the basis for identifying and distinguishing
web services, so you should make the name meaningful.
2. Review the information that is displayed in the browser. Verify that you can see the name of the web service
that you have created.
When you access a web service, and you want to write data back to Dynamics NAV, you must specify the
company name. You can specify the company as part of the URI as shown in the examples, or you can
specify the company as part of the query parameters. For example, the following URIs point to the same
OData web service and are both valid URIs.
See Also
Setup and Administration in Dynamics NAV
Classifying Data Sensitivity
5/22/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
To classify the fields that hold sensitive or personal data, a Microsoft partner can set the DataClassification
property on fields. This requires access to the database tables, either through the development environment or by
running a Windows PowerShell script. For more information, see Classifying Data.
As a customer, you can add a second level of classification by specifying sensitivity levels for the data you store in
standard and custom fields. Classifying data sensitivity helps ensure that you know where you keep personal data
in your system, and makes it easier to respond to requests from data subjects. For example, if a contact or
customer asks you to export their personal data. For more information, see Responding to Requests About
Personal Data.
IMPORTANT
Microsoft is providing this Data Sensitivity Classification feature as a matter of convenience only. It's your responsibility to
classify the data appropriately and comply with any laws and regulations that are applicable to you. Microsoft disclaims all
responsibility towards any claims related to your classification of the data.
The following table describes data sensitivity levels you can assign.
SENSITIVITY DESCRIPTION
Confidential Business data that you use for accounting or other business
purposes, and do not want to expose to other entities. For
example, this might include ledger entries.
Normal General data that does not belong to any other categories.
IMPORTANT
When you open the Data Classification worksheet for the first time, it will be empty. You must run the Data Classification
guide to generate the list of fields. To start the guide, choose the Set Up Data Classifications action.
For example, the Data Classification worksheet lets you do things like:
Use the Data Classification guide to export your fields to an Excel worksheet where you can bulk classify them.
Using the Excel worksheet is particularly useful if you are collaborating with a Microsoft partner. After you
update the worksheet, you can use the guide to import and apply the classifications. You can also use the guide
to classify fields manually.
Choose a field and then filter the list to find similar fields that are likely to belong to the same classification as
the field you based the search on.
Investigate a field by viewing its contents.
TIP
We have defined sample sensitivity classifications for the tables and fields in the Cronus demonstration company. You can use
those classifications as inspiration when you classify your own tables and fields.
See Also
Classifying Data
Responding to Requests About Personal Data
5/22/2018 • 3 minutes to read • Edit Online
Data subjects can request several types of actions regarding their personal data. If you have classified the
sensitivity of your data, and are sure they are correct, an administrator can respond to requests by using the
options under Data Privacy on the Manage Users, User Groups, and Permissions Role Center or, if you are
using the Windows client, in the IT Manager Role Center. For more information about classifying data and
classifying data sensitivity, see Classifying Data and Classifying Data Sensitivity.
The following table provides examples of the types of requests you can respond to.
NOTE
While we provide capabilities for responding to these types of request, and thereby accessing, personal data, it is your
responsibility to ensure that personal and sensitive data are located and classified appropriately.
Portability requests A data subject can make a data portability request, meaning,
in part, that you must export the data subject's personal data
from your systems and provide it in in a structured, commonly
used format. To respond to these requests you can use the
Data Privacy Utility to export personal data to an Excel file
or a RapidStart configuration package. Using Excel, you can
edit the personal data and save it in a commonly used,
machine-readable format, such as .csv or .xml. For RapidStart
configuration packages, you can configure master data tables
and their related tables that contain personal data.
Requests for deletion A data subject can request that you delete their personal data.
There are several ways to delete personal data using the
customization capabilities, but the decision and
implementation is your responsibility. In some cases, you may
choose to directly edit your data, for example deleting a
contact and then running the Delete Canceled Interaction
batch job to delete interactions for the contact.
Requests for correction A data subject can request that you correct inaccurate
personal data. There are several ways to do so. In some cases,
you can export lists to Excel to quickly bulk-edit multiple
records, and then import the updated data. For more
information, see Exporting your Business Data to Excel. You
can also manually edit fields that contain personal data, such
as editing information about a customer in the Customer card.
However, transaction records such as general, customer, and
tax ledger entries are essential to the integrity of the
enterprise resource planning system. If you store personal
data in business transaction records, consider using the
customization capabilities to modify such personal data.
NOTE
The Change Log can record details such as when, and by whom, the Parental Consent Received check box was chosen. An
administrator can set that up by using the Change Log Setup guide, and also choosing the Log Modification for Parental
Consent Received check box on the Contact card. For more information, see Logging Changes.
See Also
Classifying Data
Classifying Data Sensitivity
Exporting your Business Data to Excel
Setting Up Finance
8/13/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
To help you get going quickly, Microsoft Dynamics NAV includes standard configurations for most financial
processes. If you need to change the configurations to suit your business, go right ahead. For example, from the
Home page you can use an assisted setup guide to set up sales tax rate for your location.
However, there are some things you need to set up yourself. For example, if you want to use dimensions as a
basis for business intelligence.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Specify the posting groups that map entities like customers, Setting Up Posting Groups
vendors, items, resources, and sales and purchase
documents to general ledger accounts.
Set up a tolerance by which the system closes an invoice How to: Work with Payment Tolerances and Payment
even though the payment, including any discount, does not Discount Tolerances
fully cover the amount on the invoice.
Define how you report value-added tax amounts that you How To: Report VAT to Tax Authorities
have collected for sales to the tax authorities.
Set your Sales and Purchases features up to handle How to: Enable Application of Ledger Entries in Different
payments in foreign currencies. Currencies
Add new accounts to the existing chart of accounts. Setting Up the Chart of Accounts
Set up business intelligence (BI) charts to analyze cash flow. Setting Up Cash Flow Analysis
Enable invoicing of a customer who is not set up in the How to: Set Up Cash Customers
system.
Set up Intrastat reporting, and submit the report to an How to: Set Up and Report Intrastat
authority
Set up different interest rates that you can use on finance How to: Set Up Multiple Interest Rates
charges to charge different interests on late payments
depending on the period.
See Also
Finance
Managing Bank Accounts
Working with Dimensions
Importing Business Data from Other Finance Systems
Analyzing Cash Flow in Your Company
Working with Dynamics NAV
Defining Payment Methods
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Payment methods define how an invoice will be paid. You can set up any number of payment methods. Examples
of payment methods can be BANK, CASH, CHECK, or ACCOUNT. Payment methods are linked to vendors in
order to specify how an invoice from the specific vendor must be paid.
1. Choose the icon, enter Payment Methods, and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short description of the field or link to more information.
See Also
Finance
Working with Dynamics NAV
Setting Up Posting Groups
4/16/2018 • 4 minutes to read • Edit Online
Posting groups map entities like customers, vendors, items, resources, and sales and purchase documents to
general ledger accounts. They save time and help avoid mistakes when you post transactions. The transaction
values go to the accounts specified in the posting group for that particular entity. The only requirement is that you
have a chart of accounts. For more information, see Set Up the Chart of Accounts.
Posting groups are covered under three umbrellas:
General - Define who you sell to and buy from, and what you sell and what you buy. You can also combine
groups to specify things like the income statement accounts to post to, or use groups to filter reports.
Specific - Use sales documents, for example, instead of posting directly to the general ledger. When you create
entries in the customer ledger, corresponding entries are made in the general ledger.
Tax - Define the tax percentages and calculation types that apply to who you sell to and buy from, and what you
sell and what you buy.
The following tables describe the posting groups under each umbrella.
General Business Posting Groups Assign this group to customers and vendors to specify who
you sell to, and who you buy from. Set these up in the Gen.
Business Posting Groups window. When you do, think about
how many groups you'll need to break down sales and
purchases. For example, group customers and vendors by
geographical area, or by the type of business.
General Product Posting Groups Assign this group to items and resources to specify what you
sell, and what you buy. Set these up in the Gen. Product
Posting Groups window. When you do, consider the number
of groups you'll need to break down sales by product (items
and resources) and purchases by items. For example, divide
these groups by raw materials, retail, resources, capacity, and
so on.
General Posting Setups Combine business and product posting groups and choose
the accounts to post to. For each combination of business and
product posting groups, you can assign a set of general
ledger accounts. For example, this means you can post the
sale of the same item to different sales accounts in the general
ledger because customers are assigned to different business
posting groups. Set these up in the General Posting Setup
window.
Customer Posting Groups Define the accounts to use when you post accounts receivable
transactions. If you use inventory with receivables, the general
business posting group assigned to your customer, and the
general product posting group assigned to the inventory item
determine the accounts the sales order lines post to. Set these
up in the Customer Posting Groups window.
SPECIFIC POSTING GROUPS DESCRIPTION
Vendor Posting Groups Define where to post transactions for payables accounts,
service charge accounts, and payment discount accounts. This
is similar to customer posting groups. Set these up in the
Vendor Posting Groups window.
Inventory Posting Groups Define balance sheet inventory accounts. These also provide a
good way to organize your inventory, so you can separate
items by their posting group when you generate reports. Set
these up in the Inventory Posting Groups window.
Bank Account Posting Groups Define accounts for bank accounts. For example, this can
simplify the processes of tracing transactions and reconciling
bank accounts. Set these up in the Bank Account Posting
Groups window.
Fixed Assets Posting Groups Define accounts for different types of expenses and costs,
such as acquisition costs, accumulated depreciation amounts,
acquisition costs on disposal, accumulated depreciation on
disposal, gains on disposal, losses on disposal, maintenance
expenses, and depreciation expenses. Set these up in the FA
Posting Groups window.
Tax Business Posting Groups Determine how to calculate and post sales tax for customers
and vendors. Set these up in the Tax Business Posting
Groups window. When you do, think about how many groups
you need. For example, this can depend on factors like local
legislation, and whether you trade both domestically and
internationally.
Tax Product Posting Groups Indicate the tax calculations needed for the types of items or
resources you buy or sell.
Tax Posting Setup Combine tax business posting groups and tax product posting
groups. When you fill in a general journal line, purchase line,
or sales line, we'll look at the combination to identify the
accounts to use.
See also
The General Ledger and the Chart of Accounts
Setting Up Finance
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Work with Payment Tolerances and Payment
Discount Tolerances
4/16/2018 • 13 minutes to read • Edit Online
You can set up a payment tolerance to close an invoice when the payment does not fully cover the amount on the
invoice. You can set up a payment discount tolerance to grant a payment discount after the payment discount date
has passed.
You can use payment tolerances so that every outstanding amount has a set maximum allowed payment tolerance.
If the payment tolerance is met, then the payment amount is analyzed. If the payment amount is an underpayment,
then the outstanding amount is fully closed by the underpayment. A detailed ledger entry is posted to the payment
entry so that no remaining amount is left on the applied invoice entry. If the payment amount is an overpayment,
then a new detailed ledger entry is posted to the payment entry so that no remaining amount is left on the
payment entry.
You can use payment discount tolerances so that if you accept a payment discount after the payment discount date,
then it is always posted to either the payment discount account or a payment tolerance account.
To set up tolerances
Tolerance on days and amounts allows you to close an invoice even though the payment does not fully cover the
amount on the invoice, whether this is because the due date for the payment discount has been exceeded, goods
have been deducted or because of a minor error. This also applies to refunds and credit memos.
To set up tolerance you have to set up various tolerance accounts, specify both payment discount tolerance and
payment tolerance posting methods and then run the Change Payment Tolerance batch job.
1. Choose the icon, enter General Posting Setup, and then choose the related link.
2. In the General Posting Setup window, set up a debit and a credit sales payment tolerance account and a debit
and a credit purchase payment tolerance account.
3. Choose the icon, enter Customer Posting Groups, and then choose the related link.
4. In the Customer Posting Groups window, set up a debit and a credit payment tolerance account. For more
information, see Setting Up Posting Groups.
5. Choose the icon, enter Vendor Posting Setup, and then choose the related link.
6. In the Vendor Posting Groups window, set up a debit and a credit payment tolerance account.
7. Choose the icon, enter General Ledger Setup, and then choose the related link.
8. Open the General Ledger Setup window.
9. On the Application FastTab, fill in the Pmt. Disc. Tolerance Posting, Payment Discount Grace Period and
Payment Tolerance Posting fields.
10. Choose the Change Payment Tolerance action.
11. In the Change Payment Tolerance window, fill in the Payment Tolerance % and Max Payment Tolerance
Amount fields, and then choose the OK button.
IMPORTANT
You have now set up tolerance for local currency only. If you want Dynamics NAV to handle tolerance on payments, credit
memos, and refunds in a foreign currency, you must run the Change Payment Tolerance batch job with a value in the
Currency Code field.
NOTE
If you want to get a payment tolerance warning every time that you post an application in the tolerance, you must activate
the payment tolerance warning. For more information, see the "To enable or disable payment tolerance warning" section.
To deactivate tolerance for a customer or vendor, you must block tolerances on the relevant customer or vendor card. For
more information, see the "To block payment tolerance for customers" section.
When you set up tolerance, Dynamics NAV also checks if there are any open entries and calculates the tolerance for these
entries.
1. Choose the icon, enter General Ledger Setup, and then choose the related link.
2. In the General Ledger Setup window, on the Application FastTab, select the Payment Tolerance Warning
check box to activate the warning. To deactivate the warning, clear the check box.
NOTE
The default option for the Payment Tolerance Warning window is Leave the Balance as Remaining Amount. The default
option for the Pmt. Disc. Tolerance Warning window the is Do Not Accept the Late Payment Discount.
NOTE
If the customer or vendor has open entries, you must first remove payment tolerance from entries that are currently open.
ALL PMT.
MAX PMT. ENTRIE PMT.
PMT. DISC. PAYME TOLER S DISC. TOL.
PMT. PMT. DISC. TOL. NT ANCE CLOSE TOL.
— INV. DISC. TOL. DATE DATE DATE PMT. TYPE D GL/CL G/L
(1) If payment falls in these ranges, all application entries can be closed with or without tolerance.
(2) If payment falls in these ranges, all application entries cannot be closed even with tolerance.
(2) Payment Date is between 01/16/03 and 01/20/03 (Scenarios 4-9)
Remaining Amount per
Normal Application Rules
(1) If payment falls in these ranges, all application entries can be closed with or without tolerance.
(2) If payment falls in these ranges, all application entries cannot be closed even with tolerance.
(3) Payment Date is after 01/20/03 (Scenarios 10-15)
Remaining Amount per
Normal Application Rules
(1) If payment falls in these ranges, all application entries can be closed with or without tolerance.
(2) If payment falls in these ranges, all application entries cannot be closed even with tolerance.
ALL
PMT. ENTRIE PMT. PMT.
MAX PMT. DISC. PAYME TOLER S DISC. TOL.
PMT PMT. DISC. TOL. NT ANCE CLOSE TOL.
— INV. DISC. TOL. DATE DATE DATE PMT TYPE D GL/CL G/L
(1) If payment falls in these ranges, all application entries can be closed with or without tolerance.
(2) If payment falls in these ranges, all application entries cannot be closed even with tolerance.
(3) Payment Date is between 01/18/03 and 01/20/03 (Scenarios 10-21)
Remaining Amount per
Normal Application Rules
(1) If payment falls in these ranges, all application entries can be closed with or without tolerance.
(2) If payment falls in these ranges, all application entries cannot be closed even with tolerance.
(4) Payment Date is between 01/21/03 and 01/22/03 (Scenarios 22-27)
Remaining Amount per
Normal Application Rules
(1) If payment falls in these ranges, all application entries can be closed with or without tolerance.
(2) If payment falls in these ranges, all application entries cannot be closed even with tolerance.
(5) Payment Date is after 01/22/03 (Scenarios 28-30)
Remaining Amount per
Normal Application Rules
(1) If payment falls in these ranges, all application entries can be closed with or without tolerance.
(2) If payment falls in these ranges, all application entries cannot be closed even with tolerance.
See Also
Finance
Setting Up Finance
Managing Receivables
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Open a New Fiscal Year and Create
Accounting Periods
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Before you can post in a fiscal year, you must open the fiscal year and define its accounting periods.
For many companies, the fiscal year does not coincide with the calendar year. Fiscal periods can be measured in
other units of time, such as months or quarters. You can use the Create Fiscal Year window to set up the
accounting periods that suit your business needs. However,
See Also
How to: Specify Posting Periods
How to: Post the Year-End Closing Entry
Finance
Working with Dynamics NAV
Setting Up to Calculations and Posting Methods for
Value-Added Tax
8/13/2018 • 15 minutes to read • Edit Online
Consumers and businesses pay value-added tax (VAT) when they purchase goods or services. The amount of VAT
to pay can vary, depending on several factors. In Dynamics NAV, you set up VAT to specify the rates to use to
calculate tax amounts based on the following:
Who you sell to
Who you buy from
What you sell
What you buy
You can set up VAT calculations manually, but that can be tricky and time consuming. To make it easy, we provide
an assisted setup guide named VAT Setup that will help you with the steps. We recommend that you use the
assisted setup guide to set up VAT.
NOTE
You can use the guide only if you have created a My Company, and have not posted transactions that include VAT.
Otherwise, it would be very easy to use different VAT rates by mistake, and make VAT-related reports inaccurate.
If you want to set up VAT calculations yourself, or just want to learn about each step, this topic contains
descriptions of each step.
1. Choose the icon, enter VAT Business Posting Group, and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the fields as necessary.
You set up default VAT business posting groups by linking them to general business posting groups. Dynamics
NAV automatically assigns the VAT business posting group when you assign the business posting group to a
customer, vendor, or general ledger account.
1. Choose the icon, enter VAT Product Posting Groups, and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the fields as necessary.
1. Choose the icon, enter VAT Posting Setup, and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the fields as necessary.
1. Choose the icon, enter VAT Product Posting Groups, and then choose the related link.
2. On the VAT Product Posting Groups page, set up a new VAT product posting group for import VAT.
3. Choose the icon, enter VAT Posting Setup, and then choose the related link.
4. On the VAT Posting Setup page, create a new line, or use an existing VAT business posting groups in
combination with the new VAT product posting group for import VAT.
5. In the VAT Calculation Type field, choose Full VAT.
6. In the Purchase VAT Account field, enter the general ledger account to use for posting import VAT. All other
accounts are optional.
NOTE
To enable the EU VAT Reg. No. Validation Service, you must have administrator permissions.
When you use our service connection, we record a history of VAT numbers and verifications for each customer,
vendor, or contact, in the VAT Registration Log, so you can easily track them. The log is specific to each customer.
For example, the log is useful for proving that you have verified that the current VAT number is correct. When you
verify a VAT number, the Request Identifier column in the log will reflect that you have taken action.
You can view the VAT Registration log on the Customer, Vendor, or Contact cards, on the Invoicing FastTab, by
choosing the lookup button in the VAT Registration No. field.
Our service can also save you time when you create a customer or vendor. If you know the customer's VAT
number, you can enter it in the VAT Registration No. field on the Customer or Vendor cards, and we will fill out
the customer name for you. Some countries also provide company addresses in a structured format. In those
countries, we fill in the address too.
NOTE
There are a couple of things to note about the VIES VAT Number Validation service:
The service uses the http protocol, which means that data transferred through the service is not encrypted.
You may experience downtime for this service for which Microsoft is not responsible. The service is part of a
broad EU network of national VAT registers.
Using Reverse Charge VAT for Trade between EU Countries or Regions
Some companies must use reverse charge VAT when trading with other companies. For example this rule applies
to purchases from EU countries/regions and sales to EU countries/regions.
NOTE
This rule applies when trading with companies that are registered as VAT liable in another EU country/region. If you do
business directly with consumers in other EU countries/regions, then you should contact your tax authority for applicable
VAT rules.
TIP
You can verify that a company is registered as VAT liable in another EU country by using the EU VAT Registration Number
Validation service. The service is available for free in Dynamics NAV. For more information, see the section titled Verify VAT
registration numbers in this topic.
IMPORTANT
Before you perform VAT rate change conversion, you can test the conversion. To do so, follow the steps below, but make
sure to clear the Perform Conversion and VAT Rate Change Tool Completed check boxes. During test conversion, the
Converted field in the VAT Rate Change Log Entry table is cleared and the Converted Date field in the VAT Rate
Change Log Entry table is blank. After the conversion is complete, choose VAT Rate Change Log Entries to view the
results of the test conversion. Verify each entry before you perform the conversion. In particular, verify transactions that use
an old VAT rate.
1. Choose the icon, enter VAT Rate Change, and then choose the VAT Rate Change Setup link.
2. Verify that you have already set up the VAT product posting group conversion or general product posting
group conversion.
3. Choose the Perform Conversion check box.
IMPORTANT
Clear the VAT Rate Change Tool Completed check box. The check box is automatically selected when the VAT rate change
conversion is completed.
IMPORTANT
After the conversion, the Converted field in the VAT Rate Change Log Entry table is chosen and the Converted Date
field in the VAT Rate Change Log Entry table displays the conversion date.
See Also
Setting Up Unrealized Value Added Tax
How To: Report VAT to a Tax Authority
How to: Work with VAT on Sales and Purchases
How to: Update Currency Exchange Rates
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
You must set up a code for each currency you use if you buy or sell in currencies other than your local currency,
have receivables or payables in other currencies, or record G/L transactions in different currencies.
As companies operate in increasingly more countries/regions, it becomes more important that they be able to
review or report financials in more than one currency. The program supports use of multiple currencies. Within the
program, your general ledger is set up using your local currency (LCY ), and another currency is set up as an
additional currency, with a current exchange rate assigned.
By designating a second currency as an additional reporting currency, Dynamics NAV will automatically record
amounts in both LCY and this additional reporting currency on each G/L entry and on other entries, such as VAT
entries. When G/L entry amounts are calculated in an additional reporting currency, the information in the
Currency Exchange Rates window is used to find the relevant exchange rate.
WARNING
The Additional Reporting Currency functionality should NOT be used as a basis for financial statement translation. It is not a
tool that can perform translation of foreign subsidiary financial statements as part of a company consolidation. The additional
reporting currency functionality only provides the option of preparing reports in another currency, as if that currency was the
company’s local currency.
See Also
Closing Years and Periods
Working with Dynamics NAV
Setting Up or Changing the Chart of Accounts
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
The chart of accounts shows the ledger accounts that store your financial data. Microsoft Dynamics NAV includes
a standard chart of accounts that is ready to support your business. However, you can change the default
accounts, and you can add new accounts.
NOTE
You can delete a general ledger account. However, before you delete it, the following must be true:
See Also
The General Ledger and the Chart of Accounts
Managing Bank Accounts
Working with Dimensions
Importing from Other Finance Systems
Working with Dynamics NAV
Setting Up Cash Flow Analysis
4/16/2018 • 4 minutes to read • Edit Online
If you want some help to decide what to do with your cash, have a look at the charts on the Accountant Role
Center:
Cash Cycle
Income & Expense
Cash Flow
Cash Flow Forecasts
This topic describes where the data in the charts comes from and, if necessary, what to do to start using the charts.
Note It's a good idea to keep the calculations that are provided for the account schedule.
Enter accounts in the Totaling field for Total Revenue, Total Receivables, Total Payables, and Total
Inventory. To map to a range of accounts, or more than one specific account, enter the account numbers
separated by ".." or by a vertical bar, respectively. For example, 1111..4444 or 2222|3333|5555.
Tip Verify your mapping by choosing the Overview action.
NOTE
Alternatively, you can use your own predictive web service. For more information, see Create and use your own predictive
web service for cash flow forecasts.
TIP
Consider the length of the periods that the service will use in its calculations. The more data you provide, the more accurate
the predictions will be. Also, watch out for large variances in periods. They will also impact predictions. If Cortana Intelligence
does not find enough data, or the data varies a lot, the service will not make a prediction.
Create and use your own predictive web service for cash flow forecasts
You can also create your own predictive web service based on a public model named Forecasting model for
Microsoft Dynamics NAV. This predictive model is available online in the Cortana Intelligence Gallery. To use
the model, follow these steps:
1. Open a browser and go to the Cortana Intelligence Gallery.
2. Search for Forecasting Model for Microsoft Dynamics NAV, and then open the model in Azure Machine
Learning Studio.
3. Use your Microsoft account to sign up for a workspace, and then copy the model.
4. Run the model, and publish it as a web service.
5. Make a note of the API URL and API key. You will use these credentials for a cash flow setup.
6. Choose the icon, enter Cash Flow Setup, and then choose the related link.
7. Expand the Cortana Intelligence FastTab, and then fill in the fields.
See Also
Analyzing Cash Flow in Your Company
Setting Up Finance
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Set Up Cash Customers
8/13/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
You cannot create an invoice without a customer number. This is true, even if you make a cash sale and do not have
anything to record in a customer account.
NOTE
You may have chosen a posting group that is also used for domestic credit sales. If you want to maintain separate data on
cash sales, for example, with a special sales or receivables account, you can set up an extra posting group for this purpose.
You must enter a number for a receivables account for the posting group, even though the balance in this account will
always be 0 after you post an invoice.
See Also
Managing Receivables
How to: Register New Customers
Finance
How To: Set Up and Report Intrastat
8/13/2018 • 6 minutes to read • Edit Online
All companies in the European Union must report their trade with other EU countries/regions. You must report the
movement of goods to the statistics authorities in your country/region every month, and the report must be
delivered to the tax authorities. This is referred to as Intrastat Reporting. You use the Intrastat Journal page to
complete periodic Intrastat reports.
NOTE
We recommended that you set up an Intrastat journal batch for each month.
1. Choose the icon, enter Intrastat Journal Templates, and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short description of the field or link to more information..
Create a template for each Intrastat form you use.
3. To create batches, choose the Navigate tab, and then choose Batches.
4. Fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short description of the field or link to more information..
Create a template for each Intrastat form you use..
NOTE
In the Statistics Period field, enter the statistics period as a four-digit number, where the first two digits represent the year
and the next two digits represent the month. For example, enter 1706 for June, 2017.
1. Choose the icon, enter Commodity Codes, and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short description of the field or link to more information.
3. To assign a commodity code to an item, go to the Item Card page, expand the Costs & Posting FastTab, and
then enter the code in the Commodity Code field.
To set up transaction nature codes
1. Choose the icon, enter Transaction Nature Codes, and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short description of the field or link to more information.
TIP
If you frequently use a particular transaction nature code, you can make it the default. To do this, go to the Intrastat Setup
page, and choose the code.
To Report Intrastat
After you fill in the Intrastat journal, you can print the Checklist report to make sure that that all information in the
journal is correct. Afterward, you can print an Intrastat report as a form, or create a file to submit to the tax
authority in your country/region.
To fill in Intrastat journals
1. Choose the icon, enter Intrastat Journal and then choose the related link.
2. On the Intrastat Journal page, in the Batch Name field, choose the relevant journal batch, and then Choose
the OK button.
3. Choose the Suggest Lines action. The Starting Date and Ending Date fields will already contain the dates
specified for the statistics period on the journal batch.
4. In the Cost Regulation % field, you can enter a percentage to cover transport and insurance. If you enter a
percentage, the content of the Statistical Value field in the journal is proportionally higher.
5. Choose OK to start the batch job.
The batch job retrieves all the item entries in the statistics period and inserts them as lines in the Intrastat journal.
You can edit the lines if needed.
IMPORTANT
The batch job retrieves only the entries that contain a country/region code for which an Intrastat code has been entered on
the Countries/Regions page. Therefore, you must enter Intrastat codes for the country/region codes for which you will run
the batch job.
1. Choose the icon, enter Intrastat Journals, and then choose the related link.
2. On the Intrastat Journal page, choose the relevant journal batch in the Batch Name field.
3. If you have not already done this, fill in the journal manually or choose Suggest Lines.
4. Choose the Prints Intrastat Journal action.
5. On the Intrastat Jnl. Line FastTab, add a Type filter and then specify whether this is a Receipt or a Shipment.
6. Choose Send to to print the report.
How to: Report Intrastat in a file
You can submit the Intrastat report as a file. Before creating the file, you can print a checklist that contains the same
information that will be in the file.
1. Choose the icon, enter Intrastat Journal, and then choose the related link.
2. In the Intrastat Journal window, select the relevant journal batch in the Batch Name field.
3. If you have not already done this, fill in the journal manually or by choosing Suggest Lines.
4. Choose the Create File action.
5. In the batch job window, Choose the OK button.
6. Choose Save.
7. Browse to the location where you want to save the file, enter the file name, and then choose Save.
1. Choose the icon, enter Intrastat Journals, and then choose the related link.
2. To view the options, choose the Batch Name field.
3. Choose the journal batches to deleted, and then choose Delete.
See Also
Financial Management
How to: Set Up Multiple Interest Rates
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Multiple interest rates are used for different periods for delayed payments in trade transactions. For example, a
government specifies the maximum interest to be levied for a consumer. This interest rate can be changed twice a
year on 01 January and 01 July. The interest rate between businesses (B2B ) is agreed by the parties and there is
no limit to that customer group. The announced rate is usually four percent more than the normal bank interest.
When you create finance charge terms and reminder terms, for delayed payment penalty, you can specify multiple
interest rates so that the penalty fee is calculated from different interest rates in different periods. For more
information, see How to: Collect Outstanding Balances. For more information, see How to: Collect Outstanding
Balances.
See Also
How to: Collect Outstanding Balances
Setting Up Finance
Setting Up Banking
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Using bank account cards, you can keep track of all your bank accounts, in any currency. After you have set up the
bank accounts, you can also use the check printing option.
To use electronic banking services to import bank statements and export payments, you must set up and enable
the involved services.
TO SEE
Set up bank account cards for each of your bank accounts, so How to: Set Up Bank Accounts
you can keep track of banking transactions.
Set up an external service that enables you to export your How to: Set Up the Bank Data Conversion Service
payments to the bank for processing and import bank
statements as bank files for payment application and bank
reconciliation.
See Also
Managing Bank Accounts
Managing Receivables
Managing Payables
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Set Up Bank Accounts
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
You use bank accounts in the Dynamics NAV to keep track of your banking transactions. Accounts can be
denominated in your local currency or in a foreign currency. After you have set up bank accounts, you can also use
the check printing option.
NOTE
To fill in the Balance field with an opening balance, you must post a bank account ledger entry with the amount in question.
You can do this by performing a bank account reconciliation. For more information, see How to: Reconcile Bank Accounts
Separately. Alternatively, you can implement the opening balance as a part of general data creation in new companies by
using the Migrate Business Data assisted setup. For more information, see Welcome to Dynamics NAV.
1. Choose the icon, enter Bank Accounts, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the card for a bank account that you will export or import bank files for.
3. On the Transfer FastTab, fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short description of the field or
link to more information.
NOTE
Different file export services and their formats require different setup values in the Bank Account Card window. You will be
informed about wrong or missing setup values as you try to export the file. So read the short descriptions of the fields
carefully or refer to the related procedure topics. For example, exporting a payment file for North American electronic funds
transfer (EFT) requires that both the Last Remittance Advice No. field and the Transit No. field are filled in. For more
information, see How to: Export Payments to a Bank File.
1. Choose the icon, enter Vendors, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the card for a vendor whose bank account you will export payment bank files to.
3. Choose the Bank Accounts action.
4. In the Vendor Bank Account Card window, on the Transfer FastTab, fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a
field to read a short description of the field or link to more information.
See Also
Setting Up Banking
Managing Bank Accounts
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Set Up the Bank Data Conversion Service
8/13/2018 • 3 minutes to read • Edit Online
A global provider of services to convert payment information to any data format that your bank requires is
connected and ready to be enabled in Dynamics NAV. This is referred to in Dynamics NAV as the bank data
conversion service.
You can export payment lines from the Payment Journal window to a file or a data stream that you then upload
to your bank for automatic processing so that you do not have to make electronic payments individually. For
more information, see How to: Export Payments to a Bank File.
You can import bank statement files into the Payment Reconciliation Journal window by using the bank data
conversion service to convert a file that you receive from your bank to a data stream that Dynamics NAV can
import. For more information, see How to: Apply Payments Automatically and Reconcile Bank Accounts.
To import or export bank files, you must set up your own bank account and your vendors' bank accounts. For
more information, see How to: Set Up Bank Accounts.
NOTE
The bank data conversion service may impose a limit on the number of lines that can be exported in one file. You will
receive an error message if the limit is exceeded. It is recommended that bank statement files do not exceed 1000 lines as
the processing time in the bank data conversion service may otherwise increase significantly.
NOTE
In the CRONUS International Ltd. demonstration database, the User Name and Password fields are prefilled with
demonstration logon information, which you will replace with your company’s actual information as you sign up for
the bank data conversion service.
3. In the Sign-up URL field, choose the browser button to open the service provider’s sign-up page.
4. On the sign-up page of the bank data service provider, enter the user name and password for your
company’s subscription to the service, and then complete the sign-up process as instructed by the service
provider.
Your company is now signed up for the bank data conversion service. Proceed to enter the user name and
password that you specified for the service in the related setup fields in Dynamics NAV.
5. In the Bank Data Conv. Service Setup window, in the User Name field, enter the same value that you
entered as logon name on the service provider’s page in step 4.
6. In the Password field, enter the same value that you entered in the Password field on the service
provider’s page in step 4.
To encrypt your login information
It is recommended that you protect the logon information that you enter in the Bank Data Conv. Service Setup
window. You can encrypt data on the Dynamics NAV server by generating new or importing existing encryption
keys that you enable on the Dynamics NAV server instance that connects to the database.
1. In the Bank Data Conv. Service Setup window, choose the Encryption Management action.
2. In the Data Encryption Management window, enable encryption of your data.
NOTE
The update of supported bank data formats also occurs when you select or enter a value in the Bank Name - Data
Conversion field on the bank account.
You have now signed up for the bank data conversion service. Proceed to reflect the sign-up information on
every bank account that will use the service.
See Also
Setting Up Banking
Managing Bank Accounts
Working with Dynamics NAV
Setting Up Sales
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Before you can manage sales processes, you must configure the rules and values that define the company's sales
policies.
You must define the general setup, such as which sales documents are required and how their values are posted.
This general setup is typically performed once during the initial implementation.
A separate series of tasks related to registering new customers is to record any special price or discount
agreements that you have with each customer.
Finance-related sales setup, such as payment methods and currencies, are covered in the Finance Setup section.
For more information, see Setting Up Finance.
TO SEE
Create a customer card for each customer that you sell to. How to: Register New Customers
Enable customers to pay through PayPal by choosing the How to: Enable Customer Payment Through PayPal
PayPal logo on sales documents.
Enter the different discounts and special prices that you How to: Record Sales Price, Discount, and Payment
grant to customers depending on item, quantities, and/or Agreements
date.
Set up salespeople so that you can assign them to customer How to: Set Up Salespeople
contacts or measure salespeople's performance as a basis for
calculating the sales commission or bonus.
Specify for individual customers or for all customers how How to: Set Up Document Sending Profiles
sales documents are sent by default when you choose the
Post and Send action.
Set your email up to contain a summary of information in How to: Send Documents by Email.
the sales document that is being sent.
Use an EU web service to verify a customer's VAT registration How to: Verify VAT Registration Numbers
number.
Enter information about the different transportation vendors How to: Set Up Shipping Agents
you use, including a link to their package tracking service.
See Also
Sales
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Register New Customers
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Customers are the source of your income. You must register each customer you sell to as a customer card.
Customer cards hold the information that is required to sell products to the customer. For more information, see
How to: Invoice Sales and How to: Register New Items.
Before you can register new customers, you must set up various sales codes that you can select from when you
fill in customer cards. For more information, see Set Up Sales.
NOTE
If customer templates exist for different customer types, then a window appears when you create a new customer card from
where you can select an appropriate template. If only one customer template exists, then new customer cards always use
that template.
See Also
Sales
Setting Up Sales
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Enable Customer Payments Through
Payment Services
8/13/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
As an alternative to collecting payments through bank transfer or credit cards, your customers can pay you
through their account with payment services, such as PayPal and WorldPay.
After you enable a payment service in Dynamics NAV, a link to the service is available on sales documents that
you send by email to your customers. Customers can use the link to go to the payment service and pay the bill,
directly from the sales document. If you don't want to include the link, for example, if a customer will pay with
cash, you can remove the payment service from the invoice before posting.
The PayPal Payments Standard and WorldPay Payments Standard extensions are installed in Dynamics NAV, and
are ready for you to enable.
NOTE
The Payment Service field is available only if you've enabled the payment service.
See Also
Setting Up Sales
Sales
Customizing Dynamics NAV Using Extensions
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Record Special Sales Prices and Discounts
8/13/2018 • 7 minutes to read • Edit Online
The different price and discount agreements that apply when selling to different customers must be defined so
that the agreed rules and values are applied to sales documents that you create for the customers.
When you have recorded special prices and line discounts for sales and purchases, Dynamics NAV ensures that
your profit on item trade is always optimal by automatically calculating the best price on sales and purchase
documents and on job and item journal lines. For more information, see "Best Price Calculation" section.
Concerning prices, you can have a special sales price inserted on sales lines if a certain combination of customer,
item, minimum quantity, unit of measure, or starting/ending date exists.
Concerning discounts, you can set up and use two types of sales discounts:
Sales Line Discount An amount discount that is inserted on sales lines if a certain
combination of customer, item, minimum quantity, unit of
measure, or starting/ending date exists. This works in the
same way as for sales prices.
Because sales prices and sales line discounts are based on a combination of item and customer, you can also
perform this configuration from the item card of the item where the rules and values apply.
1. Choose the icon, enter Customers, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the customer card for a customer that will be eligible for invoice discounts.
3. In the Invoice Disc. Code field, select a code for the relevant invoice discount terms to use to calculate
invoice discounts for the customer.
NOTE
Invoice discount codes are represented by existing customer cards. This enables you to quickly assign invoice
discount terms to customers by picking the name of another customer who will have the same terms.
TIP
Before you start entering this information in the program, it is a good idea to prepare an outline of the discount structure
you want to use. This makes it easier to see which customers can be linked to the same invoice discount window. The fewer
windows you have to set up, the faster you can enter the basic information.
NOTE
The following describes how the best price is calculated for sales. The calculation is the same for purchases.
1. Dynamics NAV checks the combination of the bill-to customer and the item and then calculates the
applicable unit price and line discount percentage, using the following criteria:
Does the customer have a price/discount agreement, or does the customer belong to a group that
does?
Is the item or the item discount group on the line included in any of these price/discount agreements?
Is the order date (or the posting date for the invoice and credit memo) within the starting and ending
date of the price/discount agreement?
Is a unit of measure code specified? If so, Dynamics NAV checks for prices/discounts with the same unit
of measure code, and prices/discounts with no unit of measure code.
2. Dynamics NAV checks if any price/discount agreements apply to information on the document or journal
line, and then inserts the applicable unit price and line discount percentage, using the following criteria:
Is there a minimum quantity requirement in the price/discount agreement that is fulfilled?
Is there a currency requirement in the price/discount agreement that is fulfilled? If so, the lowest price
and the highest line discount for that currency are inserted, even if local currency would provide a
better price. If there is no price/discount agreement for the specified currency code, Dynamics NAV
inserts the lowest price and the highest line discount in your local currency.
If no special price can be calculated for the item on the line, then either the last direct cost or the unit price from
the item card is inserted.
1. Choose the icon, enter Sales Price Worksheet, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the Suggest Sales Price on Wksh. action.
3. On the Sales Prices FastTab, fill in the Sales Type and Sales Code fields with the original sales prices you
want to copy.
4. In the top section of the request window, fill in the Sales Type and Sales Code with the type and name you
want the sales prices copied to.
5. If you want the batch job to create new prices, select the Create New Prices field.
6. Choose the OK button to fill in the lines on the Sales Price Worksheet window with the suggested new
prices, indicating that they are valid for the selected Sales Type.
NOTE
This batch job only creates suggestions and it does not implement the suggested changes. If you are satisfied with the
suggestions and want to implement them, that is insert them in the Sales Prices table, you can use the Implement Price
Changes batch job, which is found on the Actions tab, in the Functions group, in the Sales Price Worksheet window.
See Also
Setting Up Sales
Sales
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Set Up Salespeople
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Many companies want to follow an individual employee's performance as a basis for calculating the sales
commission or bonus. See, for example, the Salesperson Commissions report. A company may also want to
assign a salesperson to each of their contacts.
When yo have set up a salesperson in the Salespeople window, you can select it in the Salesperson Code field
on all relevant records, such as G/L account, customer, vendor, contacts, and campaign cards. Then, when you post
or set up invoices, credit memos, journal lines, finance charge activities, and so on, the salesperson code is carried
to the resulting ledger entries.
See Also
Setting Up Sales
Sales
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Set Up Document Sending Profiles
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
You can set each customer up with a preferred method of sending sales documents, so that you do not have to
select a sending option every time you choose the Post and Send action.
In the Document Sending Profiles window, you set up different sending profiles that you can select from in the
Document Sending Profile field on a customer card. You can select the Default check box to specify that the
document sending profile is the default profile for all customers, except for customers where the Document
Sending Profile field is filled with another sending profile.
When you choose the Post and Send action on a sales document, the Post and Send Confirmation dialog box
shows the sending profile used, either the one set up for the customer or the default for all customers. In the
dialog box, you can change the sending profile for the sales document. For more information, see How to: Invoice
Sales.
See Also
Setting Up Sales
Sales
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Send Documents by Email
4/16/2018 • 4 minutes to read • Edit Online
To communicate the contents of business documents quickly to your business partners, such as the payment
information on sales documents to customers, you can use the Report Layout feature to define document-specific
content that gets inserted in email bodies automatically. For more information, see Managing Report and
Document Layouts.
To enable emails from within Dynamics NAV, start the Set Up Email assisted setup on the Home page.
You can email practically all document types as attachments to email messages directly from the window that
shows the document. In addition to the attachment, you can set up document-specific email bodies with core
information from the document preceded by standard text that greets the mail recipient and introduces the
document in question. To offer your customers to pay for sales electronically using a payment service, such as
PayPal, you can also have the PayPal information and hyperlink inserted in the email body.
From all supported documents, you initiate emailing by choosing the Send action, on posted documents, or the
Post and Send action, on non-posted documents.
If the Email field in the Send Document to window is set to Yes (Prompt for Settings), then the Send Email
window opens prefilled with the contact person in the To: field and the document attached as a PDF file. In the
Body field, you can either enter text manually or you can have the field filled with a document-specific email body
that you have set up.
The following procedure describes how to set the Sales - Invoice report up to be used for document-specific email
bodies when you email posted sales invoices.
NOTE
If you do not want to specify email settings each time you email a document, you can select the Yes (Use Default Settings)
option in the Email field in the Send Document to window. In that case, the Send Email window will not open. See Step 4.
For more information, see How to: Set Up Document Sending Profiles.
See Also
Managing Report and Document Layouts
How to: Set up Email
How to: Invoice Sales
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Set Up Shipping Agents
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
You can set up a code for each of your shipping agents and enter information about them.
If you enter an Internet address for the shipping agent, and the agent provides package tracking services on the
Internet, you can use the automatic package tracking feature. For more information, see How to: Track Packages.
When you set up shipping agents on your sales orders, you can also specify the services that each shipping agent
offers.
For each shipping agent, you can set up an unlimited number of services, and you can specify a shipping time for
each service.
When you have assigned a shipping agent service to a sales order line, the shipping time of the service will be
included in the order promising calculation, for that line. For more information, see How to: Calculate Order
Promising Dates.
NOTE
If you delete the shipping agent on the order line, the shipping agent service code is also deleted. The contents of fields that
were based in part on the shipping agent service are recalculated.
See Also
How to: Track Packages
Warehouse Management
Inventory
Setting Up Warehouse Management
Assembly Management
Design Details: Warehouse Management
Working with Dynamics NAV
Setting Up Purchasing
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Before you can manage purchase processes, you must configure the rules and values that define the company's
purchase policies.
You must define the general setup, such as which purchase documents are required and how their values are
posted. This general setup is typically performed once during the initial implementation.
A separate series of tasks related to registering new vendors is to record any special price or discount agreements
that you have with each vendor.
Finance-related purchase setup, such as payment methods and currencies, are covered in the Finance Setup
section. For more information, see Setting Up Finance.
TO SEE
Create a vendor card for each vendor that you purchase from How to: Register New Vendors
Enter the different discounts and special prices that vendors How to: Record Purchase Price, Discount, and Payment
grant you depending on item, quantities, and/or date Agreements
See Also
Purchasing
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Register New Vendors
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Vendors provide the products that you sell. Each vendor that you purchase from must be registered as a vendor
card.
Before you can register new vendors, you must set up various purchase codes that you can select from when you
fill vendor cards. When all of the required master data is created, you can perform additional configuration of the
vendor, such as prioritize the vendor for payment purposes and list items that the vendor and other vendors can
supply. Another group of setup tasks for vendors is to record your agreements concerning discounts, prices, and
payment methods. For more information, see Setting Up Purchasing.
Vendor cards hold the information that is required to buy products from the vendor. For more information, see
How to: Record Purchases and How to: Register New Items.
NOTE
If vendor templates exist for different vendor types, then a window appears when you create a new vendor card from where
you can select an appropriate template. If only one vendor template exists, then new vendor cards always use that template.
NOTE
If you do not know the invoicing address that will be used for every invoice from a vendor, do not fill in the Pay-to field.
Instead, choose the pay-to vendor number after you have set up a purchase quote, order, or invoice header.
The vendor is now registered, and the vendor card is ready to be used on purchase documents.
If you want to use this vendor card as a template when you create new vendor cards, you can save it as a vendor
template. For more information, see the following section.
See Also
Purchasing
How to: Record Purchases
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Record Special Purchase Prices and
Discounts
8/13/2018 • 7 minutes to read • Edit Online
The different price and discount agreements that apply when you buy from different vendors must be defined so
that the agreed rules and values are applied to purchase documents that you create for the vendors.
When you have recorded special prices and line discounts for sales and purchases, Dynamics NAV ensures that
your profit on item trade is always optimal by automatically calculating the best price on sales and purchase
documents and on job and item journal lines. For more information, see the "Best Price Calculation" section.
Concerning prices, you can have a special purchase price inserted on purchase lines if a certain combination of
vendor, item, minimum quantity, unit of measure, or starting/ending date exists.
Concerning discounts, you can set up and use two types of purchase discounts:
Because purchase line discounts and purchase prices are based on a combination of item and vendor, you can also
enter this configuration from the item card, where the rules and values are defined. For more information, see How
to: Register New Items.
1. Choose the icon, enter Vendors, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the vendor card for a vendor that will be eligible for invoice discounts.
3. In the Invoice Disc. Code field, select a code for the relevant invoice discount terms to use to calculate
invoice discounts for the vendor.
NOTE
Invoice discount codes are represented by existing vendor cards. This enables you to quickly assign invoice discount
terms to vendors by picking the name of another vendors who will have the same terms.
1. Choose the icon, enter Purchases & Payables Setup, and then choose the related link.
2. In the Discount Posting field, choose one of the following principles for posting discounts.
TIP
Before you enter this information, it is a good idea to prepare an outline of the discount structure that you want to use. This
makes it easier to see which vendors can be linked to the same invoice discount window. The fewer windows that you have to
set up, the faster that you can enter the basic information.
NOTE
The following describes how the best price is calculated for sales. The calculation is the same for purchases.
1. Dynamics NAV checks the combination of the bill-to customer and the item and then calculates the
applicable unit price and line discount percentage, using the following criteria:
Does the customer have a price/discount agreement, or does the customer belong to a group that does?
Is the item or the item discount group on the line included in any of these price/discount agreements?
Is the order date (or the posting date for the invoice and credit memo) within the starting and ending
date of the price/discount agreement?
Is a unit of measure code specified? If so, Dynamics NAV checks for prices/discounts with the same unit
of measure code, and prices/discounts with no unit of measure code.
2. Dynamics NAV checks if any price/discount agreements apply to information on the document or journal
line, and then inserts the applicable unit price and line discount percentage, using the following criteria:
Is there a minimum quantity requirement in the price/discount agreement that is fulfilled?
Is there a currency requirement in the price/discount agreement that is fulfilled? If so, the lowest price
and the highest line discount for that currency are inserted, even if LCY would provide a better price. If
there is no price/discount agreement for the specified currency code, Dynamics NAV inserts the lowest
price and the highest line discount in LCY.
If no special price can be calculated for the item on the line, then either the last direct cost or the unit price from the
item card is inserted.
See Also
Setting Up Purchasing
Purchasing
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Prioritize Vendors
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Dynamics NAV can suggest various payments to vendors, for example, payments that will be due soon or
payments where a discount is available. For more information, see How to: Suggest Vendor Payments.
First, you must prioritize your vendors by assigning numbers to them.
To prioritize vendors
1. Choose the icon, enter Vendors, and then choose the related link.
2. Select the relevant vendor, and then choose Edit.
3. In the Priority field, enter a number.
Dynamics NAV considers the lowest number, except 0, to have the highest priority. So, for example, if you use 1, 2,
and 3, then 1 will have the highest priority.
If you do not want to prioritize a vendor, leave the Priority field blank. Then, if you use the payment suggestion
feature, the vendor will be listed after all the vendors that have a priority number. You can enter as many priority
levels as necessary.
See Also
Setting Up Purchasing
Managing Payables
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Set Up Purchasers
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
If several purchasers work at your company, you can set them up in a window and assign them each a code. You
can then use the codes to prepare statistics and to filter information in printed reports.
To set up purchasers
1. Choose the icon, enter Salespeople/Purchasers, and then choose the related link.
2. In the Salespeople/Purchasers window, choose New.
3. In the Salesperson/Purchaser Card window, fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short
description of the field or link to more information.
See Also
Setting Up Purchasing
Managing Payables
Working with Dynamics NAV
Setting Up Inventory
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Before you can manage warehouse activities and inventory costing, you must configure the rules and values that
define the company's inventory policies.
You can provide better customer service and optimize your supply chain by organizing your inventory at different
addresses. You can then buy, store, or sell items at different locations and transfer inventory between them.
When you have set up your inventory, you can manage various processes related to item transactions. For more
information, see Manage Inventory and Warehouse Management.
TO SEE
Define the general inventory setup, such as number series How to: Set Up General Inventory Information
and how to use locations.
Configure an efficient distribution model with a combination How to: Work with Responsibility Centers
of different locations and responsibility centers assigned to
business partners or employees.
Organize your inventory at multiple locations, including How to: Set Up Locations
transfer routes.
Create item cards for inventory items that you trade in. How to: Register New Items
As a supplement to item cards, record information about your How to: Set Up Stockkeeping Units
items in a specific location or of a specific variant.
Assign items to categories and give them attributes to help How to: Categorize Items
you and customers find items.
See Also
Managing Inventory
Managing Purchasing
Managing Sales
Working with Dynamics NAV
General Business Functionality
How to: Set Up General Inventory Information
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
You specify your general inventory setup in the Inventory Setup window.
See Also
Set Up Inventory
Manage Inventory
Working with Dynamics NAV
Customizing Dynamics NAV
General Business Functionality
How to: Work with Responsibility Centers
4/16/2018 • 3 minutes to read • Edit Online
Responsibility centers provide the ability to handle administrative centers. A responsibility center can be a cost
center, a profit center, an investment center, or other company-defined administrative center. Examples of
responsibility centers are a sales office, a purchasing department for several locations, and a plant planning office.
Using this functionality, for example, companies can set up user-specific views of sales and purchase documents
related exclusively to a particular responsibility center.
Using multiple locations together with responsibility centers provides the ability to manage business operations in
the most flexible, yet optimal way.
Multiple locations allows companies to manage their inventory in multiple locations using one database. Two
concepts, locations and stockkeeping units, are the cornerstones of this granule. A location is defined as a place that
handles physical placement and quantities of items. The concept is broad enough to include locations such as plants
or production facilities as well as distribution centers, warehouses, showrooms and service vehicles. A stockkeeping
unit is defined as an item at a specific location and/or as a variant. Using stockkeeping units, companies with
multiple locations are able to add replenishment information, addresses, and some financial posting information at
the location level. As a result, they have the ability to replenish variants of the same item for each location as well as
to order items for each location on the basis of location-specific replenishment information.
Responsibility centers extends the multiple locations functionality by providing users the ability to handle
administrative centers. A responsibility center can be a cost center, a profit center, an investment center, or other
company-defined administrative center. Examples of responsibility centers are a sales office, a purchasing
department for several locations, and a plant planning office. Using this functionality, for example, companies can
set up user-specific views of sales and purchase documents related exclusively to a particular responsibility center.
4. Choose the icon, enter Company Information, and then choose the related link.
5. In the Responsibility Center field, enter a responsibility center code.
This code will be used on all purchase, sales, or service documents, if the user, customer, or vendor has no default
responsibility center. On any sales, purchase, or service document, you can enter another responsibility center than
the default.
NOTE
When you enter a responsibility center code on a document, it affects the address, dimensions, and prices on the document.
To assign responsibility centers to users
You can set up users so that in their daily routines the program retrieves only the documents relevant for their
particular work areas. Users are usually associated with one responsibility center and work only with documents
related to specific application areas at that particular center.
To set this up, you assign responsibility centers to users in three functional areas: Purchases, Sales, and Service
Management.
1. Choose the icon, enter User Setup, and then choose the related link.
2. In the User Setup window, select the user you want to assign a responsibility center to. If the user not is on the
list, you must enter a user ID in the User ID field.
3. In the Sales Resp. Ctr. Filter field, enter the responsibility center where the user will have tasks related to sales.
4. In the Purchase Resp. Ctr. Filter field, enter the responsibility center where the user will have tasks related to
purchasing.
5. In the Service Resp. Ctr. Filter field, enter the responsibility center where the user will have tasks related to
service management.
NOTE
Users will still be able to view all posted documents and ledger entries, not just those related to their own responsibility
center.
See Also
Setting Up Inventory
Setting Up Warehouse Management InventoryWarehouse Management
Warehouse Management
Design Details: Warehouse Management
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Set Up Locations
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
If you buy, store, or sell items at more than one place or warehouse, you must set each location up with a location
card and define transfer routes.
You can then create document lines for a specific location, view availability by location, and transfer inventory
between locations. For more information, see Manage Inventory.
NOTE
Many fields on the location card refer to the handling of items in inbound and outbound warehouse processes. For more
information, see Setting Up Warehouse Management.
See Also
Manage Inventory
How to: Transfer Inventory Between Locations
Working with Dynamics NAV
Customizing Dynamics NAV
General Business Functionality
How to: Register New Items
8/13/2018 • 4 minutes to read • Edit Online
Items, among other products, are the basis of your business, the goods or services that you trade in. Each item
must be registered as an item card.
Item cards hold the information that is required to buy, store, sell, deliver, and account for items.
An item can be structured as a parent item with underlying child items in a bill of materials (BOM ). In Dynamics
NAV, a bill of material can be either an assembly BOM or a production BOM, depending on its use. For more
information, see How to: Work with Bills of Material.
NOTE
If item templates exist for different item types, then a window appears when you create a new item card from where you can
select an appropriate template. If only one item template exists, then new item cards always use that template.
If you purchase the same item from more than one vendor, you can connect those vendors to the item card. The
vendors will then appear in the Item Vendor Catalog window, so that you can easily select an alternate vendor.
NOTE
In the Costing Method field, you set up how the item's unit cost is calculated by making assumptions about the flow of
physical items through your company. Five costing methods are available, depending on the type of item. For more
information, see Design Details: Costing Methods.
If you select Average, then the item’s unit cost is calculated as the average unit cost at each point in time after a purchase.
Inventory is valuated with the assumption that all inventories are sold simultaneously. With this setting, you can choose the
Unit Cost field to view, in the Average Cost Calc. Overview window, the history of transactions that the average cost is
calculated from.
On the Price and Posting FastTab, you can view special prices or discounts that you grant for the item if certain
criteria are met, such as customer, minimum order quantity, or ending date. Each row represents a special price or
line discount. Each column represents a criterion that must apply to warrant the special price that you enter in the
Unit Price field, or the line discount that you enter in the Line Discount % field. For more information, see Record
Sales Price, Discount, and Payment Agreements.
The item is now registered, and the item card is ready to be used on purchase and sales documents.
If you want to use this item card as a template when you create new item cards, you can save it as a template. For
more information, see the following section.
1. Choose the icon, enter Items, and then choose the related link.
2. Select the relevant item, and then choose the Edit action.
3. Choose the Vendors action.
4. Choose the Vendor No. field, and then select the vendor that you want to set up for the item.
5. Optionally, fill in the remaining fields.
6. Repeat steps 2 through 5 for each vendor that you want to buy the item from.
The vendors will now appear in the Item Vendor Catalog window, which you open from the item card, so that you
can easily select an alternate vendor.
See Also
Inventory
Purchasing
Sales
Working with Microsoft Dynamics NAV
How to: Set Up Stockkeeping Units
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
You can use stockkeeping units to record information about your items for a specific location or a specific variant
code.
Stockkeeping units are a supplement to item cards. They do not replace them, although they are related to them.
Stockkeeping units allow you to differentiate information about an item for a specific location, such as a warehouse
or distribution center, or a specific variant, such as different shelf numbers and different replenishment information,
for the same item.
NOTE
The information on the Stockkeeping Unit card has priority over the Item card.
See Also
How to: Register New Items
Setting Up Warehouse Management
Warehouse Management
Inventory
Assembly Management
Design Details: Warehouse Management
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Categorize Items
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
To maintain an overview of your items and to help you sort and find items, it is useful to organize your items in
item categories.
To find items by characteristics, you can assign item attributes to items and also to item categories. For more
information, see How to: Work with Item Attributes.
NOTE
If the item category has a parent item category, as indicated by the Parent Category field, then any item attributes that are
assigned to that parent item category are prefilled on the Attributes FastTab.
NOTE
Item attributes that you assign to an item category will automatically apply to the item that the item category is assigned to.
See Also
How to: Work with Item Attributes
How to: Register New Items
Inventory
Working with Dynamics NAV
Setting Up Project Management
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Before you can use Dynamics NAV to manage projects, you must set up resources, time sheets, and jobs.
Then you can create jobs and schedule resources for projects as well as manage budgets and track machine and
employee hours with time sheets. For more information, see Managing Projects.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Set up your resources and the related costs and prices, either How to: Set Up Resources
for individual resources, resource groups, or for all available
resources of the company.
Enable resources to report time usage for an individual or a How to: Set Up Time Sheets
machine and enable a manager to review the usage and its
allocation.
Create job cards and prepare job tasks. Set up prices for job How to: Set Up Jobs
items and job resources and define job posting groups.
See Also
Managing Projects
Finance
Purchasing
Sales
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Set Up Resources
4/16/2018 • 3 minutes to read • Edit Online
To correctly manage resource activities, you must set up your resources and the related costs and prices. The job-
related prices, discounts, and cost factor rules are set up on the job card. You can specify the costs and prices for
individual resources, resource groups, or all available resources of the company.
When resources are used or sold in a job, the prices and costs associated with them are retrieved from the
information that you set up.
You specify the default amount per hour when the resource is created. For example, if you use a specific machine
on a job for five hours, the job would be calculated based on the amount per hour.
To set up a resource
Create a card for each resource that you want to use in projects.
1. Choose the icon, enter Resources, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the New action.
3. Fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short description of the field or link to more information.
1. Choose the icon, enter Resource groups, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the New action.
3. Fill in the fields as necessary.
1. Choose the icon, enter Resources, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the relevant resource card, and then choose the Resource Capacity action.
3. In the Resource Capacity window, in the View By field, specify the length of the period, such as Day, that is
shown on columns on the Resource Capacity Matrix FastTab.
4. For each resource on a line, specify for each period on the columns the number of hours that the resource is
available.
5. Alternatively, to detail the resource's weekly capacity within a starting and ending date, choose the Set
Capacity action.
6. In the Resource Capacity Settings window, fill in the fields as necessary.
7. Choose the Update Capacity action. The Resource Capacity window is updated with the entered capacity.
8. Close the window.
To set up alternate resource costs
In addition to the cost specified on the resource card, you can set up alternate costs for each resource. For example,
if you pay an employee a higher hourly rate for overtime, you can set up a resource cost for the overtime rate. The
alternate cost that you set up for the resource will override the cost on the resource card when you use the
resource in the resource journal.
1. Choose the icon, enter Resources, and then choose the related link.
2. Select the resource for that you want to set up one or more alternate costs for, and then choose the Costs
action.
3. In the Resource Costs window, fill in the fields on a line as necessary.
4. Repeat step 3 for each alternate resource cost that you want to set up.
Note. To set up resource costs that will apply to all resources and resource groups, open the Resource Costs
window and fill in the fields.
1. Choose the icon, enter Resources, and then choose the related link.
2. Select the resource for that you want to set up one or more alternate prices for, and then choose the Prices
action.
3. In the Resource Prices window, fill in the fields on a line as necessary.
4. Repeat step 3 for each alternate resource price that you want to set up.
See Also
Setting Up Project Management
Project Management
Finance
Purchasing
Sales
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Set Up Time Sheets
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Time sheets in Dynamics NAV handle time registration in weekly increments of seven days. You use them to track
the time used on jobs, and you can use them to record simple resource time registration. Before you can use time
sheets, you must specify how you want them to be set up and configured.
After you have set up how your organization will use time sheets, you can specify if and how time sheets are
approved. Depending on the needs of your organization, you can designate:
One or more users as the time sheet administrator and approver for all time sheets.
A time sheet approver for each resource.
When you have set up time sheets, you can create time sheets for resources, assign them to job planning lines, and
post time sheet lines. For more information, see How to: Use Time Sheets.
OPTION DESCRIPTION
Never The user in the Time Sheet Approver User ID field on the
resource card approves the time sheet.
Always The user in the Person Responsible field on the job card
approves the time sheet.
Machine Only If the machine time sheet is linked with a job, then the user in
the Person Responsible field on the job card approves the
time sheet. If the machine time sheet is linked with a resource,
then the user in the Time Sheet Approver User ID field on
the resource card approves the time sheet.
TIP
It is recommended that you designate only one user to be the time sheet administrator for a company. In the following
procedure, you set up a time sheet owner and approver where the time sheet approver is assigned for each resource.
NOTE
You cannot change the ID of the time sheet approver if there are time sheets that have not yet been processed and have
the status of Submitted or Open.
See Also
Setting Up Project Management
Project Management
Finance
Purchasing
Sales
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Set Up Jobs
4/16/2018 • 7 minutes to read • Edit Online
In the Jobs Setup window, you must specify how you want to use certain job features.
On the individual job cards, you must set up prices for job items, job resources, and job G/L accounts, and you
must set up job posting groups.
NOTE
The Apply Usage Link check box is rather complex and is therefore explained in the following section.
NOTE
If the Apply Usage Link check box on the job card is selected, and the Line Type field on the job journal line is blank, then
new job planning lines of line type Budget are created when you post job journal lines. If the Apply Usage Link check box
on the job card is not selected, and the Line Type field on the job journal line is blank, then no job planning lines are created
when you post job journal lines. For more information, see How to: Record Usage for Jobs.
1. Choose the icon, enter Jobs Setup, and then choose the related link.
2. Select or deselect the Apply Usage Link check box.
NOTE
You can make a different setting of the Apply Usage Link check box on the individual job cards. In that case, the setting for
that job overrides the general default described above.
1. Choose the icon, enter Jobs, and then choose the related link.
2. Select the relevant job, and then choose the Resource action.
3. In the Job Resource Prices window, fill in the fields as necessary.
The optional information in the Job Task No., Work Type, Currency Code, Line Discount %, and Unit Cost
Factor fields will be used on the job planning lines and usage journals when this resource is entered and added to
the job.
The value in the Unit Price field for the resource will be used on the job planning lines and job journals when this
resource, a resource assigned to the resource group, or any resource is entered.
NOTE
This price will always override any prices set up in the existing Resource Price/Resource Group Prices window.
1. Choose the icon, enter Jobs, and then choose the related link.
2. Select the relevant job, and then choose the Item action.
3. In the Job Item Prices window, fill in the fields as necessary.
The optional information in the Job Task No., Currency Code, and Line Discount % fields will be used in the
job planning lines and job journals when this item is entered or added to the job.
The value in the Unit Price field for the item will be used on the job planning lines and job journals when this item
is entered.
NOTE
This price will always override the regular customer price (the “best price” mechanism) for items. If you want to use the
regular customer price mechanisms, then you should not create any job item prices for the job.
1. Choose the icon, enter Jobs, and then choose the related link.
2. Select the relevant job, and then choose the G/L Account action.
3. In the Job G/L Account Prices window, fill in the fields as necessary.
The optional information in the Job Task No., Currency Code, Line Discount %, Unit Cost Factor, and Unit
Cost fields will be used on the job planning lines and job journals when this general ledger account is entered and
added to a job.
The value in the Unit Price field for the general ledger job expense will be used on the job planning lines and job
journals when this general ledger account is entered.
NOTE
The necessary accounts in the chart of accounts must be set up before you set up posting groups. For more information, see
Set Up or Change the Chart of Accounts.
1. Choose the icon, enter Job Posting Groups, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the New action, and then fill in the account fields as described in the following table.
WIP Costs Account The WIP account for the calculated cost of the job WIP, which
is a balance sheet capital asset account.
WIP Accrued Costs Account An account for the Cost Value or Cost of Sales method of WIP
calculation, which is a balance sheet accrued expense liability
account. This will be posted to when the WIP adjustment
requires that usage costs posted to the income statement be
increased.
Job Costs Applied Account A balancing account to the WIP Costs Account, which is a
contra for a negative expense account.
Item Costs Applied Account A balancing account to the WIP Costs Account, which is a
contra for a negative expense account.
Resource Costs Applied Account A balancing account to the WIP Costs Account, which is a
contra for a negative expense account.
Costs Applied Account A balancing account to the WIP Costs Account, which is a
contra for a negative expense account.
Job Costs Adjustment Account The balancing account to the WIP Accrued Costs account,
which is an expense account.
G/L Expense Acc. (Budget) The sales account that will be used for general ledger
expenses in job tasks with this posting group. If left empty,
the general ledger account entered on the job planning line is
used.
WIP Accrued Sales Account The WIP account for the calculated sales value of the WIP,
which is a balance sheet Accrued Revenue account. This is
posted to when the WIP adjustment requires the recognized
revenue to be increased.
ACCOUNT FIELD DESCRIPTION
WIP Invoiced Sales Account The account for the invoiced sales value of the WIP that is not
able to be recognized. It is a balance sheet Unearned Revenue
account.
Job Sales Applied Account The balancing account to the WIP Invoiced Sales account,
which is a contra income account.
Job Sales Adjustment Account The balancing account to the WIP Job Sales Account, which is
an income account.
Recognized Costs Account The expense account that contains the recognized costs for
the job. It is a debit expense account ordinarily.
Recognized Sales Account The income account that contains the recognized income for
the job. It is a credit income account ordinarily.
See Also
Set Up Project Management
Managing Projects
Finance
Purchasing
Sales
Working with Dynamics NAV
Setting Up Fixed Assets
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Before you can work with Fixed Assets, you need to define a few things:
How you insure, maintain, and depreciate fixed assets.
How you record costs and other values in the general ledger.
The table below has links to more information. After you set those things up, you can start various activities. For
more information, see Fixed Assets.
NOTE
You can record fixed asset transactions in the Fixed Asset G/L Journal or Fixed Asset Journal windows, depending on
whether the transactions are for financial reporting or for internal management. Help for Fixed Assets only describes how
to use the Fixed Asset G/L Journal window.
When you enable a fixed asset activity in the G/L Integration section in the Depreciation Book Card window,
the Fixed Asset G/L Journal window is used to post transactions for the activity.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Set up default G/L accounts, allocation keys, journal How to: Set Up General Fixed Assets Information
templates and batches for fixed asset posting, and set up
fixed asset classes and subclasses, such as Tangible and
Intangible.
Create depreciation books, define various depreciation How to: Set Up Fixed Asset Depreciation
methods, integrate with the general ledger, and enable
duplication of entries in several depreciation books.
Enable insurance of fixed assets, set up general insurance How to: Set Up Fixed Asset Insurance
information, an insurance card per policy, and prepare
journals to post insurance costs.
Enable maintenance of fixed assets, set up general How to: Set Up Fixed Asset Maintenance
maintenance information, set up maintenance posting
accounts, and define types of maintenance work.
See Also
Fixed Assets
Finance
Welcome to Microsoft Dynamics NAV
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Set Up General Fixed Assets Information
8/13/2018 • 5 minutes to read • Edit Online
Before you can manage fixed assets, you must set up default G/L accounts, allocation keys, journal templates and
batches for fixed asset posting and reclassification, and you can classify fixed assets in classes, such as Tangible
and Intangible.
1. Choose the icon, enter Fixed Assets Setup, and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short description of the field or link to more information.
1. Choose the icon, enter FA Posting Groups, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the New action.
3. In the FA Posting Group Card window, fill in the fields as necessary.
NOTE
To make sure that balancing accounts for different fixed assets postings are automatically inserted when you choose
the Insert FA Bal. Account action on journal lines, follow the next step, based on appreciation posting.
4. On the Balancing Account FastTab, in the Appreciation Bal. Account field, select the general ledger
account to which you want to post balancing entries for appreciation.
For more information about using the Insert FA Bal. Account action on fixed asset G/L journal lines, see, for
example, How to: Revalue Fixed Assets.
1. Choose the icon, enter FA Posting Groups, and then choose the related link.
2. In the FA Posting Groups window, choose the Allocations action, and then choose a posting type.
3. In the FA Allocations window, fill in the fields as necessary.
4. Repeat steps 2 and 3 for each posting type that you want to define allocation keys for.
To set up fixed asset journal templates
A template is a predefined layout for a journal. The template contains information about trace codes, reports, and
number series. For more information, see Working with General Journals.
Dynamics NAV automatically creates a fixed asset journal template the first time that you open the Fixed Asset
Journal window, but you can set up additional journal templates.
1. Choose the icon, enter FA Journal Templates, and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the fields as necessary.
1. Choose the icon, enter FA Journal Templates, and then choose the related link.
2. Select the relevant journal template, and then choose the Batches action.
3. In the FA Journal Batches window, fill in the fields as necessary.
1. Choose the icon, enter FA Reclass. Journal Templates, and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the fields as necessary.
1. Choose the icon, enter FA Reclass. Journal Templates, and then choose the related link.
2. Select the relevant journal template, and then choose the Batches action.
3. In the FA Reclass. Journal Batches window, fill in the fields as necessary.
1. Choose the icon, enter FA Classes, and then choose the related link.
2. Enter codes and names for the classes that you want to create.
1. Choose the icon, enter FA Subclasses, and then choose the related link.
2. Enter codes and names for the classes that you want to create.
1. Choose the icon, enter FA locations, and then choose the related link.
2. Enter codes and names for the fixed asset locations that you want to create.
See Also
Setting Up Fixed Assets
Fixed Assets
Finance
Welcome to Microsoft Dynamics NAV
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Set Up Fixed Asset Depreciation
8/13/2018 • 4 minutes to read • Edit Online
You can use various methods of depreciation for preparing financial statements and income tax returns. Many
large corporations use straight-line depreciation in their financial statements because this generally permits
reporting higher earnings. For income tax purposes, however, many businesses use an accelerated depreciation
method. For more information, see Depreciation Methods.
When you have created the relevant depreciation books, you must assign one or more depreciation books to each
fixed asset. A depreciation book that is assigned to a fixed asset is referred to as a fixed asset depreciation book.
Accordingly, the window for assigned depreciation books is called FA Depreciation Books.
1. Choose the icon, enter Depreciation Books, and then choose the related link.
2. In the Depreciation Books List window, choose the New action.
3. In the Depreciation Book Card window, fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short
description of the field or link to more information.
NOTE
You can record fixed asset transactions in the Fixed Asset G/L Journal window or in the Fixed Asset Journal
window, depending on whether the transactions are for financial reporting or for internal management. Follow the
next step to define which type of journal is used for the different fixed asset activities by default.
4. On the Integration FastTab, select the check box for each fixed asset activity whose transactions you want
to post using the Fixed Asset G/L Journal window.
5. Repeat steps 2 through 4 for each depreciation method or posting method that you want to assign to fixed
assets as a depreciation book.
1. Choose the icon, enter Fixed Assets, and then choose the related link.
2. Select the fixed asset that you want to set up a assign a depreciation book to, and then choose the Edit
action.
3. In the Depreciation Book Card window, choose the Create FA Depreciation Books action.
4. In the Create FA Depreciation Books window, fill in the Depreciation Book field.
5. Choose the Copy from FA No. field, and then select the fixed asset number that you want to use as the
basis for creating new fixed asset depreciation books.
If you fill in this field, the depreciation fields in the new fixed asset depreciation books will contain the same
information as the corresponding fields in the fixed asset depreciation book that you copy from. Leave the
field blank if you want to create new fixed asset depreciation books with empty depreciation fields.
6. On the Fixed Asset FastTab, you can set a filter to select the assets that you want to create the fixed asset
depreciation books for.
7. Choose the OK button.
1. Choose the icon, enter Depreciation Books, and then choose the related link.
2. Select the depreciation book that you want to set up, and them choose the FA Posting Type Setup action.
3. In the FA Posting Type Setup window, fill in the fields as necessary.
NOTE
You cannot insert or delete lines in the FA Posting Type Setup window. You can only modify the existing lines.
We recommend that you do not change the setup for depreciation books for entries that have already been
posted. Changes will not affect the entries that are already posted, which would make depreciation book
statistics misleading.
1. Choose the icon, enter Depreciation Books, and then choose the related link.
2. Select the depreciation book that you want to define default journals for, and then choose the FA Journal
Setup action.
3. If you want to have a default setup for each user, choose the User ID field to select from the Users window.
4. In the other fields, select the journal template or journal batch that must be used by default.
See Also
Setting Up Fixed Assets
Fixed Assets
Finance
Welcome to Microsoft Dynamics NAV
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Set Up Fixed Asset Insurance
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
To manage fixed asset insurance coverage, you must first set up some general insurance information and an
insurance card per policy.
1. Choose the icon, enter FA Setups, and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short description of the field or link to more information.
1. Choose the icon, enter Insurance Types, and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the fields as necessary.
1. Choose the icon, enter Insurance, and then choose the related link.
2. In the Insurance window, choose the New action to create a new insurance card.
3. Fill in the fields as necessary.
1. Choose the icon, enter Insurance Journal Templates, and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the fields as necessary.
1. Choose the icon, enter Insurance Journal Templates, and then choose the related link.
2. Select an insurance journal template, and then choose the Batches action.
3. In the Insurance Journal Batches window, fill in the fields as necessary.
NOTE
Numbers have a special function in journal names. If a journal template name or journal batch name contains a number, the
number automatically advances by one every time that the journal is posted. For example, if HH1 is entered in the Name
field, the journal name will change to HH2 after the journal named HH1 has been posted.
See Also
Setting Up Fixed Assets
Fixed Assets
Finance
Welcome to Microsoft Dynamics NAV
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Set Up Fixed Asset Maintenance
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
To manage fixed asset maintenance, you must first set up some general maintenance information, a posting
account for maintenance costs, and maintenance codes for types of work, such as Routine Service or Repair.
1. Choose the icon, enter Fixed Assets, and then choose the related link.
2. Select the fixed asset that you to define insurance coverage for, and then choose the Edit action.
3. On the Maintenance FastTab, fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short description of the
field or link to more information.
1. Choose the icon, enter Maintenance, and then choose the related link.
2. In the Maintenance window, set up codes for different types of maintenance work.
1. Choose the icon, enter FA Posting Groups, and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the Maintenance Expense Account field for each posting group.
NOTE
To define that maintenance costs are allocated to departments or projects, set up an allocation keys. For more information,
see How to: Set Up General Fixed Assets Features.
See Also
Setting Up Fixed Assets
Fixed Assets
Finance
Welcome to Microsoft Dynamics NAV
Working with Dynamics NAV
Setting Up Warehouse Management
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
A company's distribution strategy is reflected in the configuration of its warehouse processes. This includes
defining how different items are handled in different warehouse locations, such as the degree of bin control
and the extend of workflow required between warehouse activities.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Get an overview of the capabilities of basic versus advanced Design Details: Warehouse Overview
warehouse functionality.
Set up eight different bin types, such as Picking Bin, to How to: Set Up Bin Types
define the flow activities that relate to each bin type.
Create bins, either manually or automatically, with How to: Create Bins
information, such as name, number series, and category,
according to a bin template.
Define which items you want to store in any given bin and How to: Create Bin Contents
set the rules that decide when to fill the bin with a
particular item.
Set an item up to always be placed in a specific bin. How to: Assign Default Bins to Items
Create templates to govern where and how items are put How to: Set Up Put-away Templates
away during directed put-away.
Set users up as warehouse employees at specific locations. How to: Set Up Warehouse Employees
Define different types of bins across the warehouse to How to: Set Up Locations to Use Bins
control where items are placed according to their type,
rank, or handling level.
Make additional settings to an existing location to enable it How to: Convert Existing Locations to Warehouse Locations
for warehouse activities.
Enable picking, moving, and putting away for assembly or How to: Set Up Basic Warehouses with Operations Areas
production orders in basic warehouse configurations.
Set items and locations up for the most advanced scope of How to: Set Up Items and Locations for Directed Put-away
warehouse management where all activities must follow a and Pick
strict workflow.
Define when and how items in warehouse locations are How to: Count, Adjust, or Reclassify Inventory
counted for maintenance or financial reporting purposes.
Enable warehouse workers to break a larger unit of How to: Enable Automatic Breaking Bulk with Directed Put-
measure into smaller units of measure to fulfill the needs of away and Pick
source documents.
TO SEE
Set up the warehouse to automatically suggest items to be How to: Enable Picking by FEFO
picked that expire first.
Integrate bar code readers to your warehouse Use Automated Data Capture Systems (ADCS)
management solution.
Get tips on how to reorganize locations, bins, or zones to How to: Restructure Warehouses
obtain more efficient warehouse activities.
See Also
Warehouse Management
Inventory
Assembly Management
Design Details: Warehouse Management
Working with Dynamics NAV
Design Details: Warehouse Overview
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
To support the physical handling of items on the zone and bin level, all information must be traced for each
transaction or movement in the warehouse. This is managed in the Warehouse Entry table. Each transaction is
stored in a warehouse register.
Warehouse documents and a warehouse journal are used to register item movements in the warehouse. Every
time that an item in the warehouse is moved, received, put away, picked, shipped, or adjusted, warehouse entries
are registered to store the physical information about zone, bin, and quantity. For more information, see Design
Details: Inbound Warehouse Flow.
The Bin Content table is used to handle all the different dimensions of the contents of a bin per item, such as unit
of measure, maximum quantity, and minimum quantity. The Bin Content table also contains flow fields to the
warehouse entries, warehouse instructions, and warehouse journal lines, which ensures that the availability of an
item per bin and a bin for an item can be calculated quickly. For more information, see Design Details: Availability
in the Warehouse.
When item postings occur outside the warehouse module, a default adjustment bin per location is used to
synchronize warehouse entries with inventory entries. During physical inventory of the warehouse, any differences
between the calculated and counted quantities are recorded in the adjustment bin and then posted as correcting
item ledger entries. For more information, see Design Details: Integration with Inventory.
The following illustration outlines typical warehouse flows.
Basic or Advanced Warehousing
Warehouse functionality in Dynamics NAV can be implemented in different complexity levels, depending on a
company’s processes and order volume. The main difference is that activities are performed order-by-order in
basic warehousing when they are consolidated for multiple orders in advanced warehousing.
To differentiate between the different complexity levels, this documentation refers to two general denominations,
Basic and Advanced Warehousing. This simple differentiation covers several different complexity levels as defined
by product granules and location setup, each supported by different UI documents. For more information, see
Design Details: Warehouse Setup.
NOTE
The most advanced level of warehousing is referred to as “WMS installations” in this documentation, since this level requires
the most advanced granule, Warehouse Management Systems.
The following different UI documents are used in basic and advanced warehousing.
Basic UI Documents
Inventory Put-away
Inventory Pick
Inventory Movement
Item Journal
Item Reclassification Journal
(Various reports)
Advanced UI Documents
Warehouse Receipt
Put-away Worksheet
Warehouse Put-away
Pick Worksheet
Warehouse Pick
Movement Worksheet
Warehouse Movement
Internal Whse. Pick
Internal Whse. Put-away
Bin Creation Worksheet
Bin Content Creation Worksheet
Whse. Item Journal
Whse. Item Reclass. Journal
(Various reports)
For more information about each document, see the respective window topics.
Terminology
To align with the financial concepts of purchases and sales, Dynamics NAV warehouse documentation refers to the
following terms for item flow in the warehouse.
TERM DESCRIPTION
Inbound flow Items moving into the warehouse location, such as purchases
and inbound transfers.
Outbound flow Items moving out of the warehouse location, such as sales
and outbound transfers.
See Also
Design Details: Warehouse Management
How to: Set Up Bin Types
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
You can direct the flow of items through bins that you have defined for particular warehouse activities. You give
each bin its basic flow activities, and thereby define the way the way a bin is used, by assigning it a bin type.
There are eight bin types. You can operate your warehouse with all of the eight possible bin types, or you can
choose to operate with just the RECEIVE, PUTPICK, SHIP and QC bin types. These four bin types enable
suggestions to be made that support the flow of items and allow you to record inventory discrepancies.
NOTE
Bin types are only applicable if you are using directed put-away and pick for your location.
The bin type determines only how a bin is used when processing the flow of items through the warehouse. You
can always override the suggestions for any warehouse document, and you can move items in or out of any bin by
performing a warehouse movement.
The bin types that you can create are listed below.
RECEIVE Items registered as posted receipts but not yet put away.
SHIP Items picked for warehouse shipment lines but not yet posted
as shipped.
PUT AWAY Typically, items to be stored in large units of measure but that
you do not want to access for picking purposes. Because
these bins are not used for picking, either for production
orders or shipments, your use of a Put Away type bin might
be limited, but this bin type could be useful if you have
purchased a large quantity of items. Bins of this type should
always have a low bin-ranking, so that when received items
are put away, other higher-ranking PUTPICK bins fixed to the
item are put away first. If you are using this type of bin, you
must regularly perform bin replenishment so that the items
stored in these bins are also available in PUTPICK or PICK
type bins.
PICK Items to be used only for picking, for example, for items with
an approaching expiration date that you have moved into this
type of bin. You would place a high bin ranking on these bins
so they are suggested for picking first.
BIN TYPE DESCRIPTION
PUTPICK Items in bins that are suggested for both the put-away and
pick functions. Bins of this type probably have different bin
rankings. You can set up your bulk storage bins as this type of
bin with low bin rankings compared to your ordinary pick bins
or forward picking area bins.
NOTE: Unlike all other bin types, the QC bin type has none of
the item handling check boxes selected by default. This
indicates that any content you place in a QC bin is excluded
from item flows.
See Also
Warehouse Management
Inventory
Setting Up Warehouse Management
Assembly Management
Design Details: Warehouse Management
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Create Bins
4/16/2018 • 3 minutes to read • Edit Online
The most effective way to create the bins of your warehouse is to generate groups of similar bins in the bin
creation worksheet, but you can also create your bins individually from the location card. You can also use a
function in the Bin Creation Worksheet window to create bins automatically.
NOTE
As soon as you use a bin, you cannot delete it unless it is empty. But if you want to use another bin-naming system, you can
use the reclassification journal to in effect move your items to a new bin system. This process is manual and takes time,
however, so it is best to set up your bins correctly from the start.
To work with the Bin Creation Worksheet window, you must be set up as a warehouse employee at the location
where the bins exist. For more information, see How to: Set Up Warehouse Employees.
1. Choose the icon, enter Bin Creation Worksheet, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the Calculate Bins action.
3. In the Calculate Bins window, in the Bin Template Code field, select the bin template that you want to
use as the model for the bins you are creating.
4. Fill in a description for the bins you are in the process of creating.
5. To create the bin codes, fill in the From No. and To No. fields in the three categories shown in the window:
Rack, Section,, and Level. The bin code can contain up to 20 characters.
NOTE
The number of characters that you have entered in the three categories for either field, for example, the characters
you have entered in the three From No. fields, plus the field separators, if any, must be 20 or less.
You can use letters in the code as an identifying combination, but the letter you use must be the same in the
From No. and To No. fields. For example, you might define the Rack part of the code as From No. A01
and To No. A10. The program is not set up to generate codes with letter sequences, for example, from A01
to F05.
6. If you want a character, such as a hyphen, to separate the category fields you have defined as part of the bin
code, fill in the Field Separator field with this character.
7. If you want the program not to create a line for a bin if it exists already, select the Check on Existing Bin
field.
8. When you have finished filling in the fields, choose the OK Button.
The program creates a line for each bin in the worksheet. You can now delete some of the bins, for example,
if you have a rack with a passageway through the first two levels of a couple of sections.
9. When you have deleted all unnecessary bins, choose the Create Bins action, and the program will create
bins for each line in the worksheet.
Repeat the process for another set of bins until you have created all the bins in your warehouse.
See Also
Warehouse Management
Inventory
Setting Up Warehouse Management
Assembly Management
Design Details: Warehouse Management
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Create Bin Contents
4/16/2018 • 3 minutes to read • Edit Online
After you have set up your bins, you can set up the bin contents. In other words, you can set up the items you want
to store in any given bin and set the rules that govern filling the bin with a particular item. You can do this
manually in the Bin Contents window or automatically with the Create Bin Content Worksheet window.
NOTE
You can set up several bin contents at the same time in the Bin Content Creation Worksheet window.
1. Choose the icon, enter Bin Content Creation Worksheet, and then choose the related link.
2. On the worksheet header, in the Name field, select the worksheet of the location where you want to create
bin contents.
3. In the Bin Code field, select the code of the bin for which you want to define bin content.
If you are using directed put-away and pick in this location, the fields relating to that particular bin, such as
Bin Type, Warehouse Class Code, and Bin Ranking, will be filled in automatically. This is information
that you need to consider as you define the bin content.
4. Select the item that you want to assign to the bin, and fill in the fields related to the bin content. If you are
using directed put-away and pick, and you want to use the Calculate Bin Replenishment function, fill in
the Max. Qty. and Min. Qty. fields.
To set this bin as the preferred bin for the item even if the bin quantity is 0 and all other put-away criteria
equal, select the Fixed field.
5. Repeat steps 3 through 4 for each item you want to assign to a bin.
6. Choose the Print action to preview and print the bin content you have entered in the worksheet. Continue
to revise the bin content until you are satisfied.
7. When you are ready, choose the Create Bin Content action.
In this worksheet, you can work with a number of bin content lines for a number of bins and thereby obtain a good
overview of what you are putting into various bins in a given zone, aisle, or rack.
See Also
How to: Calculate Bin Replenishment
Warehouse Management
Inventory
Setting Up Warehouse Management
Assembly Management
Design Details: Warehouse Management
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Set Up Put-away Templates
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
With directed put-away and pick functionality, the most appropriate bin for your items at any given time is
suggested, according to the put-away template that you have set up for the warehouse, the bin rankings you have
given to the bins, and the minimum and maximum quantities that you have set up for fixed bins.
You can set up a number of put-away templates and select one of them to govern put-aways in general in your
warehouse. You can also select a put-away template for any item or stockkeeping unit that might have special put-
away requirements.
See Also
Warehouse Management
Inventory
Setting Up Warehouse Management
Assembly Management
Design Details: Warehouse Management
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Set Up Warehouse Employees
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Each user who performs warehouse activities must be set up as a warehouse employee assigned to one default
location and potentially more non-default locations. This user setup filters all warehouse activities across the
database to the employee's location so that the employee can only perform the warehouse activities at the default
location. A user can be assigned to additional non-default locations for which the employee can view activity lines
but not perform the activities.
See Also
Warehouse Management
Inventory
Setting Up Warehouse Management
Assembly Management
Design Details: Warehouse Management
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Set Up Locations to Use Bins
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Bins represent the basic warehouse structure and are used to make suggestions about the placement of items.
When you have created your bins, you can define very specifically the contents that you want to place in each bin,
or the bin can function as a floating bin without specified contents.
To use the bin functionality at a location, you first activate the functionality on the Location card. Then you design
the item flow at the location by specifying bin codes in setup fields that represent the different flows.
NOTE
Before you can specify bin codes on the location card, the bin codes must be created. For more information, see How to:
Create Bins.
You can enable an existing inventory location to use zones and bins and to operate as a warehouse location.
The batch job to enable a location for warehouse operation creates initial warehouse entries for the warehouse
adjustment bin for all items that have inventory in the location. These initial entries will be balanced when
warehouse physical inventory entries are entered after the batch job is run.
You can create zones and bins either before or after the conversion. The only bin that you must create before the
conversion is the one that is to be used as the future adjustment bin.
IMPORTANT
To clear all negative inventory and any open warehouse documents before you convert the location for warehouse handling,
run a report to identify the items with negative inventory and open warehouse documents for the location. For more
information, see Check on Negative Inventory.
NOTE
It is recommended that you run the Create Warehouse Location batch job at a time when it will not impact the daily work
in the system. This job processes each entry in the Item Ledger Entry table, and if there are a large number of item ledger
entries, the job can last several hours.
For those locations that did not use warehouse management documents before the conversion, you must re-open
and release any source documents that were partially received or partially shipped before the conversion.
See Also
Warehouse Management
Inventory
Setting Up Warehouse Management
Assembly Management
Design Details: Warehouse Management
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Set Up Basic Warehouses with Operations
Areas
4/16/2018 • 8 minutes to read • Edit Online
If internal operation areas such as production or assembly exist in basic warehouse configurations where locations
use the Bin Mandatory setup field and possibly the Require Pick and Require Put-away setup fields, then you
can use the following basic warehouse documents to record your warehouse activities for internal operation areas:
Inventory Movement window.
Inventory Pick window.
Inventory Put-away window.
NOTE
Even though the settings are called Require Pick and Require Put-away, you can still post receipts and shipments directly
from the source business documents at locations where you select these check boxes.
To use these windows with internal operations, such as to pick and move components to production, you must
make some or all the following setup steps depending on how much control you need:
Enable the inventory pick, move, and put-away documents.
Define default bin structures for components and end items flowing to and from operation resources.
Make to- and from- bins that are dedicated to specific operation resources to prevent the items from being
picked for outbound documents.
Bin codes that are set up on location cards define a default warehouse flow for certain activities, such as
components in an assembly department. Additional functionality exists to make sure that when items are placed in
a certain bin, they cannot be moved or picked to other activities. For more information, see the "To create
dedicated component bins" section.
The following procedures are based on setting up basic warehouse activities around a production area. The steps
are similar for other operation areas, such as assembly, service management, and jobs.
NOTE
In the following procedure, the Bin Mandatory setup field on location cards is selected as a precondition because that is
considered the foundation for any level of warehouse management.
NOTE
When you use inventory picks, the Bin Code field on a production order component line defines the take bin from
where components are decreased when posting consumption. When you use inventory movements, the Bin Code
field on production order component lines defines the place bin in the operation area where the warehouse worker
must place the components.
5. On the Bins FastTab, in the From -Production Bin Code field, enter the code of the bin in the production
area where finished end items are taken from by default when the process involves a warehouse activity. In
basic warehouse configurations, the activity is recorded as an inventory put-away or an inventory
movement.
Now, production order component lines with the default bin code require that forward-flushed components are
placed there. However, until the components are consumed from that bin, other component demands may pick or
consume from that bin because they are still considered available bin contents. To make sure that bin content is
only available to component demand that uses that to-production bin, you must select the Dedicated field on the
line for that bin code in the Bins window that you open from the location card.
This flow chart shows how the Bin Code field on production order component lines is filled according to your
setup.
To define a default bin structure in the assembly area
Components for assembly orders cannot be picked or posted with inventory picks. Instead, use the Inventory
Movement window. For more information, see How to: Move Components to an Operation Area in Basic
Warehousing.
When picking and shipping sales line quantities that are assembled to the order, you must follow certain rules
when creating the inventory pick lines. For more information, see the “Handling Assemble-to-Order Items in
Inventory Picks” section in How to: Pick Items with Inventory Picks.
For more information, see Assembly Management.
To set up that an inventory movement is automatically created when the inventory pick for the assembly item is
created
1. Choose the icon, enter Assembly Setup, and then choose the related link.
2. Select the Create Movements Automatically check box.
To set up the bin in the assembly area where components are placed by default before they can be consumed in
assembly
The value in this field is automatically inserted in the Bin Code field on assembly order lines when this location is
entered in the Location Code field on the assembly order line.
1. Choose the icon, enter Locations, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the Location you want to set up.
3. Fill in the To-Assembly Bin Code field.
To set up the bin in the assembly area where finished assembly items are posted to when they are assembled to
stock
The value in this field is automatically inserted in the Bin Code field on assembly order headers when this
location code is filled into the Location Code field on the assembly order header.
Bin codes that are set up on location cards define a default warehouse flow for specific warehouse activities, such
as consumption of components in an assembly area. Additional functionality exists to make sure that when items
are placed in a default bin, they cannot be moved or picked to other activities.
NOTE
This setup is only possible for locations where the Bin Mandatory field is selected.
1. Choose the icon, enter Locations, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the Location you want to set up.
3. Fill in the From -Assembly Bin Code field.
To set up the bin where finished assembly items are posted to when they are assembled to a linked sales order
From this bin, the assembly items are shipped immediately, via an inventory pick, to fulfill the sales order.
NOTE
This field cannot be used if the location is set up to use directed pick and put-away.
The bin code is copied from the sales order line to the assembly order header to communicate to assembly
workers where to place the output to ready it for shipping. It is also copied to the inventory pick line to
communicate to warehouse workers where to take it from to ship it.
NOTE
The Assemble-to-Order Shipment bin is always empty. When you post an assemble-to-order sales line, then the bin content
is first positively adjusted with the assembly output. Immediately after, it is negatively adjusted with the shipped quantity.
The value in this field is automatically inserted in the Bin Code field on sales order lines that contain a quantity in
the Qty. to Assemble to Order field or if the item to be sold has Assemble-to-Order in the Replenishment
System field.
If the Asm.-to-Order Shpt. Bin Code is blank, then the From -Assembly Bin Code field is used instead. If both
setup fields are blank, then the last used bin with content is used in the Bin Code field on sales order lines.
The same bin code is in turn copied to the Bin Code field on the inventory pick line that manages the shipment of
the assemble-to-order quantity. For more information, see the “Handling Assemble-to-Order Items in Inventory
Picks” section in How to: Pick Items with Inventory Picks.
1. Choose the icon, enter Locations, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the Location you want to set up.
3. Fill in the Asm.-to-Order Shpt. Bin Code field.
Items in dedicated bins are not protected when they are picked and consumed as production components with the
Inventory Pick window.
1. Choose the icon, enter Locations, and then choose the related link. Select the location that you want to
update.
2. Choose the Bins action.
3. Select the Dedicated field for each bin that you want to use exclusively for certain internal operations and
where you want quantities to be reserved for that internal operation once placed there.
NOTE
The bin must be empty before you can select or clear the Dedicated field.
See Also
Warehouse Management
Inventory
Setting Up Warehouse Management
Assembly Management
Design Details: Warehouse Management
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Set Up Items and Locations for Directed Put-
away and Pick
4/16/2018 • 3 minutes to read • Edit Online
When you set up a warehouse location for directed put-away and pick, you have new functionality available to you
to help run the warehouse in the most efficient way possible. In order to make full use of this functionality, you
provide additional information about the items, which in turn helps to make the calculations necessary to suggest
the most efficient and effective ways to conduct warehouse activities. For more information, see Design Details:
Warehouse Setup.
1. Choose the icon, enter Locations, and then choose the related link.
2. Select the location where you want to use directed put-away and pick, and then choose the Edit action.
3. On the Warehouse FastTab, select the Directed Put-away and Pick check box.
You do not need to fill in any other fields on the location card until later in the setup process.
NOTE
You cannot set up the warehouse to use bins when the location has open item ledger entries.
The next step is to define the type of bins you want to operate. For more information, see How to: Set Up Bin
Types. The bin type defines how to use a given bin when processing the flow of items through the warehouse. You
can assign a bin type to both a zone and to a bin.
You can also define warehouse class codes, if the warehouse carries items that need various storage conditions.
Warehouse class codes are used when suggesting item placement in bins. You assign the warehouse class codes to
product groups, which are then assigned to items and SKUs, or to zones and bins that can accommodate the
storage conditions required by the warehouse class codes.
You are now ready to set up zones, if you want to operate zones in your warehouse. Using zones reduces the
number of fields you need to fill in when you set up your bins, because bins created within zones inherit several
properties from the zone. Zones can also make it easier for new or temporary employees to orient themselves in
your warehouse. Note that flow is controlled by bins, therefore it is possible to operate with bins and only one
zone.
NOTE
If you want to operate without zones, you must still create one zone code that is undefined except for the code.
The next step in setting up the warehouse is to define bins. For more information, see How to: Set Up Locations to
Use Bins.
In addition, you must create put-away templates and counting periods. For more information, see How to: Set Up
Put-away Templates.
See Also
Warehouse Management
Inventory
Setting Up Warehouse Management
Assembly Management
Design Details: Warehouse Management
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Count, Adjust, and Reclassify Inventory
8/13/2018 • 15 minutes to read • Edit Online
At least once every fiscal year you must take a physical inventory, that is, count all the items on inventory, to see if
the quantity registered in the database is the same as the actual physical quantity in the warehouses. When the
actual physical quantity is known, it must be posted to the general ledger as a part of period-end valuation of
inventory.
Although you count all items in inventory at least once a year, you may have decided to count some items more
often, perhaps because they are more valuable, or because they are very fast movers and a large part of your
business. For this purpose, you can assign special counting periods to those items. For more information, see the
"To perform cycle counting" section.
If you need to adjust recorded inventory quantities, in connection with counting or for other purposes, you can use
an item journal to change the inventory ledger entries directly without posting business transactions. Alternatively,
you can adjust for a single item on the item card.
If you need to change attributes on item ledger entries as well as the quantities, you can use the item
reclassification journal. Typical attributes to reclassify include serial/lot numbers, expiration dates, and dimensions.
NOTE
In advanced warehouse configurations, items are registered in bins as warehouse entries, not as item ledger entries.
Therefore, you perform counting, adjusting, and reclassifying in special warehouse journals that support bins. Then, you use
special functions to synchronize the new or changed warehouse entries with their related item ledger entries to reflect the
changes in inventory quantities and values. This is described in specific procedures below where relevant.
NOTE
The item entries are processed according to the information that you specified, and lines are created in the physical inventory
journal. Notice that the Qty. (Phys. Inventory) field is automatically filled in with the same quantity as the Qty. (Calculated)
field. With this feature, it is not necessary for you to enter the counted inventory on hand for items that are the same as the
calculated quantity. However, if the quantity counted differs from what is entered in the Qty. (Calculated) field, you must
overwrite it with the quantity actually counted.
5. Choose the icon, enter Whse. Phys. Invt. Journal, and choose the related link.
6. Choose the Calculate Inventory action. The Whse. Calculate Inventory batch job request window
opens.
7. Set the filters to limit the items that will be counted in the journal, and then choose the OK button.
The program creates a line for each bin that fulfills the filter requirements. You can at this point still delete
some of the lines, but if you want to post the results as a physical inventory, you must count the item in all
the bins that contain it.
If you only have time to count the item in some bins and not others, you can discover discrepancies, register
them, and later post them in the item journal using the Calculate Whse. Adjustment function.
8. Choose the icon, enter Whse. Phys. Inventory List, and choose the related link.
9. Open the report request page and print the lists on which you want employees to record the quantity of
items that they count in each bin.
10. When the counting is done, enter the counted quantities in the Qty. (Phys. Inventory) field in the
warehouse physical inventory journal.
NOTE
In the warehouse physical inventory journal, Qty. (Calculated) field is filled in automatically on the basis of
warehouse bin records and copies these quantities are copied to the Qty. (Physical) field on each line. If the quantity
counted by the warehouse employee differs from what the program has entered in the Qty. (Physical) field, you must
enter the quantity actually counted.
11. When you have entered all the counted quantities, choose the Register action.
When you register the journal, the program creates two warehouse entries in the warehouse register for
every line that was counted and registered:
If the calculated and the physical quantities differ, a negative or positive quantity is registered for the bin,
and a balancing quantity is posted to the adjustment bin of the location.
If the quantity calculated is equal to the physical quantity, the program registers an entry of 0 for both the
bin and the adjustment bin. The entries are the record that on the registering date, a warehouse physical
inventory was performed, and there was no discrepancy in inventory for the item.
When you register the warehouse physical inventory, you are not posting to the item ledger, the physical inventory
ledger, or the value ledger, but the records are there for immediate reconciliation whenever necessary. If you like to
keep precise records of what is happening in the warehouse, however, and you counted all of the bins where the
items were registered, you should immediately post the warehouse results as an inventory physical inventory. For
more information, see the "To enter and post the actual counted inventory in advanced warehouse configurations"
section.
To print the report to be used when counting
1. In the Phys. Inventory Journal window containing the calculated expected inventory, Choose the Print action.
2. In the Phys. Inventory List window, specify if the report should show the calculated quantity and if the report
should list inventory items by serial/lot numbers.
3. Set filters if you only want to print the report for certain items, bins, locations, or dimensions.
4. Choose the Print button.
Employees can now proceed to count inventory and record any discrepancies on the printed report.
To enter and post the actual counted inventory in basic warehouse configurations
1. On each line in the Phys. Inventory Journal window where the actual inventory on hand, as determined
by the physical count, differs from the calculated quantity, enter the actual inventory on hand in the Qty.
(Phys. Inventory) field.
The related fields are updated accordingly.
NOTE
If the physical count reveals differences that are caused by items posted with incorrect location codes, do not enter
the differences in the physical inventory journal. Instead, use the reclassification journal or a transfer order to redirect
the items to the correct locations. For more information, see Item Reclass. Journal or How to: Create Transfer Orders.
2. To adjust the calculated quantities to the actual counted quantities, choose the Post action.
Both item ledger entries and physical inventory ledger entries are created. Open the item card to view the
resulting physical inventory ledger entries.
3. Choose the icon, enter Items, and then choose the related link.
4. To verify the inventory counting, open the item card in question, and then, choose the Phys. Inventory
ledger Entries action.
To enter and post the actual counted inventory in advanced warehouse configurations
1. Choose the icon, enter Item Journal, and choose the related link.
2. Choose the Calculate Whse. Adjustment action.
3. Select the same items that you counted in the cycle counting physical inventory you just performed, and any
other items that require adjustment, and then choose the OK button.
The Inventory Journal window opens and lines are created for these items. Note that the net quantities
that you just counted and registered bin by bin are now ready to be consolidated and synchronized as item
ledger entries.
4. Post the journal without changing any quantities.
The quantities in the item ledger (item entries) and the quantities in the warehouse (warehouse entries) are now
once again the same for these items, and the program has updated the last counting date of the item or
stockkeeping unit.
1. Choose the icon, enter Phys. Invt. Counting Periods, and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short description of the field or link to more information.
To assign a counting period to an item
1. Choose the icon, enter Items, and then choose the related link.
2. Select the item to which you want to assign a counting period.
3. In the Phys Invt Counting Period Code field, select the appropriate counting period.
4. Choose the Yes button to change the code and calculate the first counting period for the item. The next time you
choose to calculate a counting period in the physical inventory journal, the item appears as a line in the Phys.
Invt. Item Selection window. You can then begin to count the item on a periodic basis.
To initiate a count based on counting periods in basic warehouse configurations
1. Choose the icon, enter Phys. Inventory Journal, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the Calculate Counting Period action.
The Phys. Invt. Item Selection window opens showing the items that have counting periods assigned and
need to be counted according to their counting periods.
3. Perform the physical inventory. For more information, see the "To perform a physical inventory" section.
To initiate a count based on counting periods in advanced warehouse configurations
1. Choose the icon, enter Whse. Phys. Invt. Journal, and choose the related link.
2. Choose the Calculate Counting Period action.
The Phys. Invt. Item Selection window opens showing the items that have counting periods assigned and
need to be counted according to their counting periods.
3. Perform the physical inventory. For more information, see the "To perform a physical inventory" section.
NOTE
You must count the item in all the bins that contain the particular item. If you delete some of the bin lines that the
program has retrieved for counting in the Whse. Phys. Inventory window, then you will not be counting all the items
in the warehouse. If you later post such incomplete results in the Phys. Inventory Journal, the amounts posted will be
incorrect.
1. Choose the icon, enter Items, and then choose the related link.
2. Select the item for which you want to adjust inventory, and then choose the Adjust Inventory action.
3. In the New Inventory field, enter the inventory quantity that you want to record for the item.
4. Choose the OK button.
The item’s inventory is now adjusted. The new quantity is shown in the Current Inventory field in the Adjust
Inventory window and in the Inventory field in the Item Card window.
You can also use the Adjust Inventory function as a simple way to place purchased items on inventory if you do
not use purchase invoices or orders to record your purchases. For more information, How to: Record Purchases.
NOTE
After you have adjusted inventory, you must update it with the current, calculated value. For more information, see How to:
Revalue Inventory.
1. Choose the icon, enter Item Journals, and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short description of the field or link to more information.
3. Choose the Post action to make the inventory adjustments.
NOTE
After you have adjusted inventory, you must update it with the current, calculated value. For more information, see How to:
Revalue Inventory.
1. Choose the icon, enter Whse. Item Journal, and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the header information.
3. Fill in the Item No. field on the line.
4. Enter the bin in which you are putting the extra items or where you have found items to be missing.
5. Fill in the quantity that you observe as a discrepancy in the Quantity field. If you have found extra items, enter a
positive quantity. If items are missing, enter a negative quantity.
6. Choose the Register action.
1. Choose the icon, enter Item Journal, and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the fields on each journal line.
3. Choose the Calculate Whse. Adjustment action, and fill in the filters as appropriate in the batch job request
window. The adjustments are calculated only for the entries in the adjustment bin that meet filter requirements.
4. On the Options FastTab, fill in the Document No. field with a number that you enter manually. Because no
number series has been set up for this batch job, use the number scheme set up by the warehouse, or enter the
date followed by your initials.
5. Choose the OK button. The positive and negative adjustments are totaled for each item and lines are created in
the item journal for any items where the sum is a positive or negative quantity.
6. Post the journal lines to enter the quantity differences in the item ledger. The inventory in the warehouse bins
now corresponds precisely to the inventory in the item ledger.
See Also
Inventory Warehouse Management
Sales
Purchasing
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Enable Automatic Breaking Bulk with
Directed Put-away and Pick
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
For locations that use directed put-away and pick, Dynamics NAV can, in various situations, automatically
breakbulk, that is, break a larger unit of measure into smaller units of measure, when it creates warehouse
instructions that fulfill the needs of source documents, production orders, or internal picks and put-aways. To
breakbulk sometimes also means gathering smaller units of measure, if necessary, to meet outbound requests by
breaking the larger unit of measure on the source document or production order into the smaller units of measure
that are available in the warehouse.
Breakbulking in Picks
If you want to store items in several different units of measure and allow them to be automatically combined as
needed in the picking process, select the Allow Breakbulk field on the location card.
To fulfill a task, the program automatically looks for an item in the same unit of measure. But if it cannot find this
form of the item, and this field is selected, the program will suggest that you break a larger unit of measure into the
unit of measure that is needed.
If the system can only find smaller units of measure, it will suggest that you gather items to fulfill the quantity on
the shipment or production order. In effect, it breaks the larger unit of measure on the source document into
smaller units for picking.
Breakbulking in Put-aways
In the warehouse put-away, the program automatically suggests Place action lines in the put-away unit of measure,
for example, pieces, even though the items arrive in a different unit of measure.
Breakbulking in Movements
The program also breakbulks automatically in replenishment movements, if the Allow Breakbulk field is selected
on the Option FastTab in the Calculate Bin Replenishment window.
You can view the results of the conversion process from one unit of measure to another as intermediate breakbulk
lines in the put-away, pick, or movement instructions.
NOTE
If you select the Set Breakbulk Filter field on the warehouse instruction header, the program will hide the breakbulk lines
whenever the larger unit of measure is going to be completely used. For example, if a pallet is 12 pieces and you are going to
use all 12 pieces, the pick will then direct you to take 1 pallet and place 12 pieces. However, if you have to pick only 9 pieces,
then the breakbulk lines will not be hidden, even if you have selected the Breakbulk Filter field, because you have to place
the remaining three pieces somewhere in the warehouse.
NOTE
If you want your units of measure to perform optimally in the warehouse, also in connection with the breakbulk functionality,
you should wherever possible try to:
Set up the base unit of measure for an item as the smallest unit of measure that you expect to handle in your warehouse
processes.
Set up your alternative units of measure for the item as multiples of the base unit of measure.
See Also
Warehouse Management
Inventory
Setting Up Warehouse Management
Assembly Management
Design Details: Warehouse Management
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Enable Picking Items by FEFO
8/13/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
First-Expired-First-Out (FEFO ) is a sorting method that ensures that the oldest items, those with the earliest
expiration dates, are picked first.
This functionality only works when the following criteria are met:
The item must have a serial/lot number.
On the item’s item tracking code setup, the SN -Specific Warehouse Tracking field or the Lot-Specific
Warehouse Tracking field must be selected.
The item must be posted to inventory with an expiration date.
On the location card, the Require Pick check box must be selected.
On the location card, the Pick According to FEFO check box must be selected.
On the location card, the Bin Mandatory check box must be selected.
When all the criteria are met, then serial/lot-numbered items to be picked are sorted with the oldest first in
all picks and movements, except for items that use SN -specific or lot-specific tracking.
NOTE
If some serial/lot-numbered items use specific tracking, then those are respected first and under them, the remaining, non-
specific, serial/lot numbers are listed according to FEFO.
If two serial/lot-numbered items have the same expiration date, then the program selects the item with the lowest
serial or lot number. If the serial or lot numbers are the same, then the program selects the item that was
registered first.
NOTE
When picking serial/lot-numbered items in locations set up for directed put-away and pick, only quantities on bins of
type Pick are picked according to FEFO.
To enable movements according to FEFO, either in the Inventory Movement window or the Movement
Worksheet window, you must leave the From Bin field empty.
If the Strict Expiration Posting field is selected, then only items that are not expired will be included in the pick.
This applies even if you are not using Pick according to FEFO.
See Also
Picking Items
How to: Pick Items for Warehouse Shipment
How to: Pick Items with Inventory Picks
Design Details: Warehouse Management
Inventory
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Enable Automated Data Capture Systems
(ADCS)
4/16/2018 • 5 minutes to read • Edit Online
You can use your automatic data capture system (ADCS ) to register the movement of items in the warehouse and
to register some journal activities, such as quantity adjustments in the warehouse item journal and physical
inventories.
To use ADCS, you must give each item stored in the warehouse an item identifier. You must also set up miniforms,
handheld functions, data exchanges, and specify settings for fields that control ADCS. You specify whether to use
ADCS on the location card of a warehouse.
Based on the needs of your warehouse, you define the amount of information displayed in the miniform setup for
the particular handheld device. The following are examples of information that you can display:
Data from tables within Dynamics NAV, such as a list of pick documents from which the user can select.
Text information.
Messages to show confirmations or errors about activities performed and registered by the handheld device
user.
For more information, see Configuring an Automated Data Capture System in the developer and IT-pro help.
NOTE
We recommend that you do not set up a warehouse to use ADCS if the warehouse also has a bin capacity policy.
1. Choose the icon, enter Locations, and choose the related link.
2. Select a warehouse from the list for which you want to enable ADCS, and then choose the Edit action.
3. In the Location Card window, select the Use ADCS check box.
1. Choose the icon, enter Items, and then choose the related link.
2. Select an item from the list that is part of your ADCS solution, and then choose the Edit action.
3. In the Item Card window, choose the Identifiers action.
4. In the Item Identifiers window, choose the New action.
5. In the Code field, specify the identifier for the item. For example, the identifier could be the item's bar code
number.
You can also enter a Variant Code and a Unit of Measure code.
6. If needed, enter multiple codes for each item.
7. Choose the OK button.
8. To review the information, choose the Identifier Code field to open the Item Identifiers window.
1. Choose the icon, enter ADCS Users, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the New action.
3. In the Name field, enter a name for the user. The name cannot contain more than 20 characters, including
spaces.
4. In the Password field, enter a password. The password is masked.
To specify that a warehouse employee is an ADCS user
1. Choose the icon, enter Warehouse Employees, and then choose the related link.
2. If needed, add a new warehouse employee. For more information, see How to: Set Up Warehouse Employees.
3. Choose the Edit List action.
4. Select a warehouse employee from the list. In the ADCS User field, choose the drop-down arrow, and then
select the name of an ADCS user from the list.
NOTE
The default warehouse for the employee must be one that uses ADCS.
<xsl:template match="Function[.='F6']">
<Function Key1="27" Key2="91" Key3="49" Key4="55" Key5="126" Key6="0"><xsl:value-of select="."/>
</Function>
</xsl:template>
2. In the Dynamics NAV development environment, open table 7702 and add a code representing the new key. In
this example, create a key that is named F6.
3. Add C/AL code to the relevant function of the miniform-specific codeunit to handle the function key.
To customize miniform functions
1. Choose the icon, enter Miniforms, and then choose the related link.
2. Select a miniform from the list, and then choose the Edit action.
3. Choose the Functions action.
4. In the Function Code drop-down list, select a code to represent the function that you want to associate with
the miniform. For example, you can select ESC, which associates functionality with the press of the ESC key.
In the Dynamics NAV development environment, edit the code for the Handling Codeunit field to create or
modify code to perform the required action or response.
For more information, see Configuring an Automated Data Capture System in the developer and IT-pro help.
See Also
Warehouse Management
Inventory
Setting Up Warehouse Management
Assembly Management
Design Details: Warehouse Management
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Restructure Warehouses
4/16/2018 • 4 minutes to read • Edit Online
You may want to restructure your warehouse with new bin codes and new bin characteristics. You will not
undertake this kind of activity very often, but situations can occur where a reclassification is necessary to achieve
or maintain a more efficient operation. For example:
You might want to switch to bin codes that support the use of automatic data capture, for example, with hand-
held devices.
The warehouse may have purchased a new rack system that gives new possibilities in item storage.
The company may have altered its item assortment and moved the warehouse to a new physical location to
accommodate this change.
If your warehouse is set up to use bins but not directed put-away and pick, restructure your warehouse by creating
the new bins that you want to use in the future.
a. Choose the icon, enter Item Reclassification Journal, and then choose the related link.
b. Select a journal line, and then choose the Get Bin Content action.
c. On the Bin Content FastTab, set filters in the Location Code, Bin Code, and Item No. fields to specify
the content that you want to move.
d. Choose the OK button to fill a journal line.
e. In the New Bin Code field, select the bin to which the items should be moved.
f. Repeat steps b through e for all bin content that you want to move.
g. Choose the Post action.
You have now emptied the bins where the items used to be. The default bins for your items have now been
changed to the new bins.
a. Choose the icon, enter Warehouse Reclassification Journal, and then choose the related link.
b. For the bins where no real movement of items is involved, create a line for each of your current bins in
the Warehouse Reclassification Journal with the old bin code, From Bin Code, and the new bin code,
To Bin Code.
c. If some of the movements involve actual physical movements that you want employees to perform, use
Movement Worksheets to prepare movement instructions instead of using the warehouse
reclassification journal. For more information, see How to: Move Items in Advanced Warehouse
Configurations.
3. When the old bins are emptied, reclassify them as QC type bins to ensure that they are not included in item
flows.
a. Choose the icon, enter Locations, and then choose the related link.
b. Select the line with the location, and then choose the Bins action.
c. In the Bins window, in the Bin Type Code field, enter QC for each of the old bins that you emptied in
step 3 in the previous procedure.
You have now removed the bins from the warehouse flow, and reclassified them as QC bins. QC bins have none of
the activity fields in the Bin Types window selected and are therefore not considered by the item flow. For more
information, see How to: Set Up Bin Types.
To delete a bin
1. Choose the icon, enter Locations, and then choose the related link.
2. Select the location where you want to delete bins. Choose the Bins action.
3. Select the lines for the bins that you want to delete.
4. Choose the Delete action.
If you choose the Yes button, the bin is deleted for use in the future, but the bin code in all warehouse entries
remains the same.
If you want to rename a bin so that all records associated with the bin are also renamed, including bin contents,
warehouse activity lines, registered warehouse activity lines, warehouse worksheet lines, warehouse receipt lines,
posted warehouse receipt lines, warehouse shipment lines, posted warehouse shipment lines, and warehouse
entries, you can do so in the Bins window.
NOTE
If you choose Yes and there are many entries concerning this bin, for example, because you have not deleted warehouse
documents for some time, it may take some time to rename all the records. Therefore, if you use this method, consider
running the batch job Delete Registered Whse. Documents before you start the renaming process. Also note that the
only documents that are deleted in this batch job are put-aways, picks, and movements.
If you are renaming a receiving bin or a shipping bin, all the posted receipts or shipments that refer to the bin in question are
renamed.
See Also
Warehouse Management
Inventory
Setting Up Warehouse Management
Assembly Management
Design Details: Warehouse Management
Working with Dynamics NAV
Setting Up Manufacturing
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
To convert material into produced end items, production resources, such as bills of material, routings, machine
operators, and machinery must be set up in the system.
Operators and machines are represented in the system as machine centers that may be organized in work
centers and work center groups. When these resources are established, they can be loaded with operations
according to the item's defined material (BOM ) and process (routing) structure, and according to the capacity
of the machine or work center. You can also set the production capacity of each resource. Capacity is defined
by the work time available in the machine and work centers, and is governed by calendars for each level. A
work center calendar specifies the working days or hours, shifts, holidays, and absence that determine the
work center’s gross available capacity (typically measured in minutes). All of this is determined by defined
efficiency and capacity values.
When you have set up manufacturing, you can plan and execute production orders. For more information, see
Planning and Manufacturing.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Configure the manufacturing features, such as defining The Manufacturing Setup page.
shop floor work hours and selecting planning principles.
Define a standard working week in the manufacturing How to: Create Shop Calendars
department in terms of starting and ending times of each
work day and related work shift.
Organize fixed values and requirements of production How to: Set Up Work Centers and Machine Centers
resources as work centers or machine centers to govern
their output of production performed.
Organize production operations in the required order and How to: Create Routings
assign them to work or machine centers with the required
work times.
Organize production components or subassemblies under a How to: Create Production BOMs
produced parent item and certify the BOM for execution at
work centers.
Make sure that the right component quantity is available How to: Work With Manufacturing Batch Units of Measure
when produced items are stocked in one unit of measure
but produced in another.
Define families of production items with similar How to: Work With Production Families
manufacturing processes to save consumption. For
example, four pieces of the same item can be produced
from one sheet and 10 pieces of another, different, item at
the same time.
Use standard tasks to simplify the creation of routings by How to: Set Up Standard Routing Lines
quickly attaching extra information to recurring operations.
TO SEE
Prepare work centers and routings to represent How to: Subcontract Manufacturing
subcontracted production operations.
See Also
Manufacturing
Planning
Inventory
Purchasing
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Set Up Shop Calendars
4/16/2018 • 4 minutes to read • Edit Online
A work center or machine calendar specifies the working days and hours, shifts, holidays, and absences that
determine the center’s gross available capacity, measured in time, according to its defined efficiency and capacity
values.
As a foundation for calculating a specific work or machine center calendar, you must first set up one or more
general shop calendars. A shop calendar defines a standard work week according to start and end times of each
working day and the work shift relation. In addition, the shop calendar defines the fixed holidays during a year.
The following describes how to set up work center calendars. The steps are similar when setting up machine
center calendars.
NOTE
You can also select to view the capacity values for each week or month by changing the selection in the View By
field in the Work Center Calendar window.
To reflect the new shop calendar as a line on the selected work center, it must first be calculated.
6. Choose the Calculate action.
7. On the Work Center FastTab, you can set a filter to only calculate for one work center. If you do not set a
filter, all existing work center calendars will be calculated.
8. Define the starting and ending dates of the calendar period that should be calculated, for example, one year
from 01/01/14 to 31/12/14.
9. Choose the OK button to calculate capacity.
Calendar entries are now created or updated displaying the available capacity for each period according to the
following three sets of master data:
The working days and shift defined in the assigned shop calendar.
The value in the Capacity field on the work center card.
The value in the Efficiency field on the work center card.
The calculated work center calendar will now define when and how much capacity is available at this work center.
This controls the detailed scheduling of operations performed at the work center.
To record work center absence
1. In the Work Center Calendar window, choose the Show Matrix action.
2. In the Work Center Calendar Matrix window, select the work center and calendar day when the absence
time should be recorded, and then choose the Absence action.
3. In the Absence window, define the starting time, ending time, and description of that day’s absence. For
example:
25/01/01 08:00 10:00 Maintenance
4. Choose the Update action, and then close the Absence window.
The capacity of the selected day has now decreased by the recorded absence time.
See Also
How to: Set Up Base Calendars
How to: Set Up Work Centers and Machine Centers
Setting Up Manufacturing
Manufacturing
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Set Up Work Centers and Machine Centers
8/13/2018 • 7 minutes to read • Edit Online
The program distinguishes between three types of capacities. These are arranged hierarchically. Each level
contains the subordinate levels.
The top level is the work center group. Work centers are assigned to the work center groups. Every work center
can only belong to one work center group.
You can assign various machine centers to every work center. A machine center may only belong to one work
center.
The planned capacity of a work center consists of the availability of the corresponding machine centers and the
additional planned availability of the work center. The planned availability of the work center group is, therefore,
the sum of all corresponding availabilities of the machine centers and work centers.
The availability is stored in calendar entries. Before you set up work or machine centers, you must set up shop
calendars. For more information, see How to: Create Shop Calendars.
1. Choose the icon, enter Work Centers, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the New action.
3. Fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short description of the field or link to more
information.
4. In the Work Center Group field, select the higher-level resource grouping that the work center is
organized under, if relevant. Choose the New action in the drop-down list.
5. Select the Blocked field if you want to prevent the work center from being used in any processing. This
means that output cannot be posted for an item that is produced at the work center. For more information,
see How to: Post Production Output.
6. In the Direct Unit Cost field, enter the cost of producing one unit of measure at this work center, excluding
any other cost elements. This cost is often referred to as the direct labor rate.
7. In the Indirect Cost % field, enter the general operation costs of using the work center as a percentage of
the direct unit cost. This percentage amount is added to the direct cost in the calculation of the unit cost.
8. In the Overhead Rate field, enter any non-operational costs, for example maintenance expenses, of the
work center as an absolute amount.
The Unit Cost field contains the calculated unit cost of producing one unit of measure at this work center,
including all cost elements, as follows:
Unit Cost = Direct Unit Cost + (Direct Unit Cost x Indirect Cost %) + Overhead Rate.
9. In the Unit Cost Calculation field, define whether the above calculation should be based on the amount of
time used: Time, or on the number of produced units: Units.
10. Select the Specific Unit Cost field if you want to define the work center’s unit cost on the routing line
where it is being used. This may be relevant for operations with dramatically different capacity costs than
what would normally be processed at that work center.
11. In the Flushing Method field, select whether output posting at this work center should be calculated and
posted manually or automatically, using either of the following methods.
OPTION DESCRIPTION
NOTE
If necessary, the flushing method selected here and on the Item card, can be overridden for individual operations by
changing the setting on routing lines.
12. In the Unit of Measure Code field, enter the time unit in which this work center’s cost calculation and
capacity planning are made. In order to be able to constantly monitor consumption, you must first set up a
method of measure. The units you enter are basic units. For example, the processing time is measured in
hours and minutes.
NOTE
If you select to use Days then remember that 1 day = 24 hours - and not 8 (working hours).
13. In the Capacity field, define whether the work center has more than one machine or person working at the
same time. If your Dynamics NAV installation does not include the Machine Center functionality, then the
value in this field must be 1.
14. In the Efficiency field, enter the percentage of the expected standard output that this work center actually
outputs. If you enter 100, it means that the work center has an actual output that is the same as the
standard output.
15. Select the Consolidated Calendar check box if you are also using machine centers. This ensures that
calendar entries are rolled up from machine center calendars.
16. In the Shop Calendar Code field, select a shop calendar. For more information, see How to: Create Shop
Calendars.
17. In the Queue Time field, specify a fixed time span that must pass before assigned work can begin at this
work center. Note that queue time is added to other non-productive time elements such as wait time and
move time that you may define on routing lines using this work center.
1. Choose the icon, enter Capacity Constrined Resources, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the New action.
3. Fill in the fields as necessary.
NOTE
Operations on work centers or machine centers that are set up as constrained resources will always be planned serially. This
means that if a constrained resource has multiple capacities, then those capacities can only be planned in sequence, not in
parallel as they would be if the work or machine center was not set up as a constrained resource. In a constrained resource,
the Capacity field on the work center or machine center is greater than 1.
In case of operation splitting, the setup time is only assigned once because it is assumed that some manual adjustment is
done to optimize the schedule.
See Also
How to: Create Shop Calendars
Setting Up Manufacturing
Manufacturing
Planning
Inventory
Purchasing
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Create Routings
8/13/2018 • 6 minutes to read • Edit Online
Manufacturing companies use routings to visualize and direct the manufacturing process.
The routing is the basis of process scheduling, capacity scheduling, scheduled assignment of material needs, and
manufacturing documents.
As for production BOMs, the routings are assigned to the manufacturing end item. A routing holds master data
that captures the process requirements of a given produced item. Once a production order is created for that
item, its routing will govern the scheduling of operations as represented in the Prod. Order Routing window
under the production order.
Before you can set up a routing, the following must be in place:
Item cards are created for parent items that take part in manufacturing. For more information, see How to:
Register New Items.
Production resources are set up. For more information, see How to: Set Up Work Centers and Machine
Centers.
To create a routing
1. Choose the icon, enter Routings, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the New action.
3. Fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short description of the field or link to more
information.
4. In the Type field, select Serial to calculate the production routing according to the value in the Operation
No. field.
Select Parallel to calculate the operations according to the value in the Next Operation No. field.
5. To edit the routing, set the Status field to New or Under Development. To activate it, set the Status field
to Certified.
Proceed to fill in the routing lines.
6. In the Operation No. field, enter the number of the first operation, for example, 10.
7. In the Type field, specify which kind of resource is used, for example, Work Center.
8. In the No. field, select the resource to be used, or type it in the field.
9. In the Routing Link Code field, enter a code to connect the component to a specific operation. For more
information, see the "To create routing links" section.
10. In the Run Time and Setup Time fields, enter the process times needed to perform the operation.
NOTE
Setup time is calculated per production order, whereas run time is calculated per produced item.
11. In the Concurrent Capacities field, specify how many units of the selected resource are used to perform
the operation. For example, two people allocated to one packing operation will halve the run time.
12. Continue to fill in lines for all operations involved in producing the item in question.
13. To copy lines from an existing routing, choose the Copy Routing action to select existing lines.
14. Certify the routing.
15. You can now attach the new routing to the card of the production item in question, by filling in the
Routing No. field. For more information, see How to: Register New Items.
NOTE
Remember also to recalculate the item’s standard cost from the Item card: Choose the Manufacturing action, select the
Calc. Standard Cost action, and then select the All Levels action.
1. Choose the icon, enter Routings, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the routing that contains the operations that you want to link.
Make sure the routing status is Under Development.
3. On the relevant routing line, in the Routing Link Code field, select a code.
4. Proceed to add different routing link codes to other operations in the routing, if relevant.
NOTE
You should not use the same routing link code in different operations on a routing because you may incorrectly link
a component to two different operations, so that it is consumed two times.
It is a good idea to name the routing link code after the operation in order to ensure operation-specific routing
links.
NOTE
To enable the routing links on an existing production order, you must refresh the productio1n order. For more
information, see How to: Create Production Orders.
The selected components will now be linked to the selected operations when you create or refresh a production
order using the production BOM and routing in question. This is visible in the Prod. Order Components
window under the production order, and here you can also remove and add the defined routing link codes at any
time.
1. Choose the icon, enter Routings, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the relevant routing.
3. On the Lines FastTab, select the line that you want to process, and then choose the Personnel action.
4. Fill in the fields in the Routing Personnel window.
5. Choose the OK button to exit the window. The entered values are copied and assigned to the operation.
1. Choose the icon, enter Routings, and then choose the related link.
2. Select the routing to be copied, and then choose the Versions action.
3. In the Routing Versions window, choose the New action.
4. Fill in the fields as necessary.
5. In the Version Code field, enter the unique identification of the version. Any combination of numbers and
letters is permitted.
The newly created version is automatically assigned the status New.
6. To create operation lines, select the first blank line, and then fill in the Operation No. field according to
the sequence of operations.
The operation lines are sorted in ascending order by operation numbers. To be able to make changes later,
we recommend you to select adequate step widths. The Next Operation No. field refers to the following
operation. The number of the operation can be entered directly.
7. When the routing version is completed, setting the Status field to Certified.
The time validity of the version is specified by the Starting Date field.
See Also
How to: Create Production BOMs
Setting Up Manufacturing
Manufacturing
Planning
Inventory
Purchasing
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Create Production BOMs
4/16/2018 • 5 minutes to read • Edit Online
A production bill of material (BOM ) holds master data that describes the components and subassemblies used in
the production of a parent item. Once a production order is created for that parent item, its production BOM will
govern the calculation of material requirements as represented in the Prod. Order Components window.
Dynamics NAV also support assembly BOMs. You use assembly orders for making end items from components
in a simple process that can be performed by one or more basic resources, which are not machine or work
centers, or without any resources. For example, an assembly process could be to pick two wine bottles and one
coffee sack and then pack them as a gift item. For more information, see the "Assembly BOMs or Production
BOMs" section in How to: Work with Bills of Material.
Before you can set up a routing, the following must be in place:
Item cards are created for parent items that take part in manufacturing. For more information, see How to:
Register New Items.
Production resources are set up. For more information, see How to: Set Up Work Centers and Machine
Centers.
NOTE
This scrap percentage represents components that are scrapped during production when picking from inventory,
whereas the scrap percentage on routing lines represents scrapped output before putting on inventory.
9. In the Routing Link Code field, enter a code to connect the component to a specific operation. For more
information, see the "To create routing links" section in How to: Create Routings.
10. To copy lines from an existing production BOM, choose the Copy BOM action to select existing lines.
11. Certify the production BOM.
12. You can now attach the new production BOM to the card of the parent item in question. For more
information, see How to: Register New Items.
NOTE
To recalculate the item’s standard cost from the item card, choose the Manufacturing action, and then choose the Calc.
Standard Cost action.
1. Choose the icon, enter Production BOM, and then choose the related link.
2. Select the production BOM to be copied, and then choose the Versions action.
3. On the Home tab, in the New group, choose New.
4. Fill in the fields as necessary.
5. In the Version Code field, enter the unique identification of the version. Any combination of numbers and
letters is permitted.
The newly created version is automatically assigned the status New.
6. When the BOM version is completed, setting the Status field to Certified.
The time validity of the version is specified by the Starting Date field.
NOTE
Select the Item option in the Type field to use an item from your item master data in the production BOM. If the item also
has a production BOM, whereby the Production BOM No. field is filled in on the item card, this production BOM is also
considered.
Select the Production BOM option if you want to use a phantom production BOM on the line.
Phantom production BOMs serve for structuring products. This production BOM type never leads to a finished product,
but is used exclusively for determining the dependent demand. Phantom production BOMs do not have their own item
master data.
See Also
How to: Create Routings
Setting Up Manufacturing
Manufacturing
Planning
Inventory
Purchasing
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Flush Components According to Operation
Output
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
For items that are set up with backward flushing method, the default behavior is to calculate and post component
consumption when you change the status of a released production order to Finished.
If you also define routing link codes, then calculation and posting occurs when each operation is finished, and the
quantity that was actually consumed in the operation is posted. For more information, see How to: Create
Routings.
For example, if a production order to produce 800 meters requires 8 kg of a component, then when you post 200
meters as output, 2 kg are automatically posted as consumption.
This functionality is useful for the following reasons:
Inventory Valuation - Value entries for output and consumption are created in parallel as the production
order progresses. Without routing link codes, the inventory value will increase as output is posted and then
decrease at a later point in time when the value of component consumption is posted together with the finished
production order.
Inventory Availability - With gradual consumption posting, the availability of component items is more up-
to-date, which is important to maintain the internal balance between demand and supply. Without routing link
codes, other demands for the component may believe that it is available as long as it is pending a delayed
consumption posting.
Just-in-Time – With the ability to customize products to customer requests, you can minimize waste by
making sure that work and system changes only occur when it is necessary.
The following procedure shows how to combine backward flushing and routing link codes so that the quantity that
is flushed for each operation is proportional to the actual output of the finished operation.
NOTE
Select Pick+ Forward if the component is used in a location that is set up for directed put-away and pick.
4. Choose the icon, enter Routings, and then choose the related link.
5. Define routing link codes for every operation that consumes the component. For more information, see
How to: Create Routings .
6. Choose the icon, enter Production BOM, and then choose the related link.
7. Define routing link codes from each instance of the component to the operation where it is consumed.
IMPORTANT
The component must have a routing link to the last operation in the routing.
See Also
How to: Create Production BOMs
Setting Up Manufacturing
Manufacturing
Planning
Inventory
Purchasing
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Work with Manufacturing Batch Units of
Measure
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
If an item is stocked in one unit of measure but produced in another, a production order is created that uses a
manufacturing batch unit of measure to calculate the correct quantity of the components during the Refresh
Production Order batch job. An example of a manufacturing batch unit of measure calculation is when a
manufactured item is stocked in pieces but produced in tons.
A production family is a group of individual items whose relationship is based on the similarity of their
manufacturing processes. By forming production families, some items can be manufactured twice or more in one
production, which will optimize material consumption.
In the Quantity field in the Family window, you enter the quantity that will be produced when the whole family
has been manufactured once.
Example
In punching processes, four pieces of the same item can be produced from one sheet and 10 pieces of another,
different, item at the same time. The punching machine will punch all 14 pieces in one step.
Forming production families reduces the scrap quantity because what would normally be leftover scrap, when
producing big pieces, will be used instead to produce small items.
See Also
How to: Create Production BOMs
Setting Up Manufacturing
Manufacturing
Planning
Inventory
Purchasing
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Set Up Standard Routing Lines
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
The use of standard tasks simplifies the creation and maintenance of routings. They allow you to quickly attach
extra information to recurring operations.
See Also
How to: Create Routings
How to: Create Production BOMs
Setting Up Manufacturing
Manufacturing
Planning
Inventory
Purchasing
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Subcontract Manufacturing
4/16/2018 • 6 minutes to read • Edit Online
Subcontracting selected operations to vendor is common in many manufacturing companies. Subcontracting can
be a rare occurrence or can be an integral part of all production processes.
The program provides several tools for managing subcontract work:
Work Centers with assigned vendor: This feature enables you to set up a work center that is associated with a
vendor (subcontractor). This is called a subcontract work center. You can specify a subcontract work center on a
routing operation, which allows you to easily process the subcontracted activity. In addition, the cost of the
operation can be designated at the routing or the work center level.
Work Center cost based on units or time: This feature enables you to specify whether costs associated with the
work center are based on the production time or a flat charge per unit. Although subcontractors commonly use
a flat charge per unit to charge for their services, the program can handle both options (production time and flat
charge per unit).
Subcontracting Worksheet: This feature allows you to find the production orders with material ready to send to
a subcontractor and to automatically create purchase orders for subcontract operations from production order
routings. Then the program automatically posts the purchase order charges to the production order during the
posting of the purchase order. Only production orders with a status of released can be accessed and used from a
subcontracting worksheet.
Subcontracting Worksheet
Once you have calculated the subcontracting worksheet, the relevant document, in this case a purchase order, is
created.
NOTE
Only production orders with status Released can be accessed and used from a subcontracting worksheet.
Posting output automatically for an ongoing production order when subcontracted items are received may not be
desired. Reasons for this could be that the expected output quantity that is posted may be different from the actual
quantity and that the posting date of the automatic output is misleading.
To avoid that the expected output of a production order is posted when subcontract purchases are received, make
sure the subcontracted operation is not the last one. Alternatively, insert a new last operation for the final output
quantity.
Posting output automatically for an ongoing production order when subcontracted items are received may not be
desired. Reasons for this could be that the expected output quantity that is posted may be different from the actual
quantity and that the posting date of the automatic output is misleading.
To avoid that the expected output of a production order is posted when subcontract purchases are received, make
sure the subcontracted operation is not the last one. Alternatively, insert a new last operation for the final output
quantity.
When the purchase order is posted as invoiced, then the direct cost of the purchase order is posted to the
production.
See Also
Manufacturing
Setting Up Manufacturing
Planning
Inventory
Purchasing
Working with Dynamics NAV
Setting Up Service Management
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Before you can start using Service Management features in Dynamics NAV, there are a few things to set up. For
example, you can establish coding for standard services, symptoms, and fault codes, and the service items and
service item types that your company's customer service needs require.
When you set up Service Management, you must decide what services to offer customers and the schedule for
those services. A service is a type of work performed by one or more resources and provided to a customer. For
example, a service could be a type of computer repair. A service item is the equipment or item needing servicing,
for example, the computer needing repair, installed at a specific customer. You can set up services as part of a
group of related repair or maintenance items.
When you define a service, you can associate it with the skills required to perform the service. To help your
service representatives be efficient, you can also set up real time troubleshooting guidelines and assign typical
startup costs, such as travel costs or other fees.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Set up codes that automatically assign lines on service How to: Set Up Codes for Standard Services
documents for services you deliver often.
Establish general settings that control aspects of Service How to: Configure Service Processes
Management Processes.
Define how your organization works with fault reporting. How to: Set Up Fault Reporting
Set up the service offerings that your company delivers to How to: Set Up Service Offerings
customers.
Provide troubleshooting guidelines that help service reps How to: Set Up Troubleshooting
deliver faster service.
Set up resource allocation to make it easy to assign the right How to: Set Up Resource Allocation
resource to a service task.
Define pricing for services, and set up additional service costs How to: Set Up Pricing and Additional Costs for Services
to assess on service orders.
Set things up so you can track resource hours and service How to: Set Up Work Hours and Service Hours
order status in order to forecast workloads and service needs.
Set up repair status options so that you can monitor progress How to: Set Up Statuses for Service Orders and Repairs
on repairs.
Set up a loaner program, so you can lend a substitute while How to: Set Up a Loaner Program
you work on a service item.
Set up service items and service item components. How to: Set Up Service Items
TO SEE
Lay the groundwork for creating service contracts and How to: Set Up Service Contracts
contract quotes.
See also
Service Management
Welcome to Microsoft Dynamics NAV
How to: Set Up Standard Service Codes
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
When you perform typical service, you often have to create service documents that use service lines that contain
similar information. To make it easy to create these lines, you can set up standard service codes that have a
predefined set of service lines. When you choose the code on a service document, the lines are entered
automatically. You can set up any number of standard service codes, and each code can have an unlimited number
of service lines of different types, including item, resource, cost, or standrd text linked to it. You create service lines
of each standard serice code on the Standard Service Code card. You then assign standard service codes to
service item groups on the Standard Serv. Item Gr. Codes page. Later, when you create a service document, you
can use the Get Standard Service Codes action to add service lines.
TIP
You can use the same concept to create lines on sales and purchase documents. For more information, see How to: Create
Recurring Sales and Purchase Lines.
See Also
Service Management
How to: Configure Service Processes
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
The following are some examples of the settings that you can apply to service management processes:
Some overall settings for various processes, such as warnings, next service calculations for service items, the
starting fee to assess, the fault reporting level to use, and so on.
The types if information that a technician must enter on service documents. For example, you can require them
to specify the type of order, the start and/or end dates for the work, and the type of work that was done.
Some default settings for response times and warranties. These include a default response time for starting
service, warranty discount percentages for parts and labor, and how long warranties are valid for.
Settings for contracts, such as the maximum number of days that you can use for contract service orders,
whether to use reason codes when a contract is canceled, standard texts for contract descriptions, and contract
values.
The number sequences to use for service-related documents and items.
See Also
How to: Set Up Fault Reporting
How to: Set Up Resource Allocation
How to: Set Up Codes for Standard Services
How to: Set Up Additional Costs for Services
How to: Set Up Troubleshooting
Service Management
How to: Set Up Fault Reporting
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Fault reporting lets you establish standards for recording fault information for service items. For example, you can
specify what the problem is, the symptoms you see, the reason for the problem, and how to resolve it.
Fault codes describe the typical service item faults or the actions taken on service items. Depending on the level of
fault reporting in your company, you might need to set up fault area codes and symptom codes before you set up
fault codes. Fault areas descrive areas of service item faults. Fault reason codes describe the reason for service
item faults and, if needed, whether to exclude warranty and contract discounts. For example, you might want to
exclude warranty and contract discounts if the customer was somehow responsible for the fault in the service item.
You assign fault reason codes to service orders. For more information, see How to: Work on Service Tasks.
Fault Codes are listed in the Fault Codes table. These codes
identify service item faults or actions to take on service
items. You can cluster related codes into Fault Area Code
groupings.
Fault + Symptom + Area You use fault, symptom, and fault area codes as an
implementation of the International Repair Coding System
(IRIS).
To complete the setup of fault reporting, you can also specify what repairs or resolutions are associated with a
fault or defect. You set that up on the Fault/Resolution Code Relationships page, where you set up
combinations of codes for the service item group of the service item from which you accessed the witndow and
the number of occurrences for each one.
1. Choose the icon, enter Insert Fault/Resol. Codes Relationships, and then choose the related link.
2. Enter dates to define the period you want to include in the batch job.
3. To group the relationships by service item group, choose the Relation Based on Service Item Group check
box.
4. To retain the records that you have already inserted manually in the Fault/Resol. Codes Relationships page,
choose the Retain Manually Inserted Rec. check box.
See Also
Setting Up Service Management
Service Management
How to: Set Up Service Offerings
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
When you set up service management, you must decide what services to offer customers and the schedule for
those services. A service is a type of work performed by one or more resources and provided to a customer. For
example, a service could be a type of computer repair. A service item is the equipment or item that needs servicing,
for example, the computer that needs repair, installed at a specific customer. You can set up services as part of a
group of related repair or maineenance items.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Enter information about the service items that your service How to: Create Service Items
organization is tracking.
Establish a workflow for service when the service items How to: Set Up Service Items and Service Item Components
consists of several components. The component list is always
connected to a service item, but these components can also
be based on bill of materials (BOMs).
See Also
Setting Up Service Management
Setting Up Troubleshooting for Service Items
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
You can set up troubleshooting guidelines that help technicians solve problems when providing service. For
example, guidelines might be a list of steps to perform a repair, or a series of questions to ask about the items.
After you set up troubleshooting guidelines, you can assign them to service item groups, service items, and items.
There is an inheritance hierarchy for guidelines. If you assign them to a service item group, the items included in
the group will inherit the guidelines unless you specify them for the items. Similarly, service items will inherit
guidelines from items.
See Also
Service Management
How to: Set Up Resource Allocation
4/16/2018 • 3 minutes to read • Edit Online
To ensure that a service task is performed well, it's important to find a resource who is qualified to do the work.
You can set up Dynamics NAV so that it's easy to allocate someone who has the right skills for the job. In
Dynamics NAV, we call this resource allocation. You can allocate resources based on their skill, availability, or
whether they are in the same service zone as the customer.
To use resource allocation, you must set up:
The skills required to repair and maintain service items. You assign these to service items and resources.
Geographic regions, called zones, that you define for your market. For example, East, West, Central, and so on.
You assign these to customers and resources.
Whether to display resource skills and zones, and whether to display a warning if someone chooses unqualified
resource, or a resource that is not in the customer zone.
To set up skills
1. Choose the icon, enter Skills, and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short description of the field or link to more information.
To set up zones
1. Choose the icon, enter Zones, and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short description of the field or link to more information.
1. Choose the icon, enter Resource Capacity, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the resource, and then choose the Set Capacity action.
3. Make the changes, and then choose Update Capacity.
1. Choose the icon, enter Items or Service Item, or Service Item Group, and then choose the related
link.
2. Choose the entity to update, and then choose the Resource Skills action.
3. On the line with the code to be changed, in the Skill Code field, choose the relevant skill code.
4. If the item has associated service items, a dialog box opens with the following two options:
Change the skill codes to the selected value: Select this option if you want to replace the old skill code
with the new one on all the related service items.
Delete the skill codes or update their relation: Select this option if you want to change the skill code on
this item only. The skill code on the related service items will be reassigned, that is, the Assigned From
field will be updated.
See Also
How to: Allocate Resources
How to: Set Up Work Hours and Service Hours
How to: Set Up Fault Reporting
How to: Set Up Codes for Standard Services
How to: Set Up Pricing and Additional Costs for
Services
8/13/2018 • 3 minutes to read • Edit Online
You can use the Dynamics NAV pricing features to set up and customize your application so that you apply and
adjust pricing on service items, repairs, and orders. These pricing decisions are then easily transmitted to the
invoicing process.
As your implementation requires, you can set up pricing groups and map them to specific time periods, customers,
or currency. You can set up fixed, minimum, or maximum pricing, depending on the service contracts that you have
with customers. Finally, as you adjust your prices, you can view and approve the changes before committing them
to the ledger.
1. Choose the icon, enter Service Price Groups, and then choose the related link.
2. Create a new service price group.
3. Fill in the Code and Description fields.
4. Choose the Setup action.
5. Fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short description of the field or link to more
information.
TIP
The Adjustment Type and Amount fields work together to specify whether an adjustment concerns a fixed amount,
or applies only when the total service price exceeds or is lower than the amount in the Amount field.
1. Choose the icon, enter Service Price Adjustment Groups, and then choose the related link.
2. Create a new service price adjustment group.
3. Fill in the Code and Description fields.
4. In the Type field, enter the type of the entry that you want to adjust.
To adjust only one specific entry, enter the number of this entry in the No. field. When you leave this
field blank, your adjustment group will adjust all entries of the type defined in the Type field.
To adjust service prices related to only one specific service, fill in the Work Type field. When you leave
this field blank, it will just be ignored.
5. In the Description field, enter a short description of the service price adjustment.
6. To adjust service prices related to only one specific general product posting group, fill in the Gen. Prod.
Posting Group field.
TIP
You can choose Details to add additional information about the adjustment group. For example, you can specify which item
belongs to the service price adjustment group, and whether this is an item, a resource, a resource group, or a service charge.
See Also
Setting Up Service Management
Service Management
How to: Set Up Service Items and Service Item
Components
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
1. Choose the icon, enter Service Item Groups, and then choose the related link.
2. Create a new service item group.
3. Fill in the Code and Description fields.
4. In the Default Contract Discount % field, enter the default contract discount percentage that you want the
service items in the group to have.
5. In the Default Serv. Price Group Code field, enter the default service price group code that you want the
service items in the group to have.
6. In the Default Response Time (Hours) field, enter the default response time in hours that you want the
service items in the group to have.
7. If you want to register the items in the group as service items when they are sold, select the Create Service
Item field.
1. Choose the icon, enter Service Items, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the service item for which you want to set up components.
3. Choose the Components action. The Service Item Component List window opens.
4. Add a new component.
5. In the Type field, choose Service Item if the component itself is a registered service item. Otherwise, select
Item.
6. In the No. field, choose the item or service item that is a component of the service item.
1. Choose the icon, enter Service Shelves, and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the fields as necessary.
See Also
How to: Set Up Codes for Standard Services
How to: Set Up Troubleshooting
How to: Set Up Work Hours and Service Hours
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Typically, a service management system tracks resource hours and service order status in order to forecast
workloads and service needs. Dynamics NAV has built-in tools that you can customize to record this kind of
information.
After you set the default service hours of your company, you can calculate response times for service orders or
send warnings or alerts when service calls come in. The alert feature is implemented together with the job
scheduler.
As you work on a service order, you will want to update it's status so that you can monitor progress. The service
order status reflects the repair status of all the service items in the service order. For more information, see
Understanding Service Order and Repair Status.
1. Choose the icon, enter Default Service Hours, and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short description of the field or link to more information.
IMPORTANT
If you leave the lines in the Default Service Hours window empty, the default value is 24 hours, valid only for calendar
working days.
1. Choose the icon, enter Work Hour Templates, and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short description of the field or link to more information.
NOTE
After you enter work hours for each day, the value in the Total per Week field is calculated automatically.
1. Choose the icon, enter Service Contracts, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the service contract you want to set up specific service hours for, and choose Service Hours.
3. To set up service hours based on default service hours, choose the Copy Default Service Hours action.
4. Edit the fields in the service hours entries. Insert or delete entries to set up the service hours for the contract.
Note that the fields Day, Starting Time and Ending Time are required for each line.
5. If you want the service hours to be valid from a specific date, fill in the Starting Date field.
6. If you want the service hours to be valid on holidays, select the check box in the Valid on Holidays field.
See Also
Understanding Allocation Status and Repair Status
Setting Up Service Management
Understanding Service Order and Repair Status
How to: Set Up Statuses for Service Orders and
Repairs
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
You must set up repair status options that identify the progress of repair and maintenance of service items in
service orders. You must set up at least nine repair status options that identify situations or actions taken when
servicing service items.
You can set the priority level for service order status options. There four priorities are High, Medium High,
Medium Low, and Low.
When you change the repair status of a service item in a service order, the service order status is updated. The
repair status of each service item is linked to the service order status. If the service items are linked to two or more
service order status options, the service order status with the highest priority is selected.
See Also
Understanding Service Order Status and Repair Status
Sometimes you must provide a customer a loaner item for use when your customer service team makes a repair.
In Dynamics NAV, you can set up a loaner program, loan items to your customers, and track receipts when
customers return the items. Additionally, you can add comments about loaners in one of two ways:
Enter a note or comment about the loaner itself.
Enter a note on a service item about the need for a loaner.
To set up a loaner
1. Choose the icon, enter Loaners, and then choose the related link.
2. Create a new loaner card.
3. In the No. field, enter a number for the loaner. Alternatively, if you have set up number series for loaners in the
Service Mgt. Setup window, you can press the Enter key to enter the next available loaner number.
4. Fill in the Description, Description 2, and Serial No. fields.
5. In the Unit of Measure Code field, choose the relevant unit of measure.
See Also
How to: Lend and Receive Loaners
Setting Up Service Management
Delivering Service
How to: Set Up Service Contracts
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Before you can work with contracts, you must set up the following:
Service contract groups, which gather service contracts that are related in some way.
Service contract account groups, which are used to group the service contract accounts together for service
invoices created for service contracts. You assign these groups to service contracts.
Contract templates that define contract layouts of contracts that include the most commonly used service
contract details. When you create service contract quotes, you can create them by using templates. When you
create a contract quote, the fields automatically contain the contents of the template fields.
Customer templates that let you create quotes for contacts or potential customers who are not registered as
customers in Dynamics NAV.
See Also
Setting Up Service Management
Depreciation Methods
8/13/2018 • 12 minutes to read • Edit Online
NOTE
Use this method for assets that are not subject to depreciation, for example, land. You must enter depreciation in the
fixed asset G/L journal. The Calculate Depreciation batch job omits fixed assets that use this depreciation method.
Half-Year Convention
NOTE
When you use this method, a fixed asset is depreciated by the same amount each year.
Straight-Line Depreciation
When you use the straight-line method, you must specify one of the following options in the fixed asset
depreciation book:
The depreciation period (years or months) or a depreciation ending date
A fixed yearly percentage
A fixed yearly amount
Depreciation period
Depreciation Period
If you enter the depreciation period (the number of depreciation years, the number of depreciation months, or the
depreciation ending date), the following formula calculates the depreciation amount:
Depreciation Amount = ((Book value - Salvage Value) x Number of Depreciation Days) / Remaining Depreciation
Days
Remaining depreciation days are calculated as the number of depreciation days minus the number of days
between the depreciation starting date and the last fixed asset entry date.
Book value may be reduced by posted appreciation, write-down, custom 1 or custom 2 amounts, depending on
whether the Include in Depr. Calculation field is deactivated and whether the Part of Book Value field is
activated in the FA Posting Type Setup window. This calculation ensures that the fixed asset is fully depreciated
at the depreciation ending date.
Fixed Yearly Percentage
If you enter a fixed yearly percentage, the program uses the following formula to calculate the depreciation
amount:
Depreciation Amount = (Straight-Line % x Depreciable Basis x Number of Depr. Days) / (100 x 360)
Fixed Yearly Amount
If you enter a fixed yearly amount, the program uses this formula to calculate the depreciation amount:
Depreciation Amount = (Fixed Depreciation Amount x Number of Depreciation Days) / 360
Example - Straight-Line Depreciation
A fixed asset has an acquisition cost of LCY 100,000. The estimated life is eight years. The Calculate
Depreciation batch job is run biannually.
For this example, the fixed asset ledger entry looks like this:
Declining-Balance 1 Depreciation
This accelerated depreciation method allocates the largest portion of the cost of an asset to the early years of its
useful lifetime. If you use this method, you must enter a fixed yearly percentage.
The following formula calculates depreciation amounts:
Depreciation Amount = (Declining -Bal. % x Number of Depreciation Days x Depr. Basis) / (100 x 360 )
The depreciable basis is calculated as the book value less posted depreciation since the starting date of the current
fiscal year.
The posted depreciation amount can contain entries with various posting types (write-down, custom1, and
custom2) posted since the starting date of the current fiscal year. These posting types are included in the posted
depreciation amount if there are check marks in the Depreciation Type and the Part of Book Value fields in the
FA Posting Type Setup window.
Example - Declining-Balance 1 Depreciation
A fixed asset has an acquisition cost of LCY 100,000. The Declining-Balance % field is 25. The Calculate
Depreciation batch job is run biannually.
The following table shows how the fixed asset ledger entries look.
Declining-Balance 2 Depreciation
The Declining-Balance 1 and Declining-Balance 2 methods calculate the same total depreciation amount for each
year. However, if you run the Calculate Depreciation batch job more than once a year, the Declining-Balance 1
method will result in equal depreciation amounts for each depreciation period. The Declining-Balance 2 method,
on the other hand, will result in depreciation amounts that decline for each period.
Example - Declining-Balance 2 Depreciation
A fixed asset has an acquisition cost of LCY 100,000. The Declining-Balance % field is 25. The Calculate
Depreciation batch job is run biannually. The fixed asset ledger entries look like this:
DATE CALCULATION
)
06/30/10 DA = 100,000.00 x (1 -(1 - 0.25)0.5 = 13,397.46
)
12/31/10 DA = 86,602.54 x (1 - (1 - 0.25)0.5 = 11,602.54
)
06/30/11 DA = 75,000.00 x (1 - (1 - 0.25)0.5 = 10,048.09
)
12/31/11 DA = 64,951.91 x (1 - (1 - 0.25)0.5 = 8,701.91
DB1/SL Depreciation
DB1/SL is an abbreviated combination of Declining-Balance 1 and Straight-Line. The calculation continues until
the book value equals the final rounding amount, or the salvage value that you entered.
The Calculate Depreciation batch job calculates a straight-line amount and a declining balance amount, but only
the greater of the two amounts is transferred to the journal.
You can use various percentages to calculate declining-balance.
If you use this method, you must enter the estimated useful lifetime and a declining balance percentage in the FA
Depreciation Books window.
Example - DB1-SL Depreciation
A fixed asset has an acquisition cost of LCY 100,000. In the FA Depreciation Books window, the Declining-
Balance % field contains 25 and the No. of Depreciation Years field contains 8. The Calculate Depreciation
batch job is run biannually.
The fixed asset ledger entries look like this:
DATE FA POSTING TYPE DAYS AMOUNT BOOK VALUE
1. Choose the icon, enter Depreciation Tables, and then choose the related link.
2. In the Depreciation Table List window, choose the New action.
3. Depreciation Table Card window, fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short description of
the field or link to more information.
Example - User-defined Depreciation
You use a depreciation method that allows you to depreciate assets in an accelerated manner for income tax
purposes.
You would use the following depreciation rates for a fixed asset with a three-year lifetime for tax purposes:
year 1: 25%
year 2: 38%
year 3: 37%
The acquisition cost is LCY 100,000, and the depreciable lifetime is five years. Depreciation is calculated annually.
NOTE
The estimated life of the fixed asset that is remaining after the first fiscal year will always contain a half-year using the Half-
Year Convention Method. Thus, for the Half-Year Convention method to be applied correctly, the Depreciation Ending
Date field in the FA Depreciation Book window must always contain a date which is exactly six months before the final
date of the fiscal year in which the fixed asset will fully depreciate.
NOTE
You cannot duplicate in the same journal and journal batch as you are duplicating from. If you post entries in the fixed asset
G/L journal, you can duplicate them in the fixed asset journal or in the fixed asset G/L journal using another batch.
NOTE
You cannot use the same number series in the fixed asset G/L journal and the fixed asset journal. When you post entries in
the fixed asset G/L journal, you must leave the Document No. field empty. If you enter a number in the field, the the
number is duplicated in the fixed asset journal. You'll have to manually change the document number before you can post
the journal.
See Also
Fixed Assets
Setting Up Fixed Assets
Finance
Welcome to Microsoft Dynamics NAV
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Set Up Email Manually or Using the Assisted
Setup
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
To send and receive emails from within Dynamics NAV, you must fill in the fields in the SMTP Mail Setup
window.
NOTE
Instead of entering the SMTP server details, you can use a function to enter them with information from your Office 365
subscription.
You can either set email up manually or you can get help by using the Email Setup assisted setup. For more
information, see Getting Ready for Doing Business.
To set up email
1. Choose the icon, enter SMTP Email Setup, and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short description of the field or link to more information.
3. Alternatively, choose the Apply Office 365 Server Settings action to insert any information that is already
defined for your Office 365 subscription.
4. When all the fields are correctly filled in, choose the Test Email Setup action.
5. When the test succeeds, close the window.
See Also
Working with Dynamics NAV
Setting Up Dynamics NAV
How to: Send Documents by Email
Customizing Dynamics NAV Using Extensions
Using Dynamics NAV as Your Business Inbox in Outlook
Getting Dynamics NAV on My Mobile Device
How to: Create Number Series
4/16/2018 • 3 minutes to read • Edit Online
For each company that you set up, you need to assign unique identification codes to things such as general ledger
accounts, customer and vendor accounts, invoices, and other documents. Numbering is important not only for
identification. A well-designed numbering system also makes the company more manageable and easy to analyze,
and can reduce the number of errors that occur in data entry.
NOTE
We recommend that you use the same number series codes as you see listed in the No. Series List window in the CRONUS
demonstration company. Codes such as P-INV+ might not make immediate sense to you, but Dynamics NAV has a number
of default settings that depend on these number series codes.
You create a numbering system by setting up one or more codes for each type of master data or document. For
example, you can set up one code for numbering customers, another code for numbering sales invoices, and
another code for numbering documents in general journals. After you have set up a code, you set must set up at
least one number series line. The number series line contains information such as the first and last number in the
series and the starting date. You can set up more than one number series line per number series code, with a
different starting date for each line. The series will be used consecutively, starting each series on the respective
starting date.
You typically set up your number series to automatically insert the next consecutive number on new cards or
documents that you create. However, you can also set a number series up to allow that you manually enter the
new number. You specify this with the Manual Nos. check box.
If you want to use more than one number series code for one type of master data - for example, if you want to use
different number series for different categories of items - you can use number series relationships.
1. Choose the icon, enter Sales & Receivables, and then choose the related link.
2. In the Sales & Receivables window, on the Number Series FastTab, select the desired number series for each
sales card or document.
The selected number will now be used to fill in the No. field on the card or document in question, according to the
settings you made on the number series line.
1. Choose the icon, enter No. Series, and then choose the related link.
2. Select the line with the number series you want to create relationships for and then choose Relationships.
3. In the Series Code field, enter the code for the number series that you want to relate to the series you selected
in step 2.
4. Add a line for each code that you want to relate to the selected number series.
5. Close the window.
Now when you set up something that requires a number, you can use the relationships you created to select
among the related number series.
See Also
Setting Up Dynamics NAV
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Set Up Extended Item Text
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
You can extend a standard text for items by adding extra lines, and you can set up conditions for use of the extra
lines. You do this from item cards.
See Also
Setting Up Inventory
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Set Up Base Calendars
8/13/2018 • 6 minutes to read • Edit Online
You can assign a base calendar to your company and its business partners, such as customers, vendors, or
locations. Delivery and receipt dates on future sales order, purchase order, transfer order, and production order
lines are calculated according to the calendar’s specified working days. The main task in setting up a new base
calendar is to specify and define the non-working days that you want to apply.
NOTE
When setting up a new base calendar, you can select and copy lines from an existing calendar. You do this in the relevant
Base Calendar Changes window.
IMPORTANT
Any base calendar defined for the vendor or the location affects how the dates are calculated and rounded to working days.
Specifies a date formula for the time that it takes to replenish the item. It is used to calculate the Planned Receipt Date
field, if calculating forward, and Order Date field, if calculating backwards. See the "Lead Time Calculation" section.
Forward planned receipt date = order date + planned receipt date = order date +
vendor lead time (per the vendor vendor lead time (per the location
calendar and rounded to the next calendar)
working day in first the vendor calendar
and then the location calendar)
Backward order date = planned receipt date - order date = planned receipt date -
vendor lead time (per the vendor vendor lead time (per the location
calendar and rounded to the previous calendar)
working day in first the vendor calendar
and then the location calendar)
NOTE
In addition to the lead time calculation that affects the planned receipt date and order date, as shown in the above table,
warehouse handling time and safety lead time may be added to the formulas to make up the value in the Expected Receipt
Date field, as follows: Planned Receipt Date + Safety Lead Time + Inbound Warehouse Handling Time = Expected Receipt
Date.
IMPORTANT
If your location uses a significantly different calendar than your vendors do, then it is important that you set up specific
calendars for those vendors, to calculate optimal vendor lead times. For information about how to set up vendor calendars,
see the "To assign a base calendar" section.
The contents of the Lead Time Calculation field is copied from either the item card or the SKU card, if the lead
time is defined for the item, or in the Item Vendor Catalog window, if the lead time is defined for the vendor.
To customize a calendar
The main task in customizing a base calendar for your company, or one of its business partners, is to enter any
changes to working and nonworking day status.
For example, while a base calendar would typically list all Saturdays as non-working days, the customized calendar
for a particular location may list all Saturdays during the months of November and December, and leading up to
the holiday season, as working days.
The following procedure uses the case of the location as an example. Note that at this point, you have already
assigned a base calendar to the location.
1. Choose the icon, enter Locations, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the location that you want to update, and then select the Customized Calendar field. Note that a
calendar must be selected in the Base Calendar Code field.
3. In the Customized Calendar Entries window opens, choose the Maintain Customized Calendar
Changes action.
4. In the Customized Calendar Changes, add lines for customized calendar entries.
When you enter a line, the Nonworking check box is selected. You can clear the check box if you want to
change the status to a working day.
You can use the Recurring System field to set a particular date or day as a recurring nonworking day. You
can select either the Annual Recurring or Weekly Recurring option.
If you select Annual Recurring, you must also enter the relevant date in the Date field. If you select
Weekly Recurring, you must also select the relevant day of the week in the Day field. If you leave the field
empty, you must fill in the Date field. The Day field is then filled in automatically. This could be useful if you
want to mark an individual date as a nonworking or working day.
5. Choose the OK button.
In the Customized Calendar Entries window, you will observe that the date entries are updated with the
changes that you made.
On the Location card, you will observe that the Customized Calendar field contains Yes, indicating that a
customized calendar has been set up.
IMPORTANT
If you do not fill in the Location Code field on an order line, your company’s calendar is used.
If you do not fill in the Shipping Agent Code field on the order line, your company’s calendar is used.
NOTE
If you make changes to a base calendar for which customized calendar changes exist, all existing customized calendars are
updated automatically.
1. Choose the icon, enter Customers, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the Customer card for whom you will assign a base calendar.
3. On the Shipping FastTab, in the Base Calendar Code field, select the base calendar that you want to assign.
IMPORTANT
If you do not assign a base calendar to a company, all dates are calculated as working days.
If you enter a blank location on an order line, all dates are calculated as working days.
Any base calendar defined for the vendor or the location affects how the dates are calculated and rounded to
working days.
NOTE
Before you can make customized calendar entries, you must first assign a base calendar to the company.
See Also
Purchasing
Manufacturing
Inventory
Working with Dynamics NAV
Set Up Complex Application Areas Using Best
Practices
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Entering the correct setup values from the start is important to the success of any new business software.
Whether you use Rapid Start to implement setup values or you manually enter them in the new company, you can
support your setup decisions with some general recommendations for selected setup fields that are known to
potentially cause the solution to be inefficient if defined incorrectly.
Help in Dynamics NAV includes best-practice information about how to set up key fields in the following
application areas:
Setup Best Practices: Supply Planning
Setup Best Practices: Costing Method
See Also
Design Details: Supply Planning
Design Details: Costing Methods
Working with Dynamics NAV
Setup Best Practices: Supply Planning
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Supply planning is a critical business area. When set up and used correctly, supply planning helps a company
avoid stock out and reduce both ordering costs and inventory costs.
It is not possible to prescribe one optimal setup of all planning fields as this varies from company to company
because of business variables, such as market situation and business strategy. However, there are best practices
for selecting options in items cards and global setup fields to help get the company started with timely and cost-
effective inventory flows.
The following topics provide best-practice information about how to set up selected planning fields that are key
to inventory and supply planning.
TO SEE
Learn the best practices for selecting the best reordering Setup Best Practices: Reordering Policies
policy to plan efficiently and economically for an item
according to carrying costs and demand patterns.
Learn the best practices for specifying selected planning Setup Best Practices: Planning Parameters
parameters under the defined reordering policy to plan
efficiently and economically for an item according to critical
elements, such as lead time, carrying costs, and seasonality.
Learn the best practices for applying a general supply Setup Best Practices: Global Planning Setup
strategy to all item cards, such as always receiving items one
day before they are needed or dampening the system’s
reaction to small demand fluctuations.
See Also
Design Details: Supply Planning
Design Details: Planning Parameters
Set Up Complex Application Areas Using Best Practices
Working with Dynamics NAV
Setup Best Practices: Costing Method
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
The Costing Method on the item card defines item’s cost flow is recorded and whether an actual or budgeted
value is capitalized and used in the cost calculation.
Setting the correct costing method according to item type and business environment is important to ensure
economical inventories.
The following table provides best practices on how to set up the Costing Method field. For more information, see
Design Details: Costing Methods.
FIFO Use where the product cost is stable. An item’s unit cost is the actual value of
any receipt of the item, selected by the
Use for items with a limited shelf life, FIFO rule.
because the oldest goods need to be
sold before they pass their sell-by date. In inventory valuation, it is assumed
that the first items placed in inventory
are sold first. Note: When prices are
rising, the balance sheet shows greater
value. This means that tax liabilities
increase, but credit scores and the
ability to borrow cash improve.
LIFO Use where levels of inventories are An item’s unit cost is the actual value of
consistently maintained or increased any receipt of the item, selected by the
over time. LIFO rule.
Average Use where the product cost is unstable. An item’s unit cost is the exact cost at
which the particular unit was received.
Use where inventories are piled or
mixed together and cannot be
differentiated, such as chemicals.
Specific Use in production or trade of easily An item’s unit cost is calculated as the
identifiable items with fairly high unit average unit cost at each point in time
costs. after a purchase.
Use for items that are subject to For inventory valuation, it is assumes
regulation. that all inventories are sold
simultaneously.
Use for items with serial numbers.
SETUP OPTION BEST PRACTICE COMMENT
Standard Use where cost control is critical. An item’s unit cost is preset based on
estimated.
Use in repetitive manufacturing, to
value the costs of direct material, direct When the actual cost is realized later,
labor, and manufacturing overhead. the standard cost must be adjusted to
the actual cost through variance values.
Use where there is discipline and staff
to maintain standards.
See Also
Design Details: Costing Methods
Design Details: Inventory Costing
Set Up Complex Application Areas Using Best Practices
Working with Dynamics NAV
Finance
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Microsoft Dynamics NAV includes a standard configuration of most financial processes, but you can
change the configuration to suit your business. For more information, see Setting Up Finance.
The default configuration includes a chart of accounts and standard posting groups that make the
process of assigning default general ledger posting accounts to customers, vendors, and items more
efficient.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Reconcile bank accounts and transfer funds between Managing Bank Accounts
bank accounts.
Understand the general ledger and the chart of Understanding the General Ledger and the COA
accounts.
Create budgets to forecast different financial activities How to: Create Budgets
and assign dimensions for business intelligence
purposes.
Record income or expenses directly in the general How to: Post Transactions Directly to the General
ledger without posting dedicated business Ledger
documents.
TO SEE
Post reversing entries to undo value postings in the How to: Reverse Postings
general journal or quantity postings on purchase and
sales documents.
Allocate an entry in a general journal to several How to: Allocate Costs and Income
different accounts when you post the journal.
Assign extra costs, such as freight and physical How to: Use Item Charges to Account for Additional
handling that you incur during trade, to the involved Trade Costs
items so that the cost is reflected in inventory
valuation.
Post employees' personal expenses for business- How to: Record and Reimburse Employees' Expenses
related activities and reimburse employees by making
payment to their bank account.
Recognize revenues and expenses in other periods How to: Defer Revenues and Expenses
than when the transactions were posted.
Learn how to use additional currencies and update How to: Update Currency Exchange Rates
currency exchange rates automatically.
Import salary transactions from your payroll provider How to: Import Payroll Transactions
into the general ledger.
Monitor the flow of cash in and out of your business. Analyzing Cash Flows in Your Company
Work with financial statements and overviews in Excel. Analyzing Financial Statements in Excel
Prepare a report that lists VAT from sales, and submit How to: Report VAT to Tax Authorities
the report to tax authorities in the EU.
See Also
Setting Up Finance
Sales
Purchasing
Closing Fiscal Periods
Managing Projects
Importing from Other Finance Systems
Working with General Journals
Working with Dynamics NAV
Managing Receivables
8/13/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
A regular step in any financial rhythm is to reconcile bank accounts, which requires that you apply payments to
customer or vendor ledger entries to close sales invoices and purchase credit memos.
In Dynamics NAV, one of the fastest ways to register payments from the Payment Reconciliation Journal
window by importing a bank statement file or feed. The payments are applied to open customer or vendor
ledger entries based on data matches between payment text and entry information. You can review and change
the matches before you post the journal, and close bank account ledger entries for ledger entries when you post
the journal. The bank account is reconciled when all payments are applied.
There are, however, other handy places to apply payments and reconcile bank accounts:
The Bank Account Reconciliations window, which also lets you check ledger entries. For more information,
see How to: Reconcile Bank Accounts Separately.
The Payment Registration window, where you can apply and manually check payments received as cash,
check, or bank transaction against a generated list of unpaid sales documents. Note that this functionality is
available only for sales documents.
The Cash Receipt Journal window, where you manually post receipts to the relevant general ledger,
customer, or other account by entering a payment line. You can either apply the receipt or refund to one or
more open entries before you post the cash receipt journal, or from the customer ledger entries.
Another part of managing receivables is to collect outstanding balances, including finance charges, and issue
reminders. Dynamics NAV offers ways to do those things as well. For more information, see How to: Collect
Outstanding Balances.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Apply payments to open customer or vendor ledger entries Applying Payments Automatically and Reconciling Bank
based on an imported bank statement file or feed, and Accounts
reconcile the bank account when all payments are applied.
Apply payments to open customer ledger entries based on How to: Reconcile Customer Payments Manually From a List
manual entry in a list of unpaid sales documents. of Unpaid Sales Documents
Post cash receipts or refunds for customers in the cash How to: Reconcile Customer Payments Manually
receipt journal and apply to customer ledger entries, either
from the journal or from posted ledger entries.
Remind customers of overdue amounts, calculate interest How to: Collect Outstanding Balances
and finance charges, and manage accounts receivable.
Ensure that you know the cost of shipped items by assigning How to: Use Item Charges to Account for Additional Trade
added item costs, such as freight, physical handling, Costs
insurance, and transportation that you incur after selling.
Set up a tolerance by which the system closes an invoice How to: Work with Payment Tolerances and Payment
even though the payment, including any discount, does not Discount Tolerances
fully cover the amount on the invoice.
See Also
Sales
Managing Payables
Working with Dynamics NAV
General Business Functionality
Applying Payments Automatically and Reconciling
Bank Accounts
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
You must regularly reconcile your bank, receivables, and payables accounts by applying payments recorded in the
bank to their related unpaid invoices and credit memos or other open entries in Microsoft Dynamics NAV.
You can perform this task in the Payment Reconciliation Journal window by importing a bank statement file or
feed to quickly register the payments. Payments are applied to open customer or vendor ledger entries based on
matches between payment text and entry information. You can review and change automatic applications before
you post the journal. You can choose to close any open bank account ledger entries related to the applied ledger
entries when you post the journal. The bank account is automatically reconciled when all payments are applied.
To import bank statements as a bank feed, you must first set up and enable the bank data conversion service. For
more information, see How to: Set Up the Bank Data Conversion Service.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Apply payments to open customer or vendor ledger entries by How to: Reconcile Payments Using Automatic Application
importing a bank statement, and reconcile the bank account
when all payments are applied.
Manually apply payments by viewing detailed information How to: Review or Apply Payments After Automatic
about matched data and suggestions for candidate open Application
entries to apply payments to.
Resolve payments that cannot be applied automatically to How to: Reconcile Payments That Cannot be Applied
their related open ledger entries. For example because the Automatically
amounts differ, or because a related ledger entry does not
exist.
Link text on payments to specific customer, vendor, or general How to: Map Text on Recurring Payments to Accounts for
ledger accounts to always post recurring cash receipts or Automatic Reconciliation
expenses to those accounts when no documents exist to apply
to.
See Also
Managing Receivables
Sales
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Reconcile Customer Payments Manually
From a List of Unpaid Sales Documents
8/13/2018 • 11 minutes to read • Edit Online
When your customers have made payments to your electronic bank account, you must apply each amount paid to
the related sales document and then post the payment to update the customer, general ledger, and bank ledger
entries.
NOTE
You can perform the same tasks, including vendor payments, in the Payment Reconciliation Journal window using
functions for bank statement import, automatic application, and bank account reconciliation. For more information, see
Reconcile Payments Using Automatic Application.
The Payment Registration window is designed to support you in tasks involved in balancing internal accounts
by using actual cash figures to make sure that payments are collected efficiently from customers. This payment
processing tool enables you to quickly verify and post individual or lump payments, process discounted payments,
and find specific unpaid documents for which payment is made.
Payments for different customers that have different payment dates must be posted as individual payments.
Payments for the same customer that have the same payment date can be posted as a lump payment. This is
useful, for example, when a customer has made a single payment that covers multiple sales invoices.
1. Choose the icon, enter Payment Registration Setup, and then choose the related link.
Alternatively, in the Payment Registration window, choose the Setup action.
2. Fill in the fields in the Payment Registration Setup window. Choose a field to read a short description of
the field or link to related information.
NOTE
The customer in the Name field must be the same on all lines that will be posted as a lump payment.
If the Auto Fill Date Received check box is selected in the Payment Registration Setup window, then
the work date is filled in the Date Received field.
3. In the Date Received field, enter the date when the payment was made. This date may be different from
the work date.
NOTE
This date must be the same on all lines that will be posted as a lump payment.
4. In the Amount Received field, enter amounts on multiple lines that sum up to the lump payment amount.
TIP
Try to post as many full payments as possible with the lump amount. Enter amounts that are the same as the
amount in the Remaining Amount field on as many lines as possible.
5. Repeat steps 2-4 for other lines that represent posted documents for the same customer for which a lump
payment has been made.
6. Choose the Post As Lump Payment action. The entered payment information is posted for documents
represented by lines where the Payment Made check box is selected.
Payment entries are posted to general ledger, bank, and customer accounts. Each payment is applied to the related
posted sales document.
If a payment in the bank is not represented by line in the Payment Registration window, it may be because the
related document has not yet been posted. In that case, you can use a search function to quickly find the document
and post it to process the payment. For more information, see the "To find a specific sales document that is not
fully invoiced" section.
If a payment in the bank is not represented by any document in Dynamics NAV, then you can open a prefilled
general journal from the Payment Registration window to post the payment directly to the balancing account
without applying the payment to a document. Alternatively, you may want to record the payment in the journal
until the origin of the payment has been resolved. For more information, see the "To record or post a payment
without a related document" section.
TIP
If you want to make an exception and grant the discount even though the payment is late, follow these steps:
4. Choose the Details action.
5. In the Payment Registration Details window, in the Pmt. Discount Date field on the Payment
Discount FastTab, enter a date that is after the date in the Date Received field in the Payment
Registration window.
The error message and the red font disappear, and you can proceed to process the discounted payment.
6. Verify that the Remaining Amount field contains the amount that remains to pay the full invoice amount.
7. Choose the Post Payments action to post the partial payment to general ledger, bank, and customer
accounts.
The related document remains open.
To process a payment that is lower than the remaining discounted amount
1. Choose the icon, enter Payment Registration, and then choose the related link.
2. Enter the payment amount in the Amount Received field. The amount is lower than the amount in the
Rem. Amt. after Discount field.
The Payment Made check box is automatically selected, and the Date Received field is filled with the
work date.
3. In the Date Received field, enter the payment date. The date is before the date in the Pmt. Discount Date
field.
4. Verify that the Remaining Amount field contains the amount that remains to pay the discounted amount.
5. Choose the Post Payments action to post the partial payment to general ledger, bank, and customer
accounts.
The related document remains open.
To process a payment that is more than the remaining discounted amount
1. Choose the icon, enter Payment Registration, and then choose the related link.
2. Enter the payment amount in the Amount Received field. The amount is more than the amount in the
Rem. Amt. after Discount field.
The Payment Made check box is automatically selected, and the Date Received field is filled with the
work date.
3. In the Date Received field, enter the payment date. The date is before the date in the Pmt. Discount Date
field.
4. Verify that the Remaining Amount field contains zero (0).
5. Choose the Post Payments action to post the full payment to general ledger, bank, and customer accounts.
The related document is closed, and the customer is credited the excess payment amount.
1. Choose the icon, enter Payment Registration, and then choose the related link.
2. With the pointer on any line, Choose the Search Documents action.
3. In the Document Search window, enter a search value in the Document No. field.
NOTE
The value that you enter in this field is enclosed in hidden wildcard characters. This means that the function searches
for all document numbers that contain the entered value.
4. In the Amount field, enter the specific amount that exists on the document that you want to find.
5. In the Amount Tolerance % field, enter a percentage value to define the range of amounts that you want
to search to find the open document.
If you enter 10, then the function will search for amounts in a range between ten percent lower and ten
percent higher than the value in the Amount field.
6. Choose the Search action.
The Search function searches among documents that are not fully invoiced based on the specified criteria.
If one or more documents match the criteria, then the Document Search Result window opens to display lines
that represent those documents. Each line contains a document number, description, and amount so that you can
easily find a specific document, for example based on information on your bank statement.
If a payment in the bank is not represented by any document in Dynamics NAV, then you can open a prefilled
general journal from the Payment Registration window to post the payment directly to the balancing account
without applying the payment to a document. Alternatively, you may want to record the payment in the journal
until the origin of the payment has been resolved.
1. Choose the icon, enter Payment Registration, and then choose the related link.
Proceed to record an undocumented payment.
1. Choose the General Journal action.
The General Journal window opens with one line prefilled with the balancing account of the journal batch
that is set up in the Payment Registration Setup window.
2. Fill in the remaining fields on the general journal line, such as the amount and the customer number or
other information from the bank statement. For more information, see How to: Post Transactions Directly to
the General Ledger.
You can either post the journal line to update the total on the balancing account. Alternatively, you can leave the
journal line unposted, and perhaps append it with a note that the payment needs more analysis.
If you leave the journal line unposted, it will add to the value in the Unposted Balance field at the bottom of the
Payment Registration window.
See Also
Managing Receivables
Sales
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Reconcile Customer Payments Manually
4/16/2018 • 9 minutes to read • Edit Online
When you receive a cash receipt from a customer, or you make a cash refund, you must decide whether to apply
the payment or refund to close one or more open debit or credit entries. You can specify the amount you want to
apply. For example, you can apply partial payments to customer ledger entries. Closing customer ledger entries
makes sure that information such as customer statistics, account statements, and finance charges are correct.
NOTE
In the Customer Ledger Entries window, red font means that the related payment is past its due date.
NOTE
If the Application Method field on the customer card contains Apply to Oldest, payments are applied to the oldest open
credit entry, unless you manually specify an entry. If the application method is Manual, you always apply entries manually.
You can apply customer payments manually in the Cash Receipt Journal window. A cash receipt journal is a type
of general journal, so you can use it to post transactions to general ledger, bank, customer, vendor, and fixed assets
accounts. You can apply the payment to one or more debit entries when you post the payment, or you can apply
from the posted entries later.
You can also apply customer and vendor payments in the Payment Reconciliation Journal window, by using
functions for bank statement import, automatic application, and bank account reconciliation. For more information,
see Reconcile Payments Using Automatic Application. Alternatively, you can reconcile customer payments based
on a list of unpaid sales documents in the Payment Registration window. For more information, see How to:
Reconcile Customer Payments From a List of Unpaid Sales Documents
9. To see the ledger entries, choose the icon, enter Customers, and then choose the related link. Browse to
the card for the relevant customer to see the ledger entries.
On the ledger entry list, on the line that contains the ledger entry that was fully applied to, you can see that the
Open check box is not selected.
NOTE
After you select an entry in the Apply Customer Entries window, or several entries by setting the Applies-to ID, the
Applied Amount field on the journal line will contain the sum of the remaining amounts for the posted entries you have
selected, unless the field contains something already. If you select Apply to Oldest in the Application Method field on the
customer card, the application occurs automatically.
1. Choose the icon, enter Cash Receipts Journal, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the journal you want, and fill in the first empty journal line using a currency code.
3. Choose the Apply Entries action.
4. Select the line with the entry you want to apply to the entry in the cash receipt journal, choose the Set Applies-
to ID action, and then select the entry you want to apply to.
5. Choose the OK button to return to the cash receipt journal.
6. Post the sales journal.
IMPORTANT
When you apply entries in different currencies, the entries are converted to USD. Although the exchange rates for the two
currencies are fixed, for example between USD and EUR, there may be a small residual amount when they are converted to
USD. These small residual amounts are posted as gains and losses to the account specified in the Realized Gains Account
or Realized Losses Account fields in the Currencies window. The Amount (USD) field is also adjusted on the vendor ledger
entries.
1. Choose the icon, enter Customers, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the relevant customer card.
3. Choose the Ledger Entries action.
4. Select the relevant ledger entry, and then choose the Unapply Entries action.
5. Alternatively, choose the Detailed Ledger Entry action.
6. Select the application entry, and then choose the Unapply Entries action.
7. Fill in the fields in the header, and then choose the Unapply action.
IMPORTANT
If an entry has been applied by more than one application entry, you must unapply the latest application entry first.
See Also
Managing Receivables
Sales
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Collect Outstanding Balances
4/16/2018 • 14 minutes to read • Edit Online
Managing receivables includes checking whether amounts due are paid on time. If customers have overdue
payments, you can begin by sending the Customer Statement report as a reminder. Alternatively, you can issue
reminders.
You can use reminders to remind customers about overdue amounts. You can also use reminders to calculate
finance charges, such as interest or fees and include them on the reminder. Use finance charge memos if you want
to debit customers for interest or fees without reminding them of overdue amounts.
Reminders
Before you can create reminders, you must set up reminder terms and assign them to your customers. Each
reminder term has predefined reminder levels. Each reminder level includes rules about when the reminder will
be issued, for example, how many days after the invoice due date or the date of the previous reminder. The
contents of the Finance Charge Terms window determines whether interest is calculated on the reminder.
You can periodically run the Create Reminders batch job to create reminders for all customers with overdue
balances, or you can manually create a reminder for a specific customer and have the lines calculated and filled in
automatically.
After you create the reminders, you can modify them. The text that appears at the beginning and end of a
reminder is determined by the reminder level terms, and can be seen in the Description column. If a calculated
amount has been inserted automatically in the beginning or ending text, the text will not be adjusted if you delete
lines. Then you must use the Update Reminder Text function.
A customer ledger entry with the On Hold field filled in will not prompt the creation of a reminder. However, if a
reminder is created on the basis of another entry, an overdue entry marked on hold will also be included on the
reminder. Interest is not calculated on lines with these entries.
After you have created reminders and made any needed modifications, you can either print test reports or issue
the reminders, typically as email.
Finance Charges
When a customer does not pay by the due date, you can have finance charges calculated automatically and add
them to the overdue amounts on the customer's account. You can inform customers of the added charges by
sending finance charge memos.
NOTE
You use finance charge memos to calculate interest and finance charges and to inform your customers about interest and
finance charges without reminding them of overdue payments. Alternatively, you can calculate interest on overdue
payments when you create reminders.
You can manually create a finance charge memo for an individual customer, and fill in the lines automatically.
Alternatively, you can use the Create Finance Charge Memos function job to create finance charge memos for
all or selected customers with overdue balances.
After you create the finance charge memos, you can modify them. The text that appears at the beginning and end
of the finance charge memo is determined by the finance charge terms, and can be seen in the Description
column on the lines. If a calculated amount has been inserted automatically in the beginning or ending text, the
text will not be adjusted if you delete lines. Then you must use the Update Finance Charge Text function.
After you have created finance charge memos and made any needed modifications, you can either print test
reports or issue the finance charge memos, typically as email.
NOTE
If you are using multiple currencies, the Customer Statement report is always printed in the customer's currency. The last
date in a statement period is also used as the statement date and the aging date, if aging is included.
1. Choose the icon, enter Reminder Terms, and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the fields as necessary.
3. To use more than one combination of reminder terms, set up a code for each one.
1. Choose the icon, enter Reminder Terms, and then choose the related link.
2. In the Reminder Terms window, select the line with the terms you want to set up levels for, and then
choose Levels action.
3. Fill in the fields as necessary.
For each reminder level, you can specify individual conditions, which can include additional fees in both
LCY and in foreign currency. You can define many additional fees in foreign currencies for each code in the
Reminder Levels window.
4. Choose the Currencies action.
5. In the Currencies for Reminder Levels window, define for each reminder level code and corresponding
reminder level number a currency code and an additional fee.
NOTE
When you create reminders in a foreign currency, the foreign currency conditions that you set up here will be used
to create reminders. If there are no foreign currency reminder conditions set up, the LCY reminder conditions that
are set up in the Reminder Levels window will be used and then converted to the relevant currency.
For each reminder level, you can specify text that will be printed before (Beginning Text) or after (Ending
Text) on the entries on the reminder.
6. Choose the Beginning Text or Ending Text actions respectively, and fill in the Reminder Text window.
7. To automatically insert related values in the resulting reminder text, enter the following placeholders in the
Text field.
PLACEHOLDER VALUE
%12 Content of the Add. Fee per Line field on the reminder
header
For example, if you write You owe %9 %7 due on %2., then the resulting reminder will contain the following text:
You owe USD 1.200,50 due on 02-02-2014..
After you have set up the reminder terms, with additional levels and text, enter one of the codes on each of the
customer cards. For more information, see How to: Register New Customers.
1. Choose the icon, enter Reminders, and then choose the related link.
2. In the Reminder window, choose the Create Reminders action.
3. In the Create Reminders window, fill in the fields to define how and to whom the reminders are created.
4. Choose the OK button.
1. Choose the icon, enter Reminders, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the New action.
3. On the General FastTab, fill in the fields as necessary.
4. Choose the Suggest Reminder Lines action.
5. In the Suggest Reminder Lines batch job, fill in the fields to define how and to whom the reminders are
created.
6. Select the Include Entries On Hold check box if you want the reminders to contain overdue open entries
that are on hold.
IMPORTANT
Open entries that are on hold will be inserted, irrespective of the setting in the Only Entries with Overdue Amounts
check box.
1. Choose the icon, enter Reminders, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the relevant reminder, and then choose the Update Reminder Text action.
3. In the Update Reminder Text window, enter the required level in the Reminder Level field.
4. Choose the OK button to update the beginning and ending texts.
To issue a reminder
After you have created reminders and made any needed modifications, you can either print test reports or issue
the reminders.
When you issue a reminder, the data is transferred to a separate window for issued reminders. At the same time,
reminder entries are posted. If interest or an additional fee has been calculated, entries are posted to the customer
ledger and the general ledger.
When a reminder is issued, the entries are posted according to your specifications in the Reminder Terms
window. This specification determines whether interest and/or additional fees are posted to the customer's
account and the general ledger. Setup in the Customer Posting Groups window determines which accounts are
posted to.
For each customer ledger entry on the finance charge memo, an entry is created in the Reminder/Fin. Charge
Entries window.
If the Post Interest or the Post Additional Fee check boxes are selected in the Reminder Terms window, then
the following entries are also created:
One entry in the Cust. Ledger Entries window
One receivables entry in the relevant G/L account
One interest and/or one additional fee entry in the relevant G/L account
In addition, issuing the reminder may result in VAT entries.
1. Choose the icon, enter Reminders, and then choose the related link.
2. Select the relevant reminder, and then choose the Issue action.
3. In the Issue Reminders window, fill in the fields as necessary.
4. Choose the OK button
The reminder is either printed for sent to an specified email as a PDF attachment.
Balance Due method - Finance Charge = Overdue Amount x (Interest Rate / 100)
With the average daily balance method, the number of days the payment is overdue is taken into account:
Average Daily Balance method - Finance Charge = Overdue Amount x (Days Overdue / Interest Period) x (Interest
Rate/100)
In addition, each code in the Finance Charge Terms table is linked to a subtable, the Finance Charge Text table. For
each set of finance charge terms, you can define a beginning and/or an ending text to be included on the finance
charge memo.
1. Choose the icon, enter Finance Charge Terms, and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the fields as necessary.
3. To use more than one combination of finance charge terms, set up a code for each one.
For each finance charge term, you can specify individual conditions, which can include additional fees in
both LCY and in foreign currency. You can define many additional fees in foreign currencies for each code
in the Finance Charge Terms window.
4. Choose the Currencies action.
5. In the Currencies for Fin. Chrg. Terms window, define for each term a currency code and an additional
fee.
NOTE
When you create finance charges in a foreign currency, the foreign currency conditions that you set up here will be
used to create finance charge memos. If there are no foreign currency finance charge conditions set up, then the LCY
finance charge conditions that are set up in the Finance Charge Terms window will be used and then converted to
the relevant currency.
For each finance charge term, you can specify text that will be printed before (Beginning Text) or after
(Ending Text) on the entries on the finance charge memo.
6. Choose the Beginning Text or Ending Text actions respectively, and fill in the Finance Charge Text
window.
7. To automatically insert related values in the resulting finance charge text, enter the following placeholders
in the Text field.
PLACEHOLDER VALUE
1. Choose the icon, enter Finance Charge Memo, and then choose the related link.
2. open the finance charge memo that you want to change text for, and then choose the Update Finance Charge
Text action.
3. In the Update Finance Charge Text window, you can set a filter if you want to update several memos.
4. Choose the OK button to update the beginning and ending texts.
1. Choose the icon, enter Finance Charge Memos, and then choose the related link.
2. Select the relevant memo, and then choose the Issue action.
3. In the Issue Finance Charge Memos window, fill in the fields as necessary.
4. Choose the OK button
The finance charge memo is either printed for sent to an specified email as a PDF attachment.
See Also
Managing Receivables
Sales
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Use Item Charges to Account for Additional
Trade Costs
4/16/2018 • 4 minutes to read • Edit Online
To ensure correct valuation, your inventory items must carry any added costs, such as freight, physical handling,
insurance, and transportation that you incur when purchasing or selling the items. For purchases, the landed cost of
a purchased item consists of the vendor's purchase price and all additional direct item charges that can be assigned
to individual receipts or return shipments. For sales, knowing the cost of shipping sold items can be as vital to your
company as knowing the landed cost of purchased items.
In addition to recording the added cost in you inventory value, you can use the Item Charges feature for the
following:
Identify the landed cost of an item for making more accurate decisions on how to optimize the distribution
network.
Break down the unit cost or unit price of an item for analysis purposes.
include purchase allowances into the unit cost and sales allowances into the unit price.
Before you can assign item charges, you must set up item charge numbers for the different types of item charges,
including to which G/L accounts costs related to sales, purchases, and inventory adjustments are posted to. An item
charge number contains a combination of general product posting group, tax group code, VAT product posting
group, and item charge. When you enter the item charge number on a purchase or sales document, the relevant
G/L account is retrieved based on the setup of the item charge number and the information on the document.
For both purchase and sales documents, you can assign an item charge in two ways:
On the document where the items that the item charge relates to are listed. This you typically do for documents
that are not yet fully posted.
On a separate invoice by linking the item charge to a posted receipt or shipment where the items that the item
charge relate to are listed.
NOTE
You can assign item charges to orders, invoices, and credit memos, for both sales and purchases. The following procedures
describe how to work with item charges for a purchase invoice. The steps are similar for all other purchase and sales
documents.
1. Choose the icon, enter Item Charges, and then choose the related link.
2. In the Item Charges window, choose the New action to create a new line.
3. Fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short description of the field or link to more information.
To assign an item charge directly to the purchase invoice for the item
If you know the item charge at the time when you post a purchase invoice for the item, follow this procedure.
1. Choose the icon, enter Purchase Invoices, and then choose the related link.
2. Create a new purchase invoice. For more information, see How to: Record Purchases.
3. Make sure the purchase invoice has one or more lines of type Item.
4. On a new line, in the Type field, select Charge (Item ).
5. In the Quantity field, enter the units of the item charge that you have been invoiced for.
6. In the Direct Unit Cost field, enter the amount of the item charge.
7. Fill in the remaining fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short description of the field or link to more
information.
In the following steps, you will perform the actual assignment. Until the item charge is fully assigned, the
value in the Qty. to Assign field is in red font.
8. On the Lines tab, choose the Item Charge Assignment action.
The Item Charge Assignment window opens showing one line for each line of type Item on the purchase
invoice. To assign the item charge to one or more invoice lines, you can use a function that assigns and
distributes it for you or you can manually fill in the Qty. to Assign field. The following steps describe how to
use the Suggest Item Charge Assignment function.
9. In the Item Charge Assignment window, choose the Suggest Item Charge Assignment action.
10. If there are more than one invoice lines of type Item, choose one of the four distribution options.
It the item charge is fully assigned, the value in the Qty. to Assign field on the purchase invoice is zero.
The item charge is now assigned to the purchase invoice. When you post the receipt of the purchase invoice, the
items' inventory values are updated with the cost of the item charge.
See Also
Managing Payables
How to: Record Purchases
How to: Invoice Sales
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Work with Payment Tolerances and Payment
Discount Tolerances
4/16/2018 • 13 minutes to read • Edit Online
You can set up a payment tolerance to close an invoice when the payment does not fully cover the amount on the
invoice. You can set up a payment discount tolerance to grant a payment discount after the payment discount date
has passed.
You can use payment tolerances so that every outstanding amount has a set maximum allowed payment
tolerance. If the payment tolerance is met, then the payment amount is analyzed. If the payment amount is an
underpayment, then the outstanding amount is fully closed by the underpayment. A detailed ledger entry is
posted to the payment entry so that no remaining amount is left on the applied invoice entry. If the payment
amount is an overpayment, then a new detailed ledger entry is posted to the payment entry so that no remaining
amount is left on the payment entry.
You can use payment discount tolerances so that if you accept a payment discount after the payment discount
date, then it is always posted to either the payment discount account or a payment tolerance account.
To set up tolerances
Tolerance on days and amounts allows you to close an invoice even though the payment does not fully cover the
amount on the invoice, whether this is because the due date for the payment discount has been exceeded, goods
have been deducted or because of a minor error. This also applies to refunds and credit memos.
To set up tolerance you have to set up various tolerance accounts, specify both payment discount tolerance and
payment tolerance posting methods and then run the Change Payment Tolerance batch job.
1. Choose the icon, enter General Posting Setup, and then choose the related link.
2. In the General Posting Setup window, set up a debit and a credit sales payment tolerance account and a debit
and a credit purchase payment tolerance account.
3. Choose the icon, enter Customer Posting Groups, and then choose the related link.
4. In the Customer Posting Groups window, set up a debit and a credit payment tolerance account. For more
information, see Setting Up Posting Groups.
5. Choose the icon, enter Vendor Posting Setup, and then choose the related link.
6. In the Vendor Posting Groups window, set up a debit and a credit payment tolerance account.
7. Choose the icon, enter General Ledger Setup, and then choose the related link.
8. Open the General Ledger Setup window.
9. On the Application FastTab, fill in the Pmt. Disc. Tolerance Posting, Payment Discount Grace Period and
Payment Tolerance Posting fields.
10. Choose the Change Payment Tolerance action.
11. In the Change Payment Tolerance window, fill in the Payment Tolerance % and Max Payment Tolerance
Amount fields, and then choose the OK button.
IMPORTANT
You have now set up tolerance for local currency only. If you want Dynamics NAV to handle tolerance on payments, credit
memos, and refunds in a foreign currency, you must run the Change Payment Tolerance batch job with a value in the
Currency Code field.
NOTE
If you want to get a payment tolerance warning every time that you post an application in the tolerance, you must activate
the payment tolerance warning. For more information, see the "To enable or disable payment tolerance warning" section.
To deactivate tolerance for a customer or vendor, you must block tolerances on the relevant customer or vendor card. For
more information, see the "To block payment tolerance for customers" section.
When you set up tolerance, Dynamics NAV also checks if there are any open entries and calculates the tolerance for these
entries.
1. Choose the icon, enter General Ledger Setup, and then choose the related link.
2. In the General Ledger Setup window, on the Application FastTab, select the Payment Tolerance Warning
check box to activate the warning. To deactivate the warning, clear the check box.
NOTE
The default option for the Payment Tolerance Warning window is Leave the Balance as Remaining Amount. The
default option for the Pmt. Disc. Tolerance Warning window the is Do Not Accept the Late Payment Discount.
NOTE
If the customer or vendor has open entries, you must first remove payment tolerance from entries that are currently open.
ALL PMT.
MAX PMT. ENTRIE PMT.
PMT. DISC. PAYME TOLER S DISC. TOL.
PMT. PMT. DISC. TOL. NT ANCE CLOSE TOL.
— INV. DISC. TOL. DATE DATE DATE PMT. TYPE D GL/CL G/L
(1) If payment falls in these ranges, all application entries can be closed with or without tolerance.
(2) If payment falls in these ranges, all application entries cannot be closed even with tolerance.
(2) Payment Date is between 01/16/03 and 01/20/03 (Scenarios 4-9)
Remaining Amount per
Normal Application Rules
(1) If payment falls in these ranges, all application entries can be closed with or without tolerance.
(2) If payment falls in these ranges, all application entries cannot be closed even with tolerance.
(3) Payment Date is after 01/20/03 (Scenarios 10-15)
Remaining Amount per
Normal Application Rules
(1) If payment falls in these ranges, all application entries can be closed with or without tolerance.
(2) If payment falls in these ranges, all application entries cannot be closed even with tolerance.
ALL
PMT. ENTRIE PMT. PMT.
MAX PMT. DISC. PAYME TOLER S DISC. TOL.
PMT PMT. DISC. TOL. NT ANCE CLOSE TOL.
— INV. DISC. TOL. DATE DATE DATE PMT TYPE D GL/CL G/L
(1) If payment falls in these ranges, all application entries can be closed with or without tolerance.
(2) If payment falls in these ranges, all application entries cannot be closed even with tolerance.
(3) Payment Date is between 01/18/03 and 01/20/03 (Scenarios 10-21)
Remaining Amount per
Normal Application Rules
(1) If payment falls in these ranges, all application entries can be closed with or without tolerance.
(2) If payment falls in these ranges, all application entries cannot be closed even with tolerance.
(4) Payment Date is between 01/21/03 and 01/22/03 (Scenarios 22-27)
Remaining Amount per
Normal Application Rules
(1) If payment falls in these ranges, all application entries can be closed with or without tolerance.
(2) If payment falls in these ranges, all application entries cannot be closed even with tolerance.
(5) Payment Date is after 01/22/03 (Scenarios 28-30)
Remaining Amount per
Normal Application Rules
(1) If payment falls in these ranges, all application entries can be closed with or without tolerance.
(2) If payment falls in these ranges, all application entries cannot be closed even with tolerance.
See Also
Finance
Setting Up Finance
Managing Receivables
Working with Dynamics NAV
Managing Payables
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
A big part of managing accounts payable is paying your vendors, or reimbursing your employees for expenses.
You can use functions to add payments lines for purchase invoices that are due in the Payment Journal
window. To send transactions to your bank, you can export multiple payment journal lines to a file, and then
upload the file to your bank. You can also make payments by check, including transmitting checks as electronic
payments.
Another typical task is to apply outgoing payments to their related vendor or employee ledger entries in order to
close purchase invoices, purchase credit memos, or employee accounts as paid. You can do this in the Payment
Reconciliation Journal window by importing a bank statement file to register the payments. The payments are
applied to open vendor, customer, or employee ledger entries by matching payment text and entry information.
There are various ways to review and change the matches before you post the journal. You can choose to close
any open bank account ledger entries related to the applied ledger entries when you post the journal. The bank
account is automatically reconciled when all payments are applied.
Alternatively, you can apply outgoing payments manually in the Payment Journal window or from the related
vendor or employee ledger entries.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks within accounts payable, with links to the topics that describe
them.
TO SEE
Apply vendor payments automatically to unpaid purchase Applying Payments Automatically and Reconciling Bank
invoices by importing a bank statement file. Accounts
Apply vendor payments to unpaid purchase invoices How to: Reconcile Vendor Payments Manually
manually.
Ensure correct inventory valuation by assigning added item How to: Use Item Charges to Account for Additional Trade
costs, such as freight, physical handling, insurance, and Costs
transportation that you incur when purchasing.
See Also
Purchasing
Managing Receivables
How to: Use Item Charges to Account for Additional Trade Costs
General Business Functionality
Working with Dynamics NAV
Making Payments
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
When you make payments to vendors or reimbursements to employees, you post the related payment lines in the
Payment Journal window. You can use the Suggest Vendor Payments function to find vendor payments that
are due. You can also use the Vendor - Summary Aging report to get an overview of due vendor payments.
From the payment journal, you can print computer checks or record when checks are written. If you select
Computer Check in the Bank Payment Type field, then any lines representing checks must be printed before
the payment journal can be posted.
When the payments are posted, you can export them to a bank file for upload to your bank for processing.
After the payments are made at your bank, you must apply them to their related open vendor or employee ledger
entries. You can do this manually or by importing a bank statement file and applying the payments automatically.
For more information, see Applying Payments Automatically and Reconciling Bank Accounts.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Use the Payment Journal window, which is a based on the Working with General Journals
general journal, to post payments to vendors or employees.
Use a function to suggest vendor payments according to How to: Suggest Vendor Payments
selected criteria, such as due date, discount eligibility, and
your liquidity.
Reimburse employees for personal expenses during business How to: Record and Reimburse Employees' Expenses
activities by making payment to their bank account.
Issue checks for vendor payments, either as print-outs or as How to: Work With Checks
computer checks. Void checks before or after posting.
Pay the vendor by cash or check, and post the payment when How to: Settle Purchase Invoices Promptly
you post the invoice.
Make sure that your bank only clears validated checks and How to: Export a Positive Pay file
amounts by sending them a file that contains vendor, check,
and payment information.
Export payments from the Payment Journal window to a How to: Export Payments to a Bank File
bank file that you upload to your bank for processing,
including EFT (electronic funds transfer) in North America.
See Also
Managing Payables
Purchasing
Managing Receivables
Working with Dynamics NAV
Applying Payments Automatically and Reconciling
Bank Accounts
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
You must regularly reconcile your bank, receivables, and payables accounts by applying payments recorded in the
bank to their related unpaid invoices and credit memos or other open entries in Microsoft Dynamics NAV.
You can perform this task in the Payment Reconciliation Journal window by importing a bank statement file or
feed to quickly register the payments. Payments are applied to open customer or vendor ledger entries based on
matches between payment text and entry information. You can review and change automatic applications before
you post the journal. You can choose to close any open bank account ledger entries related to the applied ledger
entries when you post the journal. The bank account is automatically reconciled when all payments are applied.
To import bank statements as a bank feed, you must first set up and enable the bank data conversion service. For
more information, see How to: Set Up the Bank Data Conversion Service.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Apply payments to open customer or vendor ledger entries by How to: Reconcile Payments Using Automatic Application
importing a bank statement, and reconcile the bank account
when all payments are applied.
Manually apply payments by viewing detailed information How to: Review or Apply Payments After Automatic
about matched data and suggestions for candidate open Application
entries to apply payments to.
Resolve payments that cannot be applied automatically to How to: Reconcile Payments That Cannot be Applied
their related open ledger entries. For example because the Automatically
amounts differ, or because a related ledger entry does not
exist.
Link text on payments to specific customer, vendor, or general How to: Map Text on Recurring Payments to Accounts for
ledger accounts to always post recurring cash receipts or Automatic Reconciliation
expenses to those accounts when no documents exist to apply
to.
See Also
Managing Receivables
Sales
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Reconcile Vendor Payments Manually
4/16/2018 • 6 minutes to read • Edit Online
When you send a payment or receive a refund from a vendor, you must decide whether to apply the payment or
refund to one or more open entries. You can specify the exact amount that you want to apply to the payment
receipt or refund, and then only partially apply vendor ledger entries. You must apply all vendor ledger entries to
obtain correct vendor statistics and reports of the account statements and finance charges.
NOTE
Vendors may sometimes give a payment refund instead of a credit memo to offset against future invoices, especially when
you return items that you have already paid for or when you have overpaid an invoice.
NOTE
If the Application Method field on the vendor card contains Apply to Oldest, then payments will automatically be applied
to the oldest open credit entry if you do not manually specify which entry to apply to. If the application method for a
customer is Manual, then you must apply entries manually.
You can apply vendor payments manually to their related purchase documents when you post the payments in the
Payment Journal window. For information about filling the payment journal, see Making Payments.
You can also apply vendor payments, and customer payments, after the payments appear as negative bank
transactions in your bank. In the Payment Reconciliation Journal window, you can use functions for bank
statement import, automatic application, and bank account reconciliation. For more information, see Reconcile
Payments Using Automatic Application.
1. Choose the icon, enter Payment Journal, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the journal you want, and fill in the first empty journal line using a currency code.
3. Choose the Apply Entries action.
4. Select the line with the entry you want to apply to the entry in the payment journal, choose the Set Applies-to
ID action, and then select the entry you want to apply to.
5. Choose the OK button to return to the payment journal.
6. Post the payment journal.
IMPORTANT
When you apply entries in different currencies to one another, the entries are converted to USD. Even though the exchange
rates for the two relevant currencies are fixed, for example between USD and EUR, there may be a small residual amount
when these foreign-currency amounts are converted to USD. These small residual amounts are posted as gains and losses to
the account specified in the Realized Gains Account or Realized Losses Account field in the Currencies window. The
Amount (USD) field is also adjusted on the relevant vendor ledger entries.
1. Choose the icon, enter Vendors, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the relevant vendor card.
3. Choose the Ledger Entries action.
4. Select the relevant ledger entry, and then choose the Unapply Entries action.
5. Alternatively, choose the Detailed Ledger Entry action.
6. Select the application entry, and then choose the Unapply Entries action.
7. Fill in the fields in the header, and then choose the Unapply action.
IMPORTANT
If an entry has been applied by more than one application entry, you must unapply the latest application entry first.
See Also
Payables
Purchasing
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Use Item Charges to Account for Additional
Trade Costs
4/16/2018 • 4 minutes to read • Edit Online
To ensure correct valuation, your inventory items must carry any added costs, such as freight, physical handling,
insurance, and transportation that you incur when purchasing or selling the items. For purchases, the landed cost of
a purchased item consists of the vendor's purchase price and all additional direct item charges that can be assigned
to individual receipts or return shipments. For sales, knowing the cost of shipping sold items can be as vital to your
company as knowing the landed cost of purchased items.
In addition to recording the added cost in you inventory value, you can use the Item Charges feature for the
following:
Identify the landed cost of an item for making more accurate decisions on how to optimize the distribution
network.
Break down the unit cost or unit price of an item for analysis purposes.
include purchase allowances into the unit cost and sales allowances into the unit price.
Before you can assign item charges, you must set up item charge numbers for the different types of item charges,
including to which G/L accounts costs related to sales, purchases, and inventory adjustments are posted to. An item
charge number contains a combination of general product posting group, tax group code, VAT product posting
group, and item charge. When you enter the item charge number on a purchase or sales document, the relevant
G/L account is retrieved based on the setup of the item charge number and the information on the document.
For both purchase and sales documents, you can assign an item charge in two ways:
On the document where the items that the item charge relates to are listed. This you typically do for documents
that are not yet fully posted.
On a separate invoice by linking the item charge to a posted receipt or shipment where the items that the item
charge relate to are listed.
NOTE
You can assign item charges to orders, invoices, and credit memos, for both sales and purchases. The following procedures
describe how to work with item charges for a purchase invoice. The steps are similar for all other purchase and sales
documents.
1. Choose the icon, enter Item Charges, and then choose the related link.
2. In the Item Charges window, choose the New action to create a new line.
3. Fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short description of the field or link to more information.
To assign an item charge directly to the purchase invoice for the item
If you know the item charge at the time when you post a purchase invoice for the item, follow this procedure.
1. Choose the icon, enter Purchase Invoices, and then choose the related link.
2. Create a new purchase invoice. For more information, see How to: Record Purchases.
3. Make sure the purchase invoice has one or more lines of type Item.
4. On a new line, in the Type field, select Charge (Item ).
5. In the Quantity field, enter the units of the item charge that you have been invoiced for.
6. In the Direct Unit Cost field, enter the amount of the item charge.
7. Fill in the remaining fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short description of the field or link to more
information.
In the following steps, you will perform the actual assignment. Until the item charge is fully assigned, the
value in the Qty. to Assign field is in red font.
8. On the Lines tab, choose the Item Charge Assignment action.
The Item Charge Assignment window opens showing one line for each line of type Item on the purchase
invoice. To assign the item charge to one or more invoice lines, you can use a function that assigns and
distributes it for you or you can manually fill in the Qty. to Assign field. The following steps describe how to
use the Suggest Item Charge Assignment function.
9. In the Item Charge Assignment window, choose the Suggest Item Charge Assignment action.
10. If there are more than one invoice lines of type Item, choose one of the four distribution options.
It the item charge is fully assigned, the value in the Qty. to Assign field on the purchase invoice is zero.
The item charge is now assigned to the purchase invoice. When you post the receipt of the purchase invoice, the
items' inventory values are updated with the cost of the item charge.
See Also
Managing Payables
How to: Record Purchases
How to: Invoice Sales
Working with Dynamics NAV
Invoicing Prepayments
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Prepayments are payments that are invoiced and posted to a sales or purchase prepayment order before final
invoicing. You might require a deposit before you manufacture items to order, or you might require payment
before you ship items to a customer. The prepayments functionality enables you to invoice and collect deposits
required from customers or to remit deposits to vendors. Thus, you can ensure that all payments are posted
against an invoice.
Prepayment requirements can be defined for a customer or vendor for all items or selected items. After you
complete the required setup, you can generate prepayment invoices from sales and purchase orders for the
calculated prepayment amount. You can change the amounts on the invoice as needed. For example, you can
specify a total amount for the entire order. You can also send additional prepayment invoices if, for example,
additional items are added to the order. You can increase quantities or add new lines to an order after issuing a
prepayment, and then you can post another prepayment invoice. If you want to delete a line for which a
prepayment has already been invoiced, you must issue a prepayment credit memo before you can delete the line.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Set up prepayment posting groups and number series, and How to: Set Up Prepayments
set up default prepayment percentages for customers,
vendors, and items.
Create an order, adjust the prepayment amounts, and issue How to: Create Prepayment Invoices
an invoice for prepayment amounts.
Issue an additional prepayment invoice, either for additional How to: Correct Prepayments
items or for an additional deposit on the original order, or
issue a prepayment credit memo.
See Also
Walkthrough: Setting Up and Invoicing Sales Prepayments
Finance
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Set Up Prepayments
4/16/2018 • 4 minutes to read • Edit Online
If you require your customers to submit payment before you ship an order to them, or if your vendor requires you
to submit payment before they ship an order to you, you can use the Prepayment functionality. The functionality
enables you to invoice and collect deposits required from customers or to remit deposits to vendors, and to ensure
that all partial payments are posted against an invoice. For more information, see How to: Create Prepayment
Invoices.
Before you can post prepayment invoices, you have to set up the posting accounts in the general ledger, and you
have to set up number series for prepayment documents.
You can define the percentage of the line amount that will be invoiced for prepayment, for a customer or vendor,
for all items or selected items. After you complete the setup, you can generate prepayment invoices from sales and
purchase orders. You can use the default percentages for each sales or purchase line, or you can change the
amounts on the invoice as needed. For example, you can specify a total amount for the entire order.
Because the prepaid amount belongs to the buyer until they have received the goods or services, you need to set
up general ledger accounts to hold the prepayment amounts until the final invoice is posted. Sales prepayments
must be recorded in a liabilities account until the items are shipped. Purchase prepayments must be recorded in an
assets account until the items are received. In addition, you must set up a separate general ledger account for each
VAT identifier.
1. Choose the icon, enter Items, and then choose the related link.
2. Select an item, and then choose the Prepayment Percentages action.
3. In the Sales Prepayment Percentages window, fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short
description of the field or link to more information.
For a customer or vendor, you can set up one default prepayment percentage for all items and all types of sales
lines. You enter this on the customer or vendor card.
1. Choose the icon, enter Customers, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the card for a customer.
3. Fill in the Prepayment % field.
4. Repeat the steps for other customers or for vendors.
To determine which prepayment percentage has first priority
An order may have a prepayment percentage on the sales header, and a different percentage for the items on the
lines. To determine which prepayment percentage applies to each sale line, the system looks for the prepayment
percentage in the following order and will apply the first default that it finds:
1. A prepayment percentage for the item on the line and the customer that the order is for.
2. A prepayment percentage for the item on the line and the customer price group that the customer belongs to.
3. A prepayment percentage for the item on the line for all customers.
4. The prepayment percentage on the sales or purchase header.
In other words, the prepayment percentage on the customer card will only apply if there is no prepayment
percentage set up for the item. However, if you change the contents of the Prepayment Percentage field on the
sales or purchase header after you create the lines, the prepayment percentage on all of the lines will be updated.
This makes it easy to create an order with a fixed prepayment percentage, regardless of the percentage set up on
items.
See Also
Invoicing Prepayments
Walkthrough: Setting Up and Invoicing Sales Prepayments
Understanding the General Ledger and the COA
Finance
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Create Prepayment Invoices
8/13/2018 • 3 minutes to read • Edit Online
If you require your customers to submit payment before you ship an order to them, or if your vendor requires you
to submit payment before they ship an order to you, you can use the prepayment functionality.
After you create a sales or purchase order, you can create a prepayment invoice. You can use the default
percentages for each sales or purchase line, or you can adjust the amount as necessary. For example, you can
specify a total amount for the entire order.
The following procedure describes how to invoice a prepayment for a sales orders. The steps are similar for
purchase orders.
NOTE
If you are located in North America, you cannot change the prepayment percentage after the prepayment invoice has been
posted. This is prevented in the North American version of Dynamics NAV because the calculation of sales tax will otherwise
be incorrect.
When you are ready to post the rest of the invoice, post it as you would post any invoice, and the prepayment
amount will automatically be deducted from the amount due.
See Also
Invoicing Prepayments
Walkthrough: Setting Up and Invoicing Sales Prepayments
Finance
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Correct Prepayments
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
You can make a correction to an order after you have posted a prepayment invoice for the order. You can add new
lines to an order after issuing a prepayment, and then you can post another prepayment invoice, but you cannot
delete a line from an order after a prepayment has been invoiced for the line.
To correct a prepayment
The following procedure shows how to issue a prepayment credit memo to cancel all invoiced prepayments for a
sales order.
1. Choose the icon, enter Sales Orders, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the relevant sales order.
3. Choose the Prepayment action, and then choose the Post Prepayment Credit Memo action or the Post
and Print Prepmt. Cr. Memo action.
4. In the Sales Credit Memo window, proceed to correct the relevant entries, as for any sales credit memo.
For more information, see How to: Process Sales Returns or Cancellations.
NOTE
To Reduce the amount in the Line Amount field, you must first increase the prepayment percentage on the line so
that the value in the Prepmt. Line Amount field is not decreased below the value in the Prepmt. Amt. Inv. field.
5. To make a prepayment invoice for any new lines in the sales credit memo, choose the Prepayment action,
and then choose the Post Prepayment Invoice action or the Post and Print Prepmt. Invoice action.
6. To issue an additional prepayment invoice, increase the prepayment amount on one or more lines and post
the prepayment invoice. A new invoice will be created for the difference between the prepayment amounts
invoiced and the new prepayment amounts.
See Also
Invoicing Prepayments
Walkthrough: Setting Up and Invoicing Sales Prepayments
Finance
Working with Dynamics NAV
Managing Bank Accounts
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
At regular intervals, you must reconcile your bank ledger entries in Dynamics NAV with the related bank
transactions in bank accounts at your bank, and then post the balance to your bank account. You can perform this
task either as part of processing the payments represented on a bank statement in the Payment Reconciliation
Journal. Alternatively, you can perform the task separately from payment processing, in the Bank Acc.
Reconciliation window, which supports check ledger entries. In both cases, you fill in the windows by importing
the bank statement into Dynamics NAV.
Sometimes, you need to transfer amounts between bank account in Dynamics NAV to reflect transfers at your
bank. You perform this task in the General Journal window, in different ways depending on the currency of the
funds.
Before you can manage bank accounts, you must set each bank account up as a bank account card. In addition,
you must set up electronic services that you may use for bank statement import and payment file export. For
more information, see Set Up Bank Accounts.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Reconcile bank accounts in connection with payment Applying Payments Automatically and Reconciling Bank
processing in the Payment Reconciliation Journal window. Accounts
Reconcile bank accounts, including check ledger entries, as a How to: Reconcile Bank Accounts Separately
separate task in the Bank Acc. Reconciliation window.
Post transfers between bank accounts in the same currency How to: Transfer Bank Funds
or in different currencies.
See Also
Setting Up Banking
Managing Receivables
Managing Payables
Working with Dynamics NAV
General Business Functionality
Applying Payments Automatically and Reconciling
Bank Accounts
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
You must regularly reconcile your bank, receivables, and payables accounts by applying payments recorded in
the bank to their related unpaid invoices and credit memos or other open entries in Microsoft Dynamics NAV.
You can perform this task in the Payment Reconciliation Journal window by importing a bank statement file
or feed to quickly register the payments. Payments are applied to open customer or vendor ledger entries based
on matches between payment text and entry information. You can review and change automatic applications
before you post the journal. You can choose to close any open bank account ledger entries related to the applied
ledger entries when you post the journal. The bank account is automatically reconciled when all payments are
applied.
To import bank statements as a bank feed, you must first set up and enable the bank data conversion service. For
more information, see How to: Set Up the Bank Data Conversion Service.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Apply payments to open customer or vendor ledger entries How to: Reconcile Payments Using Automatic Application
by importing a bank statement, and reconcile the bank
account when all payments are applied.
Manually apply payments by viewing detailed information How to: Review or Apply Payments After Automatic
about matched data and suggestions for candidate open Application
entries to apply payments to.
Resolve payments that cannot be applied automatically to How to: Reconcile Payments That Cannot be Applied
their related open ledger entries. For example because the Automatically
amounts differ, or because a related ledger entry does not
exist.
Link text on payments to specific customer, vendor, or How to: Map Text on Recurring Payments to Accounts for
general ledger accounts to always post recurring cash Automatic Reconciliation
receipts or expenses to those accounts when no documents
exist to apply to.
See Also
Managing Receivables
Sales
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Reconcile Bank Accounts Separately
4/16/2018 • 5 minutes to read • Edit Online
To reconcile bank accounts in Dynamics NAV with statements received from the bank, you must fill in the lines in
the Bank Acc. Reconciliation window.
NOTE
You can also reconcile bank accounts in the Payment Reconciliation Journal window. Any open bank account ledger
entries related to the applied customer or vendor ledger entries will be closed when you choose the Post Payments and
Reconcile Bank Account action. This means that the bank account is automatically reconciled for payments that you post
with the journal. For more information, see How to: Reconcile Payments Using Automatic Application.
To enable import of bank statements as bank feeds, you must first set up and enable the bank data conversion
service. For more information, see How to: Set Up the Bank Data Conversion Service.
The lines in the Bank Acc. Reconciliation window are divided into two panes. The Bank Statement Lines pane
shows either imported bank transactions or ledger entries with outstanding payments. The Bank Account
Ledger Entries pane shows the ledger entries in the bank account.
The activity of finding and applying entries to be reconciled is referred to as matching. You can choose to perform
matching automatically by using the Match Automatically function. Alternatively, you can manually select lines
in both panes to link each bank statement line to one or more related bank account ledger entries, and then use
the Match Manually function. The Applied checkbox is selected on lines where entries match.
You can fill in the Bank Statement Lines pane in the Bank Acc. Reconciliation window in the following ways:
Automatically, by using the Import Bank Statement function to fill in the lines according to actual bank
statements based on a file provided by the bank.
Manually, by using the Suggest Lines function to fill in the lines with ledger entries for invoices that have
outstanding payments.
When the value in the Total Balance field in the Bank Statement Lines pane equals the value in the Balance To
Reconcile field in the Bank Account Ledger Entries pane, you can choose the Post action to reconcile the
applied bank account ledger entries. Any non-applied bank account ledger entries will remain in the window,
indicating that payments processed for the bank account are not reflected in the latest bank statement, or that
some payments were received on checks.
NOTE
If bank statement lines relate to check ledger entries, then you cannot use the matching functions. Instead, you must choose
the Apply Entries action, and then select the relevant check ledger entry to match the bank statement line with.
See Also
Managing Bank Accounts
Setting Up Banking
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Transfer Bank Funds
8/13/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
You may sometimes need to transfer an amount from one bank account to another. To do this, you must post the a
transaction in the general journal. The task varies depending on whether the bank accounts use the same currency
or different currencies.
To post a transfer between bank accounts with the same currency code
1. Choose the icon, enter General Journal, and then choose the related link.
2. On a journal line, fill in the Posting Date and Document No. fields.
3. In the Account Type field, select Bank Account.
4. In the Account No. field, select the bank from which you want to transfer the funds.
5. In the Amount field, enter the amount to be transferred.
6. In the Bal. Account Type field, select Bank Account.
7. In the Bal. Account No. field, select the bank account to which you want to transfer the funds.
8. Post the journal.
1. Choose the icon, enter General Journal, and then choose the related link.
2. Create two journal lines, and fill in the Posting Date and Document No. fields.
3. On the first journal line, in the Type field, select Bank Account.
4. In the Account No. field, select the bank account from which you want to transfer the funds.
5. In the Amount field, enter the amount in the currency of the bank account. Enter credit amounts with a
minus sign. Enter debit amounts without a minus sign.
6. In the Bal. Account Type field, select Bank Account.
7. In the Bal. Account No. field, select the bank account to which you want to transfer the funds.
8. On the second journal line, in the Type field, select Bank Account.
9. In the Account No. field, select the bank account to which you want to transfer the funds.
10. In the Amount field, enter the amount in the currency of the bank account. Enter credit amounts with a
minus sign. Enter debit amounts without a minus sign.
11. In the Bal. Account Type field, select Bank Account.
12. In the Bal. Account No. field, select the bank account from which you want to transfer the funds.
NOTE
If the exchange rates used in the journal are different than the exchange rates in the Currency Exchange Rates
window, enter a third line for the exchange rate gain or loss. Enter G/L Account in the Account Type field. Enter the
G/L account number for exchange rate gain or loss in the Account No. field. Enter the exchange rate gain or loss in
the Amount field with or without a minus sign for credits and debits respectively.
See Also
Managing Bank Accounts
Setting Up Banking
Working with General Journals
Working with Dynamics NAV
Managing Intercompany Transactions
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Your organization may consist of several companies, but might not have the equivalent number of accounting and
administrative teams. The Intercompany functionality lets you do business with your subsidiary and internal
partner organizations in the same way as you engage with your external vendors and customers. You enter
intercompany transaction information only once in the appropriate documents. You can use the functionality you
are already familiar with, such as receivables and payables management. Mapping facilities for the chart of
accounts and dimensions help ensure that information appears in the right places.
There are four main benefits to the Intercompany functionality:
Increased productivity as a result of time saved and simplified transactions
Minimized error potential with one-time entry of information and system-wide, automated updates
Complete audit trail and full visibility into business activities and transaction histories
Efficient, cost-effective transactions with affiliate and subsidiary companies
You are in full control of all transaction documents. For example, you can reject a document sent to you and, in this
way, reverse postings that were incorrect. Or, when making a purchase from a partner or subsidiary company, you
can update the purchase order as long as the selling company has not shipped any goods.
When you enter a transaction, you do not need to specify the accounts for an individual set of books, but simply
give the identification of the partner company. The Intercompany functionality creates general journal lines that
result in the balancing of the books of both companies involved in a transaction. In receivables and payables, you
assign an intercompany partner code to any customer or vendor. From that moment on, all orders and invoices
generated pertaining to transactions with these companies will produce corresponding documents in the partner
company, resulting in correct balancing of the accounts.
After you set up business partners as customers and vendors in the system, and assign them intercompany
partner codes, it is possible to exchange intercompany purchase and sales documents, including items and item
charges. The Intercompany functionality allows intercompany transactions between multiple databases, for
example, in different countries/regions, as well as multiple currencies, different charts of accounts, different
dimensions, and different item numbering.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Create your intercompany vendors and customers as so- How to: Set Up Intercompany
called intercompany partners, and set up an intercompany
chart of accounts.
Use intercompany documents or journals to post transactions How to: Work with Intercompany Documents and Journals
with your intercompany partners.
Organize and process incoming and outgoing transactions How to: Manage the Intercompany Inbox and Outbox
that you exchange with your intercompany partners.
See Also
Finance
Setting Up Finance
Working with General Journals
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Set Up Intercompany
4/16/2018 • 9 minutes to read • Edit Online
To send a transaction (such as a sales journal line) from one company and have the corresponding transaction
(such as a purchase journal line) automatically created in the partner company, the companies involved must agree
on a common chart of accounts and set of dimensions for use on intercompany transactions. The intercompany
chart of accounts can be, for example, a simplified version of the parent company's chart of accounts. Each
company maps their full chart of accounts to the shared intercompany chart of accounts, and each company maps
their dimensions to the intercompany dimensions.
You must also set up an intercompany partner code for each partner company, which is agreed upon by all of the
companies, and then assign them to customer and vendor cards respectively by filling in the Intercompany
Partner Code field.
If you create or receive intercompany lines with items, you can either use your own item numbers, or you can set
up your partner's item numbers for each relevant item, either in the Vendor Item No. field or in the Common
Item No. field on the item card. You can also use the Item Cross Reference function: To map your items'
numbers to your intercompany partners descriptions of the items, open the card of each item, and then choose the
Cross References action to set up cross-references between your item descriptions and those of the intercompany
partner.
If you will make intercompany sales transactions that include resources, you must fill in the IC Partner Purch. G/L
Acc. No. field on the resource card for each relevant resource. This is the number of the intercompany general
ledger account that the amount for this resource will be posted to in your partner's company. For more
information, see
1. Choose the icon, enter IC Chart of Accounts, and then choose the related link.
2. In the IC Chart of Accounts window, choose the Export action, and then choose the Save button.
3. Specify the file name and the location where you want to save the XML file, and then choose the Save button.
To import the intercompany chart of accounts
When a file exists for the defining intercompany chart of accounts, intercompany partners can import it to make
sure they have the same accounts.
1. Choose the icon, enter IC Chart of Accounts, and then choose the related link.
2. In the IC Chart of Accounts window, choose the Import action.
3. Select the file name and location of the XML file, and then choose the Open button.
The IC Chart of Accounts window is filled with new or edited G/L account lines according to the intercompany
chart of accounts in the file. Any existing, unrelated lines in the window remain unchanged.
To map the intercompany chart of accounts to your company's chart of accounts
When you have defined or imported the intercompany chart of accounts that you and your intercompany partners
have agreed to use, you must associate each of the intercompany G/L accounts with one of your company's G/L
accounts. In the IC Chart of Accounts window, you specify how intercompany G/L accounts on incoming
transactions will be translated into G/L accounts from your company's chart of accounts.
If the accounts in the intercompany chart of accounts have the same numbers as the corresponding accounts in the
chart of accounts, you can map the accounts automatically.
1. Choose the icon, enter IC Chart of Accounts, and then choose the related link.
2. Select the lines that you want to map automatically, and then choose the Map to Acc. with Same No action.
3. For each intercompany general ledger account that was not mapped automatically, fill in the Map-to G/L Acc.
No. field.
1. Choose the icon, enter Chart of Accounts, and then choose the related link.
2. On the line for a G/L account that is used for intercompany transactions, in the Default IC Partner G/L
Account field, enter the intercompany general ledger account that your partner will post to when you post to
the general ledger account on the line.
3. Repeat step 3 for each account that you often enter in the Bal. Account No. field on a line in an intercompany
journal or document.
1. Choose the icon, enter intercompany Dimensions, and then choose the related link.
2. In the intercompany Dimensions window, choose the Import action.
3. Specify the file name and location of the XML file, and then choose the Open button.
The lines in the intercompany Dimensions window and the intercompany Dimension Values window are
imported.
To map intercompany dimensions to your company's dimensions
When you have defined or imported the dimensions that you and your intercompany partners have agreed to use,
you must associate each of the intercompany dimensions with one of your company's dimensions, and vice versa.
In the intercompany Dimensions window, you specify how intercompany dimensions on incoming transactions
will be translated into dimensions from your company's list of dimensions. In the Dimensions window, you
specify how your dimensions will be translated into intercompany dimensions on outgoing transactions.
If any of the intercompany dimensions have the same code as the corresponding dimensions in your company's
list of dimensions, then you can have the program automatically map the dimensions, then you can map the
accounts automatically.
1. Choose the icon, enter intercompany Dimensions, and then choose the related link.
2. In the intercompany Dimensions window, select the lines that you want to automatically map, and then
choose the Map to Dim. with Same Code action.
3. For each intercompany dimension that is not mapped automatically, fill in the Map-to Dimension Code
field.
4. Choose the intercompany Dimension Values action.
5. In the intercompany Dimension Values window, fill in the Map-to Dimension Value Code field.
Proceed to map dimensions to intercompany dimensions by performing similar steps.
6. Choose the icon, enter Dimensions, and then choose the related link.
7. In the Dimensions window, select the lines that you want to automatically map, and then choose the Map
to IC Dim. with Same Code action.
8. For each intercompany dimension that is not mapped automatically, fill in the Map-to IC Dimension
Value Code field.
9. Choose the Dimension Values action.
10. In the Dimension Values window, fill in the Map-to IC Dimension Value Code field.
See Also
Managing Intercompany Transactions
Finance
Setting Up Finance
Working with General Journals
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Work with Intercompany Documents and
Journals
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
You use intercompany documents or journals to post transactions with your intercompany partners. When you
post an intercompany document or journal line in your company, a corresponding document or journal line is
created in your intercompany outbox that you can transfer to your partner. Your partner can then post the
corresponding transaction in their company, without having to re-enter the data.
For sales and purchase documents, the intercompany partner code on the involved customer or vendor ensures
that all orders and invoices generated pertaining to transactions with these companies will produce corresponding
documents in the partner company, resulting in correct balancing of the accounts.
For intercompany general journal lines, you do not need to specify the accounts for an individual set of books, but
simply give the identification of the partner company. Corresponding intercompany general journal lines are then
created in the partner company that result in the balancing of the books of both companies involved in a
transaction.
1. Choose the icon, enter Sales Orders, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose New to create a new sales order. For more information, see How to: Sell Products.
3. Fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short description of the field or link to more information.
4. Make sure the customer is an intercompany partner.
5. To send the sales order before you post it, choose the Send IC Sales Order action.
NOTE
If you do perform step 4, then the sales order will be moved to your intercompany outbox where you can send it later. For
more information, see How to: Manage the Intercompany Inbox and Outbox.
1. Choose the icon, enter IC General Journals, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the relevant journal batch. For more information, see Working with General Journals.
3. Fill in the fields as necessary.
4. In the IC Partner G/L Acc. No. field, enter the intercompany general ledger account that the amount will
be posted to in your partner's company.
NOTE
This field must be filled in on a line with a bank account or general ledger account in either the Account No. field or
the Bal. Account No. field.
See Also
Managing Intercompany Transactions
Finance
Setting Up Finance
Working with General Journals
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Manage the Intercompany Inbox and
Outbox
9/21/2018 • 4 minutes to read • Edit Online
All of the intercompany transactions that you receive electronically from your intercompany partners are listed in
the intercompany Inbox.
In that case, you can set the system up to bypass the inbox and outbox by selecting the Auto. Accept Transactions check
box in the Intercompany Partner window and the Auto. Send Transactions check box in the Intercompany Setup
window respectively. The ability to automatically accept transactions is currently limited to sales and purchase documents.
1. Choose the icon, enter Company Information , and then choose the related link.
2. Save the file to the location that you specified in the Intercompany Inbox Details field in the Company
Information window.
3. Choose the icon, enter Intercompany Inbox Transactions, and then choose the related link.
4. In the Intercompany Inbox Transactions window, choose the Import Transaction File action.
5. In the window that appears, select the .xml file that contains the transactions, and then choose the Open
button.
The transactions are imported into the inbox and you can now process them.
1. Choose the icon, enter Intercompany Inbox Transactions, and then choose the related link.
2. In the Intercompany Inbox Transactions window, select a line, and then choose an action, such as Accept, to
process the line.
3. In the Complete IC Inbox Action window, fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short
description of the field or link to more information.
4. Choose the OK button.
For lines that you processed with the Accept action, document or journal lines will be created in your company.
Open each document or journal, make any necessary changes, and then post them.
Lines that you processed with the Return to Partner action will be moved to the outbox from where you can then
send them to your partner.
For lines that you processed with the Returned by Partner action, you must now post a correction to the original
transaction that you posted in your company.
1. Choose the icon, enter Intercompany Outbox Transactions, and then choose the related link.
2. In the Intercompany Outbox Transactions window, select a line, and then choose an action, such as Return
to Inbox, to process the line.
Lines that you processed with the Send to Intercompany Partner action will be sent to the relevant partner's
inbox.
Lines that you processed with the Return to Inbox action will be moved to the inbox where you can then accept
them to create documents or journal lines in your company.
For lines that you processed with the Cancel action, you must now post a correction to the original transaction
that you posted in your company.
1. Choose the icon, enter Handled IC Inbox Transactions, and then choose the related link.
2. In the Handled IC Inbox Transactions window, select the line with the transaction that you want to re-
create in the inbox, and then choose the Re-create Inbox Transaction action.
See Also
Managing Intercompany Transactions
Finance
Setting Up Finance
Working with General Journals
Working with Dynamics NAV
Accounting for Costs
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Cost accounting is used to help you understand the costs of running a business. To get started with cost
accounting, see the following topics.
TO SEE
Understand the terminology that is used in cost accounting. Terminology in Cost Accounting
Learn the processes in transferring general ledger entries to Transferring and Posting Cost Entries
cost entries.
Learn the processes in defining and allocating costs. Defining and Allocating Costs
See Also
Finance
Managing Inventory Costs
Working with Dynamics NAV
Terminology in Cost Accounting
4/16/2018 • 5 minutes to read • Edit Online
This topic defines the key terms that are used in cost accounting.
Key Terms
The following table shows definitions of the key terms in cost accounting.
TERM DEFINITION
Allocation key The allocation key is the basis that is used to allocate costs. It
is typically a quantity, such as square meters occupied,
number of employees, or man-hours used. For example, two
departments, with 20 and 10 employees respectively, share
canteen costs. The costs are distributed between the
departments by using an allocation key that represents the
number of employees. Two thirds of the costs are allocated to
the first department, and one third of the costs are allocated
to the second department.
Allocation source The allocation source establishes which costs are allocated.
Allocations are defined in allocation source and allocation
target tables. Each allocation consists of an allocation source
and one or more allocation targets. For example, all costs for
the heating cost type, which is an allocation source, can be
allocated to the workshop, production, and sales cost centers,
which are three allocation targets.
Allocation target The allocation targets determine where the costs are allocated.
Allocations are defined in allocation source and allocation
target tables. Each allocation consists of an allocation source
and one or more allocation targets. For example, all costs for
the heating cost type, which is an allocation source, can be
allocated to the workshop, production, and sales cost centers,
which are three allocation targets.
Cost type The chart of cost types has the same function as the chart of
accounts in the general ledger. They are often structured
similarly. Therefore it is possible to transfer the general ledger
chart of accounts to the chart of cost types and then modify
it. The chart of cost types can also be created from scratch.
TERM DEFINITION
Cost center Cost centers are most often departments and profit centers
that are largely responsible for company’s costs and income.
Cost centers can be synchronized with dimensions in the
general ledger. It is also possible to add new cost centers and
define their own sorting with subtotals.
Direct cost Direct costs are the costs that can be directly allocated to a
cost object, for example, material purchase for a specific
product.
Fixed cost Fixed costs are the costs that are not dependent on the level
of goods or services produced by the company. They tend to
be time-related, such as salary or rent being paid per month.
They are in contrast to variable costs, which are volume-
related, and are paid per quantity produced.
Indirect cost Indirect costs are not directly accountable to a cost object,
such as a particular function or product. Indirect costs may be
either fixed or variable. Indirect costs can be tax,
administration, personnel, and security costs and are also
known as overhead costs.
Static allocation Static allocations are based on a fixed set of values, for
example, the square meters used, or an established allocation
ratio, such as 5:2:4.
Operational cost Operational costs are the recurring expenses which are related
to the operation of a business, a device, and a component.
TERM DEFINITION
Step variable cost Step variable costs are costs that change dramatically at
certain points because they involve large purchases that
cannot be spread out over time. For example, one employee
can produce 100 tables in a month. The employee’s wage is
constant over a production range of 1 to 100 tables. If the
company wants to produce 110 tables, the company needs
two employees. So the cost will double.
Static weighting Costs are allocated according to allocation keys, which can be
modified by using a multiplier.
For example, two departments, with 20 and 10 employees
respectively, share canteen costs. The costs are distributed
between the departments by using an allocation key that
represents the number of employees that eat in the canteen.
In the first department, only 5 employees eat in the canteen,
so this department has a multiplier of 0.25. The basis for
allocation is 20 x 0.25 = 5. The total number of employees
that eat in the canteen is 15. One third of the costs are
allocated to the first department and two thirds of the costs
are allocated to the second department.
Variable cost Variable costs are expenses that change in proportion to the
activity of a business. Variable costs are the sum of marginal
costs over all units produced. Fixed costs and variable costs
make up the two components of total costs.
See Also
About Cost Accounting
Accounting for Costs
Working with Dynamics NAV
About Cost Accounting
4/16/2018 • 3 minutes to read • Edit Online
Cost accounting can help you understand the costs of running a business. Cost accounting information is
designed to analyze:
What types of costs that you incur when you run a business?
Where do the costs occur?
Who bears the costs?
In cost accounting, you allocate actual and budgeted costs of operations, departments, products, and projects to
analyze the profitability of your company.
Cost Allocations
Allocations move costs and revenues between cost types, cost centers, and cost objects. Overhead costs are first
posted to cost centers and later charged to cost objects. For example, this might be done in a sales department
that sells several products at the same time. Direct costs can be directly allocated to a cost object, such as a
material purchased for a specific product.
The allocation base that is used and the accuracy of the allocation definition have an influence on the results of
cost allocations. The allocation definition is used to allocate costs first from so-called pre-cost centers to main cost
centers and then from cost centers to cost objects.
Each allocation consists of an allocation source and one or more allocation targets. You can allocate actual values
or budgeted values by using the static allocation method that is based on a definite value, such as square footage,
or an established allocation ratio of 5:2:4. You can also allocate actual values or budgeted values by using the
dynamic allocation method with nine predefined allocation bases and 12 dynamic date ranges.
Cost Budgets
You can create as many cost budgets as you want. You can copy the cost budget to the general ledger budget and
vice versa. You can transfer budgeted costs as actual costs.
Cost Reporting
Most reports and statistics are based on the posted cost entries. You can set the sorting of the results and use
filters to define which data must be displayed. You can create reports for cost distribution analysis. In addition, you
can use the standard account schedules to define how your reports for the chart of cost types are displayed.
See Also
Accounting for Costs
Finance
Terminology in Cost Accounting
Working with Dynamics NAV
Setting Up Cost Accounting
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Before you start working with cost accounting, you must perform setup tasks.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Create the chart of cost types. How to: Set Up Cost Types
Learn about the connection between the cost type and the Defining the Relationship Between Cost Types and General
general ledger account. Ledger Accounts
Create the chart of cost centers. How to: Set Up Cost Centers
Create the chart of cost objects. How to: Set Up Cost Objects
See Also
Accounting for Costs
Transferring and Posting Cost Entries
Defining and Allocating Costs
Working with Dynamics NAV
Transferring and Posting Cost Entries
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Before you define cost allocations, you must understand how cost entries come from the following sources:
Automatic transfer of general ledger entries.
Manual cost posting for pure cost entries, internal charges, and manual allocations.
Automatic allocation postings for actual costs.
Transfer of budget entries to actual.
TO SEE
Understand criteria for transferring cost entries from general Criteria for Transferring General Ledger Entries to Cost Entries
ledger.
Transfer general ledger entries to cost entries with a batch job. How to: Transfer General Ledger Entries to Cost Entries
See Also
About Cost Accounting
Setting Up Cost Accounting
Defining and Allocating Costs
Accounting for Costs
Defining and Allocating Costs
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Cost allocations move costs and revenues between cost types, cost centers, and cost objects. You can define as
many allocations as you need. Each allocation consists of:
An allocation source.
One or more allocation targets.
The allocation source establishes which costs must be allocated, and the allocation targets determine where the
costs must be allocated. For example, an allocation source can be the costs for the Electricity and Heating cost
type. You allocate all electricity and heating costs to three cost centers: Workshop, Production, and Sales. These
cost centers are your allocation targets.
For each allocation source, you define an allocation level, a validity period, and a variant as grouping identifier. You
can use a batch job to set filters to select allocation definitions and then run cost allocations automatically.
For each allocation target, you define an allocation base. The allocation base can be either static or dynamic.
Static allocation bases are based on a definite value, such as square footage or an established allocation ratio,
such as 5:2:4.
Dynamic allocation bases depend on changeable values, such as the number of employees in a cost center or
sales revenue of a cost object throughout a certain time period.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Set up allocation source and its targets. How to: Set Up Allocation Source and Targets
Set up various filters for dynamic allocation bases. Setting Filters for Dynamic Allocation Bases
See an example of how to define a static allocation. Scenario Example: Defining Static Allocations Based on
Allocation Ratio
See an example of how to define a dynamic allocation. Scenario Example: Defining Dynamic Allocations Based on
Items Sold
See Also
Setting Up Cost Accounting
Transferring and Posting Cost Entries
Accounting for Costs
Terminology in Cost Accounting
About Cost Accounting
Creating Cost Budgets
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Budgeting in cost accounting resembles budgeting in the general ledger. A cost budget is created based on cost
types just as a budget for the general ledger is created based on general ledger accounts.
A cost budget is created for a certain period of time, for example, a fiscal year. You can create as many cost budgets
as needed. You can create a new cost budget manually, or by importing a cost budget, or by copying an existing
cost budget as the budget base. For more information, see How to: Create Budgets.
You use the following windows to create and analyze cost budgets. Choose the icon to find a window, and then
read the tooltip for each.
TO SEE
Transfer budgets from the general ledger. Copy G-L Budget to Cost Acctg. batch job
See cost budget registers and cost budget entries. Cost Budget Registers page
Print cost budget comparisons using various reports. Cost Acctg. Balance-Budget report
See Also
Accounting for Costs
How to: Create Budgets
Terminology in Cost Accounting
Defining and Allocating Costs
Working with Dynamics NAV
Managing Inventory Costs
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Cost management, also referred to as “costing”, is concerned with recording and reporting business operating
costs. It includes the reporting of manufacturing costs and inventory costs, that is, the value of items.
Central principles to understand are that costing methods define how items are valued when they leave
inventory, that cost adjustment updates the cost of goods sold with related purchase costs posted after the sale,
and that inventory values must be posted to dedicated G/L accounts at regular intervals.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Set up inventory periods, costing methods, and rounding Setting Up Inventory Valuation and Costing
methods.
Appreciate or depreciate the value of one or more items in How to: Revalue Inventory
inventory by posting their current, calculated value.
Adjust item costs, either automatically or manually, to How to: Adjust Item Costs
forward cost changes from inbound entries to their related
outbound entries.
Use special costing functions for every-day item transactions Handling Inventory and Manufacturing Costs
in the item operations.
Periodically update the standard costs of components, in How to: Update Standard Costs
assembly or production BOMs, and roll the new costs up to
the parent item.
Perform period-end control and reporting tasks, such Reporting Costs and Reconciling with the General Ledger
calculate the value of inventory and post costs to the general
ledger.
Learn about all mechanisms in the costing system. Design Details: Inventory Costing
See Also
Finance
Inventory
Sales
Purchasing
Working with Dynamics NAV
About Inventory Costing
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Managing inventory costs is concerned with recording and reporting business operating costs. It includes the
reporting of manufacturing costs and inventory costs, that is, the value of items.
Central principles to understand are that costing methods define how items are valued when they leave inventory,
that cost adjustment updates the cost of goods sold with related purchase costs posted after the sale, and that
inventory values must be posted to dedicated G/L accounts at regular intervals.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Distinguish the five different costing methods and their effect Design Details: Costing Methods
on cost flows.
Learn how item application entries dynamically link inventory Design Details: Item Application
decreases with increases to keep control of cost flows.
Learn how an item's unit cost is continuously updated with Design Details: Cost Adjustment
the cost of its latest transaction according to the item's
costing method.
Learn how an item's average cost is dynamically calculated Design Details: Average Cost
according to the selected average cost period.
Distinguish expected cost (not yet invoiced) from actual cost Design Details: Expected Cost Posting
and learn how it is managed in the general ledger.
Understand the cost adjustment mechanism, which ensures Design Details: Cost Adjustment
that costs are brought forward even if inventory transactions
happen in a random manner.
Read why standard costs are often used by manufacturing About Calculating Standard Cost
companies as a valuation base for components and end items.
Understand how the value of inventory is reflected in the Reporting Costs and Reconciling with the General Ledger
general ledger.
Learn how item charges, such as freight and insurance, can How to: Use Item Charges to Account for Additional Trade
assign additional cost components to an item's unit cost. Costs
Read how inventory periods help a company to control How to: Work with Inventory Periods
inventory value over time by defining shorter periods that can
be closed for posting as the fiscal year progresses.
Understand all mechanisms in the costing engine, including Design Details: Inventory Costing
what happens when you post assembly and production
transactions.
See Also
Managing Inventory Costs
Working with Dynamics NAV
Setting Up Inventory Valuation and Costing
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
To make sure that inventory costs are recorded correctly, you must set up various fields and windows before you
begin to make item transactions.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Set a costing method for each item to govern how its How to: Register New Items
incoming cost is used to assess inventory value and the cost
of goods sold.
Ensure that the cost is automatically posted to the general Automatic Cost Posting field in the Inventory Setup page
ledger whenever an inventory transaction is posted.
Ensure that expected costs are posted to the general ledger to Expected Cost Posting to G/L field in the Inventory Setup
see from the interim G/L accounts an estimate of the amounts page
due and the cost of the traded items before they are actually
invoiced.
Set the system up to adjust for any cost changes How to: Adjust Item Costs
automatically every time you post inventory transactions.
Define if the average cost is to be calculated per item only or Average Cost Calc. Type field in the Inventory Setup page
per item for each stockkeping unit and for each variant of the
item.
Select the period of time you would like the program to use Average Cost Period field in the Inventory Setup page
for calculating the weighted average cost of items that use the
average costing method.
Define inventory periods to control inventory value over time How to: Work with Inventory Periods
by disallowing transaction posting in closed inventory periods.
Ensure that sales returns are applied to the original outbound Exact Cost Reversing Mandatory field in the Sales &
transaction to preserve inventory value. Receivables page
Ensure that purchase returns are applied to the original Exact Cost Reversing Mandatory field in the ´Purchases &
inbound transaction to preserve inventory value. Payables page
Set up the rounding rules to apply when adjusting or Rounding Method page
suggesting item prices and when adjusting or suggesting
standard costs.
See Also
Managing Inventory Costs
Working with Dynamics NAV
Finance
How to: Revalue Inventory
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
If you want to appreciate or depreciate an item or a specific item ledger entry, you must use the revaluation
journal.
To revalue inventory
1. Choose the icon, enter Revaluation Journal, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the Calculate Inventory Value action.
3. In the Calculate Inventory Value window, fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short
description of the field or link to more information.
4. Choose the OK button.
5. On each line in the Revaluation Journal window, in the Unit Cost (Revalued) field, enter the new unit
cost. Alternatively, enter the new total amount in the Inventory Value (Revalued) field.
The relevant fields are automatically updated. Note that the Amount field shows the actual change in
inventory value for the selected item ledger entry. It calculates the difference between the Inventory
Value (Calculated) field and the Inventory Value (Revalued) field.
6. When you have completed all lines in the revaluation journal, choose the Post action.
New value entries are now created to reflect the revaluations that you have posted. You can see the new values on
the respective item cards.
See Also
Design Details: Revaluation
Inventory
Sales
Purchasing
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Adjust Item Costs
4/16/2018 • 5 minutes to read • Edit Online
The cost of an item (inventory value) that you purchase and later sell may change during its lifetime, for example
because a freight cost is added to its purchase cost after you have sold the item. Cost adjustment is especially
relevant in situations where you sell goods before you invoice the purchase of those goods. To always know the
correct inventory value, item costs must therefore regularly be adjusted. This ensures that sales and profit
statistics are up to date and that financial KPIs are correct. For more information, see Design Details: Cost
Adjustment.
As a rule, the value in the Unit Cost field on the item card is based on the standard cost for items with costing
method standard. For items with all other costing methods, it is based on the calculation of the inventory available
(invoiced costs and expected costs) divided by the quantity on hand. For more information, see the
"Understanding Unit Cost Calculation" section.
In Dynamics NAV, item costs are automatically adjusted every time that an inventory transaction occurs, such as
when posting a purchase invoice for an item.
You can also use a function to manually adjust the costs of one or more items. This is useful, for example, when
you know that item costs have changed for other reasons than item transactions.
Item costs are adjusted by the FIFO or the Average costing method, depending on your selection in the Set Up
My Company assisted setup or in the Costing Method field on the item card. For more information, see How to:
Register New Items.
If you use the FIFO costing method, then an item’s unit cost is the actual value of any receipt of the item. Inventory
is valuated with the assumption that the first items placed in inventory are sold first.
If you use the Average costing method, then an item’s unit cost is calculated as the average unit cost at each point
in time after a purchase. Inventory is valuated with the assumption that all inventories are sold simultaneously. For
items that use this costing method, you can choose the Unit Cost field on the item card to view the history of
transactions that the average cost is calculated from
The cost adjustment function processes only value entries that have not yet been adjusted. If the function
encounters a situation where changed inbound costs need to be forwarded to associated outbound entries, then
new adjustment value entries are created, which are based on the information in the original value entries but
contain the adjustment amount. The cost adjustment function uses the posting date of the original value entry in
the adjustment entry, unless that date is in a closed inventory period. In that case, the program uses the starting
date of the next open inventory period. If inventory periods are not used, then the date in the Allow Posting
From field in the General Ledger Setup window will define when the adjustment entry is posted.
1. Choose the icon, enter Adjust Item Costs/Prices, and then choose the related link.
2. In the Adjust Field field, specify which item or SKU card field you want to adjust.
3. In the Adjustment Factor field, specify the factor by which the value will be adjusted. For example, enter 1.5 to
increase the value by 50%.
4. On the Item FastTab, set filters to specify, for example, which items to process with the batch job.
5. Choose the OK button.
See Also
Managing Inventory Costs
Inventory
Sales
Purchasing
Working with Dynamics NAV
Handling Inventory and Manufacturing Costs
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Although much of the cost accounting functionality is expressed in underlying processes with no user interaction,
such as entry application and automatic cost adjustment, a number of fields, windows, and reports are aimed at
users who directly or indirectly manage the cost of items or operations.
Assigning item charges to purchase documents is an example of an indirect cost accounting task. Updating the unit
cost of assembly or production BOM item is an example of a more direct cost accounting task.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Periodically or automatically update the unit cost of one or How to: Adjust Item Costs
multiple items to forward any cost changes from inbound
entries, such as those for purchases or production output, to
the related outbound entries, such as consumption or
transfers.
Get insight into average cost dynamics to make pricing How to: Register New Items
decisions or to track cost fluctuations caused by data entry
errors.
Create a manufacturing item's standard cost by entering the About Calculating Standard Cost
three cost elements: material cost, capacity cost, and
subcontractor cost.
Calculate the unit cost of a BOM item based on the unit costs How to: Work with Bills of Material
of its underlying components.
Complete the costing life cycle of a produced item by About Finished Production Order Costs
adjusting the costs and reconciling the value entries with the
general ledger.
Change the value of an item in inventory or the value of one How to: Revalue Inventory
item ledger entry, such as a purchase transaction.
Manually undo an item application or reapply item ledger How to: Remove and Reapply Item Ledger Entries
entries created by the program.
Use the Applies-from Entry field in the item journal to How to: Close Open Item Ledger Entries Resulting from Fixed
manually create a fixed application between an inbound Application in the Item Journal
transaction and the original outbound transaction.
See Also
Manage Inventory Costs Design Details: Inventory Costing
How to: Update Standard Costs
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
You must periodically update the standard costs of components and roll the new costs up to the parent item. The
process typically consists of the following four steps:
1. Update costs at the component and capacity levels. For more information, see the Suggest Item Standard
Cost batch job.
2. Consolidate and roll up the component and capacity costs to calculate the total manufacturing or assembly cost
of the items.
3. Implement the standard costs that are entered when you run the previous batch jobs. The standard costs do not
take effect until they are implemented. For more information, see Implement Standard Cost Changes.
4. Implement the changes to update the Unit Cost field on the item card and perform inventory revaluation. For
more information, see How to: Revalue Inventory.
For more information, see About Calculating Standard Cost.
See Also
About Calculating Standard Cost
Managing Inventory Costs
Design Details: Costing Methods [Finance
Working with Dynamics NAV
Reporting Costs and Reconciling with the General
Ledger
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
At the end of accounting periods, monthly, yearly or other, a sequence of cost control and auditing tasks must be
performed to report a correct and balanced inventory value to the finance department. Apart from the posting
routine that transfers the individual item value entries to dedicated general ledger accounts, several reports,
tracing functions, and a special reconciliation tool are available to the auditor or controller responsible for this
business-critical work.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
View the inventory value of selected items, including Inventory Valuation report
information about the quantities and values of increases and
decreases in inventory over a selected period.
View the inventory value of selected production orders in Inventory Valuation - WIP report
your WIP (work in process) inventory, such as the quantities
and values of consumption, capacity usage, and output in
ongoing production orders.
View the inventory value of selected items, including their Invt. Valuation - Cost Spec. report
actual and expected cost on the date specified.
Use a report to analyze the reasons for cost variances or to Cost Shares Breakdown report
gain insight into the cost shares of sold items (COGS).
Periodically post the value entries of item transactions from How to: Reconcile Inventory Costs with the General Ledger
the inventory ledger to the related G/L accounts to reconcile
the two ledgers.
Use one window to audit the reconciliation between the How to: Reconcile Inventory Costs with the General Ledger
inventory ledger and the general ledger.
Determine the WIP amount that needs to be posted to How to: Monitor Job Progress and Performance
balance sheet accounts for period-end reporting.
See Also
Setting Up Inventory Valuation and Costing
Managing Inventory Costs
Finance
Inventory
Sales
Purchasing
Working with Dynamics NAV
Design Details: Inventory Costing
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
This documentation provides detailed technical insight to the concepts and principles that are used within the
Inventory Costing features in Dynamics NAV.
Inventory costing, also referred to as cost management, is concerned with recording and reporting business
operating costs.
In This Section
Design Details: Costing Methods
Design Details: Item Application
Design Details: Cost Adjustment
Design Details: Expected Cost Posting
Design Details: Average Cost
Design Details: Variance
Design Details: Rounding
Design Details: Cost Components
Design Details: Inventory Periods
Design Details: Inventory Posting
Design Details: Production Order Posting
Design Details: Assembly Order Posting
Design Details: Reconciliation with the General Ledger
Design Details: Accounts in the General Ledger
Design Details: Revaluation
Understanding the General Ledger and the COA
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
The general ledger stores your financial data, and the chart of accounts shows the accounts that all general
ledger entries are posted to. Dynamics NAV includes a standard chart of accounts that is ready to support your
business.
Account Categories
You can personalize the structure of your financial statements by mapping general ledger accounts to account
categories.
The G/L Account Categories window shows your categories and subcategories, and the G/L accounts that are
assigned to them. You can create new subcategories and assign those categories to existing accounts.
You create a category group by indenting other subcategories under a line in the G/L Account Categories
window. This makes it easy for you to get an overview, because each grouping shows a total balance. For
example, you can create subcategories for different types of assets, and then create category groups for fixed
assets versus current assets.
You can specify whether the accounts in each subcategory must be included in specific types of reports. The
account categories help define the layout of your financial statements.
For example, the default balance statement has a subcategory for Cash under Current Assets. If you want the
balance statement consider petty cash and checking, you can:
1. Add two new subcategories. One for petty cash, and one for your checking account.
2. Specify the additional report definition Cash Accounts for these subcategories.
3. Indent them under the Cash subcategory.
The next time you generate account schedules your balance statement will show a total balance for cash and two
lines with balances for petty cash and the checking account.
See Also
Finance
Setting Up or Changing the Chart of Accounts
Business Intelligence
Working with Dimensions
4/16/2018 • 5 minutes to read • Edit Online
To make it simpler to perform analysis on documents such as sales orders, you can use dimensions. Dimensions
are attributes and values that categorize entries so you can track and analyze them. For example, dimensions can
indicate the project or department an entry came from.
For example, instead of setting up separate general ledger accounts for each department and project, you can use
dimensions. This gives a rich opportunity for analysis, without creating a complicated chart of accounts. For more
information, see Business Intelligence.
Another example is to set up a dimension called Department, and use this dimension when you post sales
documents. This will let you use business intelligence tools to see which department sold which items. The more
dimensions you use, the more detailed reports you can base your business decisions on. For example, a single
sales entry can include multiple dimension information, such as:
The account the item sale was posted to
Where the item was sold
Who sold it
The kind of customer who bought it
Analyzing by Dimensions
The Dimensions functionality plays an important role in business intelligence, such as when defining analysis
views. For more information, see How to: Analyze Data by Dimensions.
TIP
As a quick way to analyze transactional data by dimensions, you can filter totals in the chart of accounts and entries in all
Entries windows by dimensions. Look for the Set Dimension Filter action.
Dimension Sets
A dimension set is a unique combination of dimension values. It is stored as dimension set entries in the database.
Each dimension set entry represents a single dimension value. The dimension set is identified by a common
dimension set ID that is assigned to each dimension set entry that belongs to the dimension set.
When you create a journal line, document header, or document line, you can specify a combination of dimension
values. Instead of explicitly storing each dimension value in the database, a dimension set ID is assigned to the
journal line, document header, or document line to specify the dimension set.
Setting Up Dimensions
You can define the dimensions and dimension values to categorize journals and documents, such as sales orders
and purchase orders. You set up dimensions in the Dimensions window, where you create one line for each
dimension, such as Project, Department, Area, and Salesperson.
You also set up values for dimensions. For example, values might be departments in your company. Dimension
values can be set up in a hierarchical structure similar to the chart of accounts, so that data can be broken down
into various levels of granularity, and subsets of dimension values can be totaled. You can define as many
dimensions and dimension values as you need, and everyone in your company can use them.
You can also set up some global and shortcut dimensions:
Global dimensions are used as filters, for example, on reports and batch jobs. You can use only two global
dimensions, so choose dimensions you will use often.
Shortcut dimensions are available as fields on journal and document lines. You can create up to six of these.
Setting Up Default Dimensions for Customers, Vendors, and Other accounts
You can assign a default dimension for a specific account. The dimension will be copied to the journal or
document when you enter the account number on a line, but you can delete or change the code on the line if
appropriate. You can also make a dimension required for posting an entry with a specific type of account.
Translating the Names of Dimensions
When you create a dimension, and especially a shortcut dimension, what you're actually creating is a custom field
or column heading. If your business is international, you can provide translations for the name of the dimension.
Documents that include the dimension will use the translated name, where applicable.
Example of Dimension Setup
Let's say that your company wants to track transactions based on organizational structure and geographic
locations. To do that, you can set up two dimensions in the Dimensions window:
AREA
DEPARTMENT
10 Americas Begin-Total
30 Pacific Standard
60 Europe Begin-Total
70 EU Standard
80 Non-EU Standard
For the two main geographic areas, Americas and Europe, you add subcategories for regions by indenting the
dimension values. This will let you report on sales or expenses in regions, and get totals for the larger geographic
areas. You could also choose to use countries or regions as your dimension values, or counties or cities,
depending on your business.
NOTE
To set up a hierarchy, the codes must be in alphabetical order. This includes the codes of the dimension values that are
provided in Dynamics NAV.
With this set up, you then add your two dimensions as the two global dimensions in the General Ledger Setup
window. This means that you can use AREA and DEPARTMENT as filters for general ledger entries, as well as on
all reports and account schedules. Both global dimensions are also automatically available for use on entry lines
and document headers as shortcut dimensions.
Using Dimensions
In a document such as a sales order, you can add dimension information for both an individual document line and
the document itself. For example, in the Sales Order window, you can enter dimension values for the first two
shortcut dimensions on the individual sales lines, and you can add more dimension information if you choose the
Dimensions button.
If you work in a journal instead, you can add dimension information to an entry in the same way, if you have set
up shortcut dimensions as fields directly on journal lines.
You can set up default dimensions for accounts or account types, so that dimensions and dimension values are
filled in automatically.
See Also
Business Intelligence
Finance
How to: Analyze Data by Dimensions
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Create Budgets
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
You can have multiple budgets for identical time periods by creating budgets with separate names. First, you set
up the budget name and enter the budget figures. The budget name is then included on all the budget entries you
create.
When you create a budget, you can define four dimensions for each budget. These budget-specific dimensions are
called budget dimensions. You select the budget dimensions for each budget from among the dimensions you
have already set up. Budget dimensions can be used to set filters on a budget and to add dimension information
to budget entries. For more information, see Working with Dimensions.
Budgets play an important role in business intelligence, such as in financial statement based on account schedules
that include budget entries or when analyzing budgeted versus actual amounts in the chart of accounts. For more
information, see Business Intelligence.
Budgets play an important role in business intelligence, such as in financial statement based on account schedules
that include budget entries or when analyzing budgeted versus actual amounts in the chart of accounts. For more
information, see Business Intelligence.
In cost accounting, you work with cost budgets in a similar way. For more information, see Creating Cost Budgets.
NOTE
On the Filters FastTab, you can filter the budget information by budget dimensions you have set up under the budget
name.
See Also
Finance
Business Intelligence
Setting Up Finance
The General Ledger and the Chart of Accounts
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Post Transactions Directly to the General
Ledger
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Most financial transactions are posted to the general ledger through dedicated business documents, such as
purchase invoices and sales orders. For business activities that are not represented by a document in Dynamics
NAV, such as smaller expenses or cash receipts, you can create the related transactions by posting journal lines in
the General Journal window.
A typical use of the general journal is to post employees' expenditure of own money during business activities, for
later reimbursement. For more information, see How to: Record and Reimburse Employees' Expenses.
General journals post financial transactions directly to general ledger accounts and other accounts, such as bank,
customer, vendor, and employee accounts. Posting with a general journal always creates entries on general ledger
accounts. This is true even when, for example, you post a journal line to a customer account, because an entry is
posted to a general ledger receivables account through a posting group. You can personalize your version of a
general journal by setting up a journal batch or template. For more information, see Working with General
Journals.
Unlike for entries that are posted with documents, which require a credit memo process, you can correctly reverse
entries that are posted with the general journal. For more information, see How to: Reverse Postings.
TIP
If you want to enter multiple transaction lines above one balance-account line, for example, for one bank account,
then select the Suggest Balancing Amount check box on the line for your batch in the General Journal Batches
window. Then the Amount field on the balance-account line is automatically prefilled with the value that is required
to balance the transactions.
5. Choose the Post action to record the transactions on the specified G/L accounts.
See Also
Working with General Journals
How to: Record and Reimburse Employees' Expenses
How to: Reverse Postings
Finance
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Reverse Postings
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
To undo an erroneous journal posting, you select the entry and create a reverse entry (entries identical to the
original entry but with opposite sign in the amount field) with the same document number and posting date as
the original entry. After reversing an entry, you must make the correct entry.
You can only reverse entries that are posted from a general journal line. An entry can only be reversed once.
For more information about posting from a general journal, see How to: Post Transactions Directly to the General
Ledger.
If you have made an incorrect negative quantity posting, such as a purchase order with the wrong number of
items and posted it as received but not invoiced, then you can undo the posting.
If you have made an incorrect positive quantity posting, such as a purchase return order with the wrong number
of items and posted it as shipped but not invoiced, then you can undo the posting.
1. Choose the icon, enter General Ledger Entries, and then choose the related link.
2. Select the entry that you want to reverse, and then choose the Reverse Transaction action. Note that is must
originate from a journal posting.
3. In the Reverse Transaction Entries window, select the relevant entry, and then choose the Reverse action.
4. Choose the Yes button on the confirmation message.
6. Choose the icon, enter Purchase Return Orders, and then choose the related link.
7. Open the return order in question, and then choose the Reopen action.
8. Correct the entry in the Quantity field and post the purchase return order again.
See Also
How to: Post Transactions Directly to the General Ledger
Working with General Journals
Finance
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Allocate Costs and Income
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
You can allocate an entry in a general journal to several different accounts when you post the journal. The allocation
can be made by three different methods:
Quantity
Percentage (%)
Amount
The allocation features can be used with recurring general journals and in fixed assets journals.
The following procedures describe how to prepare to allocate costs in a recurring general journal by defining
allocation keys. When allocation keys are defined, you complete and post the journal like any other recurring
general journal. For more information, see Working with General Journals.
1. Choose the icon, enter Recurring General Journal, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the Batch Name field to open the General Journal Batches window.
3. You can either modify allocations on an existing batch in the list or create a new batch with allocations.
To create a new batch, choose the New action, and go to the next step.
To change the allocations of an existing journal, select the journal and go to step 7.
4. In the Name field, enter a name for the batch, such as CLEANING. In the Description field, enter a description,
such as Cleaning Expenses Journal.
5. When you are done, close the window. A new, empty recurring journal opens.
6. Fill in the fields on the line.
7. Choose the Allocations action.
8. Add a line for each allocation. You must fill in either the Allocation %, Allocation Quantity, or Amount field.
You must also fill in the Account No. field and, if you are allocating the transaction among global dimensions,
the global dimension fields.
9. If you enter a percentage on a line, the amount in the Amount field is calculated automatically. These amounts
have the opposite sign from the total amount in the Amount field in the recurring journal.
10. After entering the allocations lines, choose OK to return to the Recurring General Journal window. The
Allocated Amt. (USD ) field is filled in and matches the Amount field.
11. Post the journal.
See Also
Closing Years and Periods
Working with General Journals
Posting Documents and Journals
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Use Item Charges to Account for Additional
Trade Costs
4/16/2018 • 4 minutes to read • Edit Online
To ensure correct valuation, your inventory items must carry any added costs, such as freight, physical handling,
insurance, and transportation that you incur when purchasing or selling the items. For purchases, the landed cost
of a purchased item consists of the vendor's purchase price and all additional direct item charges that can be
assigned to individual receipts or return shipments. For sales, knowing the cost of shipping sold items can be as
vital to your company as knowing the landed cost of purchased items.
In addition to recording the added cost in you inventory value, you can use the Item Charges feature for the
following:
Identify the landed cost of an item for making more accurate decisions on how to optimize the distribution
network.
Break down the unit cost or unit price of an item for analysis purposes.
include purchase allowances into the unit cost and sales allowances into the unit price.
Before you can assign item charges, you must set up item charge numbers for the different types of item
charges, including to which G/L accounts costs related to sales, purchases, and inventory adjustments are posted
to. An item charge number contains a combination of general product posting group, tax group code, VAT
product posting group, and item charge. When you enter the item charge number on a purchase or sales
document, the relevant G/L account is retrieved based on the setup of the item charge number and the
information on the document.
For both purchase and sales documents, you can assign an item charge in two ways:
On the document where the items that the item charge relates to are listed. This you typically do for
documents that are not yet fully posted.
On a separate invoice by linking the item charge to a posted receipt or shipment where the items that the
item charge relate to are listed.
NOTE
You can assign item charges to orders, invoices, and credit memos, for both sales and purchases. The following procedures
describe how to work with item charges for a purchase invoice. The steps are similar for all other purchase and sales
documents.
1. Choose the icon, enter Item Charges, and then choose the related link.
2. In the Item Charges window, choose the New action to create a new line.
3. Fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short description of the field or link to more
information.
To assign an item charge directly to the purchase invoice for the item
If you know the item charge at the time when you post a purchase invoice for the item, follow this procedure.
1. Choose the icon, enter Purchase Invoices, and then choose the related link.
2. Create a new purchase invoice. For more information, see How to: Record Purchases.
3. Make sure the purchase invoice has one or more lines of type Item.
4. On a new line, in the Type field, select Charge (Item ).
5. In the Quantity field, enter the units of the item charge that you have been invoiced for.
6. In the Direct Unit Cost field, enter the amount of the item charge.
7. Fill in the remaining fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short description of the field or link to
more information.
In the following steps, you will perform the actual assignment. Until the item charge is fully assigned, the
value in the Qty. to Assign field is in red font.
8. On the Lines tab, choose the Item Charge Assignment action.
The Item Charge Assignment window opens showing one line for each line of type Item on the
purchase invoice. To assign the item charge to one or more invoice lines, you can use a function that
assigns and distributes it for you or you can manually fill in the Qty. to Assign field. The following steps
describe how to use the Suggest Item Charge Assignment function.
9. In the Item Charge Assignment window, choose the Suggest Item Charge Assignment action.
10. If there are more than one invoice lines of type Item, choose one of the four distribution options.
It the item charge is fully assigned, the value in the Qty. to Assign field on the purchase invoice is zero.
The item charge is now assigned to the purchase invoice. When you post the receipt of the purchase invoice, the
items' inventory values are updated with the cost of the item charge.
See Also
Managing Payables
How to: Record Purchases
How to: Invoice Sales
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Record and Reimburse Employees' Expenses
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Dynamics NAV supports transactions for employee in a similar way as for vendors. Accordingly, employee
posting groups exist to make sure that employee ledger entries are posted to the relevant accounts in the general
ledger.
NOTE
Employee transactions can be posted in the local currency only. Reimbursement payments to employees do not support
discounts and payment tolerances.
If employees spend their own money during business activities, you can post the expense to the employee's
account. Then you can reimburse the employee by making a payment to the employee's bank account, similarly to
how you pay vendors.
1. Choose the icon, enter General Journals, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the relevant general journal batch. For more information, see Working with General Journals.
3. On a new journal line, fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short description of the field or
link to more information.
4. Repeat step 3 for all the expenses that the employee has incurred.
TIP
If you want to enter multiple expense lines above one balance-account line for the employee's bank account, then
select the Suggest Balancing Amount check box on the line for your batch in the General Journal Batches
window. Then the Amount field on the balance-account line is automatically prefilled with the value that is required
to balance the expenses.
5. Choose the Post action to record the expenses on the employee's account.
To reimburse an employee
You reimburse employees by posting payments to their bank account in the Payment Journal window.
1. Choose the icon, enter Payment Journals, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the relevant payment journal batch. For more information, see Working with General Journals.
3. Fill in the fields as necessary. For more information, see Making Payments.
4. Alternatively, choose the Suggest Employee Payment action to automatically insert journal lines for
pending employee reimbursements.
5. Choose the Post action to register the reimbursement.
See Also
How to: Post Transactions Directly to the General Ledger
Working with General Journals
How to: Reverse Postings
Finance
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Defer Revenues and Expenses
4/16/2018 • 4 minutes to read • Edit Online
To recognize a revenue or an expense in a period other than the period in which the transaction was posted, you
can use functionality to automatically defer revenues and expenses over a specified schedule.
To distribute revenues or expenses on the involved accounting periods, you set up a deferral template for the
resource, item, or G/L account that the revenue or expense will be posted for. When you post the related sales or
purchase document, the revenue or expense are deferred to the involved accounting periods, according to a
deferral schedule that is governed by settings in the deferral template and the posting date.
1. Choose the icon, enter Sales Invoices, and then choose the related link.
2. Create a sales invoice for an item that has a deferral template assigned. For more information, see How to:
Invoice Sales.
Notice that as soon as you enter the item (or resource or G/L account) on the invoice line, the Deferral
Code field is filled with the code of the assigned deferral template.
3. Choose the Deferral Schedule action.
4. In the Deferral Schedule window, change settings on the header or values on the lines, for example to
defer the amount to an additional accounting period.
5. Choose the Calculate Schedule action.
6. Choose the OK button. The deferral schedule is updated for the sales invoice. The related deferral template
is unchanged.
1. Choose the icon, enter Sales Deferral Summary, and then choose the related link.
2. In the Sales Deferral Summary window, in the Balance as of field, enter the date up to which you want to
see deferred revenues.
3. Choose the Preview button.
See Also
Finance
Setting Up Finance
Working with General Journals
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Import Payroll Transactions
8/13/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
To account for salary payments and related transactions, you must import and post financial transactions made by
your payroll provider to the general ledger. To do this, you first import a file that you receive from the payroll
provider into the General Journal window. Then you map the external accounts in the payroll file to the relevant
G/L accounts. Lastly, you post the payroll transactions according to the account mapping.
NOTE
To use this functionality, an extension for payroll import must be installed and enabled. The Ceridian Payroll and the
Quickbooks Payroll File Import extensions are pre-installed in Dynamics NAV. For more information, see Customizing
Dynamics NAV Using Extensions.
TIP
In the step about mapping the external payroll records to your G/L accounts, the mappings that you make will be
remembered next time the same records are imported. This will save you time as you do not have to manually fill in
the Account No. field in the general journal every time you have imported recurring payroll transactions.
When you choose the OK button in the assisted setup guide, the General Journal window is filled with
lines representing the transactions that the payroll file contains and with the relevant accounts prefilled in
the G/L Account fields according to mappings you made in the guide.
4. Edit or post the journal lines as for any other general ledger transactions. For more information, see How to:
Post Transactions Directly to the General Ledger.
See Also
Finance
Customizing Dynamics NAV Using Extensions
Working with General Journals
How To: Report VAT to a Tax Authority
8/13/2018 • 7 minutes to read • Edit Online
This topic describes the reports in Dynamics NAV that you can use to submit information about value-added tax
(VAT) amounts for sales and purchases to tax authorities in your region.
You can use the following reports :
The EC Sales List European Community (EC ) Sales List report lists the value added tax (VAT) amounts that
you have collected for sales to VAT-registered customers in the European Union (EU ) countries.
The VAT Return report includes VAT for sales and purchases to customers in all countries that use VAT.
If you want to view a complete history of VAT entries, every posting that involves VAT creates an entry on the
VAT Entries page. These entries are used to calculate your VAT settlement amount, such as your payment and
refund, for a specific period. To view VAT entries, choose the icon, enter VAT Entries, and then choose the
related link.
1. Choose the icon, enter Service Connections, and then choose appropriate link.
2. Fill in the required fields. Choose a field to read a short description of the field or link to more information.
NOTE
It's a good idea to test your connection. To do this, choose the Test Mode check box, then prepare and submit your
VAT report as described in the To prepare and submit a VAT report section. While in Test Mode, the service tests
whether the tax authority can receive your report, and the status of the report will indicate whether the test
submission was successful. It's important to remember that this is not an actual submission. To submit the report
for real, you must clear the Test Mode check box, and then repeat the submission process.
NOTE
For the EC Sales List report, you can review the transactions included in the report lines before you submit the
report. To do that, choose the line, and then choose the Show VAT Entries action.
4. To validate and prepare the report for submission, choose the Release action.
NOTE
Dynamics NAV validates whether the report is set up correctly. If the validation fails, the errors display under Errors
and Warnings so that you know what to fix. Typically, if the message is about a missing setting in Dynamics NAV,
you can choose the message to open the page that contains the information to correct.
5. To submit the report, choose the Submit action.
After you submit the report, Dynamics NAV monitors the service and keeps a record of your communications.
The Status field indicates where the report is in the process. For example, when the authorities process your
report, the status of the report changes to Succeeded. If the tax authority found mistakes in the report you
submitted, the status of the report will be Failed. You can view the errors under Errors and Warnings, correct
them, and then submit the report again. To view a list of all your EC Sales List reports, go to the EC Sales List
Reports page.
VAT settlement
Periodically, you must remit the net VAT to the tax authorities. If you need to settle VAT frequently, you can run the
Calc. and Post VAT Settlement batch job to close the open VAT entries and transfer purchase and sales VAT
amounts to the VAT settlement account.
When you transfer VAT amounts to the settlement account, the purchase VAT account is credited, and the sales
VAT account is debited with the amounts calculated for the specified period. The net amount is credited or debited,
if the purchase VAT amount is larger, to the VAT settlement account. You can post the settlement immediately or
print a test report first.
NOTE
When you use the Calc. and Post VAT Settlement batch job, if you don't specify a VAT Bus. Posting Group and a VAT
Prod. Posting group, entries with all business posting groups and product posting group codes are included.
Suggest Lines Fetch information from the VAT Entries table, and display it in
lines on the VAT report.
Submission Control how, and when, you submit the report based on the
requirements of your tax authority.
Response Handler Handle the return from the tax authority. For example, it
might send an email message to your company's contact
person.
NOTE
When you create codeunits for the report, pay attention to the value in the VAT Report Version field. This field must
reflect the version of the report that is, or was, required by the tax authority. For example, you might enter 2017 in the field
to indicate that the report conforms to the requirements that were in place that year. To find the current version, contact
your tax authority.
See also
Setting Up to Calculations and Posting Methods for Value-Added Tax
How to: Work with VAT on Sales and Purchases
Set Up Sales
How to: Invoice Sales
How to: Work with VAT on Sales and Purchases
8/13/2018 • 12 minutes to read • Edit Online
If your country or region requires you to calculate value-added tax (VAT) on sales and purchase transactions so
that you can report the amounts to a tax authority, you can set up Dynamics NAV to calculate VAT automatically
on sales and purchase documents. For more information, see Setting Up to Calculations and Posting Methods for
Value-Added Tax.
There are, however, some VAT-related tasks that you can do manually. For example, you might need to correct a
posted amount if you discover that a vendor uses a different rounding method.
No check mark No check mark The Unit Price on the Item Card is
copied to Unit Price Excl. VAT field on
the sales lines.
PRICES INCLUDING VAT FIELD IN SALES
PRICE INCLUDES VAT FIELD ON ITEM CARD HEADER ACTION PERFORMED
Check mark Check mark The Unit Price on the Item Card is
copied to Unit Price Incl. VAT field on
the sales lines.
NOTE
If the difference is greater, a warning will be displayed stating the maximum allowed difference. To continue, you
must adjust the amount. Choose OK and then enter an amount that is within the allowed range. If the VAT
difference is equal to or lower than the maximum allowed, Dynamics NAV will show the difference in the VAT
Difference field.
NOTE
If the VAT Posting Group setup does not have the Certificate of Supply Required check box selected, then a
record is created and the Status field is set to Not Applicable. You can update the field to reflect the correct status
information. You can manually change the status from Not Applicable to Required, and from Required to Not
Applicable as needed.
When you update the Status field to Required, Received, or Not Received, a certificate is created.
TIP
You can use the Certificates of Supply window to get a view of the status of all posted shipments for which a
certificate of supply has been created.
NOTE
Alternatively, you can print a certificate from the Certificate of Supply page.
4. To include information from the lines on the shipment document in the certificate, select the Print Line
Details check box.
5. Choose the Create Certificates of Supply if Not Already Created check box to have Dynamics NAV
create certificates for posted shipments that do not have one at the moment of execution. When you
choose the check box, new certificates will be created for all posted shipments that do not have certificates
within the selected range.
6. By default, the filter settings are for the shipment document that you have selected. Fill in the filter
information to select a specific certificate of supply that you want to print.
7. On the Certificate of Supply page, choose the Print action to print the report, or choose the Preview
action to view it on the screen.
NOTE
The Certificate of Supply Status field and the Printed field are updated for the shipment in the Certificates of
Supply page.
NOTE
You cannot create a new certificate of supply in the Certificate of Supply window when you navigate to it using
this procedure. To create a certificate for a shipment that was not set up to require one, open the posted sales
shipment, and use either of two procedures described above:
To manually create a certificate of supply certificate
To print a certificate of supply.
See Also
Setting Up to Calculations and Posting Methods for Value-Added Tax
How To: Report VAT to a Tax Authority
How to: Convert Service Contracts that Include VAT
Amounts
4/16/2018 • 3 minutes to read • Edit Online
Because the VAT rate change tool cannot convert service contracts, these contracts must be converted manually.
This topic describes several alternative methods that you can use for service contract conversion.
NOTE
This topic provides a high-level workflow.
The following procedure describes how to correct an invoice for a prepaid service contact that has been created a
year in advance.
NOTE
For this example, you must change your work date to 01.01.2017.
NOTE
Do not change the unposted service invoice. Since the service ledger entries are created when the invoice is created, a change
in the unposted invoice will not change the already created service ledger entries. However, the VAT entries are created when
the invoice is posted. This lets you change the general product posting group and the GSP product posting group on the
unposted service invoice.
See Also
How to: Work with Service Contracts and Service Contract Quotes
Finance
How to: Report VAT to Tax Authorities
How to: Work with VAT on Sales and Purchases
How To: Work with the Consolidated Trial Balance
Report
4/16/2018 • 8 minutes to read • Edit Online
If you have more than one company in Dynamics NAV, the Consolidated Trial Balance Report on the Accountant
Role Center can give you an overview of the financial health of your overall business.
The report combines general ledger (G/L ) entries from each of your companies in a new company that you create
to contain the consolidated data. This company is typically referred to as the "consolidated company." The
consolidated company is just a container for the consolidated data, and does not have any live business data. The
companies that you include in the consolidated company become Business Units in the report.
You can consolidate:
Across companies that have different charts of accounts.
Companies that use different fiscal years and different currencies.
Either the full amount or a percentage of a company's financial information
Using different currency exchange rates in individual G/L accounts
Depending on the complexity of your businesses, there are two ways to set up the report:
If you don't need advanced settings, such as including a company that you only own part of, you can use the
Company Consolidation assisted setup guide to quickly set up a consolidation. The guide helps you through
the basic steps.
If you do need more advanced settings, you can set up the consolidated company and business units yourself.
1. Choose the icon, enter Chart of Accounts, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the card for the account, and then fill in the fields on the Consolidation FastTab.
To specify exchange rates for consolidations
If a business unit uses a different currency than the consolidated company, you must specify exchange rate
methods for each account before you consolidate. For each account, the content of the Consol. Translation
Method field determines the exchange rate. On each business unit card, in the Currency Exchange Rate Table
field, you specify whether consolidation will use exchange rates from the business unit or the consolidated
company. If you use exchange rates from the consolidated company, you can change the exchange rates for a
business unit. For business units, if the Currency Exchange Rate Table field on the business unit card contains
Local, you can change the exchange rate from the business unit card. The exchange rates are copied from the
Currency Exchange Rate table, but you can change them before consolidating.
The following table describes the exchange rate methods you can use for accounts.
Average Rate (Manual) You manually calculate the average rate for the period to
consolidate. Calculate the average either as an arithmetic
average or as a best estimate, and specify the result for each
business unit. Used for income statement accounts.
Last Closing Rate The rate that was valid in the foreign exchange market on the
date for which the balance sheet or income statement is being
prepared. You enter this rate for each business unit. Used for
balance sheet accounts.
Historical Rate The exchange rate that was valid when the transaction
occurred.
Composite Rate The current period amounts are translated at the average rate
and added to the previously recorded balance in the
consolidated company. This method is typically used for
retained earnings accounts because they include amounts
from different periods and are therefore a composite of
amounts translated with different exchange rates.
2. Choose the icon, enter Business Units, and then choose the related link.
3. Do one of the following:
To test a file, choose the Test File action, enter the name of the file to test, and then choose Print.
To test the database, choose Test Database.
See Also
Working with Dynamics NAV
Exporting Your Business Data to Excel
Analyzing Financial Statements in Microsoft Excel
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
In Dynamics NAV, you can see KPIs and get overviews of the company's financial state. You can also open lists in
Excel and analyze the data there. But you can also export heavy financial statements such as the balance sheet or
the income statement to Excel, analyze the data, and print the reports.
In the Business Manager and Accountant Role Centers, you can choose which financial statements to view in Excel
from a drop-down menu in the Reports section of the ribbon. When you choose a statement, it will be opened in
Excel or Excel Online. An add-in connects the data to Dynamics NAV. However, you have to sign in with the same
account that you use with Dynamics NAV.
See Also
Finance
Setting Up Finance
The General Ledger and the Chart of Accounts
Working with Dynamics NAV
Analyzing Cash Flow in Your Company
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
As they say, cash is king. The charts on the Accountant Role Center provide insight that can help you make solid
decisions about what to do with your cash.
How long does the sales process tie up my cash? Cash Cycle
Should I increase or reduce inventory levels?
On the Accountant Role Center, under Finance Performance, the Cash Cycle, Cash Flow, and Income &
Expense charts offer ways to analyze cash flow:
See figures for a period by using the timeline slider.
Filter the chart by choosing the source in the legend.
Change the length of the period, or go to the previous or next period, by choosing options on the Finance
Performance drop down.
View the entries by choosing a point in the chart. For example, a point on the timeline or a column segment. If
the numbers seem off, this is where you can make adjustments.
Although it's separate, the Cash Flow Forecast chart is similar. You view details, filter results, and change what is
displayed in the same ways. If you change a setting, you can refresh the forecast by choosing Cash Flow
Forecast, and then Recalculate Forecast.
If you want to examine the forecast, in addition to forecast entries, you can also look at the cash flow worksheet.
For example, you can see how the forecast:
Handles confirmed sales and purchases.
Subtracts payables and adds receivables.
Skips duplicate sales orders and purchase orders.
See Also
Setting Up Finance
Working with Dynamics NAV
Setting Up Cash Flow Analysis
How to: Print Remittance Advice
8/13/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
You can print remittance advice before posting a payment journal and after posting a payment. This advice displays
vendor invoice numbers, which helps vendors to perform reconciliations.
NOTE
You can filter using the vendor's external document number to match payments with invoices.
REPORT DESCRIPTION
Remittance Advice - Journal Report This report indicates which documents are included in the
payment. For general journal lines, you can specify the journal
template and journal batch from which the remittance advices
will be printed, the date of the first activity to print, and filter
on a document number. For vendors, you can enter the
vendor numbers to include in the report.
Remittance Advice - Entries Report This report indicates which documents are included in the
payment. You define the report contents by setting filters. You
can set additional fields on the tab by choosing the Field field.
For vendor ledger entries, you can specify the vendors to
include in the report, the date of the first activity to print, the
currency, and the entry number to include.
NOTE
The Remittance Advice - Journal Report does not support cross currency application scenarios or payment tolerances. For
more information, see How to: Enable Application of Ledger Entries in Different Currencies.
TIP
For more information about how to work with reports, see Viewing Test Reports before Posting, Work with Reports, and
Searching, Filtering, and Sorting Data.
See Also
Welcome to Dynamics NAV
Closing Years and Periods
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
At the end of a fiscal year, there are a number of administrative tasks that you have to perform, like making sure
all documents and journals are posted, making sure currency data are up-to-date, closing the books, and more.
The actual tasks will depend your company.
The following table provides an overview of tasks that you typically perform to close a year and period.
TO SEE
Specify system-wide and user-specific posting date ranges. How to: Specify Posting Periods
Depending on your business needs, you may want to restrict
user posting date ranges at the start of the period-end
process or after it.
Update currency exchange rates and adjust the exchange How to: Update Currency Exchange Rates
rates of posted customer, vendor, and bank account entries.
Allocate costs and income among accounts and dimensions. Allocating Costs and Income
Prepare to report value-added tax amounts that you have How To: Report VAT to Tax Authorities
collected for sales to the tax authorities' web service.
Print reports to verify general ledger, customer, vendor and Preparing Pre-Closing Reports
bank account balances before closing a period.
Close accounting periods and fiscal year, transfer income Closing Books
statement balances to balance sheet accounts and post the
year end closing entry.
Print reports that can assist you in creating financial Preparing Closing Statements
statements.
See Also
How to: Open a New Fiscal Year
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Specify Posting Periods
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Use posting periods to specify when users can post to the general ledger.
NOTE
These posting periods apply to the company and to all users. To allow for exceptions, you can define different posting
periods for specific users in the User Setup window. These posting periods overrule those specified in the General Ledger
Setup window. For more information, see the "To set up user time constraints" section in How to: Manage Users and
Permissions.
See Also
Finance
Completing Period-End Processes
Working with Dynamics NAV
Overview of Tasks to Close Accounting Periods
8/13/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Dynamics NAV does not force you to close periods, however, there are many period-end (month-end) activities
that you can do. This topic provides an overview of optional processes and activities for closing periods.
General Ledger
Specify system-wide and user-specific posting periods.
This specifies the dates between which you allow posting. Depending on your business, you may want to
allow posting at the start of the period, or toward the end. For more information, see How to: Specify
Posting Periods.
Make all necessary G/L adjustments.
Update and post Recurring Journals.
Run account schedules as follows:
Open the Account Schedule window, and then choose the Print action.
Fixed Assets
Post all maintenance costs have been posted through the fixed asset journals or invoices.
Post adjustments.
Post appreciation.
Post depreciation.
Update and post the recurring fixed asset journal.
Intercompany
Process Intercompany Transactions
Calculate and Process Sales Tax
Complete Tax Statements.
See Also
Closing Years and Periods
Closing Books
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Update Currency Exchange Rates
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
You must set up a code for each currency you use if you buy or sell in currencies other than your local currency,
have receivables or payables in other currencies, or record G/L transactions in different currencies.
As companies operate in increasingly more countries/regions, it becomes more important that they be able to
review or report financials in more than one currency. The program supports use of multiple currencies. Within
the program, your general ledger is set up using your local currency (LCY ), and another currency is set up as an
additional currency, with a current exchange rate assigned.
By designating a second currency as an additional reporting currency, Dynamics NAV will automatically record
amounts in both LCY and this additional reporting currency on each G/L entry and on other entries, such as VAT
entries. When G/L entry amounts are calculated in an additional reporting currency, the information in the
Currency Exchange Rates window is used to find the relevant exchange rate.
WARNING
The Additional Reporting Currency functionality should NOT be used as a basis for financial statement translation. It is not a
tool that can perform translation of foreign subsidiary financial statements as part of a company consolidation. The
additional reporting currency functionality only provides the option of preparing reports in another currency, as if that
currency was the company’s local currency.
See Also
Closing Years and Periods
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Allocate Costs and Income
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
You can allocate an entry in a general journal to several different accounts when you post the journal. The
allocation can be made by three different methods:
Quantity
Percentage (%)
Amount
The allocation features can be used with recurring general journals and in fixed assets journals.
The following procedures describe how to prepare to allocate costs in a recurring general journal by defining
allocation keys. When allocation keys are defined, you complete and post the journal like any other recurring
general journal. For more information, see Working with General Journals.
1. Choose the icon, enter Recurring General Journal, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the Batch Name field to open the General Journal Batches window.
3. You can either modify allocations on an existing batch in the list or create a new batch with allocations.
To create a new batch, choose the New action, and go to the next step.
To change the allocations of an existing journal, select the journal and go to step 7.
4. In the Name field, enter a name for the batch, such as CLEANING. In the Description field, enter a
description, such as Cleaning Expenses Journal.
5. When you are done, close the window. A new, empty recurring journal opens.
6. Fill in the fields on the line.
7. Choose the Allocations action.
8. Add a line for each allocation. You must fill in either the Allocation %, Allocation Quantity, or Amount
field. You must also fill in the Account No. field and, if you are allocating the transaction among global
dimensions, the global dimension fields.
9. If you enter a percentage on a line, the amount in the Amount field is calculated automatically. These amounts
have the opposite sign from the total amount in the Amount field in the recurring journal.
10. After entering the allocations lines, choose OK to return to the Recurring General Journal window. The
Allocated Amt. (USD ) field is filled in and matches the Amount field.
11. Post the journal.
See Also
Closing Years and Periods
Working with General Journals
Posting Documents and Journals
Working with Dynamics NAV
Using Pre-Closing Reports
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
There are many standard reports that you can use to verify the accuracy of the accounts before closing the books
at the end of a year or period. For example, you can use the Customer - Trial Balance report to verify that the
balance for a customer posting group is equal to the balance on the corresponding general ledger account on a
certain date.
The following table describes a number of reports that may be useful in this process.
Print a detailed trial balance report for one or more bank Bank Acc. - Detail Trial Bal.
accounts with additional information about individual entries.
Print a detail trial balance for selected customers. Customer - Trial Balance
Print a detail trial balance with detailed information about Customer - Detail Trial Bal.
individual entries, for selected customers during a selected
period.
Print a detail trial balance for selected vendors. Vendor - Trial Balance
Print a detail trial balance with detailed information about Vendor - Detail Trial Balance
individual entries, for selected vendors during a selected
period.
Print a trial balance with the current year's and the previous Closing Trial Balance
year's figures.
Print a detailed trial balance report for general ledger account Detail Trial Balance
balances.
Print a trial balance report with balances and net changes for Trial Balance
general ledger accounts.
To see a report, choose the icon, type the name as it appears in the table, and then choose the related link.
See Also
Closing Years and Periods
Working with Dynamics NAV
Closing the Books
4/16/2018 • 3 minutes to read • Edit Online
After you ensure that all your accounts are up-to-date, and you allocate costs and income, then you can close the
books for a fiscal year or period.
You are not required to close a year, but doing so will make working in the system easier for you because you will
be able to take advantage of the convenient filtering options provided. You also do not have to worry about losing
details of transactions when you close because all details are retained, even after you close the year.
See Also
How to: Open a New Fiscal Year
Working with Dynamics NAV
Preparing Closing Statements
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
There are a number of standard reports that you can use to gather the information that you need to prepare your
company's closing statements.
The following table describes a number of reports that may be useful in this process, with links to the topics that
describe them.
Print a trial balance report with balances and net changes for Trial Balance
general ledger accounts.
Get an overview of accounts receivable, with the age of Aged Accounts Receivable
amounts receivable calculated from the due date, posting
date, or document date.
Get an overview of accounts payable, with the age of amounts Aged Accounts Payable
payable calculated from the due date, posting date or
document date.
Print a trial balance report with balances and net changes for Trial Balance by Period
general ledger accounts calculated for a series of periods.
Check whether customer and vendor ledger entries balance Reconcile Cust. and Vend. Accs
with corresponding general ledger entries.
To see a report, choose the icon, type the name as it appears in the table, and then choose the related link.
See Also
Closing Years and Periods
Working with Dynamics NAV
Business Intelligence
Business Intelligence
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Businesses capture a tremendous amount of data through daily activity. This data, which reflects such things as
the organization's sales figures, purchases, operational expenses, employee salaries, and budgets, can become
valuable information, or business intelligence, for decision makers. Dynamics NAV contains a number of
features that help you gather, analyze, and share your company data.
The Dimensions functionality plays an important role in business intelligence. A dimension is data that you can
add to an entry as a kind of marker. This data is used to group entries with similar characteristics, such as
customers, regions, products, and salesperson, and easily retrieve these groups for analysis. Among other uses,
you use dimensions when defining analysis views and when creating account schedules for reporting. For more
information, see Working with Dimensions.
TIP
As a quick way to analyze transactional data by dimensions, you can filter totals in the chart of accounts and entries in all
Entries windows by dimensions. Look for the Set Dimension Filter action.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
View actual amounts compared to budgeted amounts for all How to: Analyze Actual Amounts Versus Budgeted Amounts
accounts and for several periods.
Create new account schedules to define financial statements How to: Work with Account Schedules
for reporting or for display as charts.
Analyze your financial performance by setting up KPIs based How to: Set Up and Publish KPI Web Services Based on
on account schedules, which you then publish as web Account Schedules
services. The published account-schedule KPIs can be viewed
on a web site or imported to Microsoft Excel using OData
web services.
Set up analysis views to analyze data using dimensions. How to: Analyze Data by Dimensions
Create new analysis reports for sales, purchases, and How to: Create Analysis Reports
inventory, and set up analysis templates.
Enable global financial reporting by to international How to: Create Reports with XBRL
accounting organizations with the eXtensible Business
Reporting Language standard.
See Also
Finance
Using Dynamics NAV as a Power BI Data Source
Closing Fiscal Periods
Importing from Other Finance Systems
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Analyze Actual Amounts Versus Budgeted
Amounts
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
As a part of gathering, analyzing, and sharing your company data, you view actual amounts compared to budgeted
amounts for all accounts and for several periods.
To analyze budgeted amounts, you must first create budgets. For more information, see How to: Create Budgets.
To view a budget
In a budget with dimensions, you can filter the entries and see specific budgets.
1. Choose the icon, enter G/L Budgets, and then choose the related link.
2. In the G/L Budgets window, open the budget that you want to view.
3. At the top of the window, fill in the fields as necessary to define what is shown. Choose a field to read a short
description of the field or link to more information.
NOTE
If you have selected Period in either the Show as Lines or the Show as Columns field, then you must fill in the View by
field. If you have not selected Period in either the Show as Lines or Show as Columns field, then enter the appropriate
period in Date Filter field.
NOTE
Only entries from the general ledger budget with the filter codes that you enter on the Filters FastTab are included in the
calculation. Budget entries with other filter codes or without any filter codes are not included. As long as the filter remains on
the window, the budget only displays the budget entries with these filter codes.
TIP
If you want to modify the budget, you can modify the budget entries. Choose an amount to view the underlying general
ledger budget entries.
1. Choose the icon, enter Chart of Accounts, and then choose the related link.
2. In the Chart of Accounts window, choose the G/L Balance/Budget action.
3. At the top of the window, fill in the fields as necessary to define what is shown.
4. To see a specification that makes up the amount shown, choose the field.
NOTE
The filters you set in the window header will be applied to general ledger entries and also budget entries.
The leftmost columns contain the chart of accounts. Of the five columns on the rightmost side, the first four
columns show actual and budgeted debit and credit amounts for each account. The fifth column shows the
proportional relationship between the actual and the budgeted amounts on the general ledger account.
TIP
Use the View by field in the G/L Balance/Budget window to select the period length. Use the View as field to select the
way the amounts will be calculated, Net Change or Balance at Date. Choose the Previous Period or Next Period action
to change the period.
1. Choose the icon, enter Chart of Accounts, and then choose the related link.
2. In the Chart of Accounts window, select the relevant general ledger account, and then choose the G/L
Account Balance/Budget action.
3. At the top of the window, fill in the fields as necessary to define what is shown.
4. To see a specification of an amount shown, choose the field.
See Also
Business Intelligence How to: Work with Account Schedules
Finance
Setting Up Finance
The General Ledger and the Chart of Accounts
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Work with Account Schedules
4/16/2018 • 4 minutes to read • Edit Online
Use account schedules to get insight into the financial data stored in your chart of accounts. Account schedules
analyze figures in G/L accounts, and compare general ledger entries with general ledger budget entries. The
results display in charts on your Home page, such as the Cash Flow chart.
Dynamics NAV provides a few sample account schedules that you can use right away, or you can set up your own
rows and columns to specify the figures to compare. For example, you can create account schedules to calculate
profit margins on dimensions like departments or customer groups. You can create as many customized financial
statements as you want.
Setting up account schedules requires an understanding of the financial data in the chart of accounts. For example,
you can view general ledger entries as percentages of budget entries. This requires that budgets are created. For
more information, see How to: Create Budgets.
1. Choose the icon, enter Account Schedules, and then choose the related link.
2. In the Account Schedule Names window, choose the New action to create a new account schedule name.
3. Fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short description of the field or link to more
information.
4. Choose the Edit Account Schedule action.
5. In the Account Schedule window, fill in the fields as necessary.
When you have created a new account schedule and set up the rows, you must set up columns. You can
either set them up manually or assign a predefined column layout to your account schedule.
6. Choose the Edit Column Layout Setup action.
7. In the Column Layout window, fill in the fields as necessary.
NOTE
If you did not assign a default column layout to the account schedule, you must set the columns up manually.
1. Choose the icon, enter Account Schedules, and then choose the related link.
2. In the Account Schedule Names window, select an account schedule.
3. Choose the Edit Account Schedule action to set up an account schedule row to calculate the total on which
the percentages will be based.
4. Insert a line immediately above the first row for which you want to display a percentage.
5. Fill in the fields on the line as follows: In the Totaling Type field, enter Set Base for Percent. In the Totaling
field, enter a formula for the total that the percentage will be based on. For example, if row 11 contains the total
sales, enter 11.
6. Choose the Edit Column Layout Setup action to set up a column.
7. Fill in the fields on the line as follows: In the Column Type field, select Formula. In the Formula field, enter a
formula for the amount that you want to calculate a percentage for, followed by %. For example, if column
number N contains the net change, enter N%.
8. Repeat steps 4 through 7 for each group of rows that you want to break down by percentage.
1. Choose the icon, enter Account Schedules, and then choose the related link.
2. In the Account Schedule Names window, select an account schedule.
3. Choose the Edit Account Schedule action
4. In the Account Schedule window, in the Name field, select the default account schedule name.
5. Choose the Insert Accounts action.
6. Select the accounts that you want to include in your statement, and then choose the OK button.
The accounts are now inserted into your account schedule. If you want you can also change the column
layout.
7. Choose the Overview action.
8. On the Dimension Filters FastTab, set the budget filter to the desired filter name.
9. Choose the OK button.
Now you can copy and paste your budget statement into a spreadsheet.
See Also
Business Intelligence
Finance
Setting Up Finance
The General Ledger and the Chart of Accounts
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Set Up and Publish KPI Web Services Based
on Account Schedules
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
In the Account Schedule KPI Web Service Setup window, you set up how to show the account-schedule KPI
data and which specific account schedules to base the KPIs on. When you choose the Publish Web Service
button, the specified account-schedule KPI data is added to the list of published web services in the Web Services
window.
FIELD DESCRIPTION
Forecasted Values Start Specify at what point in time forecasted values are shown
on the account-schedule KPI graphic.
G/L Budget Name Specify the name of the general ledger budget that
provides forecasted values to the account-schedule KPI
web service.
Web Service Name Specify the name of the account-schedule KPI web service.
Proceed to specify one or more account schedules that you want to publish as a KPI web service according
to the setup that you made in the previous table.
3. On the Account Schedules FastTab, fill in the fields as described in the following table.
FIELD DESCRIPTION
Acc. Schedule Name Specify the account schedule that the KPI web service is
based on.
Acc. Schedule Description Specify the description of the account schedule that the
KPI web service is based on.
4. Repeat step 3 for all the account schedules that you want to base the account-schedule KPI web service on.
5. To view or edit the selected account schedule, on the Account Schedule FastTab, choose the Edit Account
Schedule action.
6. To view the account-schedule KPI data that you have set up, choose the Account Schedule KPI Web
Service action.
7. To publish the account-schedule KPI web service, choose the Publish Web Service action. The web service
is added to the list of published web services in the Web Services window.
NOTE
You can also publish the KPI web service by pointing to the Account Schedule KPI Web Service Setup page object from
the Web Services window. For more information, see How to: Publish a Web Service.
See Also
Business Intelligence
Finance
Setting Up Finance
The General Ledger and the Chart of Accounts
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Analyze Data by Dimensions
4/16/2018 • 3 minutes to read • Edit Online
In financial analysis, a dimension is data that you can add to an entry as a kind of marker. This data is used to
group entries with similar characteristics, such as customers, regions, products, and salesperson, and easily
retrieve these groups for analysis. Dimensions can be used on entries in journals, documents, and budgets. The
term dimension describes how analysis occurs. A two-dimensional analysis, for example, would be sales per area.
However, by using more than two dimensions when creating an entry, you can carry out a more complex analysis,
such as sales per sales campaign per customer group per area. For more information, see Working with
Dimensions.
Analyzing data by dimensions gives you greater insight into your business, so you can evaluate information, such
as how well your business is operating, where it is thriving and where it is not, and where more resources should
be allocated.
TIP
As a quick way to analyze transactional data by dimensions, you can filter totals in the chart of accounts and entries in all
Entries windows by dimensions. Look for the Set Dimension Filter action.
1. Choose the icon, enter Analysis Views, and then choose the related link.
2. In the Analysis View List window, choose the New action.
3. Fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short description of the field or link to more information.
4. To add other dimension codes in addition to the four on the Dimensions FastTab, choose the Filter action, fill
in the fields, and then choose the OK button.
5. To update the view, choose the Update action.
To analyze by dimensions
You can use the Analysis by Dimensions matrix to view the amounts in your general ledger by using the
analysis views that you have already set up. You fill in the Analysis by Dimensions window to define what will be
shown in the matrix, and then you choose the Show Matrix action to view the matrix.
The leftmost columns contain information based on what you have selected in the Show as Lines field in the
header.
The rightmost columns contain information based on to what you have selected in the Show as Columns field
in the header.
1. Choose the icon, enter Analysis by Dimensions, and then choose the related link.
2. Select the relevant analysis view, and then choose the Edit Analysis View action.
3. At the top of the Analysis by Dimensions window, fill in the fields to define what is shown.
4. e. To see a specification of an amount shown in the matrix window, choose the amount.
IMPORTANT
You cannot select a period length shorter than the period specified for the date compression on the Analysis View card.
The Next Set and Previous Set commands are inactive if you have selected Period in either the Show as Lines or the
Show as Columns field.
NOTE
You can use the Dimensions - Detail report to display a detailed classification of how dimensions have been used on
entries over a selected period. You can use the Dimensions - Total report to display only the total amounts.
TIP
You can also change the view by changing the contents of the Show as Lines field and Show as Columns field. To reverse a
view setting, choose the Reverse Lines and Columns action.
1. Choose the icon, enter Analysis by Dimensions, and then choose the related link.
2. In the Analysis by Dimensions window, choose the Analysis View Code field.
3. Select the line with the relevant analysis view.
4. Choose the Update action.
TIP
If you select the Update on Posting check box on an analysis view card, the view is automatically updated when an
involved transaction is posted.
NOTE
To update some or all analysis views at the same time, you must use the Update Analysis Views batch job.
See Also
Business Intelligence
Finance
Setting Up Finance
The General Ledger and the Chart of Accounts
Working with Dimensions
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Create Analysis Reports
8/13/2018 • 6 minutes to read • Edit Online
Sales managers need to analyze turnover, gross profit and other key sales performance indicators on a regular
basis. Purchasers, are more interested in the dynamics of purchase volumes, vendors' performance and purchase
prices. Whereas logistics/inventory managers need information on inventory turnover, analysis of inventory
movement, and statistics on inventory value.
You can use analysis reports to create customized reports based on records of your posted transactions, for
example, sales, purchases, transfers and inventory adjustments. In a customizable report, the source data, which is
derived from the item ledger (with associated value entries), can be combined, compared and presented in
meaningful user-defined ways. In this sense, the analysis report is very similar to a PivotTable report in Microsoft
Excel.
You can create your personalized report that focuses on your key accounts in terms of total turnover both in
amounts and quantities sold, gross profit and gross profit percentage during the current month, and have it
compare those figures with the results from previous months or the same month last year, and calculate deviations.
All this can be done in one and the same view, with the possibility to navigate to the cause of identified problem
areas by choosing the drop-down button to access details on the level of individual transactions.
The analysis report consists of the objects that you want to analyze, such as customers, customer groups, sales
people and so on, represented as lines, and the analysis parameters, that is, the way you want to analyze the object,
represented as columns, such as profit calculations, periodic comparisons of sales amounts and volumes or
periodic comparisons of actual and budgeted figures.
In addition to analysis reports, you can create and view similar information in analysis views, which are based on
dimensions. For more information, see How to: Analyze Data by Dimensions.
Example
You can set up lines like these:
Computers
Displays
Spare Parts
Then you can set up columns like these:
Sales Current Month
Sales Last Month
Sales in Pct. of last Month
Computers
Displays
Spare parts
Total
You can, for example, set up one set of lines and several sets of column layouts to show monthly and annual
reports respectively.
1. Choose the icon, enter Sales Column Templates, and then choose the related link.
2. Select the first empty line, and then fill in the fields as necessary.
3. Choose the Columns action.
4. In the Analysis Columns window, fill in the fields to specify the columns that you want to include in your
analysis report.
NOTE
To define a column, you must fill in the Analysis Type Codes field for all column types except Formula. Set up the
analysis type codes in the Analysis Types window.
Note. In the Ledger Entry Type field, if you select Item Entries, the actual figures from the item ledger
entry are copied. If you select Item Budget Entries, the budgeted figures from the budget are copied.
5. Choose the OK button to save your changes.
1. Choose the icon, enter Sales Line Templates, and then choose the related link.
2. Select the first empty line, and then fill in the fields as necessary.
3. Choose the Lines action.
4. In the Analysis Lines window, create lines for the items, customers, vendors, or salespeople you want to view
figures for in your analysis report. You must fill in the Type, Range, and the Description fields.
NOTE
Alternatively, when you want to create many individual lines for each item, customer, and so on, you can select the
appropriate insert option to fill in all the relevant fields on the line. If you need to, you can then edit the lines manually. To
insert lines, choose the Insert Items action or the Insert Item Groups action.
1. Choose the icon, enter Sales Analysis Reports, and then choose the related link.
2. In the Analysis Report Sale window, choose the New action.
3. Fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short description of the field or link to more information.
4. Choose the Edit Analysis Report action.
5. In the Sales Analysis Report window, choose the Show Matrix action
NOTE
Building combinations of line and column templates to create reports and assigning them unique names is optional. If you
do this, selecting a report name means that you will not need to select line and column templates in the Sales Analysis
Report window. After you have chosen a report name, you can change line and column templates independently and then
later select the report name again to restore the original combination.
See Also
Business Intelligence
Finance
Setting Up Finance
The General Ledger and the Chart of Accounts
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Create Reports with XBRL
4/16/2018 • 7 minutes to read • Edit Online
XBRL, which stands for eXtensible Business Reporting Language, is an XML -based language for tagging financial
data, and enabling businesses to efficiently and accurately process and share their data. The XBRL initiative enables
global financial reporting by numerous ERP software companies and international accounting organizations. The
goal of the initiative is to provide a standard for the uniform reporting of financial information for banks, investors,
and government authorities. Such business reporting can include:
• Financial statements
• Financial information
• Non-financial information
• Regulatory filings, such as annual and quarterly financial statements
Dynamics NAV enables companies to implement data in XBRL, and take advantage of the flexibility and
automation it provides for both collecting and sharing data.
Layered Taxonomies
A taxonomy can consist of a base taxonomy, for example, us-gaap or IAS, and then have one or more extensions.
To reflect this, a taxonomy refers to one or more schemas which all are separate taxonomies. When the additional
taxonomies are loaded into the database, the new elements are simply added to the end of the existing elements.
Linkbases
In XBRL Spec. 2, the taxonomy is described in several XML -files. The primary XML file is the taxonomy schema file
itself (.xsd file) which only contains an unordered list of elements or facts to be reported. In addition to this, there
are usually associated some linkbase files (.xml). The linkbase files contain data which is complementary to the raw
taxonomy (.xsd file). There are six types of linkbases files of which four have relevance for Product Name XBRL.
These are:
Label linkbase: This linkbase contains labels or names for the elements. The file may contain labels in
different languages which are identified with an XML property called 'lang'. The XML language identifier
usually contains a two-letter abbreviation, and although it should be easy to guess what the abbreviation
means, there is no connection to the Windows language code or to the language codes defined in the demo
data. Therefore, when the user looks up the languages for a specific taxonomy, he will see all the labels for
the first element in the taxonomy, meaning that he can then see an example of each language. A taxonomy
can have several label linkbases attached to it as long as these linkbases contain different languages.
Presentation linkbase: This linkbase contains information about the structure of the elements, or more
precisely; how the issuer of the taxonomy suggests that the program presents the taxonomy to the user. The
linkbase contains a series of links that each connect two elements as parent and child. When applying all
these links, the elements can be shown in a hierarchical way. Note that the presentation linkbase deals with
just that: the presentation of elements to the user.
Calculation linkbase: This linkbase contains information about which elements roll up to which. The
structure is quite similar to the presentation linkbase, except that each link or ‘arc’, as they are called, has a
weight property. The weight can be either 1 or –1 indicating whether the element should be added to or
subtracted from its parent. Note that the rollups are not necessarily in keeping with the visual presentation.
Reference linkbase: This linkbase is an xml file that contains supplementary information about the data that
is required by the taxonomy issuer.
1. Choose the icon, enter XBRL Taxonomies, and then choose the related link.
2. In the XBRL Taxonomies window, select a taxonomy from the list.
3. Choose the Lines action.
4. Select a line and fill in the fields.
5. To read detailed information about what to fill in, choose the Information action.
6. To set up the mapping of the general ledger accounts in the chart of accounts to the XBRL lines, choose the G/L
Map Lines action.
7. To add notes to the financial statement, choose the Notes action.
NOTE
You can only export data that correspond to the source type you have selected in the Source Type field that includes
description and notes.
NOTE
Lines that are not relevant can be marked as line type NOT APPLICABLE so the lines are not exported.
1. Choose the icon, enter XBRL Taxonomies, and then choose the related link.
2. In the XBRL Taxonomies window, create a new line and enter the name and description of the taxonomy.
3. Choose the Schemas action, and then insert the description of the schema.
4. To import the schema, in the XBRL Schemas window, choose the Import action, and the select a folder and an
XSD file. Choose the Open button.
5. To import the linkbase, in the XBRL Schemas window, choose the Linkbases action, and then select a folder
and an XML file. Choose the Open button..
6. You can now choose to apply the linkbase to the schema. Repeat until you have imported all linkbases.
7. Choose the Apply to Taxonomy action to apply the linkbase to the schema.
IMPORTANT
Instead of individually applying the linkbases after the import, you can wait until you have imported all linkbases and then
apply them at the same time. To do this, choose the NO button when you are prompted to apply the newly imported
linkbase to the schema. Then select the lines with the linkbases that you want to apply.
1. Choose the icon, enter XBRL Taxonomies, and then choose the related link.
2. In the XBRL Taxonomies window, choose the Schemas action.
3. To update a schema, select the schema you want to update, and then choose the Import action.
4. To update or add a new linkbase, choose the Linkbases action.
5. Select the relevant linkbase or press Ctrl+N for a new line, select the type of linkbase, and then insert a
description.
6. To import the linkbase, choose the Import action.
7. Choose the Yes button to apply the linkbase to the schema.
See Also
Finance
Business Intelligence
Working with Dynamics NAV
Sales
4/16/2018 • 3 minutes to read • Edit Online
You create a sales invoice or sales order to record your agreement with a customer to sell certain
products on certain delivery and payment terms.
You must use sales orders if your sales process requires that you can ship parts of an order quantity, for
example, because the full quantity is not available at once. If you sell items by delivering directly from
your vendor to your customer, as a drop shipment, then you must also use sales orders. In all other
aspects, sales orders work the same way as sales invoices. With sales orders, you can also use the
Order Promising functionality to communicate certain delivery dates to your customers.
You can negotiate with the customer by first creating a sales quote, which you can convert to a sales
invoice or sales order when you agree on the sale. After the customer has confirmed the agreement,
you can send an order confirmation to record your obligation to deliver the products as agreed.
You can easily correct or cancel a posted sales invoice before it is paid. This is useful if you want to
correct a typing mistake or if the customer requests a change early in the order process. If the posted
sales invoice is paid, then you must create a sales credit memo or a sales return order to reverse the
sale.
Good sales and marketing practices are all about how to make the best decisions at the right time.
Marketing functionality in Dynamics NAV provides precise and timely overview of your contact
information so that you can serve your prospective customers more efficiently and increase customer
satisfaction. For more information, see Relationship Management.
In business environments where the customer must pay before products are delivered, such as in retail,
you must wait for the receipt of payment before you deliver the products. In most cases, you process
incoming payments some weeks after delivery by applying the payments to their related posted,
unpaid sales invoices. For more information, see How to: Reconcile Payments Using Automatic
Application.
Sales documents can be sent as PDF files attached to email. The email body will contain an extract of
the sales document, such as products, total amount, and a link to the PayPal site. For more information,
see How to: Send Documents by Email.
For all sales processes, you can incorporate an approval workflow, for example, to require that large
sales to certain customers are approved by the accounting manager. For more information, see Using
Workflows.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Create a sales quote where you offer products on How to: Make Offers
negotiable terms before converting the quote to a sales
invoice.
Create a sales invoice to record your agreement with a How to: Invoice Sales
customer to sell products on certain delivery and
payment terms.
TO SEE
Process a sales order that involves partial shipping or How to: Sell Products
drop shipment.
Set up standard sales or purchase lines that you can How to: Create Recurring Sales and Purchase Lines
quickly insert on documents, for example, for recurring
replenishment orders.
Link a sales order to a purchase order to sell a drop- How to: Make Drop Shipments
shipment item that will be delivered directly from your
vendor to your customer.
Have a nonstock item shipped from a vendor to your How to: Create Special Orders
warehouse so that you can ship the item on to your
customer.
Perform an action on an unpaid posted sales invoice to How to: Correct or Cancel Unpaid Sales Invoices
automatically create a credit memo and either cancel
the sales invoice or recreate it so you can make
corrections.
Create a sales credit memo to revert a specific posted How to: Process Sales Returns or Cancellations
sales invoice to reflect which products the customer
returns and which payment amount you will refund.
Manage your customer's commitment to purchase How to: Work with Blanket Sales Orders
large quantities delivered in several shipments over
time.
Sell assembly items that are not currently available by How to: Sell Items Assembled to Order
creating a linked assembly order to supply the full or
partial sales order quantity.
Invoice a customer once for multiple shipments by How to: Combine Shipments on a Single Invoice
combining the shipments on one invoice.
Inform your customers of order delivery dates by How to: Calculate Order Promising Dates
calculating either the capable-to-promise date or the
available-to-promise date.
See Also
Setting Up Sales
How to: Register New Customers
Managing Receivables
Managing Payables
Project Management
Working with Dynamics NAV
General Business Functionality
How to: Make Offers
8/13/2018 • 4 minutes to read • Edit Online
You create a sales quote to record your offer to a customer to sell certain products on certain delivery and
payment terms. You can send the sales quote to the customer to communicate the offer. You can email the
document as a PDF attachment. You can also have the email body prefilled with a summary of the quote. For
more information, see How to: Send Documents by Email.
While you negotiate with the customer, you can change and resend the sales quote as much as needed. When the
customer accepts the quote, you convert the sales quote to a sales invoice or a sales order in which you process
the sale. For more information, see How to: Invoice Sales or How to: Sell Products.
You can fill customer fields on the sales quote in two ways depending on whether the customer is already
registered. See steps 2 and 3 in the following procedure.
See Also
Sales
Setting Up Sales
How to: Send Documents by Email
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Invoice Sales
8/13/2018 • 5 minutes to read • Edit Online
You create a sales invoice or sales order to record your agreement with a customer to sell certain products on
certain delivery and payment terms.
There are a couple of scenarios where you must use a sales order instead of a sales invoice:
If you need to ship only part of an order quantity, for example, because the full quantity is not on hand.
If you sell items that your vendor delivers directly to your customer, known as drop shipment. For more
information, see How to: Make Drop Shipments.
In all other aspects, sales orders and sales invoices work in the same way. For more information, see How to:
Sell Products.
You can negotiate with the customer by first creating a sales quote, which you can convert to a sales invoice
when you agree on the sale. For more information, see How to: Make Offers.
If the customer decides to buy, you post the sales invoice to create the related quantity and value entries. When
you post the sales invoice, you can also email the document as a PDF attachment. You can have the email body
prefilled with a summary of the invoice and payment information, such as a link to PayPal. For more
information, see How to: Send Documents by Email.
In business environments where the customer must pay before products are delivered, such as in retail, you
must wait for the receipt of payment before you deliver the products. In most cases, you process incoming
payments some weeks after delivery by applying the payments to their related posted, unpaid sales invoices.
For more information, see How to: Reconcile Payments Using Automatic Application.
You can easily correct or cancel a posted sales invoice before it is paid. For example, this is useful if you want to
correct a typing mistake or if the customer requests a change early in the order process. For more information,
see How to: Correct or Cancel Unpaid Sales Invoices. If the posted sales invoice is paid, then you must create a
sales credit memo to reverse the sale. For more information, see How to: Process Sales Returns or
Cancellations.
You can fill customer fields on the sales invoice in two ways depending on whether the customer is already
registered. See steps 2 and 3 in the following procedure.
You create a sales order or sales invoice to record your agreement with a customer to sell certain products on
certain delivery and payment terms.
NOTE
You use sales orders if your sales process requires that you can ship parts of an order quantity, for example, because the
full quantity is not available at once. If you sell items by delivering directly from your vendor to your customer, as a drop
shipment, then you must also use sales orders. For more information, see How to: Make Drop Shipments. In all other
aspects, sales orders work the same way as sales invoices. For more information, see How to: Invoice Sales.
You can negotiate with the customer by first creating a sales quote, which you can convert to a sales order when
you agree on the sale. For more information, see How to: Make Offers.
After the customer has confirmed the agreement, for example after a quote process, you can send an order
confirmation to record your obligation to deliver the products as agreed.
When you deliver the products, either fully or partially, you post the sales order as shipped or as shipped and
invoiced to create the related item and customer ledger entries in your system. When you post the sales order,
you can also email the document as a PDF attachment. You can have the email body prefilled with a summary
of the order and payment information, such as a link to PayPal. For more information, see How to: Send
Documents by Email.
In business environments where the customer must pay before products are delivered, such as in retail, you
must wait for the receipt of payment before you deliver the products. In most cases, you process incoming
payments some weeks after delivery by applying the payments to their related posted, unpaid sales invoices.
For more information, see How to: Reconcile Payments Using Automatic Application.
You can easily correct or cancel a posted sales invoice resulting from a sales order before it is paid. This is useful
if you want to correct a typing mistake or if the customer requests a change early in the order process. For more
information, see How to: Correct or Cancel Unpaid Sales Invoices. If the posted sales invoice is paid, then you
must create a sales credit memo to reverse the sale. For more information, see How to: Process Sales Returns or
Cancellations.
You can fill customer fields on the sales order in two ways depending on whether the customer is already
registered. See steps 2 and 3 in the following procedure.
NOTE
If the item is of type Item - Service or Resource, the quantity is a time unit, such as hours, as indicated in the
Unit of Measure Code field on the line.
The value in the Line Amount field is calculated as Unit Price x Quantity.
The price and line amounts are with or without sales tax, depending on what you selected in the Prices
Including Tax field on the customer card.
20. If you want to give a discount, enter a percentage in the Line Discount % field. The value in the Line
Amount field updates accordingly.
If special item prices are set up on the Sales Prices and Sales Line Discounts FastTab on the customer
or item card, the price and amount on the sales line automatically update if the price criteria is met. For
more information, see Record Sales Price, Discount, and Payment Agreements.
21. Repeat steps 9 through 12 for every product or charge you want to sell to the customer.
The totals under the lines are automatically calculated as you create or modify lines.
22. In the Invoice Discount Amount field, enter an amount that should be deducted from the value shown
in the Total Incl. Tax field.
If you have set up invoice discounts for the customer, then the specified percentage value is automatically
inserted in the Invoice Discount % field if the criteria are met, and the related amount is inserted in the
Inv. Discount Amount Excl. Tax field. For more information, see Record Sales Price, Discount, and
Payment Agreements.
23. To only ship a part of the order quantity, enter that quantity in the Qty. to Ship field. The value is copied
to the Qty. to Invoice field.
24. To only invoice a part of the shipped quantity, enter that quantity in the Qty. to Invoice field. The
quantity must be lower than the value in the Qty. to Ship field.
25. When the sales order lines are completed, choose the Post and Send action.
The Post and Send Confirmation dialog box displays the customer's preferred method of receiving
documents. You can change the sending method by choosing the lookup button for the Send Document to
field. For more information, see How to: Set Up Document Sending Profiles.
The related item and customer ledger entries are now created in your system, and the sales order is output as a
PDF document. When the sales order is fully posted, it is removed from the list of sales orders and replaced
with new documents in the list of posted sales invoices and the list of posted sales shipments.
See Also
Sales
Setting Up Sales
Inventory
How to: Send Documents by Email
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Create Recurring Sales and Purchase Lines
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
If you often need to create sales and purchase lines with similar information, you can set up standard lines that you
can then insert on recurring sales and purchase documents, for example, for recurring replenishment orders.
The following procedure shows how to work with standard sales lines. It works in a similar way for standard
purchase lines.
1. Choose the icon, enter Create Recurring Sales Invoices, and then choose the related link.
2. In the Create Recurring Sales Inv. window, fill in the fields as necessary.
3. In the Code field, enter the code for standard sales lines assigned to a customer that you want to create sales
invoices for.
4. Choose the OK button.
Sales invoices are created for the customers with the specified standard customer sales code, and any specified
direct-debit information, for posting on the specified date.
See Also
Sales
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Make Drop Shipments
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
A drop shipment is the shipment of items from one of your vendors directly to one of your customers.
When a sales order is marked for drop shipment, and you create a purchase order specifying the customer in the
Sell-to Customer No. field, you can link the two documents and thereby instruct the vendor to ship directly to
the customer.
1. Choose the icon, enter Sales orders, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the sales order that you created in the "To create a sales order for a drop shipment" section.
3. In the Qty. to Ship field, specify how many of the order quantity to ship, the full or a partial order quantity.
4. Choose the Post or Post and Send action.
5. Choose either the Ship option to invoice later, or the Ship and Invoice option to invoice immediately.
See Also
How to: Create Special Orders|
How to: Sell Products
How to: Record Purchases
Sales
Inventory
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Create Special Orders
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
You can create a special order for a specific nonstock item to be shipped to a specific customer. Your vendor ships
the item to your warehouse and you can then ship the item on to your customer either independently or together
with other items on another order.
Special orders imply that the purchase and sales order are linked to ensure that the specific nonstock item is
picked and delivered to the customer.
Before you can use this feature, you must first set up the customer, vendor, and item cards necessary for the order.
4. Choose the icon, enter Requisition Worksheet, and then choose the related link.
5. Choose the Special Order action, and then choose the Get Sales Orders action.
6. In the Get Sales Orders window, show results where the Document No. is the sales order number.
Choose the OK button. A requisition worksheet line is created for the item.
7. On the requisition worksheet line, in the Action Message field, select New.
8. In the Req. Worksheet window, choose the Carry Out Action Message action. The Carry Out Action
Msg. - Req. window opens. Choose the OK button.
A message appears telling you that the purchase orders have been created. Choost the OK button.
A purchase order created as a special order for a sales order is respected by the planning system as it balances
demand and supply. That is, the purchase order (supply) remains linked to the sales order (demand), even if that
purchase order could supply another earlier demand. For more information, see Design Details: Reordering
Policies.
NOTE
You cannot use the special order functionality if the item is already reserved. Therefore, for items that are sold on special
orders, make sure the Reserve field on the item card is not set to Always.
See Also
How to: Work with Nonstock Items
Sales
How to: Make Drop Shipments
Design Details: Reordering Policies
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Correct or Cancel Unpaid Sales Invoices
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
In Dynamics NAV, you can correct or cancel a posted sales invoice by issuing a corrective credit memo. This is
useful if you make a mistake or if the customer requests a change.
In the Posted Sales Invoice window, you can choose the Create Corrective Credit Memo action to achieve the
effect of cancelling or correcting the sales invoice. For more information, see How to: Process Sales Returns or
Cancellations.
See Also
Sales
Setting Up Sales
How to: Send Documents by Email
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Process Sales Returns or Cancellations
8/13/2018 • 15 minutes to read • Edit Online
If a customer wants to return items or be reimbursed for items or services that you have sold and received
payment for, you must create and post a sales credit memo that specifies the requested change. To include the
correct sales invoice information, you can create the sales credit memo directly from the posted sales invoice or
you can create a new sales credit memo with copied invoice information.
If you need more control of the sales return process, such as warehouse documents for the item handling or
better overview when receiving items from multiple sales documents with one sales return, then you can create
sales return orders. A sales return order automatically issues the related sales credit memo and other return-
related documents, such as a replacement sales order, if needed. For more information, see the "To create a sales
return order based on one or more a posted sales documents" section.
A return or reimbursement may relate to only some of the items or services on the original sales invoice. In that
case, you must edit information on the lines on the sales credit memo or sales return order. When you post the
sales credit memo or sales return order, the sales documents that are affected by the change are reversed and a
refund payment can be created for the customer. For more information, see Making Payments.
In addition to the original posted sales invoice, you can apply the sales credit memo or sales return order to other
sales documents, for example another posted sales invoice because the customer is also returning items delivered
with that invoice.
You can send the posted sales credit memo to the customer to confirm the return or cancellation and
communicate that the related value will be reimbursed, for example when the items are returned.
The credit memo posting will also revert any item charges that were assigned to the posted document, so that the
item’s value entries are the same as before the item charge was assigned.
Inventory Costing
To preserve correct inventory valuation, you typically want to put returned items back in inventory at the unit cost
that they were sold at, not at their current unit cost. This is referred to as exact cost reversing.
Two functions exist to assign exact cost reversing automatically.
FUNCTION DESCRIPTION
Get Posted Document Lines to Reverse function in the Copies lines of one or more posted documents to be reversed
Sales Return Order window into the sales return order. For more information, see the "To
create a sales return order, and related sales credit memo, for
on one or more a posted sales invoices" section.
Copy Document function in the Sales Credit Memo and Copies both the header and lines of one posted document to
Sales Return Order windows be reversed.
To assign exact cost reversing manually, you must choose the Appl.-from Item Entry field on any type of return
document line, and then select the number of the original sales entry. This links the sales credit memo or sales
return order to the original sales entry and ensures that the item is valued at the original unit cost.
For more information, see Design Details: Inventory Costing.
NOTE
This field only works for posted shipments and posted invoice lines, not for posted return or posted credit memo
lines.
At the left side of the window, the different document types are listed, and the number in brackets shows
the number of documents available of each document type.
7. In the Document Type Filter field, select the type of posted document lines you would like to use.
8. Select the lines that you would like to copy to the new document.
NOTE
If you use Ctrl+A to select all lines, all lines within the filter you have set are copied, but the Show Reversible
Quantity Only filter is ignored. For example, suppose you have filtered the lines to a particular document number
with two lines, one of which has already been returned. Even if the Show Reversible Quantity Only field is
selected, if you press Ctrl+A to copy all lines, both lines are copied, instead of only the one that has not yet been
reversed.
NOTE
If part of the quantity of the posted document line has already been reversed or sold or consumed, a line is
created for only the quantity that remains in inventory or that has not been returned. If the full quantity of
the posted document line has already been reversed, a new document line is not created.
If the flow of goods in the posted document is the same as the flow of goods in the new document, a copy
of the original posted document line in the new document is created. The Appl.-from Item Entry field is
not filled in because, in this case, exact cost reversing is not possible. For example, if you use the Get Posted
Document Lines to Reverse function to get a posted sales credit memo line for a new sales credit memo,
only the original posted credit memo line is copied to the new credit memo.
10. In the Sales Return Order window, in the Return Reason Code field on each line, select the reason for
the return.
11. Choose the post action.
1. Choose the icon, enter Sales Credit Memos, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the New action to open a new empty sales credit memo.
3. Fill in the credit memo header with relevant information about the customer that you want to give the sales
allowance to.
4. On the Lines FastTab, in the Type field, select Charge (Item ).
5. In the No. field, select the appropriate item charge value.
You may want to create a special item charge number to cover sales allowances.
6. In the Quantity field, enter 1.
7. In the Unit Price field, enter the amount of the sales allowance.
8. Assign the sales allowance as an item charge to the items in the posted shipment. For more information, see
How to: Use Item Charges to Account for Additional Trade Costs. When you have assigned the allowance,
return to the Sales Credit Memo window.
When you post the sales return order, the sales allowance is added to the relevant sales entry amount. In this way,
you can maintain accurate inventory valuation.
1. Choose the icon, enter Combine Return Receipts, and then choose the related link.
2. In the Combine Return Receipts window, fill in the fields to select the relevant return receipts.
3. Select the Post Credit Memos check box. If not, you must manually post the resulting purchase credit
memos.
4. Choose the OK button.
To remove a received and invoiced return order
When you invoice return receipts in this way, the return orders from which the return receipts were posted still
exist, even if they have been fully received and invoiced.
When return receipts are combined on a credit memo and posted, a posted sales credit memo is created for the
credited lines. The Quantity Invoiced field on the originating sales return order is updated based on the
invoiced quantity.
1. Choose the icon, enter Delete Invoiced Sales Return Orders, and then select the link.
2. Specify in the No. filter field which return orders to delete.
3. Choose the OK button.
Alternatively, delete individual sales return orders manually.
See Also
Sales
Setting Up Sales
How to: Send Documents by Email
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Work with Blanket Sales Orders
8/13/2018 • 6 minutes to read • Edit Online
A blanket sales order represents a framework for a long-term agreement between you and your customer.
A blanket order is typically made when a customer has committed to purchasing large quantities that are to be
delivered in several smaller shipments over a certain period of time. Often blanket orders cover only one item with
predetermined delivery dates. The main reason for using a blanket order rather than a sales order is that quantities
entered on a blanket order do not affect item availability and thus can be used as a worksheet for monitoring,
forecasting, and planning purposes.
On the blanket order, each separate shipment can be set up as an order line, which can then be converted into a
sales order at the time of shipping.
An example of when a blanket sales order could be used is if a customer calls and places an order of 1000 units of
an item and they want the items to be delivered in 250 units every week over the next month.
NOTE
Blanket purchase orders work in a similar way as blanket sales orders. This documentation does not cover blanket purchase
orders.
1. Choose the icon, enter Blanket Purchase Orders, and then choose the related link.
2. Select a blanket purchase order, and then choose the Statistics action.
3. In the Purchase Blanket Order Statistics window, on the General FastTab, you can see summary
information about the entire order based on the total quantity in the various Quantity fields on the blanket
purchase order lines.
On the Invoicing FastTab, you can see summary information based on the total quantity in the Qty. to
Invoice fields on the purchase blanket order lines.
On the Shipping FastTab, you can see summary information based on the total quantity in the Qty. to
Receive fields on the purchase blanket order lines.
On the Prepayment FastTab, you can see summary information about any prepaid amounts.
On the Vendor FastTab, you can see certain basic information about the vendor.
1. Choose the icon enter Blanket Sales Orders, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the blanket sales order you want to view.
3. To view unposted entries, select the line in question, choose the Line action, and then choose the Unposted
Lines action. Choose one of the following options.
OPTION DESCRIPTION
Orders Specifies open orders associated with the selected line.
Invoices Specifies open invoices that have been associated with the
selected line. Open invoices are manually associated with a
blanket order by entering the blanket order number on
the sales invoice line.
Return Orders Specifies open return orders that have been associated
with the selected line.
Credit Memos Specifies open credit memos that have been associated
with the selected line.
4. To view posted entries, select the line in question, choose the Line action, and then choose the Posted Lines
action. Choose one of the following options.
OPTION DESCRIPTION
Return Receipts Posted return receipts that have been associated with the
selected line.
Credit Memos Posted credit memos that have been associated with the
selected line.
5. In the Sales Lines window, choose the Show Document action to view the entry.
See Also
Sales
Setting Up Sales
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Combine Shipments on a Single Invoice
8/13/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
If you want to invoice more than one shipment at a time, you can use the combined shipments feature.
Before you can create a combined shipment, more than one sales shipment for the same customer in the same
currency must be posted. In other words, you must have filled in two or more sales orders and posted them as
shipped, but not invoiced. To combine shipments, the Combine Shipments check box must be selected on the
Shipping FastTab of the Customer card.
NOTE
You will need to manually post the invoices if the Post Invoices check box was not selected on the batch job.
See Also
Sales
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Calculate Order Promising Dates
11/23/2018 • 7 minutes to read • Edit Online
A company must be able to inform their customers of order delivery dates. The Order Promising Lines window
enables you to do this from a sales order line.
Based on an item’s known and expected availability dates, Dynamics NAV instantly calculates shipment and
delivery dates, which can then be promised to the customer.
If you specify a requested delivery date on a sales order line, then that date is used as the starting point for the
following calculations:
requested delivery date - shipping time = planned shipment date
planned shipment date - outbound whse. handling time = shipment date
If the items are available to pick on the shipment date, then the sales process can continue. If the items are not
available to be picked on the shipment date, then a stock-out warning is displayed.
If you do not specify a requested delivery date on a sales order line, or if the requested delivery date cannot be
met, then the earliest date on which that the items are available is calculated. That date is then entered in the
Shipment Date field on the line, and the date on which you plan to ship the items as well as the date on which
they will be delivered to the customer are calculated using the following calculations:
shipment date + outbound whse. handling time = planned shipment date
planned shipment date + shipping time = planned delivery date
CODE DESCRIPTION
d Calendar day
w Week
m Month
q Quarter
y Year
For example, "3w" indicates that the offset time is three weeks. To indicate the current period, prefix to any
of these codes with the letter “c”. For example, if you want the offset time to be the current month, enter cm.
3. Enter a number series in the Order Promising Nos. field by selecting a line from the list in the No. Series
window.
4. Enter an order promising template in the Order Promising Template field by selecting a line from the list
in the Req. Worksheet Template List window.
5. Enter a requisition worksheet in the Order Promising Worksheet field by selecting a line from the list on
the Req. Wksh. Names window.
To enter inbound warehouse handling time in the inventory setup window
If you want to include warehouse handling time in the order promising calculation on the purchase line, you can
set it up as a default for the inventory and for your location.
1. Choose the icon, enter Inventory Setup, and then choose the related link.
2. On the General FastTab, in the Inbound Whse. Handling Time field, enter the number of days that you want
to include in the order promising calculation.
NOTE
If you have filled in the Inbound Whse. Handling Time field on the Location Card for your location this field is used as the
default inbound warehouse handling time.
NOTE
If you leave the Inbound Whse. Handling Time field blank, then the calculation uses the value in the Inventory Setup
window.
1. Choose the icon, enter Inventory Setup, and then choose the related link.
2. On the General FastTab, in the Outbound Whse. Handling Time field, enter the number of days you want to
include in the order promising calculation.
NOTE
If you have filled in the Outbound Whse. Handling Time field on the Location card for your location, this field is used as
the default outbound warehouse handling time.
1. Choose the icon, enter Items, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the relevant item card.
3. On the Planning FastTab, select the Critical field.
See Also
Sales
Date Calculation for Purchases
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Track Packages
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
A number of shipping agents provide services on the Internet that allow you to track parcels you have handed
over to the agent. If you use one or more of these shipping agents, you can set up certain basic information and
use the automatic tracking feature from posted shipments. For more information, see How to: Set Up Shipping
Agents.
To track a package
1. Choose the icon, enter Sales Shipments, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the relevant shipment.
3. In the Package Tracking No. field, enter the package number you have received from the shipping agent.
4. Choose the Track Package action.
Your default browser opens the shipping agent's tracking page.
See Also
How to: Set Up Shipping Agents
Sales
Setting Up Sales
How to: Send Documents by Email
Working with Dynamics NAV
Purchasing
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
You create a purchase invoice or purchase order to record the cost of purchases and to track
accounts payable. If you need to control an inventory, purchase invoices are also used to dynamically
update inventory levels so that you can minimize your inventory costs and provide better customer
service. The purchasing costs, including service expenses, and inventory values that result from
posting purchase invoices contribute to profit figures and other financial KPIs on your Home page.
You must use purchase orders if your purchasing process requires that you record partial receipts of
an order quantity, for example, because the full quantity was not available at the vendor. If you sell
items by delivering directly from your vendor to your customer, as a drop shipment, then you must
also use purchase orders. For more information, see How to: Make Drop Shipments. In all other
aspects, purchase orders work the same way as purchase invoices.
You can have purchase invoices created automatically by using the OCR (Optical Character
Recognition) service to convert PDF invoices from your vendors to electronic documents, which are
then converted to purchase invoices by a workflow. To use this functionality, you must first sign up
for the OCR service, and then perform various setup. For more information, see How to: Process
Incoming Documents.
Products can be both inventory items and services. For more information, see How to: Register New
Items.
For all purchase processes, you can incorporate an approval workflow, for example, to require that
large purchases are approved by the accounting manager. For more information, see Using Approval
Workflows.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Create a purchase invoice to record your agreement How to: Record Purchases
with a vendor to purchase products on certain
delivery and payment terms.
Create a purchase quote to reflect a request for quote How to: Request Quotes
from your vendor, which you can later convert to a
purchase order.
Create a purchase invoice for all or selected lines on a How to: Purchase Items for a Sale
sales invoice.
Perform an action on an unpaid posted purchase How to: Correct or Cancel Unpaid Sales Invoices
invoice to automatically create a credit memo and
either cancel the purchase invoice or recreate it so you
can make corrections.
Create a purchase credit memo to revert a specific How to: Process Purchase Returns or Cancellations
posted purchase invoice to reflect which products you
are returning to the vendor and which payment
amount you will collect.
TO SEE
Prepare to invoice multiple receipts from the same How to: Combine Receipts on a Single Invoice
vendor once by combining the receipts on one
invoice.
Learn how Dynamics NAV calculates when you must Date Calculation for Purchases
order an item to receive it on a certain date.
See Also
Setting Up Purchasing
How to: Register New Vendors
Managing Payables
Managing Projects
Working with Dynamics NAV
General Business Functionality
How to: Record Purchases
8/13/2018 • 4 minutes to read • Edit Online
You create a purchase invoice or purchase order to record the cost of purchases and to track accounts payable.
If you need to control an inventory, purchase invoices and purchase orders are also used to dynamically
update inventory levels so that you can minimize your inventory costs and provide better customer service.
The purchasing costs, including service expenses, and inventory values that result from posting purchase
invoices or orders contribute to profit figures and other financial KPIs on your Home page.
NOTE
You must use purchase orders if your purchasing process requires that you record partial receipts of an order quantity,
for example, because the full quantity was not available at the vendor. If you sell items by delivering directly from your
vendor to your customer, as a drop shipment, then you must also use purchase orders. For more information, see How
to: Make Drop Shipments. In all other aspects, purchase orders work the same way as purchase invoices. The following
procedure is based on a purchase invoice. The steps are similar for a purchase order.
When you receive the inventory items, or when the purchased service is completed, you post the purchase
invoice or order to update inventory and financial records and to activate payment to the vendor according to
the payment terms. For more information, see Making Payments.
Cau t i on
Do not post a purchase invoice until you receive the items and know the final cost of the purchase, including
any additional charges. Otherwise, your inventory value and profit figures may be skewed.
You can easily correct or cancel a posted purchase invoice before you pay the vendor. This is useful if you want
to correct a typing mistake or if you want to change the purchase early in the order process. For more
information, see How to: Correct or Cancel Unpaid Purchase Invoices. If you have already paid for items on
the posted purchase invoice, then you must create a purchase credit memo to reverse the purchase. For more
information, see How to: Process Purchase Returns or Cancellations.
Items can be type Inventory or Service. For more information, see How to: Register New Items. The
purchase invoice process is the same for both item types.
You can fill vendor fields on the purchase invoice in two ways depending on whether the vendor is already
registered.
NOTE
If you have set up recurring purchase lines for the vendor, such as a monthly replenishment order, then you can
insert these lines on the invoice by choosing the Get Recurring Purchase Lines action.
10. On the Lines FastTab, in the Item No. field, enter the number of an inventory item or service.
11. In the Quantity field, enter the number of items to be purchased.
NOTE
For items of type Service, the quantity is a time unit, such as hours, as indicated in the Unit of Measure Code
field on the line.
The Line Amount field is updated to show the value in the Direct Unit Cost field multiplied by the
value in the Quantity field.
The price and line amount are shown with or without sales tax depending on what you selected in the
Prices Including Tax field on the vendor card.
12. In the Invoice Discount Amount field, enter an amount that should be deducted from the value
shown in the Total Incl. Tax field at the bottom of the invoice.
NOTE
If you have set up invoice discounts for the vendor, then the specified percentage value is automatically inserted
in the Vendor Invoice Discount % field if the criteria are met, and the related amount is inserted in the
Invoice Discount Amount field.
13. When you receive the purchased items or services, choose Post.
The purchase is now reflected in inventory and financial records, and the vendor payment is activated. The
purchase invoice is removed from the list of purchase invoices and replaced with a new document in the list of
posted purchase invoices.
See Also
Purchasing
Setting Up Purchasing
How to: Request Quotes
How to: Purchase Items for a Sale
How to: Register New Vendors
How to: Prepare Drop Shipments
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Request Quotes
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
A purchase quote can be used as a preliminary draft for a purchase order, and the order can then be converted to a
purchase invoice or a order.
See Also
Purchasing
Setting Up Purchasing
How to: Send Documents by Email
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Purchase Items for a Sale
8/13/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
From sales orders and sales invoices, you can use functions to quickly create purchase documents for missing item
quantities that are required by the sale. You can use two different functions depending on the document type.
FUNCTION DESCRIPTION
Create Purchase Orders From a sales order, this function creates a purchase order for
each vendor of items on the sales order. You can edit the
purchase quantity before you create the purchase orders.
Only unavailable sales quantities are suggested.
Create Purchase Invoice From a sales order and from a sales invoice, this function
creates a purchase invoice for a selected vendor for all lines or
selected lines on the sales document. The full sales quantity is
suggested.
NOTE
You can also change the Quantity to Purchase field on grayed lines even though they represent fully available sales
quantities.
NOTE
This function creates a purchase invoice for the exact item quantity on the selected sales document. To change the purchase
quantity, you must edit the purchase invoice after it is created.
See Also
Purchasing
How to: Record Purchases
How to: Invoice Sales
How to: Register New Vendors
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Correct or Cancel Unpaid Purchase Invoices
8/13/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
You can correct or cancel a posted purchase invoice. This is useful if you want to correct a typing mistake, or if you
want to change the purchase early in the order process.
If you have already paid for products on the posted purchase invoice, you cannot correct or cancel it from the
posted purchase invoice itself. Instead, you must manually create a purchase credit memo to reverse the purchase,
optionally managed with a purchase return order. For more information, see How to: Process Purchase Returns or
Cancellations.
In the Posted Purchase Invoice window, you can choose the Correct button or the Cancel button. When you
correct or cancel a posted purchase invoice, the corrective purchase credit memo is applied to all general ledger
and inventory ledger entries that were created when the initial purchase invoice was posted. This reverses the
posted purchase invoice in your financial records and leaves the corrective posted purchase credit memo for your
audit trail. In the following the use of Correct and Cancel is described.
NOTE
If the Canceled check box is selected, then you cannot correct the posted purchase invoice because it has already
been corrected or canceled.
NOTE
If the Canceled check box is selected, then you cannot cancel the posted purchase invoice because it has already
been canceled or corrected.
See Also
Purchasing
How to: Record Purchases
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Combine Receipts on a Single Invoice
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
If you want to invoice more than one purchase receipt at a time, you can use the Combine Receipts function.
Before you can create a combined purchase receipt, more than one receipt from the same vendor in the same
currency must be posted. In other words, you must have filled in two or more purchase orders and posted them as
received, but not invoiced.
When purchase receipts are combined on an invoice and posted, then a posted purchase invoice is created for the
invoiced lines. The Quantity Invoiced field on the originating purchase order, or blanket purchase order, is
updated based on the invoiced quantity. However, this original purchase document is not deleted, even if it has
been fully received and invoiced, and you must therefore delete the purchase document.
To combine receipts
1. Choose the icon, enter Purchase Invoices, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the New action. For more information, see How to: Record Purchases.
3. On the Lines FastTab, choose the Get Receipt Lines action.
4. Select multiple receipt lines that you want to include in the invoice.
If an incorrect receipt line was selected or you want to start over, you can just delete the lines on the
purchase invoice and then use the Get Receipt Lines function again.
5. To post the invoice, choose the Post action.
See Also
Purchasing
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Process Purchase Returns or Cancellations
8/13/2018 • 13 minutes to read • Edit Online
If you want to return items to your vendor or cancel services that you have purchased, then you can create and
post a purchase credit memo that specifies the requested change with regard to the original purchase invoice. To
include the correct purchase invoice information, you can create the purchase credit memo directly from the
posted purchase invoice or you can create a new purchase credit memo with copied invoice information.
If you need more control of the purchase return process, such as warehouse documents for the item handling or
better overview when shipping back items from multiple purchase documents with one purchase return, then you
can create purchase return orders. A purchase return order automatically issues the related purchase credit memo.
For more information, see the "To create a purchase return order based on one or more a posted purchase
documents" section.
NOTE
If a posted purchase invoice has not yet been paid, then you can use the Correct or Cancel functions on the posted
purchase invoice to automatically reverse the involved transactions. These functions only work for unpaid invoices, and they
do not support partial returns or cancellations. For more information, see How to: Correct or Cancel Unpaid Purchase
Invoices.
Typically, you create a purchase credit memo or purchase return order in reaction to a credit memo sent to you by
a vendor. The purchase credit memo or purchase return order functions as your internal documentation of the
credit memo process for accounting purposes or to control the shipping of the involved items.
The change may relate to all the products on the original purchase invoice or only to some of the products.
Accordingly, you can partially return received items or demand partial reimbursement of received services. In that
case, you must edit the information on the purchase credit memo or purchase return order.
In addition to the original posted purchase invoice, you can apply the purchase credit memo or purchase return
order to other purchase documents, for example another posted purchase invoice because you are also returning
items delivered with that invoice.
The credit memo posting will also revert any item charges that were assigned to the posted document, so that the
item’s value entries are the same as before the item charge was assigned.
Inventory Costing
To preserve correct inventory valuation, you typically want to pick return items from inventory at the unit cost that
they were purchased at, not at their current unit cost. This is referred to as exact cost reversing.
Two functions exist to assign exact cost reversing automatically.
FUNCTION DESCRIPTION
Get Posted Document Lines to Reverse function in the Copies lines of one or more posted documents to be reversed
Purchase Return Order window into the purchase return order. For more information, see the
"To create a purchase return order, and related purchase credit
memo, for on one or more a posted purchase invoices"
section.
FUNCTION DESCRIPTION
Copy Document function in the Purchase Credit Memo Copies both the header and lines of one posted document to
and Purchase Return Order windows be reversed.
To assign exact cost reversing manually, you must choose the Appl.-from Item Entry field on any type of return
document line, and then select the number of the original purchase entry. This links the purchase credit memo or
purchase return order to the original purchase sales entry and ensures that the item is valued at the original unit
cost.
For more information, see Design Details: Inventory Costing.
NOTE
This field only works for posted receipts and posted invoice lines, not for posted return or posted credit memo lines.
At the left side of the window, the different document types are listed, and the number in brackets shows
the number of documents available of each document type.
7. In the Document Type Filter field, select the type of posted document lines you would like to use.
8. Select the lines that you would like to copy to the new document.
NOTE
If you use Ctrl+A to select all lines, all lines within the filter you have set are copied, but the Show Reversible
Quantity Only filter is ignored. For example, suppose you have filtered the lines to a particular document number
with two lines, one of which has already been returned. Even if the Show Reversible Quantity Only field is selected,
if you press Ctrl+A to copy all lines, both lines are copied, instead of only the one that has not yet been reversed.
NOTE
If part of the quantity of the posted document line has already been reversed or sold or consumed, a line is
created for only the quantity that remains in inventory or that has not been returned. If the full quantity of
the posted document line has already been reversed, a new document line is not created.
If the flow of goods in the posted document is the same as the flow of goods in the new document, a copy of
the original posted document line in the new document is created. The Appl.-from Item Entry field is not
filled in because, in this case, exact cost reversing is not possible. For example, if you use the Get Posted
Document Lines to Reverse function to get a posted purchase credit memo line for a new purchase credit
memo, only the original posted credit memo line is copied to the new credit memo.
10. In the Purchase Return Order window, in the Return Reason Code field on each line, select the reason
for the return.
11. Choose the Post action.
To create a replacement purchase order from a purchase return order
You may agree with your vendor that they compensate you for a purchased item by replacing the item. The
replacement item can be the same or it can be different. This situation could occur if the vendor mistakenly
shipped the wrong item.
1. In the Purchase Return Order window for an active return process, on an empty line, make a negative entry
for the replacement item by inserting a negative amount in the Quantity field.
2. Choose the Move Negative Lines action.
3. In the Move Negative Purchase Lines window, fill in the fields as necessary.
4. Choose the OK button. The negative line is deleted from the purchase return order, and a new purchase order
is created. For more information, see How to: Record Purchases.
1. Choose the icon, enter Purchase Credit Memos, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the New action to open a new empty purchase credit memo.
3. Fill in the credit memo header with information about the vendor who sent you the purchase allowance.
4. On the Lines FastTab, in the Type field, select Charge (Item ).
5. In the No. field, select the appropriate item charge value.
You may want to create a special item charge number to cover purchase allowances.
6. In the Quantity field, enter 1.
7. In the Direct Unit Cost field, enter the amount of the purchase allowance.
8. Assign the purchase allowance as an item charge to the items in the posted receipt. For more information,
see How to: Use Item Charges to Account for Additional Trade Costs. When you have assigned the
allowance, return to the Purchase Credit Memo window.
When you post the purchase return order, the purchase allowance is added to the relevant purchase entry amount.
In this way, you can maintain accurate inventory valuation.
NOTE
The following procedure assumes that there are several purchase return orders for the vendor, and that they have been
posted as shipped.
1. Choose the icon, enter Purchase Credit Memos, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the New action.
3. On the General FastTab, fill in the fields as necessary.
4. Choose the Get Return Shipment Lines action.
5. Select multiple return shipment lines that you want to include in the invoice.
If an incorrect return shipment line was selected or you want to start over, you can just delete the lines on
the purchase credit memo and then use the Get Return Shipment Lines function again.
6. Choose the Post action.
To remove open purchase return orders after combined return shipment posting
1. Choose the icon, enter Delete Invoiced Purchase Return Orders, and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the fields as necessary, and then choose the OK button.
3. Alternatively, delete the individual purchase return orders manually.
See Also
Purchasing
How to: Record Purchases
How to: How to: Correct or Cancel Unpaid Purchase Invoices
Working with Dynamics NAV
Date Calculation for Purchases
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Dynamics NAV automatically calculates the date on which you must order an item to have it in inventory on a
certain date. This is the date on which you can expect items ordered on a particular date to be available for picking.
If you specify a requested receipt date on a purchase order header, then the calculated order date is the date on
which the order must be placed to receive the items on the date that you requested. Then, the date on which the
items are available for picking is calculated and entered in the Expected Receipt Date field.
If you do not specify a requested receipt date, then the order date on the line is used as the starting point for
calculating the date on which you can expect to receive the items and the date on which the items are available for
picking.
See Also
Date Calculation for Sales
How to: Calculate Order Promising Dates
Working with Dynamics NAV
Inventory
8/13/2018 • 3 minutes to read • Edit Online
For each physical product that you trade in, you must create an item card of type Inventory.
Items that you offer to customers but do not keep in inventory you can register as nonstock
items, which you can convert to inventory items when necessary. You can increase or decrease
the quantity of an item in inventory by posting directly to the item ledger entries, for example,
after a physical count or if you do not record purchases.
Inventory increases and decreases are naturally also recorded when you post purchase and sales
documents respectively. For more information, see How to: Record Purchases, How to: Sell
Products, and How to: Invoice Sales. Transfers between locations changes inventory quantities
across your company's warehouses.
To increase your overview of items and to help you find them, you can categorize items and give
them attributes to search and sort by.
NOTE
The physical handling of items is referred to as warehouse activities. For more information, see
Warehouse Management.
Inventory Reconciliation
When you post inventory transactions, such as sales shipments, purchase invoices, or inventory
adjustments, the changed item costs are recorded in item value entries. To reflect this change of
inventory value in your financial books, the inventory costs are automatically posted to the
related inventory accounts in the general ledger. For each inventory transaction that you post,
the appropriate values are posted to the inventory account, adjustment account, and COGS
account in the general ledger. For more information, see How to: Reconcile Inventory Costs with
the General Ledger.
Even though inventory costs are automatically posted to the general ledger, it is still necessary to
ensure that the costs of goods are forwarded to the related outbound sales transaction,
especially in situations where you sell goods before you invoice the purchase of those goods.
This is referred to as cost adjustment. Item costs are automatically adjusted when you post item
transactions, but you can also adjust item costs manually. For more information, see How to:
Adjust Item Costs.
TO SEE
Create item cards for inventory items that you trade How to: Register New Items
in.
Structure parent items that you sell as kits How to: Work with Bills of Material
consisting of the parent's components or that you
assemble to order or to stock.
Maintain an overview of items and help you find How to: Categorize Items
and sort items by organizing them in categories.
TO SEE
Assign item attributes of different value types to How to: Work with Item Attributes
your items to help you sort and find items.
Create special item cards for items that you offer to How to: Work with Nonstock Items
customers but do not maintain inventory for.
Perform physical counting, make negative or How to: Count, Adjust, and Reclassify Inventory
positive adjustments, and change information, such Inventory
as location or lot number, on item ledger entries.
View the availability of items per location, by period, How to: How to: View the Availability of Items
by sales or purchase event, or by their use on
assembly or production BOMs.
Transfer inventory items between locations with How to: Transfer Inventory Between Locations
transfer orders, to manage warehouse activities, or
with the item reclassification journal.
Reserve inventory or inbound items for sales orders, How to: Reserve Items
purchase orders, service orders, assembly orders, or
production orders.
Assign serial numbers or lot numbers to any How to: Work with Serial and Lot Numbers
outbound or inbound document or journal line, for
example to track items in case of recalls.
Find where any serial or lot number was used in its How to: Trace Item-Tracked Items
supply chain, for example in recall situations.
Manage business operations in sales offices, a How to: Work with Responsibility Centers
purchasing departments, or plant planning offices
across multiple locations.
See Also
Warehouse Management
Purchasing
Sales
Working with Microsoft Dynamics NAV
General Business Functionality
How to: Register New Items
8/13/2018 • 4 minutes to read • Edit Online
Items, among other products, are the basis of your business, the goods or services that you trade in. Each
item must be registered as an item card.
Item cards hold the information that is required to buy, store, sell, deliver, and account for items.
An item can be structured as a parent item with underlying child items in a bill of materials (BOM ). In
Dynamics NAV, a bill of material can be either an assembly BOM or a production BOM, depending on its
use. For more information, see How to: Work with Bills of Material.
NOTE
If item templates exist for different item types, then a window appears when you create a new item card from where
you can select an appropriate template. If only one item template exists, then new item cards always use that template.
If you purchase the same item from more than one vendor, you can connect those vendors to the item card.
The vendors will then appear in the Item Vendor Catalog window, so that you can easily select an alternate
vendor.
NOTE
In the Costing Method field, you set up how the item's unit cost is calculated by making assumptions about the flow
of physical items through your company. Five costing methods are available, depending on the type of item. For more
information, see Design Details: Costing Methods.
If you select Average, then the item’s unit cost is calculated as the average unit cost at each point in time after a
purchase. Inventory is valuated with the assumption that all inventories are sold simultaneously. With this setting, you
can choose the Unit Cost field to view, in the Average Cost Calc. Overview window, the history of transactions that
the average cost is calculated from.
On the Price and Posting FastTab, you can view special prices or discounts that you grant for the item if
certain criteria are met, such as customer, minimum order quantity, or ending date. Each row represents a
special price or line discount. Each column represents a criterion that must apply to warrant the special price
that you enter in the Unit Price field, or the line discount that you enter in the Line Discount % field. For
more information, see Record Sales Price, Discount, and Payment Agreements.
The item is now registered, and the item card is ready to be used on purchase and sales documents.
If you want to use this item card as a template when you create new item cards, you can save it as a template.
For more information, see the following section.
1. Choose the icon, enter Items, and then choose the related link.
2. Select the relevant item, and then choose the Edit action.
3. Choose the Vendors action.
4. Choose the Vendor No. field, and then select the vendor that you want to set up for the item.
5. Optionally, fill in the remaining fields.
6. Repeat steps 2 through 5 for each vendor that you want to buy the item from.
The vendors will now appear in the Item Vendor Catalog window, which you open from the item card, so
that you can easily select an alternate vendor.
See Also
Inventory
Purchasing
Sales
Working with Microsoft Dynamics NAV
How to: Work with Bills of Material
4/16/2018 • 6 minutes to read • Edit Online
You use bills of materials (BOMs) to structure parent items that must be assembled or produced by resources or
machine centers from components. An assembly BOM can also be used to sell a parent item as a kit consisting of
its components.
1. Choose the icon, enter Items, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the card for an assembly item. (The Assembly BOM field in the Items window contains Yes.)
3. In the Item Card window, choose the Assembly action, and then choose the Assembly BOM action.
4. In the Assembly BOM window, choose the Show BOM action.
OPTION DESCRIPTION
Top Level Calculates the assembly item's standard cost as the total cost
of all purchased or assembled items on that assembly BOM
regardless of any underlying assembly BOMs.
All Levels Calculates the assembly's item standard cost as the sum of: 1)
The calculated cost of all underlying assembly BOMs on the
assembly BOM. 2) The cost of all purchased items on the
assembly BOM.
The costs of the items that make up the assembly BOM are copied from the component item cards. The cost of
each item is multiplied by the quantity, and the total cost is shown in the Unit Cost field on the item card.
See Also
How to: Register New Items
How to: View the Availability of Items
Inventory
Working with Microsoft Dynamics NAV
How to: Categorize Items
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
To maintain an overview of your items and to help you sort and find items, it is useful to organize your items in
item categories.
To find items by characteristics, you can assign item attributes to items and also to item categories. For more
information, see How to: Work with Item Attributes.
NOTE
If the item category has a parent item category, as indicated by the Parent Category field, then any item attributes that
are assigned to that parent item category are prefilled on the Attributes FastTab.
NOTE
Item attributes that you assign to an item category will automatically apply to the item that the item category is assigned
to.
See Also
How to: Work with Item Attributes
How to: Register New Items
Inventory
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Work with Item Attributes
8/13/2018 • 4 minutes to read • Edit Online
When customers inquire about an item, either in correspondence or in an integrated web shop, they may ask or
search according to characteristics, such as height and model year. To provide this customer service, you can
assign item attribute values of different types to your items, which can then be used when searching for items.
You can also assign item attributes to item categories, which then apply to the items that use the item categories.
For more information, see How to: Categorize Item.
TIP
If you attach pictures to items, the Image Analyzer extension can detect attributes in the image, and suggest the attributes
so you can decide whether to assign them. The extension is ready to go. You just need to enable it. For more information,
see The Image Analyzer Extension for Dynamics NAV.
NOTE
If you select Option in the Type field, then you can choose the Item Attribute Values action to create values for the item
attribute. For more information, see the "To create values for item attributes of type Option" section.
NOTE
Item attributes for parent item categories will be inherited to child item categories. This is indicated by the Inherited From
field on the Attributes FastTab. For more information, see How to: Categorize Items.
NOTE
You can only select values directly for item attributes that have fixed values, such as Color. For item attributes that
have variable values, such as Width, you must specify the item attribute value by first selecting a condition. See step
5.
5. In the Value field for a variable item attribute, choose the lookup button.
6. In the Specify Filter Value window, in the Condition field, choose the drop-down arrow and select a
condition.
7. In the Value field, enter an attribute value to filter items by.
Example: To filter on items where the material description begins with "blue", fill in the fields as follows:
Attribute field: Material Description, Condition field: Begins With, Value field: blue.
8. Choose the OK button.
The items in the Items window are filtered by the specified item attribute values.
See Also
How to: Categorize Items
How to: Register New Items
Inventory
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Work with Nonstock Items
4/16/2018 • 3 minutes to read • Edit Online
You can offer certain items to your customers for their convenience, which you do not want to maintain in
inventory until you start selling them. When you want to start maintaining such items in inventory, you can
convert them to normal item cards in two ways.
From a nonstock item card, create a new item card based on a template.
From a sales order line of type Item with an empty *No field, select a nonstock item. An item card is
automatically created for the nonstock item.
NOTE
You cannot select a nonstock item from the Sales Invoice window. You can select a nonstock item from the Sales Quote
window, but the nonstock item will not be converted to a normal item when you use the Make Order function.
A nonstock item typically has the item number of the vendor who supplies it. To enable conversion of a nonstock
item card to a normal item card, you must first set up how vendor item numbering is converted to your own item
numbering.
1. Choose the icon, enter Nonstock Items, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the New action.
3. Fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short description of the field or link to more information.
1. Choose the icon, enter Nonstock Item Setup, and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the fields as necessary.
NOTE
An Item cross reference record is automatically created for the vendor of the item between the vendor's item number and
your new item number.
See Also
How to: Register New Items
How to: Create Special Orders|
Inventory
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Count, Adjust, and Reclassify Inventory
8/13/2018 • 15 minutes to read • Edit Online
At least once every fiscal year you must take a physical inventory, that is, count all the items on inventory, to see if
the quantity registered in the database is the same as the actual physical quantity in the warehouses. When the
actual physical quantity is known, it must be posted to the general ledger as a part of period-end valuation of
inventory.
Although you count all items in inventory at least once a year, you may have decided to count some items more
often, perhaps because they are more valuable, or because they are very fast movers and a large part of your
business. For this purpose, you can assign special counting periods to those items. For more information, see the
"To perform cycle counting" section.
If you need to adjust recorded inventory quantities, in connection with counting or for other purposes, you can
use an item journal to change the inventory ledger entries directly without posting business transactions.
Alternatively, you can adjust for a single item on the item card.
If you need to change attributes on item ledger entries as well as the quantities, you can use the item
reclassification journal. Typical attributes to reclassify include serial/lot numbers, expiration dates, and
dimensions.
NOTE
In advanced warehouse configurations, items are registered in bins as warehouse entries, not as item ledger entries.
Therefore, you perform counting, adjusting, and reclassifying in special warehouse journals that support bins. Then, you use
special functions to synchronize the new or changed warehouse entries with their related item ledger entries to reflect the
changes in inventory quantities and values. This is described in specific procedures below where relevant.
NOTE
The item entries are processed according to the information that you specified, and lines are created in the physical
inventory journal. Notice that the Qty. (Phys. Inventory) field is automatically filled in with the same quantity as the Qty.
(Calculated) field. With this feature, it is not necessary for you to enter the counted inventory on hand for items that are
the same as the calculated quantity. However, if the quantity counted differs from what is entered in the Qty. (Calculated)
field, you must overwrite it with the quantity actually counted.
5. Choose the icon, enter Whse. Phys. Invt. Journal, and choose the related link.
6. Choose the Calculate Inventory action. The Whse. Calculate Inventory batch job request window
opens.
7. Set the filters to limit the items that will be counted in the journal, and then choose the OK button.
The program creates a line for each bin that fulfills the filter requirements. You can at this point still delete
some of the lines, but if you want to post the results as a physical inventory, you must count the item in all
the bins that contain it.
If you only have time to count the item in some bins and not others, you can discover discrepancies,
register them, and later post them in the item journal using the Calculate Whse. Adjustment function.
8. Choose the icon, enter Whse. Phys. Inventory List, and choose the related link.
9. Open the report request page and print the lists on which you want employees to record the quantity of
items that they count in each bin.
10. When the counting is done, enter the counted quantities in the Qty. (Phys. Inventory) field in the
warehouse physical inventory journal.
NOTE
In the warehouse physical inventory journal, Qty. (Calculated) field is filled in automatically on the basis of
warehouse bin records and copies these quantities are copied to the Qty. (Physical) field on each line. If the
quantity counted by the warehouse employee differs from what the program has entered in the Qty. (Physical) field,
you must enter the quantity actually counted.
11. When you have entered all the counted quantities, choose the Register action.
When you register the journal, the program creates two warehouse entries in the warehouse register for
every line that was counted and registered:
If the calculated and the physical quantities differ, a negative or positive quantity is registered for the
bin, and a balancing quantity is posted to the adjustment bin of the location.
If the quantity calculated is equal to the physical quantity, the program registers an entry of 0 for both
the bin and the adjustment bin. The entries are the record that on the registering date, a warehouse
physical inventory was performed, and there was no discrepancy in inventory for the item.
When you register the warehouse physical inventory, you are not posting to the item ledger, the physical
inventory ledger, or the value ledger, but the records are there for immediate reconciliation whenever necessary. If
you like to keep precise records of what is happening in the warehouse, however, and you counted all of the bins
where the items were registered, you should immediately post the warehouse results as an inventory physical
inventory. For more information, see the "To enter and post the actual counted inventory in advanced warehouse
configurations" section.
To print the report to be used when counting
1. In the Phys. Inventory Journal window containing the calculated expected inventory, Choose the Print
action.
2. In the Phys. Inventory List window, specify if the report should show the calculated quantity and if the report
should list inventory items by serial/lot numbers.
3. Set filters if you only want to print the report for certain items, bins, locations, or dimensions.
4. Choose the Print button.
Employees can now proceed to count inventory and record any discrepancies on the printed report.
To enter and post the actual counted inventory in basic warehouse configurations
1. On each line in the Phys. Inventory Journal window where the actual inventory on hand, as determined
by the physical count, differs from the calculated quantity, enter the actual inventory on hand in the Qty.
(Phys. Inventory) field.
The related fields are updated accordingly.
NOTE
If the physical count reveals differences that are caused by items posted with incorrect location codes, do not enter
the differences in the physical inventory journal. Instead, use the reclassification journal or a transfer order to
redirect the items to the correct locations. For more information, see Item Reclass. Journal or How to: Create
Transfer Orders.
2. To adjust the calculated quantities to the actual counted quantities, choose the Post action.
Both item ledger entries and physical inventory ledger entries are created. Open the item card to view the
resulting physical inventory ledger entries.
3. Choose the icon, enter Items, and then choose the related link.
4. To verify the inventory counting, open the item card in question, and then, choose the Phys. Inventory
ledger Entries action.
To enter and post the actual counted inventory in advanced warehouse configurations
1. Choose the icon, enter Item Journal, and choose the related link.
2. Choose the Calculate Whse. Adjustment action.
3. Select the same items that you counted in the cycle counting physical inventory you just performed, and
any other items that require adjustment, and then choose the OK button.
The Inventory Journal window opens and lines are created for these items. Note that the net quantities
that you just counted and registered bin by bin are now ready to be consolidated and synchronized as item
ledger entries.
4. Post the journal without changing any quantities.
The quantities in the item ledger (item entries) and the quantities in the warehouse (warehouse entries) are now
once again the same for these items, and the program has updated the last counting date of the item or
stockkeeping unit.
1. Choose the icon, enter Phys. Invt. Counting Periods, and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short description of the field or link to more information.
To assign a counting period to an item
1. Choose the icon, enter Items, and then choose the related link.
2. Select the item to which you want to assign a counting period.
3. In the Phys Invt Counting Period Code field, select the appropriate counting period.
4. Choose the Yes button to change the code and calculate the first counting period for the item. The next time
you choose to calculate a counting period in the physical inventory journal, the item appears as a line in the
Phys. Invt. Item Selection window. You can then begin to count the item on a periodic basis.
To initiate a count based on counting periods in basic warehouse configurations
1. Choose the icon, enter Phys. Inventory Journal, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the Calculate Counting Period action.
The Phys. Invt. Item Selection window opens showing the items that have counting periods assigned
and need to be counted according to their counting periods.
3. Perform the physical inventory. For more information, see the "To perform a physical inventory" section.
To initiate a count based on counting periods in advanced warehouse configurations
1. Choose the icon, enter Whse. Phys. Invt. Journal, and choose the related link.
2. Choose the Calculate Counting Period action.
The Phys. Invt. Item Selection window opens showing the items that have counting periods assigned
and need to be counted according to their counting periods.
3. Perform the physical inventory. For more information, see the "To perform a physical inventory" section.
NOTE
You must count the item in all the bins that contain the particular item. If you delete some of the bin lines that the
program has retrieved for counting in the Whse. Phys. Inventory window, then you will not be counting all the
items in the warehouse. If you later post such incomplete results in the Phys. Inventory Journal, the amounts posted
will be incorrect.
1. Choose the icon, enter Items, and then choose the related link.
2. Select the item for which you want to adjust inventory, and then choose the Adjust Inventory action.
3. In the New Inventory field, enter the inventory quantity that you want to record for the item.
4. Choose the OK button.
The item’s inventory is now adjusted. The new quantity is shown in the Current Inventory field in the Adjust
Inventory window and in the Inventory field in the Item Card window.
You can also use the Adjust Inventory function as a simple way to place purchased items on inventory if you do
not use purchase invoices or orders to record your purchases. For more information, How to: Record Purchases.
NOTE
After you have adjusted inventory, you must update it with the current, calculated value. For more information, see How to:
Revalue Inventory.
1. Choose the icon, enter Item Journals, and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short description of the field or link to more information.
3. Choose the Post action to make the inventory adjustments.
NOTE
After you have adjusted inventory, you must update it with the current, calculated value. For more information, see How to:
Revalue Inventory.
1. Choose the icon, enter Whse. Item Journal, and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the header information.
3. Fill in the Item No. field on the line.
4. Enter the bin in which you are putting the extra items or where you have found items to be missing.
5. Fill in the quantity that you observe as a discrepancy in the Quantity field. If you have found extra items, enter
a positive quantity. If items are missing, enter a negative quantity.
6. Choose the Register action.
1. Choose the icon, enter Item Journal, and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the fields on each journal line.
3. Choose the Calculate Whse. Adjustment action, and fill in the filters as appropriate in the batch job request
window. The adjustments are calculated only for the entries in the adjustment bin that meet filter
requirements.
4. On the Options FastTab, fill in the Document No. field with a number that you enter manually. Because no
number series has been set up for this batch job, use the number scheme set up by the warehouse, or enter
the date followed by your initials.
5. Choose the OK button. The positive and negative adjustments are totaled for each item and lines are created
in the item journal for any items where the sum is a positive or negative quantity.
6. Post the journal lines to enter the quantity differences in the item ledger. The inventory in the warehouse bins
now corresponds precisely to the inventory in the item ledger.
To reclassify an item's lot number
1. Choose the icon, enter Item Reclass. Journals, and then choose the related link.
2. In the Item Reclass. Journal window, fill in the fields as necessary.
3. To In the Lot No. field, enter the items current lot number.
4. In the New Lot No. field, enter the item's new lot number.
5. Choose the Post action.
Special steps apply when you want to reclassify serial or lot numbers. For more information, see How to: Work
with Serial and Lot Numbers.
See Also
Inventory Warehouse Management
Sales
Purchasing
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: View the Availability of Items
4/16/2018 • 7 minutes to read • Edit Online
From the context of a business task, you can get advanced information about when and where an item is
available, such as when talking to a customer about a delivery date.
You can view the availability of all items per location, and you can view the availability of each item by event, by
period, or by location. An event is any scheduled item transaction, such as a sales shipment or an inbound
transfer receipt.
NOTE
Availability views by location require that you maintain inventory at more than one location. For more information, see
How to: Set Up Locations.
In Dynamics NAV, availability figures are shown in two different fields, each with a different definition:
The Quantity on Hand field shows the actual quantity today according to posted item ledger entries.
The Projected Available Balance field is calculated and shows the quantity on hand plus scheduled receipts
minus gross requirements. (In Dynamics NAV, scheduled receipts include quantities on purchase orders and
inbound transfer orders. Gross requirements include quantities on sales orders and outbound transfer orders.)
TIP
The projected available balance is especially relevant to view in the Item Availability by Periods and Item Availability by
Event windows as they contain the date dimension.
NOTE
The following procedures describe how to view advanced availability information from the items list and item card. You can
also access the information from sales document lines, for the item on the line. For more information, see How to: Sell
Products.
1. Choose the icon, enter Items, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the card of an item that you want to view availability for.
3. Choose the Item Availability by action, and then choose the Event action.
The Item Availability by Event window shows how the inventory quantity of the item will develop over
time according scheduled shipment and receipt events. The window gives a condensed view that shows
one line of accumulated information per time interval in which inventory quantities change. Time intervals
where no events occurred are not shown. You can expand each line to show details about the event or
events that caused the accumulated quantity on the line.
4. Choose the value in the Projected Available Balance field to view the item ledger entries or open
documents that make up the value.
1. Choose the icon, enter Items, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the card of an item that you want to view availability for.
3. Choose the Item Availability by action, and then choose the Period action.
The Item Availability by Periods window shows how the inventory quantity of the item will develop
over time, shown for a period that you select, such as Day, Week, or Quarter.
4. Choose the value in the Projected Available Balance field to view the item ledger entries or open
documents that make up the value.
1. Choose the icon, enter Items, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the card of an item that you want to view availability for.
3. Choose the Item Availability by action, and then choose the Location action.
The Item Availability by Location window shows how the inventory quantity of the item will develop in
the future, shown for each location where it is stored.
4. Choose the value in the Qty. on Hand field to view the item ledger entries that make up the value.
5. Choose the value in the Projected Available Balance field to view the item ledger entries or open
documents that make up the value.
To view the availability of all items by the location where they are
stored
You view the availability of all your items across all your locations in the Items by Location window.
1. Choose the icon, enter Items, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the Items by Location action.
The Items by Location window shows for all your items how many are available at each location.
3. Choose the value in the Qty. on Hand field to view the item ledger entries that make up the value.
FIELD DESCRIPTION
Able to Make Parent Shows how many units of any subassembly in the top item
you can make. The field specifies how many immediate parent
units you can assemble. The value is based on availability of
the item on the line.
Able to Make Top Item Shows how many units of the top item you can make. The
field specifies how many units of the top-line BOM item you
can assemble. The value is based on availability of the item on
the line.
NOTE
By default, availability figures on the lines show the total availability of all items under the top item. These figures are
displayed in the Available Quantity field, and the focus is on the top item. However, information about how many
subassemblies you can make may be skewed. To get a true indication of how many of the shown subassemblies you can
make, you must clear the Show Total Availability chack box and then see the figure in the Able to Make Parent field.
The Bottleneck field specifies which item in the BOM structure restricts you from making a larger quantity than
the quantity that is shown in the Able to Make Top Item field. For example, the bottleneck item can be a
purchased component with an expected receipt date that is too late to make additional units of the top item by
the date in the Needed by Date field.
See Also
Manage Inventory
Assembly Management
How to: Work with Bills of Materials
How to: Set Up Locations
How to: Transfer Inventory Between Locations
How to: Sell Products
Working with Dynamics NAV
General Business Functionality
How to: Transfer Inventory Between Locations
8/13/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
You can transfer inventory items between locations by creating transfer orders. Alternatively, you can use the item
reclassification journal.
With transfer orders, you ship the outbound transfer from one location and receive the inbound transfer at the
other location. This allows you to manage the involved warehouse activities and provides more certainty that
inventory quantities are updated correctly.
With the reclassification journal, you simply fill in the Location Code and the New Location Code fields. When
you post the journal, the item ledger entries are adjusted at the locations in question. With this method,
warehouse activities are not managed.
NOTE
If you have items recorded in your inventory without a location code, for example from a time when you only had one
warehouse, then you cannot transfer those items using transfer orders. Instead, you must use the reclassification journal to
reclassify the items from a blank location code to an actual location code. For more information, see step 3 in the "To
transfer items with the item reclassification journal" section.
To transfer items, locations and transfer routes must be set up. For more information, see How to: Set Up
Locations.
NOTE
If you have filled in the In-Transit Code, Shipping Agent Code, and Shipping Agent Service fields in the Trans.
Route Spec. window when you set up the transfer route, then the corresponding fields on the transfer order are
filled in automatically.
When you fill in the Shipping Agent Service field, the receipt date at the transfer-to location is calculated
by adding the shipping time of the shipping agent service to the shipment date.
As a warehouse worker at the transfer-from location, proceed to ship the items.
3. Choose the Post action, choose the Ship option, and then choose the OK button.
The items are now in transit between the specified locations, according to the specifies transfer route.
As a warehouse worker at the transfer-from location, proceed to receive the items.
4. Choose the Post action, choose the Receive option, and then choose the OK button.
NOTE
To transfer items that have no location code, leave the Location Code field blank.
4. In the New Location Code field, enter the location that you want to transfer the items to.
5. Choose the Post action.
See Also
Manage Inventory
How to: Set Up Locations
Working with Dynamics NAV
Customizing Dynamics NAV
General Business Functionality
How to: Reserve Items
4/16/2018 • 4 minutes to read • Edit Online
You can reserve items for sales orders, purchase orders, service orders, assembly orders, and production orders.
You can reserve items on inventory or inbound on open document or journal lines. You perform the work in the
Reservation window.
Each line in the Reservation window, which you open to reserve items, displays information about one type of
line (sales, purchase, journal) or inventory entry. The lines describe how many items are available to be reserved
from each type of line or entry.
1. Choose the icon, enter Sales Orders, and then choose the related link.
2. On a sales order, on the Lines FastTab, choose the Reserve action. The Reservation window opens.
3. Select the line that you want to reserve the items from.
4. Choose one of the following actions.
FUNCTION DESCRIPTION
Reserve from Current Line To reserve the items from the document on the line you
have selected.
Cancel Reservation from Current Line To cancel reservation of the items from the document on
the line you have selected.
NOTE
If item tracking lines exist for the sales order, the reservation system will take you through special steps. For more
information, see the "To reserve a specific serial or lot number" section.
1. Choose the icon, enter Firm Planned Prod. Order, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the firm planned production order you want to reserve parent items for.
3. Select the relevant production order line.
4. On the Lines FastTab, choose the Reserve action.
5. In the Reservation window, select the Sales Line, Order line, and then choose the Reserve from Current
Line action.
The quantity you entered in the firm planned production order line is now reserved.
1. Choose the icon, enter Firm Planned Prod. Order, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the firm planned production order you want to reserve component items for.
3. Select the relevant production order line.
4. On the Lines FastTab, choose Line, and then choose Components.
5. Select the relevant component line.
6. Choose On the Lines FastTab, choose the Reserve action.
7. In the Reservation window, select a line, and then choose the Reserve from Current Line action.
The quantity you entered in the firm planned production component line is now reserved.
To change a reservation
Sometimes, you may want to change an item reservation.
1. From the document line that you have reserved from, on the Lines FastTab, choose the Reserve action.
2. In the Reservation window, choose the Reservation Entries action.
3. The Reservation Entries window, update the Quantity field on the line you want to change.
4. Confirm the subsequent message, by choosing the OK button.
To cancel a reservation
Sometimes, you may want to cancel an item reservation.
1. From the document line that you want to cancel a reservation from, on the Lines FastTab, choose the Reserve
action.
2. In the Reservation window, choose Reservation Entries action.
3. In the Reservation Entries window, choose the Cancel Reservation action.
4. Confirm the subsequent message, by choosing the OK button.
1. Choose the icon, enter Sales Orders, and then choose the related link.
2. Create a sales order line for an item-tracked item.
3. Assign serial and lot numbers to the sales order line. For more information, see How to: Work with Serial and
Lot Numbers.
4. On the sales order line, choose the Reserve action.
5. Choose the Yes button to reserve specific serial or lot numbers.
6. In the Item Tracking List window, select the serial and lot number combination that you have just assigned.
7. Choose the OK button to open the Reservation window showing only supply with the specified item tracking
number. If there are any non-specific reservations on any of the item tracking numbers that you have specified
for this line, you are informed of the quantity that has already been reserved.
8. Choose either the Auto Reserve or the Reserve from Current Line action to create the reservation on the
specific item tracking numbers.
See Also
Inventory
Design Details: Reservation, Order Tracking, and Action Messaging
Design Details - Item Tracking and Reservations
How to: Work with Serial and Lot Numbers
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Work with Serial and Lot Numbers
4/16/2018 • 16 minutes to read • Edit Online
You can assign serial numbers and lot numbers to any outbound or inbound document, and its posted item
tracking entries are displayed in the related item ledger entries. You perform the work in the Item Tracking
Lines window.
The matrix of quantity fields at the top of the Item Tracking Lines window displays the quantities and sums of
item tracking numbers being defined on the lines. The quantities must correspond to those of the document line,
which is indicated by 0 in the Undefined fields.
As a performance measure, the program collects the availability information in the Item Tracking Lines window
only once, when you open the window. This means that the program does not update the availability information
during the time that you have the window open, even if changes occur in inventory or on other documents
during that time.
Items with serial or lot numbers can be traced both backwards and forward in their supply chain. This is useful
for general quality assurance and for product recalls. For more information, see How to: Trace Item-Tracked
Items.
FIELD DESCRIPTION
Total Requested Quantity The total number of items that are requested that will be
used in this and other documents
Current Pending Quantity The number of items that are requested that will be used on
the current document but that is not yet committed to the
database
Current Requested Quantity The number of items that are requested that will be used on
the current document
Total Available Quantity The total number of items in inventory, minus the quantity of
the item that are requested on this and other documents
(total requested quantity), and minus the quantity that is
requested but not yet committed on this document (current
pending quantity)
If you work in the Item Tracking Lines window for a long period of time or if there is a great deal of activity with
the item you are working with, then you can choose the Refresh Availability action. In addition, the availability
of the item is automatically rechecked when you close the window to confirm that there are no availability
problems.
1. Choose the icon, enter Item Tracking Codes, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the New action.
3. Fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short description of the field or link to more information.
4. On the Serial No. and the Lot No. FastTabs, define policies of item tracking by serial and lot numbers
respectively.
To set up expiration rules for serial or lot numbers
For some items you might want to set up specific expiration dates and rules in the item tracking code. This
functionality allows you to keep track of when specific serial numbers and lot numbers expire.
1. Select an existing item tracking code, and then choose the Edit action.
2. On the Misc. FastTab, select the following check boxes.
FIELD DESCRIPTION
Strict Expiration Posting Specifies that an expiration date assigned to the item
tracking number as it entered inventory must be
respected when it exits inventory.
Man. Expir. Date Entry Reqd. Specifies that you must manually enter an expiration date
on the item tracking line.
1. Choose the icon, enter Item Tracking Codes, and then choose the related link.
2. Select an existing item tracking code, and then choose the Edit action.
3. On the Misc. FastTab, fill in the Warranty Date Formula field, and then select the check box as follows.
FIELD DESCRIPTION
Warranty Date Formula Specifies the last day of warranty for the item.
Man. Warranty Date Entry Reqd. Specifies that you must manually enter a warranty date
on the item tracking line.
1. Choose the icon, enter Purchase Orders, and then choose the related link.
2. Select the relevant document line and on the Lines FastTab, choose the Line action, and then choose the
Item Tracking Lines action.
You can assign serial or lot numbers in the following ways:
Automatically, by choosing Assign Serial No. or Assign Lot No. to assign serial/lot numbers from
predefined number series.
Automatically, by choosing Create Customized SN to assign serial/lot numbers based on number
series you define specifically for the arrived items.
Manually, by entering serial or lot numbers directly, for example, the vendor's numbers.
Manually, by assigning a specific number to each item unit.
3. To assign automatically, choose the Create Customized SN action.
4. In the Customized SN field, enter the starting number of a descriptive serial number series, for example
S/N -Vend0001.
5. In the Increment field, enter 1 to define that each sequential number increases by one.
The Quantity to Create field contains the line quantity by default, but you can modify it.
6. Select the Create New Lot No. check box to organize the new serial numbers in a distinct lot.
7. Choose the OK button.
A lot number with individual serial numbers is created according to the item quantity of the document line,
starting from S/N -Vend0001.
The matrix of quantity fields in the header displays dynamically the quantities and sums of the item tracking
numbers you define in the window. The quantities must correspond to those of the document line, which is
signified by 0 in the Undefined fields.
When the document is posted, the item tracking entries are carried to the associated item ledger entries.
NOTE
To assign item tracking numbers in warehouse activities, the SN Warehouse Tracking and Lot Warehouse Tracking
check boxes must be selected on the item’s item tracking code card.
1. Select the relevant document and, on the Lines FastTab, choose the Order action, and then choose the
Item Tracking Lines action.
You can assign item tracking numbers in the following ways:
Automatically, from predefined number series: Choose the Assign Serial No. or Assign Lot No.
action.
Automatically, based on parameters you define specifically for the outbound item: Choose the Create
Customized SN action.
Manually, by entering serial or lot numbers, without using a number series.
2. For this procedure, assign a serial number automatically by choosing Assign Serial No.
The Quantity to Create field contains the line quantity by default, but you can modify it.
3. Select the Create New Lot No. field to organize the new serial numbers in a distinct lot.
4. Choose the OK button to create a lot number and new individual serial numbers according to the quantity
to handle on the related document line.
The matrix of quantity fields at the top displays dynamically the quantities and sums of the item tracking numbers
that you define in the window. The quantities must correspond to those of the document line, which is signified
by 0 in the Undefined fields.
When the document is posted, the item tracking entries are carried to the associated item ledger entries.
NOTE
To handle item tracking numbers in warehouse activities, the item must be set up with SN/Lot Warehouse Tracking, as this
dictates the special principles governing serial and lot numbers in the warehouse.
1. From any outbound document, select the line that you want to select serial or lot numbers for.
2. On the Lines FastTab, choose the Actions action, choose the Line or the Item action, and then choose the
Item Tracking Lines action.
3. In the Item Tracking Lines window, you have three options for specifying lot or serial number:
Select the Lot No. or Serial No. field, and then select a number from the Item Tracking Summary
window.
Choose the Select Entries action. The Select Entries window shows all lot or serial numbers along
with availability information.
4. In the Selected Quantity field, enter the quantity of each lot or serial number that you would like to use.
5. Choose the OK button, and the selected item tracking information is transferred to the Item Tracking
Lines window.
6. Type or scan in the item tracking number.
The matrix of quantity fields in the header dynamically displays the quantities and sums of the item tracking
numbers you define in the window. The quantities must correspond to those of the document line, which is
signified by 0 in the Undefined fields.
When you post the document line, the item tracking information is transferred to the associated item ledger
entries.
1. Choose the icon, enter Transfer Orders, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the transfer order you want to process. On the Lines FastTab, choose choose the Line action, choose
the Item Tracking Lines action, and then choose the Shipment action.
3. In the Item Tracking Lines window, assign or select serial or lot numbers as for any other outbound item
transaction.
When handling serial and lot numbers for transfer items, the items typically have numbers already
assigned to them. Therefore, the process typically consists of selecting from existing serial or lot numbers.
4. Post the transfer order, first ship and then receive, to record that the items are transferred carrying their
item tracking entries.
During the transfer, the Item Tracking Lines window remains locked for writing.
To handle serial and lot numbers when getting receipt lines from a
purchase invoice
When you use functionality to get posted receipt or shipment lines from related invoices or credit memos, then
any item tracking lines on the warehouse documents are transferred automatically, however, they are processed
in a special way.
The functionality supports the following inbound processes:
Get Receipt Lines - from a purchase invoice.
Get Return Shipment Lines - from a purchase credit memo.
The functionality supports the following outbound processes:
Get Shipment Lines - from a sales invoice or combined shipments.
Get Return Receipt Lines - from a sales credit memo.
In these situations, the existing item tracking lines are copied automatically to the invoice or credit memo, but the
Item Tracking Lines window does not permit changes to the serial or lot numbers. Only the quantities can be
changed.
1. Choose the icon, enter Purchase Invoices, and then choose the related link.
2. Open a purchase invoice for items that are purchase with serial or lot numbers.
3. From a purchase invoice line, on the Lines FastTab, choose the Get Receipt Lines action.
4. In the Get Receipt Lines window, select a receipt lines that has item tracking lines, and then choose the
OK button.
The source document is copied to the purchase invoice as a new line, and its item tracking lines are copied
to the underlying Item Tracking Lines window.
5. In the purchase invoice, select the transferred receipt line.
6. On the Lines FastTab, choose the Line action, and then choose the Item Tracking Lines action to see the
transferred item tracking lines.
The contents of the Serial No. and Lot No. fields are not editable. However, you can delete complete lines or
change the quantities to match changes being made on the source line.
1. Choose the icon, enter Item Reclass. Journal, and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the line with the relevant information. For more information, see How to: Count, Adjust, and
Reclassify Inventory.
3. Choose the Item Tracking Lines action.
4. In the Serial No. or Lot No. field, select the current serial or lot number.
5. If you want to enter a new item tracking number, enter it in the New Serial No. or New Lot No. field. If
you want, you can merge one or more lots to one new or existing lot.
NOTE
Be aware that when you reclassify expiration dates, then the items with the earliest expiration dates for outbound
transactions are suggested first. For more information, see Picking by FEFO.
6. If you would like to enter a new expiration date for the serial or lot number, enter it in the New Expiration
Date field.
IMPORTANT
If you are reclassifying a lot to the same lot number but with a different expiration date, you must reclassify the
entire lot, using one item reclassification journal line. If you are reclassifying more than one lot to one new lot
number, meaning that you are merging more than one lot into one new lot, you must enter the same new
expiration date for all the lots. If you are reclassifying one existing lot to a second existing lot that has a different
expiration date, you must use the expiration date from the second lot. If you leave the New Expiration Date field
blank, the lot or serial number will be reclassified with a blank expiration date.
7. If you have existing information on the old serial or lot number, you can copy it to the new serial or lot
number.
a. In the Item Tracking Lines window, choose the New Serial No. Information action or the New Lot
No. Information action.
b. To copy information from the old lot or serial number, choose the Copy Info action.
c. In the information list window, select the lot or serial number that you would like to copy from, and
choose the OK button.
8. If you want to modify the existing information for the lot or serial number, you can record lot or serial
information.
9. Post the journal to link the renewed item tracking numbers or expiration dates to the associated item
ledger entry
See Also
How to: Trace Item-Tracked Items
Inventory
Design Details: Item Tracking Design Details - Item Tracking and Reservations
How to: Reserve Items
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Work with Responsibility Centers
4/16/2018 • 3 minutes to read • Edit Online
Responsibility centers provide the ability to handle administrative centers. A responsibility center can be a cost
center, a profit center, an investment center, or other company-defined administrative center. Examples of
responsibility centers are a sales office, a purchasing department for several locations, and a plant planning office.
Using this functionality, for example, companies can set up user-specific views of sales and purchase documents
related exclusively to a particular responsibility center.
Using multiple locations together with responsibility centers provides the ability to manage business operations in
the most flexible, yet optimal way.
Multiple locations allows companies to manage their inventory in multiple locations using one database. Two
concepts, locations and stockkeeping units, are the cornerstones of this granule. A location is defined as a place
that handles physical placement and quantities of items. The concept is broad enough to include locations such as
plants or production facilities as well as distribution centers, warehouses, showrooms and service vehicles. A
stockkeeping unit is defined as an item at a specific location and/or as a variant. Using stockkeeping units,
companies with multiple locations are able to add replenishment information, addresses, and some financial
posting information at the location level. As a result, they have the ability to replenish variants of the same item for
each location as well as to order items for each location on the basis of location-specific replenishment
information.
Responsibility centers extends the multiple locations functionality by providing users the ability to handle
administrative centers. A responsibility center can be a cost center, a profit center, an investment center, or other
company-defined administrative center. Examples of responsibility centers are a sales office, a purchasing
department for several locations, and a plant planning office. Using this functionality, for example, companies can
set up user-specific views of sales and purchase documents related exclusively to a particular responsibility center.
4. Choose the icon, enter Company Information, and then choose the related link.
5. In the Responsibility Center field, enter a responsibility center code.
This code will be used on all purchase, sales, or service documents, if the user, customer, or vendor has no default
responsibility center. On any sales, purchase, or service document, you can enter another responsibility center than
the default.
NOTE
When you enter a responsibility center code on a document, it affects the address, dimensions, and prices on the document.
To assign responsibility centers to users
You can set up users so that in their daily routines the program retrieves only the documents relevant for their
particular work areas. Users are usually associated with one responsibility center and work only with documents
related to specific application areas at that particular center.
To set this up, you assign responsibility centers to users in three functional areas: Purchases, Sales, and Service
Management.
1. Choose the icon, enter User Setup, and then choose the related link.
2. In the User Setup window, select the user you want to assign a responsibility center to. If the user not is on the
list, you must enter a user ID in the User ID field.
3. In the Sales Resp. Ctr. Filter field, enter the responsibility center where the user will have tasks related to
sales.
4. In the Purchase Resp. Ctr. Filter field, enter the responsibility center where the user will have tasks related to
purchasing.
5. In the Service Resp. Ctr. Filter field, enter the responsibility center where the user will have tasks related to
service management.
NOTE
Users will still be able to view all posted documents and ledger entries, not just those related to their own responsibility
center.
See Also
Setting Up Inventory
Setting Up Warehouse Management InventoryWarehouse Management
Warehouse Management
Design Details: Warehouse Management
Working with Dynamics NAV
Project Management
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
In Dynamics NAV, you can perform common project management tasks, such as configuring a job and
scheduling a resource, as well as providing the information needed to manage budgets and monitor progress.
You can track machine and employee hours on the project by using time sheets. As a project manager, you
have a good overview, not only of individual jobs, but also of the allocation of employees, machinery and other
resources being used in all projects.
Before you can use Dynamics NAV to manage projects, you must set up resources, time sheets, and jobs. For
more information, see Setting Up Project Management.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Create jobs, assign job tasks, and prepare job planning lines. How to: Create Jobs
Allocate resources to jobs and manage resource prices. How to: Use Resources for Jobs
Create a time sheet with integrated job task and planning How to: Use Time Sheets for Jobs
lines and post time sheet lines to a job journal.
Budget for resources to be used in jobs and compare actual How to: Manage Job Budgets
item and resource usage to budgeted usage to improve the
quality and cost efficiency of future projects.
Review and record usage on various parts of your job, How to: Record Usage for Jobs
which is automatically updated as you modify and transfer
information from job planning lines to job journals or job
invoices for posting.
Purchase supplies for a job, either on purchase orders or How to: Manage Job Supplies
invoices, and record item and time usage.
Learn about WIP (Work in Process), a feature that ensures Understanding WIP Methods
correct financial statements and enables you to estimate the
financial value of jobs that are ongoing.
Post the consumption of materials, resources, and other How to: Monitor Job Progress and Performance
expenses of job work in process (WIP) to monitor its
financial value and to maintain correct financial statements
even though you post job expenses before invoicing the
job.
Record job costs for resource usage, materials, and job- How to: Invoice Jobs
related purchases on an on-going basis and invoice the
customer, either when the job is finished or according to an
invoicing schedule.
See Also
Setting Up Project Management
Customizing Dynamics NAV
Purchasing
Sales
Finance
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Create Jobs
4/16/2018 • 3 minutes to read • Edit Online
When you start a new project, you must create a job card with integrated job tasks and job planning lines,
structured in two layers.
The first layer consists of job tasks. You must create at least one job task per job because all posting refers to a job
task. Having at least one job task in your job enables you to set up job planning lines and to post consumption to
the job.
The second layer consists of job planning lines, which specify the detailed use of resources, items and various
general ledger expenses.
The layer structure enables you to divide the job into smaller tasks, and therefore use more specific details in
budgeting, quotes, and registration. In addition, it gives you insight into how a job is progressing. For example,
you can track whether you are meeting designated milestones or if you are on target to meet budget expectations.
NOTE
The New Job action on the Project Manager Role Center launches an assisted setup that guides you through the steps of
creating a job with integrated tasks and planning lines. The following procedure describes how to perform the steps
manually.
1. Choose the icon, enter Jobs, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the New action, and then fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short description of the
field or link to more information.
3. To specify the job with information on other jobs, choose the Copy Job action, fill in the fields as necessary,
and then choose the OK button.
NOTE
If you are using time sheets with your job, you must also designate a person responsible. This person can approve time
sheets for the employee tasks associated with the job. For more information, see How to: Set Up Timesheets.
1. Choose the icon, enter Jobs, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the job card for a relevant job.
3. On the Tasks FastTab, fill in the fields as necessary on a new line.
4. To indent tasks and create a hierarchy, Choose the Tasks action, the then choose Indent Job Tasks action.
5. Repeat steps 3 and 4 for all the tasks that you need for the job.
6. To specify the job tasks with information on other job tasks, choose the Copy Job Tasks from action, fill in the
fields as necessary, and then choose the OK button.
TYPE DESCRIPTION
Budget Provides estimated usage and costs for the job, typically in a
time and materials type project. Planning lines of this type
cannot be invoiced.
Both Budget and Billable Provides budgeted usage equal to what you want to invoice.
Note. As you enter information on job planning lines, cost information is automatically filled in. For example, the
cost, price, and discount for resources and items are initially based on the information that is defined on the
resource and item cards.
1. Choose the icon, enter Jobs, and then choose the related link.
2. Open a relevant job card.
3. Select a job task for which the Job Task Type field contains Posting, and then choose the Job Planning
Lines action.
4. In the Job Planning Lines window, on a new line, fill in the fields as necessary.
5. Repeat steps 3 and 4 for all planning lines that you need for the job task.
See Also
Project Management
Finance
Purchasing
Sales
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Use Resources for Jobs
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
You record the usage of resources in the job journal to keep track of costs, prices, and the work types that are
linked to jobs. For more information, see How to: Record Usage for Jobs.
You can also post the usage of a resource in a resource journal. Entries posted in a resource journal have no effect
on the general ledger.
1. Choose the icon, enter Adjust Resource Costs/Prices, and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the fields on a line as necessary, and then choose the OK button.
NOTE
This batch job does not create or adjust alternate costs or prices for resources. It only changes the contents of the field on
the resource card for the Adjust Field field that you selected in the batch job. The adjustment will take effect immediately for
resources, so check your adjustment factors before you run the batch job.
1. Choose the icon, enter Resource Price Changes, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the Suggest Res. Price Chg. (Price) action, and then fill in the fields as necessary.
3. Choose the OK button.
4. When the batch job is finished, the Resource Price Changes window shows the results of the batch job.
1. Choose the icon, enter Suggest Res. Price Chg. (Price), and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the fields as necessary.
3. Choose the OK button.
4. When the batch job is finished, open the Resource Price Changes window to see the results of the batch job.
See Also
Project Management
Finance
Purchasing
Sales
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Use Time Sheets for Jobs
8/13/2018 • 7 minutes to read • Edit Online
You use the Create Time Sheets batch job to set up time sheets for a specified number of time periods or weeks.
You must have permissions to be able to create time sheets.
You can copy and use your job planning lines in a time sheet. In that way, you must only enter the information in
one place and the line information is always correct.
After you have approved time sheet entries for a job, you can post them to the relevant job journal or resource
journal.
Before you can use time sheets, you must set up general information and specify an administrator and one or
more approvers of time sheets. For more information, see How to: Set Up Time Sheets.
1. Choose the icon, enter Time Sheets, and then choose the related link.
2. In the Time Sheet List window, choose the Create Time Sheets action.
3. Fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short description of the field or link to more information.
NOTE
The Use Time Sheet and Time Sheet Owner User ID fields must be filled in on the card for the resource of the time sheet.
1. Choose the icon, enter Time Sheets, and then choose the related link.
2. In the Time Sheet List window, select a time sheet for the relevant time period, and then choose the Edit
Time Sheet action.
3. Choose the Create lines from job planning action. Any job planning lines in the time sheet time period are
copied to the time sheet for the person or machine in the Resource No. field on the time sheet.
1. Choose the icon, enter Time Sheets, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the relevant time sheet.
3. Choose the Description field.
4. In the Time Sheet Line Job Detail window, choose the Work Type Code field, and select a work type from
the list, such as Miles.
5. If no work types exist, chose the New action.
6. In the Work Types window, fill in the fields as necessary.
7. Repeat step 4 to assign the new work type to the time sheet.
1. Choose the icon, enter Time Sheets, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the time sheet for a period later than the period for an existing time sheet with lines.
3. Choose the Copy Lines from Previous Time Sheet action.
The lines are copied, including details such as type and description. For example, if the line is related to a job, the
Job No. is copied. All copied lines have the status Open. You can now modify the lines as needed.
1. Choose the icon, enter Time Sheets, and then choose the related link.
2. Select a time sheet for the relevant time period, and then choose the Edit Time Sheet action.
3. Fill in the fields on a line as necessary. Enter the number of hours used by the resource on each day of the
week.
TIP
You can review the sum of time sheet hours that you have entered in the Actual/Budgeted Summary FactBox.
4. Repeat step 3 for other work types that the resource performs.
5. Choose the Submit action, and then choose the All open lines action to submit all lines or the Selected
lines only action to submit only the lines that are selected in the Time Sheet window.
NOTE
You can only submit time sheet lines for which you have entered time.
6. To modify information on a line that has been set to Submitted, select the line, and then choose the
Reopen action.
NOTE
A manager may reject a time sheet line that is submitted for approval. If a line has a status of Rejected, you can
make changes to the line, and then choose Submit again.
1. Choose the icon, enter Manager Time Sheets, and then choose the related link.
2. Select a time sheet from the list.
3. In the Time Sheet window, choose the Approve action, and then choose the All submitted lines action to
approve all lines or the Selected lines only action to approve only the lines that are selected in the Time
Sheet window.
4. Choose the OK button.
5. Alternatively, choose the Reject action and follow steps 4 through 5.
TIP
Use the Time Sheet Status and Actual/Budgeted Summary FactBoxes to get an overview of time sheet information.
After you have approved or rejected a time sheet, it cannot be modified unless it is first reopened. The following
procedure explains how to reopen an approved or rejected time sheet.
NOTE
You can only reopen lines that have the status Approved. You cannot reopen lines that have the status Rejected.
You cannot reopen a time sheet if it has been posted.
3. In the Time Sheet window, choose the Reopen action, and then choose the All submitted lines action to
reopen all lines or the Selected lines only action to reopen only the lines that are selected in the Time
Sheet window.
4. Choose the OK button. The status of the time sheets line or lines is changes to Submitted.
1. Choose the icon, enter Resource Journal, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the Suggest Lines from Time Sheets action.
3. Fill in the fields as necessary.
4. Choose the OK button. Entries for usage are created in the resource journal, where you can modify the
information as needed.
5. Choose the Post action.
6. To verify the posting, choose the Ledger Entries action. The Resource Ledger Entries window opens showing
the result of posting the resource journal.
1. Choose the icon, enter Job Journal, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the Suggest Lines from Time Sheets action.
3. Fill in the fields as necessary.
4. Choose the OK button. Entries for usage are created in the job journal, where you can modify the
information as needed.
NOTE
Information about work type and whether the work is chargeable is copied from the time sheet line. If needed, you
can reduce the quantity of hours and do a partial posting. If you reduce the quantity, then the next time that you
choose the Suggest Lines From Time Sheets action, the line that is created will contain the remaining quantity of
hours.
NOTE
When you archive a time sheet, it is removed from the lists in both the Time Sheets window and the Manager Time
Sheets window.
1. Choose the icon, enter Move Time Sheets to Archive, and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the fields as necessary, and then choose the OK button.
3. To review archived time sheets, choose the icon, enter Time Sheet Archives or Manager Time Sheet
Archives, and then choose the related link.
See Also
Project Management
Setting Up Project Management
Finance
Purchasing
Sales
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Manage Job Budgets
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
You can set up a budget for each job. The budget is used to plan the resources that you allocate to a job. The
budget can be either general with few entries or it can contain more entries that are divided into activity levels. You
can then compare the budgeted amounts with the actual usage as recorded in the job journal. By monitoring
differences between actual usage and budgeted usage, you can control an ongoing project and improve the quality
of future jobs by reducing the risk of underestimating costs.
The following procedure describes how to estimate budgeted costs during planning. For information about
recording budgeted versus actual job prices and costs, see How to: Record Usage for Jobs.
1. Choose the icon, enter Jobs, and then choose the related link.
2. Open a relevant job.
3. Select a task line of type Posting, and then choose the Job Planning Lines action.
4. On a new line, fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short description of the field or link to
more information.
For the Line Type field, refer to the following information.
Both Budget and Billable The cost and price amounts entered on the planning line are
the budgeted costs for the particular planning line. The price
amount will be invoiced.
NOTE
The Planning Date field for the planning line contains the date when usage related to the planning line is expected to be
completed. It is also the date when the planning line may be transferred to a sales invoice and posted.
NOTE
When you fill in the Quantity field, all total price and total cost information will be calculated and filled in for that planning
line. You can edit them at any time.
In the Job Card window, you can now see a summary of the total budgeted costs, budgeted price, billable cost and
billable price for each task.
For information about recording budgeted versus actual job prices and costs, see How to: Record Usage for Jobs.
See Also
Project Management
Finance
Purchasing
Sales
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Record Usage for Jobs
4/16/2018 • 4 minutes to read • Edit Online
In the Job Planning Lines window, you can review and record usage on various parts of your job, which is
automatically updated as you modify and transfer information between jobs and job journals or job invoices. This
requires that you have set up a job so that the Apply Usage Link is turned on. For more information, see How
to: Set Up Jobs.
For example, for planning lines of type Budget, you can enter the quantity of a resource, and indicate what
quantity to transfer to the job journal. If the type of the planning line is Billable, you can enter the quantity of the
resource, and indicate what quantity to transfer to an invoice. By comparing the quantity that has been transferred
to the journal or invoice with the remaining quantity, you can quickly review usage information.
The following procedures describe how to record actual (billable) or budgeted job prices and costs. For
information about estimating budgeted values during planning, see How to: Manage Job Budgets.
1. Choose the icon, enter Jobs, and then choose the related link.
2. Select the relevant job, and then choose the Job Planning Lines action.
3. Select a job planning line of type Billable for which you want to record usage.
4. In the Qty. To Transfer to Invoice field, enter the number that you want to transfer. The default quantity is
the value that you enter in the Quantity field.
The Quantity to Invoice field shows the quantity that remains to complete the job and be invoiced.
5. Choose the Create Sales Invoice action.
6. In the Job Transfer to Sales Invoice window, fill in the fields as necessary, and then choose the OK
button.
7. In the Job Planning Lines window, select the relevant line, and then choose the Post action.
8. Review the recorded usage by observing the Quantity, Quantity to Invoice, Qty. To Transfer to
Invoice fields, and, if the sales invoice is posted, the Qty. Invoiced fields.
9. Repeat steps 3 through 8 to record additional usage.
10. To review a related posted sales invoice, choose the Sales Invoices/Credit Memos action.
11. In the Job Invoices window, select the relevant invoice, and then choose the Open Sales Invoice/Credit
Memo action.
1. Choose the icon, enter Jobs, and then choose the related link.
2. Select a relevant open job, and then choose the Job Planning Lines action.
3. In the Job Planning Lines window, on a relevant job planning line, in the Qty. to Transfer to Journal field,
enter the quantity that you want to transfer to a job journal.
4. Choose the Create Job Journal Lines action.
5. In the Job Transfer Job Planning Line window, fill in the fields as necessary.
6. Choose the OK button. Job journal lines are created.
7. To verify the transfer, open the relevant job journal batch and check the entries.
8. When the job journal lines are complete, choose the Post action.
NOTE
This requires that the Apply Usage Link check box has been selected for the job, or is the default setting for all jobs in your
organization. For more information, see How to: Set Up Jobs.
1. Choose the icon, enter Job Journals, and then choose the related link.
2. Select a relevant job journal, and then choose the Ledger Entries action.
3. In the Job Ledger Entries window, choose Show Linked Job Planning Lines action.
See Also
Project Management
Finance
Purchasing
Sales
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Manage Job Supplies
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Managing project supplies of items, services, and expenses is an integral and critical aspect of the execution of all
jobs. You can use inventory quantities or make job-specific purchases using purchase orders or purchase invoices.
For example, a service job on a computer requires a new disk. You create a purchase invoice to buy a new disk and
record the job that it will be used on.
If the purchase process does not require that the physical transaction be recorded separately, then a purchase may
be processed in the Job G/L Journal window. For more information, see How to: Record Usage for Jobs.
1. Choose the icon, enter Purchase Invoices, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the New action and fill in the fields as necessary. For more information, see How to: Record
Purchases.
3. In the Job No. and Job Task No. fields, select the information of the job that you want to purchase items
or services for. If these fields are not visible, you will have to add them. For more information, see
Personalization in the Web Client or Personalization in the Windows Client.
The value that you select in the Job Line Type field defines whether a planning line is created when you
post the usage of the item. If the field contains Billable, then job planning lines that are ready to be
invoiced to the customer are created. For more information, see How to: Invoice Jobs.
4. Choose the Post action.
1. Choose the icon, enter Job G/L Journals, and then choose the related link.
2. Create a new line and enter information about the expense, including information in the Job No. and Job Task
No fields.
3. When the journal is complete, choose the Post action.
See Also
Project Management
Finance
Purchasing
Sales
Working with Dynamics NAV
Understanding WIP Methods
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Dynamics NAV supports the following methods of calculating and recording the value of work in process.
Cost Value Recognized Revenue = Billable Invoiced Cost value calculations start by
Price calculating the value of what has been
provided by taking a proportion of the
Estimated Total Costs = Billable Total estimated total costs based on
Price x Budget Cost Ratio percentage of completion. Invoiced
costs are subtracted by taking a
WIP Costs = (Percentage of Completion proportion of the estimated total costs
- Invoiced %) x Estimated Total Costs based on the invoiced percentage.
Cost of Sales Recognized Revenue = Billable Invoiced Cost of sales calculations begin by
Price calculating the recognized costs. Costs
are recognized proportionally based on
Recognized Costs = Budget Total Cost x budget total costs.
Invoiced Percentage
This calculation requires that the billable
Invoiced % = Billable Invoiced Price / total price and budget total costs be
Billable Total Price correctly entered for the whole job.
Sales Value Recognized Costs = Usage Total Costs Sales value calculations recognize
revenue proportionally based on usage
Recognized Revenue = Usage Total total costs and the expected cost
Price x Expected invoicing ratio recovery ratio.
Cost Recovery % = Billable Total Price / This calculation requires that the billable
Budget Total Price total price and budget total price be
correctly entered for the whole job.
WIP Sales = Recognized Sales - Billable
Invoiced Price
WIP METHOD CALCULATION FORMULA CALCULATION DESCRIPTION
Percentage of Completion Recognized Costs = Usage Total Costs Percentage of completion calculations
recognize revenue proportionally based
Recognized Revenue = Billable Total on the percentage of completion, that
Price x Percentage of Completion is, usage total costs vs. budget costs.
Completed Contract WIP Amount = WIP Cost Amount = Completed contract does not recognize
Usage (Total Cost) revenue and costs until the job is
complete. You may want to do this
WIP Sales Amount = Billable (Invoiced when there is high uncertainty around
Price) the estimates of costs and revenue for
the job.
See Also
Project Management
Finance
Purchasing
Sales
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Monitor Job Progress and Performance
4/16/2018 • 4 minutes to read • Edit Online
As a job progresses, materials, resources, and other expenses are consumed and must be posted to the job. Work
in Process (WIP ) is a feature that enables you to estimate the financial value of jobs in the general ledger while the
jobs are ongoing. In many cases, you might post expenses for a job before invoicing a job. When only expenses
have been posted, your financial statement will be inaccurate. For more information, see Understanding WIP
Methods.
To track the value in the general ledger, you can calculate WIP and post the value to the general ledger.
You can calculate WIP based on the following:
Cost Value
Sales Value
Recognizable Cost
Percentage of Completion
Completed Contract
If you want to view the result using a different method, you can change the method and calculate WIP again.
There is no limit to the number of times that you calculate WIP. WIP is only calculated, it does not get posted to
the general ledger. After you have calculated WIP, you can post to the general ledger.
NOTE
After you have used your new method to create WIP entries, you cannot delete the method or modify it.
1. Choose the icon, enter Job WIP Methods, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the New action, and then fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short description of the
field or link to more information.
3. Close the window.
4. To make this new method the default, choose the icon, enter Jobs Setup, and then choose the related link.
5. In the Default WIP Method field, choose the method from the list.
1. Choose the icon, enter Jobs, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the New action. For more information, see How to: Create Jobs.
3. In the Job Card window, in the WIP Method field, select a WIP method from the list. If a default method has
been defined, you can select another option if needed.
To calculate WIP
You can determine the WIP amount that is to be posted to balance sheet accounts for the period end reporting.
You use the Job Calculate WIP batch job to do this.
1. Choose the icon, enter Job Calculate WIP, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the Calculate WIP action.
3. In the Job Calculate WIP window, fill in the fields as necessary.
4. Choose the OK button.
NOTE
The batch job only calculates the WIP. It is not posted to the general ledger. To do so, you must run the Post WIP to G/L
batch job when you have calculated the WIP. For more information, see the following procedure.
To post WIP
When you have calculated WIP, you can post it to balance sheet accounts for the period end reporting. You use
the Job Post WIP to G/L batch job to do this.
1. Choose the icon, enter Job Post WIP to G/L, and then choose the related link.
2. In the Job Post WIP to G/L window, fill in the fields as necessary.
3. Choose the OK button.
NOTE
Item entries create item ledger entries and reduce the inventory quantity. The Post Inventory Cost to G/L batch job
transfers the cost from inventory to the general ledger. Resource entries create resource ledger entries.
1. Choose the icon, enter Job Journals, and then choose the related link.
2. Select a relevant job journal, and then choose the Calc. Remaining Usage action.
3. In the Job Calc. Remaining Usage window, enter the document number and posting date that is to be
inserted in the journal, and then choose the OK button.
4. Update the journal with any modifications that may be needed.
5. Choose the Post.
See Also
Managing Projects Managing Inventory Costs
Finance
Purchasing
Sales
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Invoice Jobs
4/16/2018 • 3 minutes to read • Edit Online
During the project, job costs from resource usage, materials, and job-related purchases can accumulate. As the job
progresses, these transactions get posted to the job journal. It is important that all costs get recorded in the job
journal before you invoice the customer.
You can invoice the whole job from the Job Task Lines window or only invoice selected billable lines from the
Planning Lines window. Invoicing can be done after the job is finished or at certain intervals during the job's
progress based on an invoicing schedule.
NOTE
If you select Billable in the Job Line Type field on the purchase documents for job-related purchases, then job planning
lines that are ready to be invoiced to the customer are created. For more information, see How to: Manage Project Supplies.
1. Choose the icon, enter Job Create Sales Invoice, and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short description of the field or link to more information.
3. Set filters if you want to limit the jobs that the batch job will process.
4. Choose the OK button to create the invoices.
1. Choose the icon, enter Jobs, and then choose the related link.
2. Open a relevant job.
3. Select a job task for which the Job Task Type field contains Posting, and then choose the Job Planning
Lines action.
4. On a job planning line, in the Qty. To Transfer to Invoice field, enter the quantity of the item, resource,
general ledger account type that you want to invoice.
5. Choose the Create Sales Invoice action.
6. In the Job Create Sales Invoice window, enter the posting date and whether you want to create a new
invoice or append this invoice to an existing one.
7. Choose the OK button.
On the job planning line, in the Qty. Transferred to Invoice field, you can see the quantity.
8. In the Job Planning Lines window, choose the Sales Invoices/Credit Memos action.
The Sales Invoice window opens, showing the quantity that you have transferred to the invoice.
9. Make any additional changes, and then choose the Post action.
NOTE
The above procedure is similar for creating, reviewing, and posting a job-related sales credit memo.
1. Choose the icon, enter Jobs, and then choose the related link.
2. Select an open job, and then choose the Edit action.
3. In the Status field, select Completed.
4. Follow the assistance steps to calculate and post WIP. Alternatively, follows steps 5 and 6 to do so
manually.
5. Choose the Calculate WIP action.
6. In the Job Calculate WIP window, fill in the fields as necessary.
The job WIP entries created by running the batch job will have the Job Complete check box selected to
show that they are completion entries.
7. Choose the Job Post WIP to G/L action.
8. In the Job Post WIP to G/L window, fill in the fields as necessary.
The job WIP general ledger entries created by running the batch job will have the Job Complete check box
selected to show they are completion entries.
See Also
Managing Projects
Finance
Purchasing
Sales
Working with Dynamics NAV
Fixed Assets
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
The Fixed Assets functionality in Dynamics NAV provides an overview of your fixed assets and ensures correct
periodic depreciation. It also enables you to keep track of your maintenance costs, manage insurance policies,
post fixed asset transactions, and generate various reports and statistics.
For each fixed asset, you must set up a card containing information about the asset. You can set up buildings or
production equipment as a main asset with a component list, and you can group them in various ways, such as
by class, department, or location. Then you can begin to acquire, maintain, and sell the fixed assets. You can also
set up budgeted assets. This makes it possible to include any anticipated acquisitions and sales in reports.
To keep track of fixed asset depreciations as well as other financial transactions related to fixed assets, you set
up one or more depreciation books for each fixed asset in your company. Depreciation is done by running a
report to calculate periodic depreciation and fill in a journal with the resulting entries, ready to be posted.
Dynamics NAV supports several depreciation methods. For more information, see Depreciation Methods. You
can set up multiple depreciation books per fixed asset for different purposes, such as one for tax reporting and
another for internal reporting.
For each asset, you can record maintenance costs and the next service date. Keeping track of maintenance
expenses can be important for budgeting purposes and for making decisions about whether to replace a fixed
asset.
Each fixed asset can be attached to one or more insurance policies. You can therefore easily verify that insurance
policy amounts are in accordance with the value of the assets that are linked to the policy. This also makes it
easy to monitor annual insurance premiums.
NOTE
You can record fixed asset transactions in the Fixed Asset G/L Journal window or in the Fixed Asset Journal window,
depending on whether the transactions are for financial reporting or for internal management. Help for Fixed Assets only
describes how to use the Fixed Asset G/L Journal window. For more information, see How to: Set Up Fixed Asset
Depreciation.
Before you can begin to manage fixed assets, you must set up default values, fixed asset accounting, posting
groups, allocation keys, journals, and posting types. For more information, see Setting Up Fixed Assets.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Create fixed assets, assign depreciation methods, post How to: Acquire Fixed Assets
acquisitions, salvage values, and print fixed asset lists.
Record service visits, post maintenance costs, and monitor How to: Maintain Fixed Assets
maintenance costs.
Update insurance information, post acquisition costs to How to: Insure Fixed Assets
insurance policies, modify insurance coverage, view
insurance statistics, and list insurance policies.
TO SEE
Reclassify fixed assets, transfer fixed assets to different How to: Transfer, Split, or Combine Fixed Assets
locations, split up or combine assets.
Adjust values of fixed assets, post appreciation, and post How to: Revalue Fixed Assets
write-down transactions.
Calculate depreciation, post depreciation, and analyze How to: Depreciate or Amortize Fixed Assets
depreciation in fixed assets reports.
Post disposal transactions, view disposal ledger entries, and How to: Dispose of or Retire Fixed Assets
post partial disposals.
Manage fixed asset budgets, budget acquisition costs, How to: Manage Budgets for Fixed Assets
budget disposals of fixed assets, and budget depreciation.
See Also
Setting Up Fixed Assets
Customizing Dynamics NAV
Finance
Welcome to Microsoft Dynamics NAV
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Acquire Fixed Assets
4/16/2018 • 5 minutes to read • Edit Online
For each fixed asset, you must set up a card containing information about the asset. You can set up buildings or
production equipment as a main asset with a component list, and you can group them in various ways, such as by
class, department, or location. A depreciation book must be set up and assigned to each fixed asset before you can
acquire it.
When a fixed asset is set up and a depreciation book assigned, you must acquire the fixed asset. To acquire a fixed
asset, you record its acquisition cost in the relevant G/L account, bank account, or vendor by posting an
acquisition transaction from the Fixed Asset G/L Journal window. You can use the Assisted Fixed Asset
Acquisition window to create and post the required general journal lines automatically.
The salvage value is the residual value of a fixed asset when it can no longer be used. You can post the salvage
value at the same time as you post the acquisition cost. For more information, see How to: Depreciate or Amortize
Fixed Assets.
Indexation is used to adjust values for general price-level changes. The Index Fixed Assets batch job can be used
to calculate the acquisition costs at replacement costs.
1. Choose the icon, enter Fixed Assets, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the New action, and then fill in the fields on the General FastTab as necessary. Choose a field to
read a short description of the field or link to more information.
3. On the Depreciation Book FastTab, fill in the fields as necessary. This step assigns a depreciation book to
the fixed asset.
4. If you need to assign more than one depreciation book to the fixed asset, choose the Add More
Depreciation Books action. For more information, see the "To assign a depreciation book to a fixed asset"
section in How to: Set Up Fixed Asset Depreciation.
When all fields required to acquire a fixed asset are filled in, the You are ready to acquire the fixed
asset. Acquire notification appears at the top of the page.
5. Choose the Acquire action in the notification.
6. Follow the steps in the Assisted Fixed Asset Acquisition window to complete the automatic acquisition
of the fixed asset.
NOTE
You can also post acquisition cost as credits. In that case, remember that the value in the Acquisition Cost Incl. VAT field
must be with a minus sign to indicate a credit.
When you choose Finish, the Book Value field in the Fixed Asset Card window is filled, indicating that the fixed
asset has been acquired at the specified acquisition cost.
1. Choose the icon, enter Fixed Assets, and then choose the related link.
2. Select the fixed asset that is the main asset, and then choose the Main Asset Components action.
3. In the Main Asset Components window, choose the FA No. field, and then select the fixed asset that you
want to add as a component of the main asset.
4. Close the window.
5. Repeat steps 3 and 4 for each component asset that you want to add.
6. Choose the icon, enter Fixed Asset Setup, and then choose the related link.
7. Select the Allow Posting to Main Assets check box.
To post a fixed asset acquisition manually with the fixed asset G/L
journal
The following procedure describes how to acquire a fixed asset manually by creating and posting lines in the
Fixed Asset G/L Journal window. You can also acquire a fixed asset automatically by using the Assisted Fixed
Asset Acquisition window. For more information, see step 5 in the "To create a fixed asset and acquire it
automatically" section.
NOTE
You can also post acquisition cost as credits. In that case, remember that the value in the Amount field must be with a
minus sign to indicate a credit.
1. Choose the icon, enter FA G/L Journals, and then choose the related link.
2. In the Fixed Asset G/L Journal window, in the FA Posting Type field, select Acquisition Cost.
3. Fill in the remaining fields as necessary.
4. Choose the Post action.
TIP
If you fill in the Insurance No. field in the fixed asset G/L journal when you post an acquisition cost, then Dynamics NAV will
also post the acquisition cost of the fixed asset to the insurance coverage ledger. For more information, see How to: Insure
Fixed Assets.
IMPORTANT
You cannot use the Reverse Transactions function for fixed asset entries.
1. Choose the icon, enter Cancel FA Entries, and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short description of the field or link to more information.
3. Choose the OK button to run the batch job.
4. When the incorrect entry or entries are canceled, proceed to post the correct acquisition cost.
To cancel ledger entries for multiple fixed assets at a time, use the Cancel FA Ledger Entries batch job.
1. Choose the icon, enter Cancel FA Entries, and then choose the related link.
2. Create the acquisition journal line. For more information, see the "To post a fixed asset acquisition manually
with the fixed asset G/L journal" section.
3. In the Salvage Value field on the journal line, enter the salvage value amount as a credit (with a minus sign).
4. Choose the Post action.
NOTE
The Salvage Value posting type is an option in the Fixed Asset Journal window only. It is not available in the Fixed Asset
G/L Journal window because salvage value is never posted to the general ledger.
See Also
Fixed Assets
Setting Up Fixed Assets
Finance
Welcome to Microsoft Dynamics NAV
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Maintain Fixed Assets
8/13/2018 • 4 minutes to read • Edit Online
Maintenance expenses are routine periodic costs undertaken to preserve the value of fixed assets. Unlike capital
improvements, they do not increase values.
You can record and maintain an up-to-date file on maintenance and service of your fixed assets to have complete
maintenance records on a fixed asset easily accessible. Each time a fixed asset is sent to service, you record all
relevant information such as date of service, vendor number and service agent's phone number. Maintenance
registration is recorded for each fixed asset from the relevant fixed asset card.
Indexation is used to adjust values for general price-level changes. The Index Fixed Assets batch job can be used
to recalculate the maintenance costs.
1. Choose the icon, enter Fixed Assets, and then choose the related link.
2. Select the fixed asset that you want to record maintenance for, and then choose the Maintenance
Registration action.
3. In the Maintenance Registration window, fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short
description of the field or link to more information.
4. Choose the icon, enter FA G/L Journals, and then choose the related link.
5. Create an initial journal line and fill in the fields as necessary.
6. In the FA Posting Type field, select Maintenance.
7. Choose the Insert FA Bal. Account action. A second journal line is created for the balancing account that is
set up for maintenance posting.
NOTE
Step 7 only works if you have set up the following: In the FA Posting Group Card window for the posting group of
the fixed asset, the Maintenance Account field contains the general ledger debit account and the Maintenance Bal.
Account field contains the general ledger account to which you want to post balancing entries for appreciation. For
more information, see the "To set up fixed asset posting groups" section in How to: Set Up General Fixed Asset
Information.
1. Choose the icon, enter Maintenance Next Service, and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the Starting Date and Ending Date fields.
3. Choose the Print or Preview button.
1. Choose the icon, enter Fixed Assets, and then choose the related link.
2. Select the fixed asset you want to view maintenance costs for, and then choose the Depreciation Books action.
3. In the FA Depreciation Books window, select the relevant fixed asset depreciation book, and then choose the
Statistics action.
4. In the Fixed Asset Statistics window, choose the Maintenance field.
The Maintenance Ledger Entries window opens showing the entries that make up the amount in the
Maintenance field.
1. Choose the icon, enter Maintenance Analysis, and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the fields as necessary.
3. Choose the Print or Preview button.
1. Choose the icon, enter Fixed Assets, and then choose the related link.
2. Select the fixed asset that you want to view ledger entries for, and then choose the Depreciation Books action.
3. In the FA Depreciation Books window, select the relevant fixed asset depreciation book, and then choose the
Maintenance Ledger Entries action.
1. Choose the icon, enter Maintenance Details, and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the fields as necessary.
3. Choose the Print or Preview button.
See Also
Fixed Assets
Setting Up Fixed Assets
Finance
Welcome to Microsoft Dynamics NAV
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Insure Fixed Assets
8/13/2018 • 5 minutes to read • Edit Online
An insurance policy for a fixed asset is represented by an insurance card. You can assign one fixed asset to one
insurance policy or multiple fixed assets to one insurance policy.
You assign a fixed asset to an insurance policy by posting to the insurance coverage ledger from the Insurance
Journal window.
In addition, you can assign a fixed asset to an insurance policy and create coverage ledger entries when you post
its acquisition cost. You do this by posting an acquisition cost from the fixed asset journal with the Insurance No.
field filled in. The Automatic Insurance Posting check box in the Fixed Asset Setup window must be selected.
For more information, see the "To post a fixed asset acquisition manually with the fixed asset G/L journal" section
in How to: Acquire Fixed Assets.
If the Automatic Insurance Posting check box in the Fixed Asset Setup window is not selected, then posting
acquisitions from the fixed asset journal will create lines in the Insurance Journal window, which you must then
post manually.
WARNING
If you do not select the Automatic Insurance Posting check box in the Fixed Asset Setup window, then your insurance
journal should be based on a journal template without a number series. This is because the inserted document numbers
from the fixed asset journal line will otherwise conflict with the number series of the insurance journal. For more information
about journal templates and batches, see How to: Set Up General Fixed Assets Information.
After you have assigned a fixed asset to an insurance policy, the Insured check box is selected on the fixed asset
card. When you sell the fixed asset, the check box is automatically deselected.
1. Choose the icon, enter Insurance, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the New action to create a new card for an insurance policy. Choose a field to read a short description
of the field or link to more information.
3. Alternatively, select the insurance policy that you want to change, and then choose the Edit action.
1. Choose the icon, enter Insurance Journals, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the relevant journal, and fill in the journal lines as necessary.
3. To assign multiple fixed assets to one insurance policy, create journal lines with the same value in the
Insurance No. field and different values in the FA No. field.
4. Choose the Post action.
NOTE
The entries from an insurance journal are only posted to the insurance coverage ledger.
1. Choose the icon, enter Index Insurance, and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the fields as necessary.
NOTE
In the Index Figure field, you enter a decrease of 5%, for example, as 95, whereas you enter an increase of 2% as
102.
4. Choose the icon, enter Insurance Journals, and then choose the related link.
5. Open the relevant insurance journal, review the created values, and then post them to the insurance
coverage ledger.
1. Choose the icon, enter Insurance, and then choose the related link.
2. Select the relevant insurance policy, and then choose the Coverage Ledger Entries action.
1. Choose the icon, enter Insurance, and then choose the related link.
2. Select the relevant insurance policy, and then choose the Total Value Insures per FA action.
3. Fill in the fields as necessary.
4. Choose the Show Matrix action.
5. To see the underlying insurance coverage ledger entries, choose a value in the matrix.
1. Choose the icon, enter Insurance Journals, and then choose the related link.
2. Create one journal line for the fixed asset and the correct insurance policy where the value in the Amount field
is positive.
3. Create another journal line for the fixed asset and the incorrect insurance policy where the value in the
Amount field is negative.
4. Choose the Post action.
The fixed asset will be detached from the incorrect insurance policy, on the second line, and attached to the correct
insurance policy, on the first line.
See Also
Fixed Assets
Setting Up Fixed Assets
Finance
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Transfer, Split, or Combine Fixed Assets
4/16/2018 • 4 minutes to read • Edit Online
You use the fixed asset reclassification journal to transfer, split up, and combine fixed assets. You view or print the
results of fixed asset reclassification with the Fixed Asset-Book Value 02 report.
3. Choose the icon, enter FA Reclass. Journals, and then choose the related link.
4. Create a reclassification journal where the FA No. field contains the original fixed asset, and the New FA
No. field contains the new fixed asset to be moved.
5. Choose the Reclassify action.
Two lines are now created in the fixed asset G/L journal using the template and batch that you have
specified in the FA Journal Setup window for the specified depreciation book. For more information, see
How to: Set Up Fixed Asset Depreciation.
6. Choose the icon, enter FA G/L Journals, and then choose the related link.
7. In the Fixed Asset G/L Journal window, choose the Post action to post the reclassification that you
performed in steps 4 and 5.
If you have posted an acquisition cost for one asset, you can use the fixed asset reclassification journal to split the
acquisition cost among several assets.
3. Choose the icon, enter FA Reclass. Journals, and then choose the related link.
4. Create two reclassification journal lines, one for each new fixed asset.
5. On the first line, enter the second fixed asset in the New FA No. field and 25 in the Reclassify Acq. Cost %
field.
6. On the second line, enter the third fixed asset in the New FA No. field and 40 in the Reclassify Acq. Cost
% field.
7. On both lines, select the Reclassify Acquisition Cost and Reclassify Depreciation check boxes.
8. Choose the Reclassify action.
Two lines are now created in the fixed asset G/L journal using the template and batch that you have
specified in the FA Journal Setup window for the specified depreciation book. For more information, see
How to: Set Up Fixed Asset Depreciation.
9. Choose the icon, enter FA G/L Journals, and then choose the related link.
10. In the Fixed Asset G/L Journal window, choose the Post action to post the reclassification that you
performed in steps 4 through 8.
1. Choose the icon, enter FA Reclass. Journals, and then choose the related link.
2. Create a reclassification journal where the FA No. field contains the fixed asset to be moved/combined, and
the New FA No. field contains the fixed asset that it will be combined with.
3. Leave the Reclassify Acq. Cost % field empty to move/combine the entire acquisition cost.
4. Select the Reclassify Acquisition Cost and Reclassify Depreciation check boxes.
5. On the Actions tab, choose Reclassify.
Two lines are now created in the fixed asset G/L journal using the template and batch that you have
specified in the FA Journal Setup window for the specified depreciation book. For more information, see
How to: Set Up Fixed Asset Depreciation.
6. Choose the icon, enter FA G/L Journals, and then choose the related link.
7. In the Fixed Asset G/L Journal window, choose the Post action to post the reclassification that you
performed in steps 2 through 5.
See Also
Fixed Assets
Setting Up Fixed Assets
Finance
Welcome to Microsoft Dynamics NAV
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Revalue Fixed Assets
8/13/2018 • 6 minutes to read • Edit Online
Revaluation of fixed assets can consist of appreciations, write-downs, or general value adjustments.
When the value of a fixed asset has increased, you post a journal line with a higher amount, an appreciation, to the
depreciation book. The new amount is recorded as an appreciation according to the fixed asset posting setup.
When the value of a fixed asset has decreased, you post a journal line with a lower amount, a write-down, to the
depreciation book. The new amount is recorded as a write-down according to the fixed asset posting setup.
Indexation is used to adjust multiple fixed asset values, for example per general price changes. The Index Fixed
Assets batch job can be used to change various amounts, such as write-down and appreciation amounts.
NOTE
Step 4 only works if you have set up the following: In the FA Posting Group Card window for the posting group of
the fixed asset, the Appreciation Account field contains the general ledger debit account and the Appreciation
Bal. Account field contains the general ledger account to which you want to post balancing entries for appreciation.
For more information, see the "To set up fixed asset posting groups" section in How to: Set Up General Fixed Asset
Information.
1. Choose the icon, enter Index Fixed Assets, and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the fields as necessary.
3. Choose the OK button.
Revaluation lines are created per your settings in step 2. The lines are created in either the fixed asset
journal or the fixed asset G/L journal, depending on your template and batch setup in the FA Journal
Setup window. For more information, see How to: Set Up General Fixed Asset Information.
4. Choose the icon, enter FA G/L Journals, and then choose the related link.
5. Select the journal with the fixed assets that you want to revalue, and then choose the Ledger Entries action.
6. Check the created entries, and then choose the Post action to post the journal.
TIP
If the index figures are for simulation purposes only, you can create a special depreciation book to store them in.
Then these entries will not affect any of the other depreciation books.
See Also
Fixed Assets
Setting Up Fixed Assets
Finance
Welcome to Microsoft Dynamics NAV
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Depreciate or Amortize Fixed Assets
8/13/2018 • 4 minutes to read • Edit Online
Depreciation is used to allocate the cost of fixed assets, such as machinery and equipment, over their depreciable
life. For each fixed asset, you must define how it will be depreciated.
There are two ways to post depreciation:
Automatically, by running the Calculate Depreciation batch job.
Manually, by using the fixed asset G/L journal.
Dynamics NAV can calculate daily depreciation, which allows you to calculate depreciation for any period. You can
therefore analyze current operating results on, for example, a monthly, quarterly, or annual basis. The calculation
uses a standard year of 360 days and a standard month of 30 days. For more information, see Depreciation
Methods.
If several departments use a fixed asset, periodic depreciation can be automatically allocated to these departments
according to a user-defined allocation table.
You can cancel incorrect depreciation entries by using the Cancel FA Ledger Entries batch job. Afterward, you
can post the correct amount by running the Calculate Depreciation batch job again. The errors you correct are
posted as fixed asset error ledger entries.
Indexation is used to adjust values for general price-level changes. You can use the Index Fixed Assets batch job
to recalculate the depreciation amounts.
1. Choose the icon, enter Calculate Depreciation, and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short description of the field or link to more
information.
3. Choose the OK button.
The batch job calculates the depreciation and creates lines in the fixed asset G/L journal.
4. Choose the icon, enter FA G/L Journals, and then choose the related link.
In the Fixed Asset G/L Journal window, in the No. of Depreciation Days field you can see how many
days of depreciation have been calculated.
5. Choose the Post action.
1. Choose the icon, enter Fixed Asset G/L Journal, and then choose the related link.
2. Create an initial line and fill in the fields as necessary.
3. In the FA Posting Type field, select Allocation.
4. Choose the Insert FA Bal. Account action. A second journal line is created for the balancing account that is set
up for allocation posting.
5. On the Home tab, choose Post to post the journal.
1. Choose the icon, enter Depreciation Books, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the depreciation book, and then select the Part of Duplication List check box.
IMPORTANT
If you have selected the Use Duplication List field, do not use number series on the journal. The reason is that the number
series for the fixed asset G/L journal does not the number series for the fixed asset journal.
5. Choose the icon, enter FA Journals, and then choose the related link.
NOTE
The Fixed Asset Journal window contains new lines for different depreciation books according to the duplication list.
6. Review or edit the lines, and then choose the Post action.
NOTE
Another way to duplicate an entry in a separate book is to enter a depreciation book code in the Duplicate in
Depreciation Book field when you fill in a journal line.
You can copy entries from one depreciation book to another by using the Copy Depreciation Book batch job.
The batch job creates journal lines in the journal batch that you have specified in the FA Journal Setup window
for the depreciation book that you want to copy to. For more information, see the following procedure.
See Also
Fixed Assets
Setting Up Fixed Assets
Finance
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Dispose of or Retire Fixed Assets
8/13/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
When you sell or otherwise dispose of a fixed asset, the disposal value must be posted to calculate and record the
gain or loss. A disposal entry must be the last entry posted for a fixed asset. For partially disposed fixed assets, you
can post more than one disposal entry. The total of all posted disposal amounts must be a credit amount.
NOTE
If you trade-in a fixed asset for another one, you must record both the sale of the old asset (disposal) and the purchase of
the new one (acquisition). For more information, see How to: Acquire Fixed Assets.
NOTE
Step 4 only works if you have set up the following: In the FA Posting Group Card window for the posting group of
the fixed asset, the Disposal Account field contains the general ledger debit account and the Disposal Bal. Account
field contains the general ledger account to which you want to post balancing entries for appreciation. For more
information, see the "To set up fixed asset posting groups" section in How to: Set Up General Fixed Asset Information.
1. Choose the icon, enter Fixed Assets, and then choose the related link.
2. Select the fixed asset that you want to view entries for, and then choose the Depreciation Books action.
3. Select the depreciation book that you want to view entries for, and then choose the Ledger Entries action.
4. Select a line with Disposal in the FA Posting Category field, and then choose the Navigate action.
5. In the Navigate window, select the general ledger entry line, and then choose the Show action.
The General Ledger Entries window opens where you can see the entries that the disposal posting resulted in.
See Also
Fixed Assets
Setting Up Fixed Assets
Finance
Welcome to Microsoft Dynamics NAV
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Manage Budgets for Fixed Assets
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
You can set up budgeted fixed assets. For example, this lets you include anticipated acquisitions and sales in
reports.
To prepare your budgeted income statement, budgeted balance sheet, and cash budget, you need information
about future investments, disposals and depreciation of fixed assets. You can get this information from the Fixed
Asset - Projected Value report. Before you print this report, you must prepare the budget.
1. Choose the icon, enter Fixed Assets, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the New action to create a new fixed asset card for the budgeted fixed asset.
3. Select the Budgeted Asset check box to prevent posting to the general ledger.
4. Fill in the remaining fields, assign a depreciation book, and then post the first acquisition cost with the budgeted
fixed asset entered in the Budgeted FA No. field on the journal line. For more information, see How to:
Acquire Fixed Assets.
1. Choose the icon, enter Fixed Assets, and then choose the related link.
2. Select the fixed asset to be disposed of, and then choose the Depreciation Books action.
3. In the FA Depreciation Books window, fill in the Projected Disposal Date and Projected Proceeds on
Disposal fields. Choose a field to read a short description of the field or link to more information.
1. Choose the icon, enter FA Projected Value, and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the fields as necessary.
3. Choose the Print or Preview button.
To budget depreciation
You can use the Fixed Asset - Projected Value report to calculate future depreciation. The report shows the book
value and accumulated depreciation at the start of the selected period, changes during the period, and the book
value and accumulated depreciation at the end of the selected period.
1. Choose the icon, enter FA Projected Value, and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the fields as necessary.
3. To see total values for all assets, clear the Print per Fixed Asset check box.
4. Leave the Fixed Asset FastTab blank to have all assets included. In the Budgeted Asset field, enter No to
exclude budgeted assets or Yes to see budgeted assets only.
5. Choose the Print or Preview button.
See Also
Fixed Assets
Setting Up Fixed Assets
Finance
Welcome to Microsoft Dynamics NAV
Working with Dynamics NAV
Managing Relationships
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
The relationship management features of Dynamics NAV help you manage and support your sales efforts. With
these features, you have access to complete and accurate information so you can focus your interactions on
preferred customer/contact segments.
Good sales and marketing practices are all about how to make the best decisions at the right time. Dynamics NAV
provides a precise and timely overview of your contact information so that you can serve your prospective
customers more efficiently and increase customer satisfaction.
To get started, see the following topics:
Managing Contacts
Managing Segments
Recording Interactions
Managing Marketing Campaigns
Managing Sales Opportunities
See Also
Sales
Setting Up Relationship Management
Managing Customers and Sales Created in Dynamics 365 for Sales
Working with Dynamics NAV
Setting Up Relationship Management
4/16/2018 • 4 minutes to read • Edit Online
Before you get started working with your contacts and marketing interests, there are a few decisions and steps that
you should take to set up how the marketing area manages certain aspects of your contacts. For example, you can
decide whether to synchronize the contact card with the customer card, vendor card, and bank account card, how
number series are defined, or what the standard salutation should be when writing to your contacts.
Managing your contacts and having a strategy in place to identify, attract, and retain customers will help optimize
your business and increase customer satisfaction. Using a good contact management system will also help you
create and maintain relationships with your customers. Communication is the key to these relationships. Being
able to tailor communication with potential and existing customers, vendors, and business partners according to
their needs, is necessary for companies to succeed. Establishing a strategy and defining how your company uses
contact information is a primary step. This information will be viewed by many different groups in your company,
so having a good system in place will help everyone be more productive.
You set up the marketing and contact management from the Marketing Setup window. To open the Marketing
Setup window, choose the icon, enter Marketing Setup, and then choose the related link.
See Also
Managing Contacts
Working with Dynamics NAV
Creating and Managing Contacts
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Different groups at your company will have business relationships with various companies. For example, a
salesperson might regularly meet prospective customers and at the end of the week record the results of these
visits.
All of the external entities that you have business relationships with (for example, customers, prospective
customers, vendors, lawyers, and consultants) should be recorded as contacts. Having this data recorded in one
central location ensures every group in your company can view and use the information efficiently.
Communication with your contacts will be more successful if all details are readily available. For example, a
marketing person might like to know what other products a specific customer has purchased before attempting to
interest them in a new product.
You can record information based on a company or a person at that company. You can also create an independent
contact person for people who do not work for a particular company, but who work independently or freelance.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Create a contact card for each new company that you interact Creating Contact Companies
with, such as a customer or vendor.
Create a contact card for each contact person who works for Creating Contact Persons
the companies that you interact with.
See Also
Managing Sales Opportunities
Setting Up Relationship Management
Working with Dynamics NAV
Managing Segments
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
You create segments to select a group of contacts according to specific criteria. For example, a segment could be
the industry that the contacts belong to or your business relationship with the contacts. You can create a segment
to select the contacts you want to target with a campaign.
There are two main tasks in creating a segment:
Enter general information about the segment. Before you can select the contacts within the segment, you must
first create the segment.
Select the contacts to be included within the segment.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Create segments which allow you to select a group of How to: Create Segments
contacts. For example, direct mail.
Manage the contacts that are assigned to segments. How to: Add Contacts to Segments
Learn about using interactions and segments, including Managing Interaction and Segments
logging.
See Also
Managing Sales Opportunities
Managing Contacts
Working with Dynamics NAV
Managing Interactions With Contacts
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
In Microsoft Dynamics NAV, interactions are all types of communications between your company and your
contacts. For example, communications can be by letter, fax, email, telephone, meetings, and so on.
The relationship management area enables you to record all the interactions you have with your contacts in order
to keep track of the sales and marketing efforts you have directed at your contacts and to improve your future
business interactions with them. Setting up your application to record interactions consists of these tasks:
Setting up interaction templates
Creating interactions on contacts or segments
View and manage recorded interactions
Creating Interactions
There are two ways of recording interactions:
You can manually create interactions that are linked to a single contact or to a segment. For more information,
see How to: Create Interactions on Contacts and Segments.
You can automatically record interactions when you perform actions in the application, for example, when you
print an invoice, or quote. For more information, see Automatically Record Interactions with Contacts.
You can delete interaction log entries that have been canceled. To delete interaction log entries, choose the icon,
enter Delete Canceled Interaction Log Entries, and then choose the related link, and then fill in the information.
See Also
Managing Contacts
Managing Sales Opportunities
Working with Dynamics NAV
Managing Sales Opportunities
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Any incoming lead can be considered a sales opportunity. You can create opportunities and associate them to a
salesperson so that you can keep track of potential sales.
Before you can start using opportunity management, you must set up sales cycles and sales cycle stages. As you
create opportunities, you should provide information about the contact, salesperson, sales cycle, and dates, as well
as your estimates for the sales value of the opportunity and your estimation of the chances of its success.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Set up the sales cycles that you usually follow, and the How to: Set Up Opportunity Sales Cycles and Cycle Stages
different stages within each opportunity sales cycle.
Create sales opportunities that you have from your contacts. How to: Create Opportunities
Move a sales opportunity through the sales cycle to Processing Sales Opportunities
completion.
See Also
Sales
Creating and Managing Contacts
Working with Dynamics NAV
Managing Customers and Sales Created in Dynamics
365 for Sales
4/16/2018 • 6 minutes to read • Edit Online
If you use Dynamics 365 for Sales for customer engagement, you can use Dynamics NAV for order processing and
finances and have seamless integration in the lead-to-cash process.
When your application is set up to integrate with Dynamics 365 for Sales, you have access to Sales data from
Dynamics NAV and the other way around in some cases. This integration enables you to work with and
synchronize data types that are common to both services, such as customers, contacts, and sales information, and
keep the data up to date in both locations.
For example, the sales person in Dynamics 365 for Sales can use the price lists from Dynamics NAV when they
create a sales order. When they add the item to the sales order line in Dynamics 365 for Sales, they are also able to
see the inventory level (availability) of the item from Dynamics NAV.
Conversely, order processors in Dynamics NAV can handle the special characteristics of sales orders transferred
automatically or manually from Dynamics 365 for Sales, such as automatically create and post valid sales order
lines for items or resources that were entered in Sales as write-in products. For more information, see the
"Handling Special Sales Order Data" section.
NOTE
Before you can integrate with Dynamics 365 for Sales, you must make various technical preparations. For more information,
see Setting Up Dynamics 365 for Sales Integration in the Developer and IT-pro help.
NOTE
The following explains the assisted setup, but you can perform the same tasks manually in the Dynamics 365 for Sales
Connection Setup window.
In the assisted setup guide, you can choose which data to synchronize between the two services. You can also
specify that you want to import your existing Dynamics 365 for Sales solution. In that case, you must specify an
administrative user account.
Setting Up the User Account for Importing the Solution
To import an existing Dynamics 365 for Sales solution, the setup guide uses an administrative account. This
account must be a valid user in Dynamics 365 for Sales with the following security roles:
System Administrator
Solution Customizer
For more information, see Create users and assign Microsoft Dynamics NAV (online) security roles on techNet and
How to: Manage Users and Permissions.
This account is only used during the setup. Once the solution is imported into Dynamics NAV, the account is no
longer needed.
Setting Up the User Account for Synchronization
The integration relies on a shared user account. So in your Office 365 subscription, you must create a dedicated
user that will be used for synchronization between the two services. This account must already be a valid user in
Dynamics 365 for Sales, but you do not have to assign security roles to the account because the setup guide will
do that for you. You must specify this user account one or more times in the setup guide, depending how much
synchronization you want to enable. For more information, see Create users and assign Microsoft Dynamics NAV
(online) security roles on techNet.
If you choose to enable item availability, the integration user account must have a web services access key. This is
a two-step thing in the Dynamics NAV page for that user account, you must choose the Change Web Service
Key button; and in the Dynamics 365 Connection Setup guide, you must specify that user as the OData web
service user.
If you choose to enable sales order integration, you must specify a user that can handle this synchronization - the
integration user or another user account.
Coupling Records
In the assisted setup guide, you can choose to synchronize between the two services. But later, you can also set up
synchronization of specific types of data. This is referred to as coupling, and this section provides
recommendations for what you must take into consideration.
For example, if you want to see Dynamics 365 for Sales accounts as customers in Dynamics NAV, you must couple
the two types of records. It is not very complicated - you open the Customer List window in Dynamics NAV, and
there is an action in the ribbon to couple this data with Dynamics 365 for Sales. Then you specify which Dynamics
NAV customers match which accounts in Dynamics 365 for Sales.
In certain areas, the functionality relies on you couple certain sets of data before other sets of data as shown in the
following list:
Customers and accounts
Couple salespeople with Dynamics 365 for Sales users first
Items and resources
Couple units of measure with Dynamics 365 for Sales unit groups first
Items and resource prices
Couple customer price groups with Dynamics 365 for Sales prices first
NOTE
If you are using prices in foreign currencies, make sure that you couple currencies to Dynamics 365 for Sales transaction
currencies.
Dynamics 365 for Sales sales orders depends on additional information like customers, units of measure,
currencies, customer price groups, items and/or resources. In order for Dynamics 365 for Sales sales orders to
work seamlessly, you must couple customers, units of measure, currencies, customer price groups, items and/or
resources first.
Synchronizing Records Fully
At the end of the assisted setup guide, you can choose the Run Full Synchronization action to start
synchronizing all Dynamics NAV records with all related records in the connected Dynamics 365 for Sales solution.
In the CRM Full Synch. Review window, you choose the Start action. The synchronization then begins to execute
jobs according to dependencies. For example, currency records are synchronized before customer records. The full
synchronization may take a long time and will therefore run in the background so that you can continue to work in
Dynamics NAV.
To check the progress of individual jobs in a full synchronization, drill down on the Job Queue Entry Status, To
Int. Table Job Status, or From Int. Table Job Status field in the CRM Full Synch. Review window.
From the Dynamics 365 Connection Setup window, you can get details about full synchronization at any time.
From here, you can also open the Integration Table Mappings window to see details about the tables in
Dynamics NAV and in the Dynamics 365 for Sales solution that must be synchronized.
See Also
Relationship Management
Working with Dynamics NAV
Customizing Dynamics NAV
How to: Manage Users and Permissions
Manage Human Resources
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
In Dynamics NAV, you can keep detailed records of your employees. You can register and maintain employee
information, such as employment contracts, confidential information, qualifications, and employee contacts.
You can also register employee absences, which allows you to analyze registered absences as necessary.
To start using the Human Resources functionality, you must set up employees and other basic information. You can
then associate various codes to an employee, which allows you to filter information for specific employees.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Register new employees or edit records for existing How to: Register Employees
employees, and attach related information, such as contracts
and articles.
Record employees' absence and view absence statistics by How to: Manage Employee Absence
various filters.
See Also
Finance
Working with Dynamics NAV
Customizing Dynamics NAV
How to: Register Employees
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
To use the Human Resources functionality, you must first register each employee by creating a card with all the
core and related information.
You can modify an employee's details at any time. Keeping up-to-date records about your employees simplifies
personnel tasks. For example, if an employee's address changes, you register this on the employee card.
The following procedures describe how to create an initial employee card and how to assign two types of
employee details to an employee. In addition, you can assign various other related information, such as
qualifications and causes of inactivity. You assign employee information either by choosing a field or an action in
the Employee Card window.
NOTE
You can reimburse employees for their expenses during business activities. For this purpose, you must fill in the fields on the
Payments FastTab in the Employee Card window. For more information, see How to: Record and Reimburse Employees'
Expenses.
To set up an employee
1. Choose the icon, enter Employees, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the New action.
3. In the Employee Card window, fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short description of the
field or link to more information.
1. Choose the icon, enter Employees, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the card for the relevant employee.
3. In the Employee Picture FactBox, choose the drop-down button, and then choose Import.
4. In the Select a picture to upload window, choose the Choose button.
5. Select the file, and then choose Open.
The picture is inserted in the Employee Picture FactBox.
1. Choose the icon, enter Employees, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the card for the relevant employee.
3. Choose the Alternate Addresses action.
4. In the Alternate Address List window, fill in the fields as necessary.
5. Repeat step 4 for each alternate address.
See Also
How to: Record and Reimburse Employees' Expenses
Finance
Working with Dynamics NAV
Customizing Dynamics NAV
How to: Manage Employee Absence
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
To manage an employee's absence, you must record the absence in the Absence Registration window. It can then
be viewed in different ways for analysis and reporting needs.
You can view employee absence in two different windows:
The Absence Registration window, where you register all employee absences with a line for each absence.
The Employee Absences window, where the absences for one employee only is shown. This is the information
that you entered in the Absence Registration window, filtered by the particular employee.
To obtain meaningful statistics, you should always use the same unit of measure (hour or day) when registering
employee absences.
TIP
To obtain meaningful statistics, always use the same unit of measure, hour or day, when registering employee
absences.
See Also
Manage Human Resources
Finance
Working With Dynamics NAV
Customizing Dynamics NAV
Planning
8/13/2018 • 3 minutes to read • Edit Online
The production operations required to transform inputs into finished goods must be planned daily or weekly
depending on the volume and nature of the products. Dynamics NAV offers features to supply for anticipated
and actual demand from sale, assembly, and production as well as features for distribution planning using
stockkeeping units and location transfers.
NOTE
This topic mainly describes planning for companies involved in manufacturing or assembly management where the
resulting supply orders can be either production, assembly, transfer, or purchase orders. The main interface for this
planning work is the Planning Worksheet window.
Dynamics NAV also supports supply planning for wholesale companies where the resulting supply orders can only be
transfer and purchase orders. The main interface for this planning work is the Requisition Worksheet window, which
is described indirectly in this topic as most planning functionality applies to both worksheets.
Before you can plan and execute production orders, you must configure production capacities, such as
creating shop calendars, routings, production BOMs, and machine centers. For more information, see Setting
Up Manufacturing.
Planning can be seen as the preparation required supply orders in the assembly or manufacturing
departments to fulfill demand. For more information, see Assembly Management and Manufacturing.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Get a brief introduction to how the planning system can be About Planning Functionality
used to detect and prioritize demand and suggest a
balanced supply plan.
Understand how all aspects of the planning system works Design Details: Supply Planning
and how to adjust the algorithms to meet planning
requirements in different environments.
Learn how the planning logic differentiates between Planning With or Without Locations
demand at locations according to the SKU setup and
demand without location codes.
Forecast production demand presented by expected sales How to: Create a Production Forecast
and production orders.
Create one-to-one production orders automatically from a How to: Create Production Orders from Sales Orders
sales order to cover the exact demand of that sales order
line.
Create a project production order directly from a multiline How to: Plan Project Orders
sales order representing a production project.
TO SEE
Use the Order Planning window to manually plan for How to: Plan for New Demand Order by Order
sales or production demand one production BOM level at a
time.
Use the Planning Worksheet window to run both the How to: Run Full Planning, MPS or MRP
MPS and MRP options to automatically create either a
high-level or detailed supply plan at all item levels.
Initiate or update a production order as rough-scheduled How to: Replan or Refresh Production Orders Directly
operations in the master production schedule.
Recalculate work or machine center calendars due to "To calculate a work center calendar" section in How to: Set
planning changes. Up Shop Calendars
Track the order demand (tracked quantity), forecast, How to: Track Relations Between Demand and Supply
blanket sales order, or planning parameter (untracked
quantity) that has given rise to the planning line in
question.
View an item's projected available inventory by different How to: View the Availability of Items
views and see which gross requirements, planned order
receipts, and other events influence it over time.
Perform selected planning activities, such as changing or How to: Modify Planning Suggestions in a Graphical View
adding planning worksheet lines, in a graphical view of the
supply plan.
See Also
Setting Up Manufacturing
Manufacturing
Inventory
Purchasing
Design Details: Supply Planning
Setup Best Practices: Supply Planning
Working with Dynamics NAV
About Planning Functionality
4/16/2018 • 5 minutes to read • Edit Online
The planning system takes all demand and supply data into account, nets the results, and creates suggestions for
balancing the supply to meet the demand.
For detailed information, see Design Details: Supply Planning.
NOTE
For all the fields that are mentioned in this topic, read the tooltip to understand their function. Choose a field to read a short
description of the field or link to more information.
Planning Calculation
The planning system is driven by anticipated and actual customer demand, as well as inventory reordering
parameters. Running the planning calculation will result in the program suggesting specific actions (Action
Messages) to take concerning possible replenishment from vendors, transfers between warehouses, or production.
If replenishment orders already exist, the suggested actions could be to increase or expedite the orders to meet the
changes in demand.
The basis of the planning routine is in the gross-to-net calculation. Net requirements drive planned order releases,
which are scheduled based on the routing information (manufactured items) or the item card lead time (purchased
items). Planned order release quantities are based on the planning calculation, and are affected by the parameters
set on the individual item cards.
Planning Parameters
The planning parameters control when, how much, and how to replenish based on the various settings on the item
card (or stockkeeping unit - SKU ), and the manufacturing setup.
The following planning parameters exist on the item or SKU card:
Dampener Period
Dampener Quantity
Reordering Policy
Reorder Point
Maximum Inventory
Overflow Level
Time Bucket
Lot Accumulation Period
Rescheduling Period
Reorder Quantity
Safety Lead Time
Safety Stock Quantity
Assembly Policy
Manufacturing Policy
The following order modifiers exist on the item or SKU card:
Minimum Order Quantity
Maximum Order Quantity
Order Multiple
Global planning setup fields on the Manufacturing Setup window include:
Dynamic Low -Level Code
Current Production Forecast
Use Forecast on Locations
Default Safety Lead Time
Blank Overflow Level
Combined MPS/MRP Calculation
Components at Location
Default Dampener Period
Default Dampener Quantity
For more information, see Design Details: Planning Parameters
NOTE
Supply on planning lines with Exception warnings is normally not modified according to planning parameters. Instead, the
planning system only suggests a supply to cover the exact demand quantity. However, you can set the planning run up to
respect certain planning parameters for planning lines with certain warnings. For more information, see “Respect Planning
Parameters for Exception Warnings” in Calculate Plan - Plan. Wksh.
Attention
The attention warning is displayed in two situations:
The planning starting date is earlier than the work date.
The planning line suggests to change a released purchase or production order.
NOTE
In planning lines with warnings, the Accept Action Message field is not selected, because the planner is expected to further
investigate these lines before carrying out the plan.
See Also
Design Details: Supply Planning
Planning
Setting Up Manufacturing
Manufacturing
Inventory
Purchasing
Setup Best Practices: Supply Planning
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Subcontract Manufacturing
4/16/2018 • 6 minutes to read • Edit Online
Subcontracting selected operations to vendor is common in many manufacturing companies. Subcontracting can
be a rare occurrence or can be an integral part of all production processes.
The program provides several tools for managing subcontract work:
Work Centers with assigned vendor: This feature enables you to set up a work center that is associated with a
vendor (subcontractor). This is called a subcontract work center. You can specify a subcontract work center on a
routing operation, which allows you to easily process the subcontracted activity. In addition, the cost of the
operation can be designated at the routing or the work center level.
Work Center cost based on units or time: This feature enables you to specify whether costs associated with the
work center are based on the production time or a flat charge per unit. Although subcontractors commonly use
a flat charge per unit to charge for their services, the program can handle both options (production time and flat
charge per unit).
Subcontracting Worksheet: This feature allows you to find the production orders with material ready to send to
a subcontractor and to automatically create purchase orders for subcontract operations from production order
routings. Then the program automatically posts the purchase order charges to the production order during the
posting of the purchase order. Only production orders with a status of released can be accessed and used from a
subcontracting worksheet.
Subcontracting Worksheet
Once you have calculated the subcontracting worksheet, the relevant document, in this case a purchase order, is
created.
NOTE
Only production orders with status Released can be accessed and used from a subcontracting worksheet.
Posting output automatically for an ongoing production order when subcontracted items are received may not be
desired. Reasons for this could be that the expected output quantity that is posted may be different from the actual
quantity and that the posting date of the automatic output is misleading.
To avoid that the expected output of a production order is posted when subcontract purchases are received, make
sure the subcontracted operation is not the last one. Alternatively, insert a new last operation for the final output
quantity.
Posting output automatically for an ongoing production order when subcontracted items are received may not be
desired. Reasons for this could be that the expected output quantity that is posted may be different from the actual
quantity and that the posting date of the automatic output is misleading.
To avoid that the expected output of a production order is posted when subcontract purchases are received, make
sure the subcontracted operation is not the last one. Alternatively, insert a new last operation for the final output
quantity.
When the purchase order is posted as invoiced, then the direct cost of the purchase order is posted to the
production.
See Also
Manufacturing
Setting Up Manufacturing
Planning
Inventory
Purchasing
Working with Dynamics NAV
Planning With or Without Locations
4/16/2018 • 4 minutes to read • Edit Online
Concerning planning with or without location codes on demand lines, the planning system operates in a straight
forward way when:
demand lines always carry location codes and the system fully uses stockkeeping units, including the relevant
location setup.
demand lines never carry location codes and the system does not use SKUs or any location setup (see last
scenario below ).
However, if demand lines sometimes have location codes and other times do not, the planning system will follow
certain rules depending on setup.
Demand at Location
When the planning system detects demand at a location (a line with a location code), it will behave in different
ways depending on 3 critical setup values.
During a planning run, the system checks for the 3 setup values in sequence and plans accordingly:
1. Is there a check mark in the Location Mandatory field?
If yes, then:
2. Does SKU exist for the item?
If yes, then:
The item is planned according to planning parameters on the SKU card.
If no, then:
3. Does the Components at Location field contain the demanded location code?
If yes, then:
The item is planned according to planning parameters on the item card.
If no, then:
The item is planned according to: Reordering Policy = Lot-for-Lot, Include Inventory = Yes, all other
planning parameters = Empty. (Items using reordering policy Order remain using Order as well as the other
settings.)
NOTE
This minimal alternative only covers the exact demand. Any planning parameters defined are ignored.
See Also
Planning
Setting Up Manufacturing
Manufacturing
Inventory
Purchasing
Design Details: Supply Planning
Setup Best Practices: Supply Planning
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Create a Production Forecast
4/16/2018 • 5 minutes to read • Edit Online
You can create sales and production forecasts with the Production Forecast window.
Forecasting functionality is used to create anticipated demand; actual demand is created from sales and production
orders. During creation of the Master Production Schedule (MPS ), the forecast is netted against the sales and
production orders. The Component option on the forecast determines which type of requirements to take into
consideration in the netting process. If the forecast is for a sales item, only sales orders net the forecast. If it is for
components, only dependent demand from production order components net the forecast.
Forecasting allows your company to create "what if" scenarios and efficiently and cost-effectively plan for and meet
demand. Accurate forecasting can make a critical difference in customer satisfaction levels with regard to order
promising dates and on-time delivery.
Component Forecast
The component forecast can be seen as an option forecast in relation to a parent item. This can, for example, be
useful if the planner can estimate the demand for the component.
As the component forecast is designed to define options for a parent item, the component forecast should be equal
or less than the sales item forecast quantity. If the component forecast is higher than the sales item forecast, the
system treats the difference between these two types of forecast as independent demand.
Forecasting Periods
The forecast period is valid from its starting date until the date the next forecast starts. The time interval window
gives you multiple choices to insert the demand at a specific date in a period. It is therefore recommended not to
change the forecast period scope unless you want to move all forecast entries to the starting date of this period.
Forecast by Locations
It can be stated in the manufacturing setup if. Note, though, that if location-based forecasts are viewed in isolation,
the overall forecast may not be representative.
NOTE
You should consider which time interval that you want to use for future forecasts so that the time interval is
consistent throughout. When you enter a forecast quantity, it is valid on the first day of the time interval that you
select. For example, if you select a month, then you enter the forecast quantity on the first day of the month. If you
select a quarter, then you enter the forecast quantity on the first day of the first month in the quarter.
8. In the View as field, select how the forecast quantities are shown for the time interval. If you select Net
Change, then the net change in balance is displayed for the time interval. If you select Balance at Date,
then the window displays the balance as of the last day in the time interval.
NOTE
You can also edit an existing forecast. In the Production Forecast Matrix window, choose the Copy Production Forecast
action and populate the Production Forecast window with an existing forecast. You can then edit quantities as appropriate.
See Also
Setting Up Manufacturing
Manufacturing
Inventory
Purchasing
Design Details: Supply Planning
Setup Best Practices: Supply Planning
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Create Production Orders from Sales Orders
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
You can create production orders for produced items directly from sales orders.
See Also
Setting Up Manufacturing
Manufacturing
Inventory
Purchasing
Design Details: Supply Planning
Setup Best Practices: Supply Planning
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Plan Project Orders
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
This planning task starts from a sales order and uses the Sales Order Planning window. Once you have created a
project production order, you can plan it further by using the Order Planning window.
6. Choose the icon, enter Production Orders, and then choose the related link.
7. Open the production order just created.
Notice that the Source Type field of the production order contains Sales Header and the order has
multiple lines, one for each sales line item that must be produced.
8. Choose the Planning action.
9. In the Order Planning window, choose the Refresh action to calculate new demand.
The order header line for the project order is displayed with all unfulfilled demand lines expanded under it.
Although the production order contains lines for several produced items, the total demand for all production order
lines is listed under one order header line in the Order Planning window, and the original customer name is
displayed. You can now proceed to plan for the demand as described in How to: Plan for New Demand Order by
Order.
NOTE
Demand lines in the project production order that have Prod. Order in their Replenishment System field represent
underlying production orders. After you have generated these production orders, you must again calculate a plan in the
Order Planning window to identify any unfulfilled component demand for them. In that case, they are displayed as demand
lines under a normal production order header line, meaning, the project relation is no longer visible in the window. However,
if you are using the Order Tracking feature, then you can look back and forth to all supply orders made under the original
sales order.
See Also
Planning
Setting Up Manufacturing
Manufacturing
Inventory
Purchasing
Design Details: Supply Planning
Setup Best Practices: Supply Planning
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Plan for New Demand Order by Order
4/16/2018 • 6 minutes to read • Edit Online
This planning task can be performed in the Order Planning window, which displays all new demand along with
availability information and suggestions for supply. It provides the visibility and tools needed to effectively plan
demand from sales lines and component lines and then create different types of supply orders directly.
You can enter the Order Planning window in two ways depending on your focus: From an order that you want to
plan for specifically or in batch mode because you want to plan for all and any new demand.
OPTION DESCRIPTION
Qty. on Other Locations Shows if the item exists on another location. You can then
look up and select it.
Substitutes Exist Shows if a substitute item is created for the item. You can
then look up and select it. Note that this feature only
applies to components, that is, from demand lines of type
Production.
Quantity Available Shows the total availability of the item, that is, the
Projected Available Balance.
Earliest Date Available Shows the arrival date of an inbound supply order that
can cover the needed quantity on a date later than the
demand date.
5. In the Replenishment System field, select which type of supply order to create.
The default value is that of the item card, or SKU card, but you can change it to one of three options:
OPTION DESCRIPTION
In the Supply From field you must select a value according to the selected replenishment system.
NOTE
If the field is not filled in, the system will display an error message when you use the Make Supply Order function,
and no supply order will be created for the planning line in question. This, however, is not the case if the
replenishment system is Prod. Order.
6. From the Supply From field, you can look up in the relevant list and select where the supply should come
from:
If replenishment system is Purchase, the look-up button in this field looks up in the Item Vendor
Catalog window.
If replenishment system is Transfer, the look-up button in this field looks up in the Location List
window.
In case the item exists in another location, the Qty. on Other Location field at the bottom shows a value
and you can then look up and select the location from which the item should be supplied when you make
the transfer order.
If a substitute exists for the demanded item, the Substitute Exists field is set to Yes, and you can then look
up to the Item Substitution Entries window and select the substitute.
7. Select the Reserve check box if you want to make a reservation between the supply order you are creating
and the demand line that it is created for. It is empty by default.
NOTE
You can only select this check box if the item has Optional or Always in the Reserve field on its item card.
8. In the Qty. to Order field, you can enter the quantity that will go on the supply order you are creating.
The default value is the same quantity as that in the Needed Quantity field. But you may decide to order
more or less than this quantity based on your knowledge of the demand situation. If, for example, you see in
the Order Planning window that several unrelated demand lines are for the same purchased item, and
they are due around the same date, you can consolidate these by entering the total needed quantity in the
Qty. to Order field of one line, and then delete the other, obsolete planning lines for that item.
9. In the Due Date and Order Date fields, you can enter the dates that should apply to the created supply
orders.
These two fields are interrelated according to the Default Safety Lead Time field, which can be found in
the Manufacturing Setup window. By default, the due date is the same as the demand date, but you can
change this as you like.
NOTE
If you enter a date later than the demand date, you will receive a warning message.
OPTION DESCRIPTION
The Active Line Make a supply order only for the line where the cursor is
placed.
The Active Order Make supply orders for all lines in the order where the
cursor is placed.
All Lines Make supply orders for all lines in the Order Planning
window.
5. On the Options FastTab, define what kind of supply orders, or requisition worksheet lines, should be made.
NOTE
The settings you last made in the Make Supply Orders window will be saved under your user ID so that they are
the same the next time you use the window.
6. Choose the OK button to make the suggested supply orders or requisition worksheet lines.
You have now planned for the unfulfilled demand by making respective supply orders. Details about specific work
flows when using the Order Planning window would depend on a company’s internal policies.
When you have finished your planning work in the Order Planning window, for example defined an alternative
way to supply the quantity, you can proceed to create supply orders for one or more of the planning lines.
NOTE
The supply orders you create may introduce new dependent demand, for example for underlying production orders, and you
should therefore choose Calculate Plan again to find and resolve this before moving down the list.
See Also
Planning
Setting Up Manufacturing
Manufacturing
Inventory
Purchasing
Design Details: Supply Planning
Setup Best Practices: Supply Planning
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Run Full Planning, MPS or MRP
4/16/2018 • 10 minutes to read • Edit Online
The terms "running the planning worksheet" or "running MRP" refer to the calculation of the master production
schedule and material requirements based on actual and forecasted demand. The planning system can calculate
either Master Planning Schedule (MPS ) or Material Requirements Planning (MRP ) on request, or it can calculate
both at the same time.
MPS is the calculation of a master production schedule based on actual demand and the production forecast.
The MPS calculation is used for end items that have a forecast or a sales order line. These items are called MPS
items and are identified dynamically when the calculation starts.
MRP is the calculation of material requirements based on actual demand for components and the production
forecast on the component level. MRP is calculated only for items that are not MPS items. The purpose of MRP
is to provide time-phased formal plans, by item, to supply the appropriate item, at the appropriate time, in the
appropriate location, in the appropriate quantity.
The planning algorithms used for both MPS and MRP are identical. The planning algorithms pertain to netting,
reuse of existing replenishment orders, and action messages. The planning system process examines what is
needed or will be needed (demand) and what is on-hand or expected (supply). When these quantities are netted
against each other, Dynamics NAV provides action messages. Action messages are suggestions to create a new
order, change an order (quantity or date), or cancel an order already on order. The term "order" includes purchase
orders, assembly orders, production orders, and transfer orders.
Links created by the planning engine between demand and its related supply can be tracked in the Order Tracking
window. For more information, see How to: Track Relations Between Demand and Supply.
Proper planning results depend on the set up done on item cards, assembly BOMs, production BOMs, and
routings.
FIELD DESCRIPTION
Ending Date This is the ending date of the planning horizon. Neither
demand nor supply is considered after this date. If the
reorder cycle for an item extends beyond the ending date,
the effective planning horizon for that item is equal to the
order date + reorder cycle.
Stop and Show First Error Select if you want the planning run to stop as soon as it
encounters an error. At the same time, a message is
displayed with information about the first error. If an error
exists, only the successful planning lines made before the
error was encountered will be presented in the planning
worksheet. If you do not select this field, the Calculate
Plan batch job will continue until it has completed, that is,
errors will not interrupt the batch job. If one or more
errors exist, a message will display after completion with
information about how many items are affected. The
Planning Error Log window will then open to provide
more details about the error and links to the affected item
cards.
Exclude Forecast Before Define how much of the selected forecast to include in the
planning run by entering a date before which forecast
demand is not included, thus allowing you to exclude old
information.
Respect Planning Parameters for Exception Warnings By default, this field is selected.
4. On the Item FastTab, set filters to run the planning based on item, item description, or location.
5. Choose the OK button. The batch job runs and then the planning worksheet is populated with the planning
lines.
FIELD DESCRIPTION
Production Order Specify how you want to create production orders. You
can do this directly from the planning line proposals. You
can create either planned or firm planned production
orders.
Assembly Order Specify how you want to create assembly orders. You can
do this directly from the planning line proposals.
FIELD DESCRIPTION
Purchase Order Specify how you want to create purchase orders. You can
do this directly from the planning line proposals.
Transfer Order Specify how you want to create transfer orders. You can
do this directly from the planning line proposals.
Stop and Show First Error Select if you want the Carry Out Action Msg. - Plan.
batch job to stop as soon as it encounters an error. At the
same time, a message is displayed with information about
the firsterror. If an error exists, only the planning lines
processed before the error was encountered will create
supply orders.
3. On the Planning Line FastTab, you can set filters to limit the perform action messages.
4. Choose the OK button.
The batch job deletes the lines in the planning worksheet after it has performed the action message. The other lines
remain in the planning worksheet until they are either accepted at a later date or else deleted. You can also delete
the lines manually.
Action Messages
Action messages are issued by the order tracking system when balance is unattainable in the existing order
network. They can be viewed as a suggestion for you to process changes that reestablish equilibrium between
supply and demand.
The generation of action messages occurs one level at a time, for each item's low -level code. This makes sure that
all items that experience or will experience changes in supply or demand are considered.
To avoid small, superfluous, or unimportant action messages, the user can establish dampeners, which serve to
restrict the generation of action messages to only those changes that exceed the defined quantity or number of
days.
After you have reviewed the action messages and determined whether to accept some or all of the suggested
changes, select the Accept Action Message field, and then you are ready to update the schedules accordingly.
NOTE
An action message is a suggestion to create a new order, cancel an order, or change the quantity or date of an order. An
order is a purchase order, transfer order, or production order.
In response to any supply/demand imbalances, the following action messages are generated.
ACTION MESSAGE DESCRIPTION
Resch. & Chg. Qty. If both the dates and quantities of an order have been
modified, you must change plans with regard to both
circumstances. Action messaging gathers both actions in one
message, Resched. and Chg. Qty., to ensure that the order
network returns to balance.
See Also
Planning
Setting Up Manufacturing
Manufacturing
Inventory
Purchasing
Design Details: Supply Planning
Setup Best Practices: Supply Planning
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Replan or Refresh Production Orders Directly
8/13/2018 • 3 minutes to read • Edit Online
The Replan function on production orders is typically used after you have added or changed components that
constitute underlying production orders. The function calculates changes made to components and routings lines,
and it includes items on lower production BOM levels for which it may generate new production orders.
Based on the changes you have made to the components and routing lines, the Replan function calculates and
plans for any new demand for the production order.
The Refresh function on production orders is typically used after you have done one of the following:
Created a production order header manually to calculate and create line data for the first time.
Made changes to the production order header to recalculate all the line data.
The Refresh function calculates changes made to a production order header and does not involve production BOM
levels. The function calculates and initiates the values of the component lines and routing lines based on the
master data defined in the assigned production BOM and routing, according to the order quantity and due date on
the production order’s header.
You can either insert the production order lines manually or use the function that calculates the production order
lines from the header.
NOTE
If you use the Refresh function to recalculate production order lines, the old production order lines are deleted and new lines
are calculated.
OPTION DESCRIPTION
7. In the Plan field, select whether to calculate production requirements for produced items on the production
BOM, as follows.
OPTION DESCRIPTION
8. Select One Level, and choose the OK button to replan the production order, and calculate and create a new
underlying production order for the introduced subassembly, if it is not fully available.
NOTE
Changes implemented with the Replan function are very likely to change the capacity need of the production order and you
may therefore have to reschedule operations afterwards.
1. Choose the icon, enter Firm Planned Prod. Order, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the New action. For more information, see How to: Create Production orders.
3. Choose the Refresh action.
4. In the Refresh Production Order window, select one of the following options:
OPTION DESCRIPTION
Backward
Calculate Lines
Routings
Component Need
OPTION DESCRIPTION
5. Choose the OK button to confirm your selection. Now the production order lines are calculated.
NOTE
Calculating production order components deletes previous changes in the components.
See Also
Planning
Setting Up Manufacturing
Manufacturing
Inventory
Purchasing
Design Details: Supply Planning
Setup Best Practices: Supply Planning
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Track Relations Between Demand and
Supply
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
From any supply or demand document in the so-called order network, you can track the order demand (tracked
quantity), forecast, blanket sales order, or planning parameter (untracked quantity) that has given rise to the
planning line in question.
The planning worksheets also offers supporting planning information about non-order entities to help the planner
obtain an optimal supply plan. For more information, see the "Untracked Planning Elements" section.
1. Choose the icon, enter Firm Planned Prod. Order, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the relevant firm planned production order from the list.
3. On the Lines FastTab, choose the Functions action, and then choose the Order Tracking action.
The lines in the Order Tracking display the documents that are related to the current production order line.
A typical planning activity is to change or add planning worksheet lines to modify the suggested supply orders
before you commit them by running the Carry out Action Message function. An alternative to doing this in the
planning worksheet is to use a graphical view.
In the Item Availability by Timeline window, you can modify certain supply orders and suggestions by dragging
elements on the x-axis to change quantity or dragging elements on the y-axis to change due date.
In the Item Availability by Timeline window and the Planning Worksheet window you can make the
following changes:
Modify a suggested supply order that only exists as a planning line.
Modify an existing supply order that the planning system suggests to change.
Create a new suggested supply order and modify it.
For more information about the planning line types that are shown, see the Description field on the Event
Changes FastTab.
When you choose Save Changes in the Item Availability by Timeline window, the modifications that you have
made are copied to the planning or requisition worksheet. You can now implement them using the Carry Out
Action Msg.-Plan. function.
The following procedure shows how to modify supply suggestions by drag and drop. As an alternative, you can
change the Due Date and Quantity fields on the Event Changes FastTab and immediately see the changes
graphically on the Timeline FastTab in the Planning Worksheet window.
Create New Supply Creates a new element point where you access the drop-
down menu, which represents a new suggested supply
order. It becomes a new line in the planning worksheet
when you choose Save Changes.
Auto-Adjust Supply Optimizes a new supply that you have created in the
graph by making sure that it results in zero inventory
before the next supply.
Delete Supply Deletes the element in the Timeline FastTab and deletes
the planning line when you choose Save Changes. The
icon changes to a disk that has a red cross when the
supply has been deleted.
7. Choose the Reload action if you want to reset all the changes that you have made after you last opened the
Item Availability by Timeline window or selected Reload.
8. When the elements are placed where you want them in the diagram, choose Save Changes to copy
modified quantity and date changes to the planning or requisition lines that represent the graphical
elements.
To implement the supply plan changes, you must follow the resulting action messages from the planning or
requisition worksheet. For more information, see Carry Out Action Msg.-Plan..
- Cannot be modified.
- Visible when the Show Projected Inventory field is
selected (orange graph).
SYMBOL/ICON DESCRIPTION
Red circle Existing supply orders that are not in planning suggestions.
- Cannot be modified.
- Visible when the Show Projected Inventory field is
selected (orange graph).
- Cannot be modified.
- Visible when the Forecast Name field has a value.
Green circle with an icon shaped as a disk that has a red cross Suggested supply order with action message Cancel.
- Cannot be modified.
- Visible when the Include Planning Suggestions field is
selected (green graph).
Green circle with an icon shaped as a disk that has a star Suggested supply orders with action message New.
- Can be modified.
- Visible when the Include Planning Suggestions field is
selected (green graph).
Green circle with an icon shaped as a disk that has one or two Suggested supply orders with action message Reschedule,
arrows Change Qty., or Resched. and Chg. Qty.
- Can be modified.
- Visible when the Include Planning Suggestions field is
selected (green graph).
When you access the drop-down menu for the Timeline FastTab, the following functions appear depending what
you choose
FUNCTION DESCRIPTION
FUNCTION DESCRIPTION
Create New Supply Creates a new element on the point where you access the
drop-down menu, which represents a new suggested supply
order. It becomes a new line in the planning worksheet when
you choose Save Changes on the Process tab.
Auto-Adjust Supply Optimizes a new supply that you have created in the graph by
making sure that it creates zero inventory before the next
supply.
Delete Supply Deletes the element in the Timeline FastTab and deletes the
planning line when you choose Save Changes on the
Process tab. The icon changes to a disk that has a red cross
when the supply has been deleted. Note: You can only delete
a supply of action message type New. After you choose Save
Changes on the Process tab, you must manually delete the
planning line in question in the planning or requisition
worksheet.
Show Document Opens the order, planning line, or forecast that the element
represents.
Zoom Out (Ctrl++) Makes the scale of the x-axis larger, so that fewer days are
shown. Note: You can also do this by pressing Ctrl + scroll
mouse wheel.
Zoom In (Ctrl+-) Makes the scale of the x-axis smaller, so that more days are
shown. Note: You can also do this by pressing Ctrl + scroll
mouse wheel.
Reset Zoom (Ctrl+0) Reverts the scale of the x-axis to what was used before you
zoomed.
In addition to the keyboard actions that were mentioned earlier, you can also use the following keyboard actions in
the TimeLine FastTab.
Select an element, then press Shift+Arrow Moves the element in the direction of the arrow stroke.
KEYBOARD ACTION DESCRIPTION
While moving an element, press Esc. Cancels the move. Note: Does not work if you have released
the mouse button.
See Also
Planning
Setting Up Manufacturing
Manufacturing
Inventory
Purchasing
Design Details: Supply Planning
Setup Best Practices: Supply Planning
Working with Dynamics NAV
Assembly Management
4/16/2018 • 3 minutes to read • Edit Online
To support companies that supply products to their customers by combining components in simple
processes without the need of manufacturing functionality, Dynamics NAV includes features to assemble
items that integrate with existing features, such as sales, planning, reservations, and warehousing.
An assembly item is defined as a sellable item that contains an assembly BOM. For more information, see
How to: Work with Bills of Material.
Assembly orders are internal orders, just like production orders, that are used to manage the assembly
process and to connect the sales requirements with the involved warehouse activities. Assembly orders
differ from other order types because they involve both output and consumption when posting. The
assembly order header behaves similarly to a sales order line, and the assembly order lines behave
similarly to consumption journal lines.
To support a just-in-time inventory strategy and the ability to customize products to customer requests,
assembly orders may be automatically created and linked as soon as the sales order line is created. The link
between the sales demand and the assembly supply enables sales order processors to customize the
assembly item on the fly, promise delivery dates according to component availability, and to post output
and shipment of the assembled item directly from their sales order interface. For more information, see
How to: Sell Items Assembled to Order.
On one sales order line, you can sell a quantity that is available and must be picked from stock together
with a quantity that must be assembled to the order. Certain rules exist to govern the distribution of such
quantities to ensure that assemble-to-order quantities take priority over inventory quantities in partial
shipping. For more information, see the “Combination Scenarios” section in Understanding Assemble to
Order and Assemble to Stock.
Special functionality exists to govern the shipping of assemble-to-order quantities. When an assemble-to-
order quantity is ready to be shipped, the warehouse worker in charge posts an inventory pick for the sales
order line(s) in question. This, in turn, creates an inventory movement for the components, posts the
assembly output, and the sales order shipment. For more information, see the "Handling Assemble-to-
Order Items in Inventory Picks” section in How to: Pick Items with Inventory Picks.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Learn about the difference between assembling items Understanding Assemble to Order and Assemble to Stock
right before shipping sales orders and assembling items
that are intended for storage.
Fill in fields on location cards and in inventory setup to How to: Set Up Basic Warehouses with Operations Areas
define how items flow to and from the assembly
department.
Customize an assembly item to a customer’s request How to: Quote an Assemble-to-Order Sale
during the sales process, and convert to a sale when
accepted.
TO SEE
Sell assembly items that are not currently available by How to: Sell Items Assembled to Order
creating a linked assembly order to supply the full or
partial sales order quantity.
When some assemble-to-order items are already in How to: Sell Inventory Items in Assemble-to-Order Flows
inventory, deduct that quantity from the assembly order
and reserve it from inventory.
When you are selling assembly items from inventory and How to: Sell Assemble-to-Order Items and Inventory
all items are not available, initiate an assembly order to Items Together
automatically supply a part or all of the sales order
quantity.
Undo a posted assembly order, for example because the How to: Undo Assembly Posting
order was posted with mistakes that must be corrected.
Learn about the difference between assembly BOMs and How to: Work with Bills of Material
production BOMs and the involved processing differences.
Learn how assembly consumption and output are Design Details: Assembly Order Posting
handled when you post assembly orders and how the
derived item and resource costs are processed and
distributed to the general ledger.
See Also
How to: Work with Bills of Material
Inventory
Design Details: Warehouse Management
Working with Dynamics NAV
Understanding Assemble to Order and Assemble to
Stock
8/13/2018 • 5 minutes to read • Edit Online
Assemble to Order
You typically use assemble to order for items that you do not want to stock because you expect to customize them
to customer requests or because you want to minimize the inventory carrying cost. The supporting functionality
includes:
Ability to customize assembly items when taking a sales order.
Overview of availability of the assembly item and its components.
Ability to reserve assembly components immediately to guarantee order fulfillment.
Function to determine profitability of the customized order by rolling up price and cost.
Integration to the warehouse to make assembly and shipping easier.
Ability to assemble to order at the point of making a sales quote or a blanket sales order.
Ability to combine inventory quantities with assemble-to-order quantities.
In the assemble-to-order process, the item is assembled in response to a sales order and with a one-to-one link
between the assembly order and the sales order.
When you enter an assemble-to-order item on a sales line, an assembly order is automatically created with a
header that is based on the sales line and with lines that are based on the item’s assembly BOM multiplied by the
order quantity. You can use the Assemble-to-Order Lines window to see the linked assembly order lines to
support you in customizing the assembly item and in a delivery date that is based on component availability
information. For more information, see How to: Sell Items Assembled to Order.
NOTE
Although it is not part of the default process, you can sell inventory quantities with the assemble-to-order quantities. For
more information, see How to: Sell Inventory Items in Assemble-to-Order Flows.
To enable this process, the Assembly Policy field on the item card must be Assemble-to-Order.
Assemble to Stock
You typically use assemble to stock for items that you want to assemble ahead of sales, such as to prepare for a kit
campaign, and keep in stock until they are ordered. These items are usually standard items such as packaged kits
that you do not offer to customize to customer requests.
In the assemble-to-stock process, the item is assembled without an immediate sales demand and is stocked in the
warehouse as an inventory item for later sale or consumption as a subassembly. For more information, see How
to: Assemble Items. From this point, the item is picked and processed as a single item and is treated like a finished
production item.
When you enter an assemble-to-stock item on a sales line, the line like any other item sold from inventory. For
example, availability is checked for the assembly item only.
NOTE
Although it is not part of the default process, you can assemble an item to order even if it is set up to be assembled to
stock. For more information, see How to: Sell Assemble-to-Order Items and Inventory Items Together.
To enable this process, the Assembly Policy field on the item card must be Assemble-to-Stock.
Combination Scenarios
A general principle in Assembly Management is that when combined on a sales order line, assemble-to-order
quantities must be shipped before inventory quantities.
If an assembly order is linked to a sales order line, then the value in the Qty. to Assemble to Order field on the
sales order line is copied to the Quantity to Assemble field, via the Quantity field on the assembly order header.
For more information, see How to: Sell Items Assembled to Order.
In addition, the value in the Quantity to Assemble field is related to the Qty. to Ship field on the sales order
line, and this relation manages the shipping of assemble-to-order quantities, both partially and completely. This is
true both when the full sales line quantity is assembled to order and in combination scenarios where one part of
the sales line quantity is assembled to order and another part is shipped from inventory. However, in the
combination scenario, you have additional flexibility when shipping partially in that you can modify the Quantity
to Assemble field, within predefined rules, to specify how many units to ship partially from inventory and how
many to ship partially by assembling to order.
If the full sales line quantity must be assembled to order and shipped, then the value in the Qty. to Ship field is
copied to Quantity to Assemble field on the linked assembly order when you change the quantity to ship. This
ensures that the quantity being shipped is fully supplied by the assemble-to-order quantity.
However, in combination scenarios, the full value in the Qty. to Ship is not copied to the Quantity to Assemble
field on the assembly order header. Instead, a default value is inserted in the Quantity to Assemble field that is
calculated from the Qty. to Ship field according to a predefined rule that ensures shipment of assemble-to-order
quantities first.
If you want to deviate from this default, for example because you only want to assemble more or less of the
quantity in the Qty. to Ship field, then you can modify the Quantity to Assemble field, but only within
predefined rules, as illustrated below
An example why you would want to modify the quantity to assemble is that you want to partially post shipment of
inventory quantities before the assembly output can be shipped.
The following explains the rules that define the minimum and maximum values that you can enter manually in the
Quantity to Assemble to deviate from the default value in a combination scenario. The table shows a
combination scenario where the Qty. to Ship field on the linked sales order line is changed from 7 to 4, and the
Quantity to Assemble is therefore defaulted to 4.
Initial 10 7
Change 4
Based on the above situation, you can only modify the Quantity to Assemble field as follows:
The minimum quantity that you can enter is 1. This is because you must at least assemble one unit to be able
to sell the four units, assuming that the remaining three are available in the inventory.
The maximum quantity that you can enter is 4. This is to ensure that you do not assemble more of this
assemble-to-order item than what is needed on the sale.
See Also
Assembly Management
How to: Work with Bills of Material
Inventory
Design Details: Warehouse Management
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Quote an Assemble-to-Order Sale
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
You can use assembly management to customize an assembly item to a customer’s request during the sales
process. For more information, see How to: Sell Items Assembled to Order.
As when you sell any other type of item, you can also create a sales quote for a customized assembly item before
converting it to a sales order. This process involves several extra steps when you compare it to creating a regular
sales quote, and it uses a variation of a linked assembly order, which is an assembly quote.
NOTE
Like all types of quotes, the quantities on assembly quotes are not used in availability, planning, or reservations.
NOTE
You should not quote a partial quantity. Therefore, you must enter the same quantity that you entered in the
Quantity field on the sales quote line.
4. On the Lines FastTab, choose Line, choose Assemble to Order, and then choose Assemble-to-Order
Lines. Alternatively, choose the Qty. to Assemble to Order field on the line.
5. In the Assemble-to-Order Lines window, review or modify the assembly order lines according to the
quote that the customer is requesting. If you want to view more information, choose the Show Document
action to open the complete blanket quote order. You cannot change the contents of most fields, and you
cannot post.
6. When you have adjusted the assembly order lines according to the quote, close the Assemble-to-Order
Lines window to return to the Sales Quote window.
7. If the customer accepts the quote, then create a sales order for the quoted assembly item. For more
information, see How to: Make Offers. The linked assembly quote and any customizations are linked to that
new sales order to prepare for assembly of the item or items to be sold.
See Also
Assembly Management
How to: Work with Bills of Material
Inventory
Design Details: Warehouse Management
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Assemble Items
4/16/2018 • 4 minutes to read • Edit Online
If the Replenishment System field on the item card contains Assembly, then the default method of supplying
the item is to assemble it from defined components and potentially by a defined resource.
The components and resources that go into this kind of an assembly item must be defined in an assembly BOM.
For more information, see How to: Work with Bills of Material.
Assembly items can be set up for two different assembly processes:
Assemble to stock.
Assemble to order.
You typically use Assemble to Stock for items that you want to assemble ahead of sales, such as to prepare for a
kit campaign, and keep in stock until they are ordered. These items are usually standard items such as packaged
kits that you do not offer to customize to customer requests.
You typically use Assemble to Order for items that you do not want to stock because you expect to customize
them to customer requests or because you want to minimize the inventory carrying cost by supplying them just in
time. For more information, see How to: Sell Items Assembled to Order.
For more information about how to set up an assembly item, see Understanding Assemble to Order and
Assemble to Stock.
These setup options are default settings that manage how sales and assembly order lines are initially processed.
You can depart from these defaults and supply the assembly item in the most optimal way when processing a
sale. For more information, see How to: Sell Inventory Items in Assemble-to-Order Flows and How to: Sell
Assemble-to-Order Items and Inventory Items Together.
NOTE
Assembly components are handled in a special way in basic warehouse configurations. For more information, see the
“Handling Assemble-to-Order Items in Inventory Picks” section in How to: Pick Items with Inventory Picks.
In this procedure, you create and process an assembly order for items that are assembled to stock, which means
without a linked sales order. The steps include initiating the assembly order, handling potential component
availability issues, and partially posting assembly item output.
To assemble an item
1. Choose the icon, enter Assembly Orders, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the New action. The New Assembly Order window opens.
3. Fill in the fields as necessary. Choose a field to read a short description of the field or link to more
information.
4. In the Item No. field, select the assembly item that you want to process. The field is filtered to show only
items that are set up for assembly, which means that they have assembly BOMs assigned.
5. In the Quantity field, enter how many units of the item that you want assembled.
NOTE
If one or more components are not available to fulfill the entered assembly item quantity on the defined due date,
then the Assembly Availability window automatically opens to provide detailed information about how many
assembly items can be assembled based on component availability. For more information, see How to: View the
Availability of Items. When you close the window, the assembly order is created with availability alerts on the
affected component lines.
The assembly order lines are automatically filled with the contents of the assembly BOM and with line
quantities according to the assembly order header.
NOTE
If the Assembly Availability window opened when you filled in the assembly order header, then each affected
assembly order line contains a Yes in the Avail. Warning field with a link to detailed availability information. For
more information, see Check Availability. You can resolve a component availability issue by postponing the starting
date, replacing the component with another item, or selecting an available substitution if one is defined.
6. In the Quantity to Assemble field, enter how many units of the assembly item that you want to post as
output the next time that you post the assembly order. This quantity can be lower than the value in the
Quantity field to reflect a partial output posting.
NOTE
To make sure that component consumption posting matches the assembly item output posting, the quantity fields
in the assembly order lines automatically adjust to the value that you enter in the Quantity to Assemble field.
7. On assembly order lines of type Item or Resource, in the Quantity to Consume field, specify how many
units you want to post as consumed the next time that you post the assembly order. By default, the
expected quantity to consume according to the assembly BOM and the assembly order header quantity is
inserted, but you can increase or decrease it, such as to reflect an overconsumption of components or that
extra resources were used.
8. When you are ready to partially or fully post, choose the Post action.
NOTE
If warnings are still present in any of the assembly order lines, then the posting is blocked. A message about which
component or components are not in inventory is displayed.
After posting succeeds, the assembly item is posted as output to the location code and potential bin code that are
defined on the assembly order. For manually created assembly orders, the location may be copied from the
Default Location for Orders setup field. For assemble-to-order flows, the location code may be copied from the
sales order line.
See Also
Assembly Management
How to: Work with Bills of Material
Inventory
Design Details: Warehouse Management
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Sell Items Assembled to Order
4/16/2018 • 3 minutes to read • Edit Online
If the Assembly Policy field on the item card of an assembly item is Assemble-to-Order, then the item is not
expected to be in inventory, and it must be assembled specifically to a sales order. When you enter the item on a
sales order line, then an assembly order is automatically created and linked to the sales order.
NOTE
If some assemble-to-order items are already in inventory, then you can deduct that quantity from the assembly order and
reserve it from inventory. For more information, see How to: Sell Inventory Items in Assemble-to-Order Flows.
In this procedure, you process the sale of an item that will be assembled according to specifications that are
requested by the customer. The steps include initiating the sales order line, customizing the assembly item by
editing its components and resources, checking availability to establish a delivery date, and releasing the sales
order to be assembled and immediately shipped.
NOTE
The following procedure does not include the standard sales order steps before the step where you enter the assemble-to-
order item on a sales order line.
NOTE
If one or more components of the requested assembly item quantity are not available, then a detailed availability
warning window opens. For more information, see Assembly Availability.
An assembly order is now automatically created and linked to the sales order line. The due date of this
assembly order is synchronized with the shipment date of the sales order line.
The quantity to sell is copied to the Qty. to Assemble to Order field, which indicates that the item setup
expects the full quantity on the sales line to be assembled to the order. You can decrease the quantity to
assemble to order, such as if you know that some items are already available. For more information, see
How to: Sell Inventory Items in Assemble-to-Order Flows.
6. To reflect that the customer wants an additional item in a kit, on the Lines FastTab, choose the Line action,
choose the Assemble to Order action, and then choose the Assemble-to-Order Lines action to view
and change the standard assembly components. Alternatively, choose the Qty. to Assemble to Order
field.
7. In the Assemble-to-Order Lines window, create a new line of type Item for the requested additional kit
content. The line represents an additional assembly component.
You could also customize the order by increasing the quantity of one standard item in the kit. You can do
this by increasing the value in the Quantity Per field on the specific assembly order line.
NOTE
The Assemble-to-Order Lines window only contains the basic fields that a salesperson is expected to use to
customize the component list, add item tracking numbers, or to solve component availability issues. To see more
assembly order information, such as the assembly order starting date, on the Home tab, in the Process group,
choose Show Documents. This opens a full view of the assembly order that is linked to the sales order line. You
cannot change the contents of most fields on the assembly order header, and you cannot post assembly output
from it because you must use shipment posting of the sales order line.
On the header of linked assembly orders, only the Starting Date field can be changed to enable assembly workers
to specify a date that is earlier than the due date when they will start the process. All fields on the lines of the
linked assembly order can be changed so that warehouse workers can enter consumption figures during the
process.
8. Review or react to component availability issues. For example, select an available substitute item or
establish a later due date.
9. Close the Assemble-to-Order Lines window. The linked assembly order is now ready to start to
assemble the customized items by the due date.
10. On the sales order, choose the Release action to notify the assembly department that the assembly
process can start.
11. In the assembly department, perform the steps of assembling the items that are sold in this procedure.
For more information, see How to: Assemble Items.
See Also
Assembly Management
How to: Work with Bills of Material
Inventory
Design Details: Warehouse Management
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Sell Inventory Items in Assemble-to-Order
Flows
4/16/2018 • 3 minutes to read • Edit Online
If the Assembly Policy field on the item card of an assembly item contains Assemble-to-Order, then the default
sales order process assumes that the item is not in inventory and must be assembled for that specific sales order.
Therefore, a linked assembly order is automatically created when you add the item to a sales order line. For more
information, see How to: Sell Items Assembled to Order. However, if a part of the sales order quantity is already
available in inventory, then you can decrease the assembly order quantity by changing the Qty. to Assemble to
Order field on the sales order line.
This scenario is rare because assemble-to-order items are expected to always be customized, and the chance that
they are in inventory in the configuration that is requested by another customer is low. However, if a company
does have assemble-to-order quantities in inventory because of returns or order cancellations, then these
quantities should be picked and sold before new ones are assembled.
NOTE
No functionality exists on sales orders that automatically alerts or helps you deduct assembly order quantities that are
already available. Instead, you must monitor availability information, such as in the Sales Line Details FactBox.
Similar functionality is available when you are selling assembly items from inventory and a part or all of the
quantity is unavailable and can be supplied by an assembly order. For more information, see How to: Sell
Assemble-to-Order Items and Inventory Items Together.
NOTE
Certain rules apply to the Qty. to Ship field on sales order lines that contain a combination of assemble-to-order quantities
and inventory quantities. For more information, see the Combination Scenarios section in Understanding Assemble to Order
and Assemble to Stock.
In this procedure, you replace assemble-to-order quantities with inventory quantities on a sales order line. The
steps include detecting that availability exists, deducting that quantity from the linked assembly order, and then
reserving the inventory quantity to make sure that it is picked and shipped for the order.
The Bin Code field on the sales order may be prefilled according to the Assemble-to-Order Shpt. Bin Code or
the From -Assembly Bin Code field on the location card. In that case, the Bin Code field on the sales order line
may be incorrect in this combination of assemble-to-order and assemble-to-stock quantities. It is a good idea to
look in the Bin Code field and ensure that the placement works for all quantities. Alternatively, enter the two
different quantities on separate sales order lines.
See Also
Assembly Management
How to: Reserve Items
How to: Work with Bills of Material
Inventory
Design Details: Warehouse Management
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Sell Assemble-to-Order Items and Inventory
Items Together
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
If the Assembly Policy field on the item card of an assembly item contains Assemble-to-Stock, then the default
sales order process assumes that the item is already assembled and can be picked from inventory, if it is available.
Therefore, no assembly order is automatically created and linked to the sales order line. However, if a part (or all)
of the quantity is not available, then you have the flexibility to create an assembly order for the remaining
quantity by filling in the Qty. to Assemble to Order field on the sales order line. In this manner, you can
assemble the item to order although it is set up to be assembled to stock by default.
Similar flexibility exists when you are selling items to be assembled to the order and a part of the quantity is in
inventory, which you want to deduct from the assembly order. For more information, see How to: Sell Inventory
Items in Assemble-to-Order Flows.
NOTE
Certain rules apply to the Qty. to Ship field on sales order lines that contain a combination of assemble-to-order quantities
and inventory quantities. For more information, see the Combination Scenarios section in Understanding Assemble to
Order and Assemble to Stock.
NOTE
The following procedure does not include the standard sales order steps that you need to follow before you create an
assembly order for unavailable quantities.
The Bin Code field on the sales order may be prefilled according to the Assemble-to-Order Shpt. Bin Code
field or the From -Assembly Bin Code field on the location card. In that case, the Bin Code field on the sales
order line may be incorrect in this combination of assemble-to-order and assemble-to-stock quantities. It is a
good idea to examine the Bin Code field and make sure that the placement works for all quantities. Alternatively,
enter the two different quantities on separate sales order lines.
See Also
Assembly Management
How to: Work with Bills of Material
Inventory
Design Details: Warehouse Management
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Undo Assembly Posting
4/16/2018 • 3 minutes to read • Edit Online
Sometimes you may need to undo a posted assembly order, for example when the order was posted with mistakes
that must be corrected, or because it should not have been posted in the first place and must be rolled back.
When you undo a posted assembly order, a set of corrective item ledger entries is created to reverse the original
entries. Each positive output entry for the assembly item is reversed by a negative output entry. Each negative
consumption entry for an assembly component is reversed by a positive consumption entry. Fixed cost application
is automatically created between the corrective and original entries to ensure exact cost reversal.
When you undo a fully posted assembly order, then you can choose to recreate the assembly order to its original
state, for example to make corrections before reposting it. Alternatively, you can choose to not recreate the
assembly order.
When you undo a partially posted assembly order, then all affected quantity fields, such as the Assembled
Quantity, Consumed Quantity, and Remaining Quantity fields are restored to the values they had before the
posting in question.
To recreate or restore assembly orders, the following conditions must apply to the assembly item that was output
in the original posting:
It must still be in inventory, that is, it is not sold or otherwise consumed by outbound transactions.
It must not be reserved.
It must exist in the bin that it was output to.
In addition, existing assembly orders can only be restored if the number of lines and the sequence of lines on the
original assembly order are not changed.
TIP
To solve conflicts due to line changes, you can manually revert the changes on the lines in question before undoing the
related posted assembly order. Alternatively, you can post the assembly order fully and then select to recreate it when
undoing the posting.
The following procedure describes how to undo posted assembly orders where the items were assembled to stock.
If you want to undo posted assembly orders where the items were assembled to a sales order, then you must use
the Undo Shipment function on the posted shipment that relates to the posted assembly order. For more
information, see How to: Reverse Postings. The undoing of the posted assembly order then happens automatically
in the same way as described in this topic.
NOTE
To restore quantities from multiple partial postings in an assembly order, you must undo all the posted assembly orders in
question by following steps 1 through 3 above for each posted assembly order.
See Also
Assembly Management
How to: Reverse Postings
How to: Process Sales Returns or Cancellations
How to: Work with Bills of Material
Inventory
Design Details: Warehouse Management
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Work with Bills of Material
4/16/2018 • 6 minutes to read • Edit Online
You use bills of materials (BOMs) to structure parent items that must be assembled or produced by resources or
machine centers from components. An assembly BOM can also be used to sell a parent item as a kit consisting of
its components.
1. Choose the icon, enter Items, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the card for an assembly item. (The Assembly BOM field in the Items window contains Yes.)
3. In the Item Card window, choose the Assembly action, and then choose the Assembly BOM action.
4. In the Assembly BOM window, choose the Show BOM action.
OPTION DESCRIPTION
Top Level Calculates the assembly item's standard cost as the total cost
of all purchased or assembled items on that assembly BOM
regardless of any underlying assembly BOMs.
All Levels Calculates the assembly's item standard cost as the sum of: 1)
The calculated cost of all underlying assembly BOMs on the
assembly BOM. 2) The cost of all purchased items on the
assembly BOM.
The costs of the items that make up the assembly BOM are copied from the component item cards. The cost of
each item is multiplied by the quantity, and the total cost is shown in the Unit Cost field on the item card.
See Also
How to: Register New Items
How to: View the Availability of Items
Inventory
Working with Microsoft Dynamics NAV
Design Details: Assembly Order Posting
4/16/2018 • 5 minutes to read • Edit Online
Assembly order posting is based on the same principles as when posting the similar activities of sales orders and
production consumption/output. However, the principles are combined in that assembly orders have their own
posting UI, like that for sales orders, while the actual entry posting happens in the background as direct item and
resource journal postings, like that for production consumption, output, and capacity.
Similarly to production order posting, the consumed components and the used resources are converted and
output as the assembly item when the assembly order is posted. For more information, see Design Details:
Production Order Posting. However, the cost flow for assembly orders is less complex, especially because
assembly cost posting only occurs once and therefore does not generate work-in-process inventory.
The following journal postings occur during assembly order posting:
The item journal posts positive item ledger entries, representing output of the assembly item, from the
assembly order header
The item journal posts negative item ledger entries, representing consumption of assembly components, from
the assembly order lines.
The resource journal posts usage of assembly resources (time units), from the assembly order lines.
The capacity journal posts value entries relating to the resource usage, from the assembly order lines.
The following diagram shows the structure of item and resource ledger entries that result from assembly order
posting.
NOTE
Machine and work centers are included to illustrate that capacity ledger entries are created from both production and
assembly.
The following diagram shows how assembly data flows into ledger entries during posting:
Posting Sequence
The posting of an assembly order occurs in the following order:
1. The assembly order lines are posted.
2. The assembly order header is posted.
The following table outlines the sequence of actions.
ACTION DESCRIPTION
IMPORTANT
Unlike for production output, which is posted at expected cost, assembly output is posted at actual cost.
Cost Adjustment
Once an assembly order is posted, meaning that components (material) and resources are assembled into a new
item, then it should be possible to determine the actual cost of that assembly item, and the actual inventory cost of
the components involved. This is achieved by forwarding costs from the posted entries of the source (the
components and resources) to the posted entries of the destination (the assembly item). The forwarding of costs is
done by calculating and generating new entries, called adjustment entries that become associated with the
destination entries.
The assembly costs to be forwarded are detected with the Order Level detection mechanism. For information
about other adjustment detection mechanisms, see Design Details: Cost Adjustment.
Detecting the Adjustment
The order Level detection function is used in conversion scenarios, production and assembly. The function works
as follows:
Cost adjustment is detected by marking the order whenever a material/resource is posted as consumed/used.
Cost is forwarding by applying the costs from material/resource to the output entries associated with the same
order.
The following graphic shows the adjustment entry structure and how assembly costs are adjusted.
NOTE
The Make WIP Adjustments element, in lines 7 and 8, is responsible for forwarding production material and capacity usage
to the output of unfinished production orders. This is not used when adjusting assembly order costs as the concept of WIP
does not apply to assembly.
For information about how costs from assembly and production are posted to the general ledger, see Design
Details: Inventory Posting.
Assembly Order Header Item Inventory Posting Group Gen. Prod. Posting Group
Assembly Order Line Item Inventory Posting Group Gen. Prod. Posting Group
Accordingly, only actual costs are posted to the general ledger, and no interim accounts are populated from
assembly order posting. For more information, see Design Details: Accounts in the General Ledger
Assemble to Order
The item ledger entry that results from posting an assemble-to-order sale is fixed applied to the related item
ledger entry for the assembly output. Accordingly, the cost of an assemble-to-order sale is derived from the
assembly order that it was linked to.
Item ledger entries of type Sale that result from posting assemble-to-order quantities are marked with Yes in the
Assemble to Order field.
Posting sales order lines where a part is inventory quantity and another part is assemble-to-order quantity results
in separate item ledger entries, one for the inventory quantity and one for the assemble-to-order quantity.
See Also
Design Details: Inventory Costing
Design Details: Production Order Posting
Design Details: Costing Methods
Managing Inventory Costs
Finance
Working with Dynamics NAV
Manufacturing
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
When demand is planned for and the materials have been issued according to production BOMs, then the
actual production operations can start and be executed in the sequence defined by the production order
routing.
An important part of executing production, from a system point of view, is to post production output to
the database to report progress and to update inventory with the finished items. Output posting can be
done manually, by filling and posting journal lines after production operations. Or, it can be done
automatically with the use of backward flushing. In that case material consumption is automatically
posted along with output when the production order changes to finished.
As an alternative to the batch journal for output posting for multiple production orders, you can use the
Production Journal window to post consumption and/or output for one production order line.
Before you can begin to produce items, you must make various setup, such as work centers, routings, and
production BOMs. For more information, see Setting Up Manufacturing.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Record and post production output along with material How to: Post Consumption and Output for One Released
and time consumption for a single released production Production Order Line
order line.
Batch post the quantity of components used per How to: Batch Post Consumption
operation in a journal that can processes multiple
planned production orders.
Post the quantity of finished items and the time spent How to: Batch Post Output and Run Times
per operation in a journal that can processes multiple
released production orders.
Post the number of items produced in each finished How to: Post Scrap
operation which do not qualify as finished output, but as
scrapped material.
View the shop floor load as a result of planned and How to: View the Load in Work and Machine Centers
released production orders.
Use the Capacity Journal window to post consumed How to: Post Capacities
capacities that are not assigned to a production order,
such as maintenance work.
TO SEE
Calculate and adjust the cost of finished production items About Finished Production Order Costs
and consumed components for financial reconciliation.
See Also
Setting Up Manufacturing
Planning
Inventory
Purchasing
Working with Dynamics NAV
About Production Orders
4/16/2018 • 13 minutes to read • Edit Online
Production orders are used to manage the conversion of purchased materials into manufactured items. Production
orders route work through various work or machine centers on the shop floor.
Before proceeding with production, most companies perform supply planning, typically once a week, to calculate
how many production orders and purchase orders to execute to fulfill that week’s sales demand. Purchase orders
supply the components that are required according to the production BOM to produce the end items.
Production orders are the central components of the program's manufacturing functionality and they contain the
following information:
Products planned for manufacturing
Materials required for the planned production orders
Products that have just been manufactured
Materials that have already been selected
Products that have been manufactured in the past
Materials that were used in previous manufacturing operations
Production orders are the starting points for:
Planning future manufacturing
Controlling current manufacturing
Tracking of finished manufacturing
See Also
Manufacturing
Setting Up Manufacturing
Planning
Inventory
Purchasing
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Create Production Order Headers
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
You can create a production order manually, and the first step is to create a production order header.
Production orders are typically created automatically by a planning function to fulfill a known demand. For more
information, see Planning.
In the following procedure, a firm planned production order is created. You can also create production orders with
a different status.
See Also
Manufacturing
Setting Up Manufacturing
Planning
Inventory
Purchasing
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Subcontract Manufacturing
4/16/2018 • 6 minutes to read • Edit Online
Subcontracting selected operations to vendor is common in many manufacturing companies. Subcontracting can
be a rare occurrence or can be an integral part of all production processes.
The program provides several tools for managing subcontract work:
Work Centers with assigned vendor: This feature enables you to set up a work center that is associated with a
vendor (subcontractor). This is called a subcontract work center. You can specify a subcontract work center on a
routing operation, which allows you to easily process the subcontracted activity. In addition, the cost of the
operation can be designated at the routing or the work center level.
Work Center cost based on units or time: This feature enables you to specify whether costs associated with the
work center are based on the production time or a flat charge per unit. Although subcontractors commonly use
a flat charge per unit to charge for their services, the program can handle both options (production time and
flat charge per unit).
Subcontracting Worksheet: This feature allows you to find the production orders with material ready to send to
a subcontractor and to automatically create purchase orders for subcontract operations from production order
routings. Then the program automatically posts the purchase order charges to the production order during the
posting of the purchase order. Only production orders with a status of released can be accessed and used from
a subcontracting worksheet.
Subcontracting Worksheet
Once you have calculated the subcontracting worksheet, the relevant document, in this case a purchase order, is
created.
NOTE
Only production orders with status Released can be accessed and used from a subcontracting worksheet.
Posting output automatically for an ongoing production order when subcontracted items are received may not be
desired. Reasons for this could be that the expected output quantity that is posted may be different from the actual
quantity and that the posting date of the automatic output is misleading.
To avoid that the expected output of a production order is posted when subcontract purchases are received, make
sure the subcontracted operation is not the last one. Alternatively, insert a new last operation for the final output
quantity.
Posting output automatically for an ongoing production order when subcontracted items are received may not be
desired. Reasons for this could be that the expected output quantity that is posted may be different from the actual
quantity and that the posting date of the automatic output is misleading.
To avoid that the expected output of a production order is posted when subcontract purchases are received, make
sure the subcontracted operation is not the last one. Alternatively, insert a new last operation for the final output
quantity.
When the purchase order is posted as invoiced, then the direct cost of the purchase order is posted to the
production.
See Also
Manufacturing
Setting Up Manufacturing
Planning
Inventory
Purchasing
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Register Consumption and Output for One
Released Production order line
4/16/2018 • 3 minutes to read • Edit Online
This execution task is performed in the Production Journal window. The journal combines the functions of the
separate consumption journal and output journals into one journal. The combined journal is accessed directly from
a released production order. Its main purpose is to manually post the consumption of components, the quantity of
end items produced, and the time spent in operations. The values are posted to ledger entries under the released
production order. Consumption quantities are posted as negative item ledger entries, output quantities are posted
as positive ledger entries, and times spent are posted as capacity ledger entries. Such posted values can also be
viewed at the bottom of the journal as actual quantities.
NOTE
Because consumption data is processed together with output data, this journal offers an opportunity to display linked
components and operations in a logical process structure. Components are indented under their respective operation. This
requires that you use routing link codes.
NOTE
Components without routing link codes are listed first in the journal.
NOTE
Posting dates entered on individual lines will override this field.
4. In the Flushing Method Filter field at the top of the journal, you can choose to also view consumption and
output that is posted automatically according to the flushing methods defined for the item and resource
respectively.
On each type of line in the journal, only the relevant fields are shown. The rest are blank and write-
protected.
When the journal is opened, it is preset with the quantities to be posted. If nothing is posted so far, all
quantity fields will show by default the expected quantities carried from the production order. If partial
postings have been made, the quantity fields on the lines will show the remaining quantities. The quantities
and times already posted for the order are displayed at the bottom of the journal as actual entries.
Concerning the quantities in the Output Quantity field, you have the option to set up which values to
preset when the journal is first opened. This is done from the Manufacturing Setup window, General
FastTab, in the Preset Output Quantity field.
5. Proceed to enter the relevant consumption and output quantities in the editable fields.
NOTE
Only the output quantity on the last journal line of entry type Output will adjust the inventory level when posting
the journal. Therefore, do not to post the journal, with the expected output quantity preset on the last output line,
until all end items are actually produced.
6. Select the Finished field of output lines to indicate that the operation is finished. This field is related to the
Routing Status field on a production order routing line.
7. Choose the Post action to register the quantities you have entered and then close the journal.
If values remain to be posted, the journal will contain these remaining values next time it is opened. Posted values
are shown as actual values in the bottom of the journal.
NOTE
If an item that is being consumed is blocked, the journal will not post consumption quantities for that item. If a machine or
work center is blocked, the journal will not post output quantities or process times for the output line in question.
NOTE
If you close the journal without posting, the changes will be lost.
WARNING
The Production Journal window cannot be used by two users simultaneously. This means that if User 2 opens the window
and enters data when User 1 is already working in the window, then User 2 may lose data when User 1 closes the window.
See Also
Manufacturing
Setting Up Manufacturing
Planning
Inventory
Purchasing
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Batch Post Production Consumption
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
If the flushing method is Manual, you must post the components manually, using a consumption journal.
You can also set the system up to automatically post (flush) components when you start or finish production
orders. For more information, see Enable Flushing of Components According to Operation Output.
See Also
Manufacturing
Setting Up Manufacturing
Planning
Inventory
Purchasing
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Batch Post Output and Run Times
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
The output quantity represents the work progress in the form of the finished quantity.
NOTE
Only when you post output quantity on the last operation, the inventory is updated automatically.
1. Choose the icon, enter Output Journal, and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the fields with the production order data and the output data.
3. If the operation is completed, select the Finished field.
4. Choose the Post action to post the time spent per operation. Capacity ledger entries are updated for the used
work or machine centers.
See Also
Manufacturing
Setting Up Manufacturing
Planning
Inventory
Purchasing
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Post Scrap Manually
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
NOTE
The scrap quantity does not increase the output quantity.
See Also
Manufacturing
Setting Up Manufacturing
Planning
Inventory
Purchasing
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: View Load on Work and Machine Centers
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
In the Work Center Card and Machine Center Card windows, you can view the shop floor load as a result of
planned and released production orders.
See Also
Manufacturing
Setting Up Manufacturing
Planning
Inventory
Purchasing
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Post Capacities
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
In the capacity journal, you post consumed capacities that are not assigned to the production order. For example,
maintenance work must be assigned to capacity, but not to a production order.
To post capacities
1. Choose the icon, enter Capacity Journals, and then choose the related link.
2. Fill in the Posting Date and Document No. fields.
3. In the Type field, enter the type of the capacity, either Machine Center or Work Center, that you are posting.
4. In the No. field, enter the number of the machine center or work center.
5. Enter the relevant data in the other fields, such as Starting Time, Ending Time, Quantity, and Scrap.
6. Choose the Post action to post the capacities.
1. Choose the icon, enter Work Centers, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the relevant Work Center card from the list, and then choose the Capacity Ledger Entries action.
The Capacity Ledger Entries window displays the posted entries from the work center in the order they were
posted.
See Also
Manufacturing
Setting Up Manufacturing
Planning
Inventory
Purchasing
Working with Dynamics NAV
About Finished Production Order Costs
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Finishing the production order is an important task in completing the costing lifecycle of the item that is being
produced. Final costs, including variances in a standard cost environment, actuals in a FIFO, Average, or LIFO cost
environment, are calculated using the Adjust Cost - Item Entries batch job, which allows for financial
reconciliation of the costs of item production. For a production order to be considered for cost adjustment, the
status must be Finished. It is therefore critical that upon completion, the status of a production order is changed
to Finished.
Example
In a standard cost environment, when you consume material to produce an item, stated simply, the cost of the item
plus labor and overhead go into WIP. When the item is produced, WIP is reduced by the amount of the standard
cost of the item. Typically, these costs do not net to zero. So that these costs can net to zero, you must run the
Adjust Cost - Item Entries batch job, noting that only production orders with the status of Finished will be
considered for adjustment.
See Also
Managing Inventory Costs
Manufacturing
Working with Dynamics NAV
Warehouse Management
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
After goods are received and before goods are shipped, a series of internal warehouse activities take place
to ensure an effective flow through the warehouse and to organize and maintain company inventories.
Typical warehouse activities include putting items away, moving items inside or between warehouses, and
picking items for assembly, production, or shipment. Assembling items for sale or inventory may also be
considered warehouse activities, but these are covered elsewhere. For more information, see Assembly
Management.
In large warehouses, these different handling tasks can be separated by departments and the integration
managed by a directed workflow. In simpler installations, the flow is less formalized and the warehouse
activities are performed with so-called inventory put-aways and inventory picks. For more information
about basic versus advanced warehouse configurations, see Design Details: Warehouse Overview.
Before you can perform warehouse activities, you must set the system up for the relevant complexity of
warehouse processing. For more information, see Setting Up Warehouse Management.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Record the receipt of items at warehouse locations, either How to: Receive Items
with a purchase order only, in simple location setups, or
with a warehouse receipt, in case of semi or fully
automated warehouse processing at the location.
Bypass the put-away and pick processes to expedite an How to: Cross-Dock Items
item straight from receiving or production to shipping.
Put away items received from purchases, sales returns, Putting Items Away
transfers, or production output according to the
configured warehouse process.
Record the shipment of items from warehouse locations, How to: Ship Items
either with a sales order only, in simple location setups, or
with a warehouse shipment, in case of semi or fully
automated warehouse processes at the location.
See Also
Inventory
Setting Up Warehouse Management
Assembly Management
Design Details: Warehouse Management
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Receive Items
4/16/2018 • 4 minutes to read • Edit Online
When items arrive at a warehouse that is not set up for warehouse receipt processing, you simply record the
receipt on the related business document, such as a purchase order, a sales return order, or an inbound transfer
order.
When items arrive at a warehouse that is set up for warehouse receipt processing, you must retrieve the lines of
the released source document that triggered their receipt. If you have bins, you can either accept the default bin
that is filled in, or if the item has never been used before in the warehouse, fill in the bin where the item should be
put away. You must then fill in the quantities of the items you have received, and post the receipt.
1. Choose the icon, enter Purchase Orders, and then choose the related link.
2. Open an existing purchase order, or create a new one. For more information, see How to: Record Purchases.
3. In the Qty. to Receive field, enter the received quantity.
The value in the Qty. Received field is updated. If this is a partial receipt, then the value is lower than the
value in the Quantity field.
4. Choose the Post action.
NOTE
If you wish to receive items with warehouse class codes other than the class code of the bin in the Bin Code field on
the document header, you must delete the contents of the Bin Code field on the header before you retrieve source
document lines for the items.
3. Choose the Get Source Documents action. The Source Documents window opens.
From a new or an open warehouse receipt, you can use the Filters to Get Source Docs. window to
retrieve the released source document lines that define which items to receive or ship.
a. Choose the Use Filters to Get Src. Docs. action.
b. To set up a new filter, enter a descriptive code in the Code field, and then choose the Modify action.
c. Define the type of source document lines that you want to retrieve by filling in the relevant filter fields.
d. Choose the Run action.
All released source document lines that fulfill the filter criteria are now inserted in Warehouse Receipt
window from which you activated the filter function.
The filter combinations that you define are saved in the Filters to Get Source Docs. window until the next
time you need it. You can make an unlimited number of filter combinations. You can change the criteria at
any time by choosing the Modify action.
4. Select the source documents for which you want to receive items, and then choose the OK button.
The lines of the source documents appear in the Warehouse Receipt window. The Qty. to Receive field is
filled with the quantity outstanding for each line, but you can change the quantity as necessary. If you
deleted the contents of the Bin Code field on the General FastTab before getting the lines, you must fill in
an appropriate bin code on each receipt line.
NOTE
To fill in the Qty. to Receive field on all the lines with zero, choose the Delete Qty. to Receive action. To fill it in
once again with the quantity outstanding, choose the Autofill Qty. to Receive action.
NOTE
You cannot receive more items than the number in the Qty. Outstanding field on the source document line. To
receive more items, retrieve another source document that contains a line for the item by using the filter function to
get source documents with the item.
5. Post the warehouse receipt. The quantity fields are updated on the source documents, and the items are
recorded as part of company inventory.
If you are using warehouse put-away, the receipt lines are sent to the warehouse put-away function. The items,
although received, cannot be picked until they have been put away. The received items are identified as available
inventory only when the put-away has been registered.
If you are not using warehouse put-away but you are using bins, the put-away of the items in the bin specified on
the source document line is recorded.
NOTE
If you use the Post and Print function, you both post the receipt and print a put-away instruction that shows you where to
place the items in storage.
If your location uses directed put-away and pick, then the put-away templates are used to calculate the best place to put
the items away. This is then printed on the put-away instruction.
See Also
Warehouse Management
Inventory
Setting Up Warehouse Management
Assembly Management
Design Details: Warehouse Management
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Cross-Dock Items
4/16/2018 • 8 minutes to read • Edit Online
Cross-docking functionality is available to you if you have set up your location to require warehouse receive and
put-away processing.
When you cross-dock items, you process items in receiving and shipping without ever placing them in storage,
thereby expediting the item through the put-away and pick processes and limiting the physical handling of items.
You can cross-dock items for both shipments and for production orders. When you prepare a shipment or pick
items for production and you are using bins, the item is automatically picked from a cross-dock bin before any
other bin. You must look in the cross-dock area to see if the items you need are available there before you get the
items in their usual storage area.
If you have calculated cross-dock quantities, put-away lines to the cross-dock bin for cross-dock calculations are
created when you post the receipt. Other put-away lines are created as usual.
If you want to post the cross-dock items right away to make them available for picking, you must also register a
put-away for the other items originating from the receipt line, namely those that need to be stored. If only some
items on a receipt line are being cross-docked, you must therefore make an effort to put away the remaining items
as quickly as possible. Alternatively, your warehouse policy could be to encourage cross-docking of entire receipt
lines whenever possible.
In the put-away instruction, you can to your advantage delete both Take and Place instruction lines for each receipt
line that concern receipts that are to be fully put away in storage. These lines can later be created as put-away lines
from the put-away worksheet or the posted receipt. When they are deleted, you can then put away and register the
lines that concern cross-dock items.
If you have selected the Use Put-away Worksheet field on the location card and have posted your receipt with
calculated cross-docks, all the receipt lines become available in the worksheet. The cross-dock information is lost
and cannot be recreated. Therefore, if you wish to use cross-dock functionality, you should relay lines to the put-
away worksheet by deleting put-away instructions rather than using the automatic relay function provided in the
Use Put-away Worksheet field.
If you post the warehouse receipt and you do not have the Use Put-away Worksheet field selected, the items to
be cross-docked appear as separate lines on the put-away instruction. The Cross-Dock Information field on each
put-away line shows whether the line contains cross-dock items, items from the same receipt that all need to be
stored, or items that need to be stored originating from a receipt line where some of the items are to be cross-
docked. With this field, employees can easily see why the full receipt quantity is not being placed in storage.
The program does not keep separate records about items that have been cross-docked, but registers them as
ordinary put-away instructions.
6. Choose the icon, enter Stockkeeping Unit, and select the related link.
7. For each item or stockkeeping unit that you want to be able to cross-dock, select the item, and then choose
the Edit action.
8. In the Stockkeeping Unit Card window, select the Use Cross-Docking check box.
NOTE
Cross-docking is only possible if your location is set up to require warehouse receive and put-away processing.
NOTE
In the warehouse put-away, you can continue to change the quantities that are being put away in storage or cross-docked,
as necessary. For example, you might decide to cross-dock an extra quantity to expedite the cross-dock registration.
See Also
Warehouse Management
Inventory
Setting Up Warehouse Management
Assembly Management
Design Details: Warehouse Management
Working with Dynamics NAV
Putting Items Away
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
The warehouse activity of putting items away after they are received or output is performed in different ways
depending on how warehouse management features are configured. The complexity can rank from no warehouse
features, through basic warehouse configurations for order-by order handling in one or more activities only, to
advanced configurations where all warehouse activities must be performed in a directed workflow. For more
information, see Setting Up Warehouse Management.
If you decide that you want to organize and record put-away information with warehouse documents, you place a
check mark in the Require Put-away field on the location card. This indicates that when you have items coming
into the warehouse location through an inbound source document, you want the put-away of those items to be
controlled by the system. An inbound source document can be a purchase order, a sales return order, an inbound
transfer order, or a production order whose output is ready for put-away.
If your location is set up to use put-away processing but not receive processing, you use the Inventory Put-away
window to organize the put-away information, print it, enter the result of the actual put-away and post the put-
away information, which in turn posts the receipt information for the source document. In the case of a production
order, the posting process posts the output of the order and finishes the production order.
If your location is set up to require both receive and put-away processing, so that you have placed check marks in
both the Require Receive and the Require Put-away field on the location card, there is a different process for
putting items away. In this case, you will use the Warehouse Put-away window to handle the put-away. The
warehouse put-away functions similarly to the inventory put-away, except that instead of posting the information,
you register the put-away. Note that the registering of the warehouse put-away does not post the receipt of the
items. It merely updates the bin content. As a warehouse manager, you can use a put-away worksheets to organize
put-away information before creating the individual warehouse put-away instructions.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Post the receipt of items directly from the inbound order How to: Receive Items
document and thereby record the put away, because no
warehouse configuration exists.
Put items away order by order and post the receipt in the How to: Put Items Away with Inventory Put-aways
same activity, in a basic warehouse configuration.
Put items away for multiple orders in an advanced warehouse How to: Put Items Away with Warehouse Put-aways
configuration.
Put produced or assembled items away in a basic or an How to: Put Away Production or Assembly Output
advanced warehouse configuration.
Plan optimized put-away instructions for a number of posted How to: Plan Put-aways in Worksheets
warehouse receipts rather than have warehouse workers act
directly on receipts.
Put back items that were picked technically with an internal How to: Pick and Put Away Without a Source Document
pick, for example for a production order that did not consume
the expected quantity.
TO SEE
Split a put-away line to place part of the put-away quantity in How to: Split Warehouse Activity Lines
available bins because the designated bin is filled up.
Get immediate access to put-aways that are assigned to you How to: Find Your Warehouse Assignments
as a warehouse worker.
See Also
Warehouse Management
Inventory
Setting Up Warehouse Management
Assembly Management
Design Details: Warehouse Management
Working with Dynamics NAV
Moving Items
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
The warehouse activity of moving items within the warehouse is performed in different ways depending on how
warehouse management features are configured. The complexity can rank from no warehouse features, through
basic warehouse configurations for order-by order handling in one or more activities only, to advanced
configurations where all warehouse activities must be performed in a directed workflow. For more information, see
Setting Up Warehouse Management.
While in one warehouse location, items may need to be moved between bins to support the daily warehouse
activities involved in keeping items flowing through the warehouse. Some movements happen in direct relation to
internal operations, such as a production order that needs components delivered or end items put away. Other
movements happen as mere warehouse space optimization or as ad-hoc movements to and from operations.
Moving items to other locations affects the item ledger entries and must therefore be done by transfer order. For
more information, see How to: Transfer Inventory Between Locations.
Additional movement tasks are to periodically replenish picking bins or shop floor bins and to modify bin content
information.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Move items between bins in basic warehouse configurations How to: Move Items in Basic Warehouse Configurations
at any time and without source documents.
Use the warehouse movement worksheet to move items in How to: Move Items in Advanced Warehouse Configurations
advanced warehouse configurations, both for source
documents and ad hoc.
Bring component items to internal operations in basic How to: Move Components to an Operation Area in Basic
warehouse configurations as requested by source documents Warehouse Configurations
for those operations.
Plan which bins to fill or empty to maintain an efficient flow, How to: Plan Warehouse Movements in Worksheets
such as emptying a bulk storage area before a large receipt.
Update the frequency at which bins, such as picking bins, How to: Calculate Bin Replenishment
must be replenished as a result of demand fluctuations.
Restructure your warehouse with new bin codes and new bin How to: Restructure Warehouses
characteristics and potentially move them around.
See Also
Warehouse Management
Inventory
Setting Up Warehouse Management
Assembly Management
Design Details: Warehouse Management
Working with Dynamics NAV
Pick Items
4/16/2018 • 3 minutes to read • Edit Online
The warehouse activity of picking items before they are shipped or consumed is performed in different ways,
depending on how warehouse management features are configured. The complexity can rank from no warehouse
features, through basic warehouse configurations for order-by-order handling in one or more activities only, to
advanced configurations where all warehouse activities must be performed in a directed workflow. For more
information, see Setting Up Warehouse Management.
If you decide to organize and record your picking activity with warehouse documents, you place a check mark in
the Require Pick field on the location card. This indicates that when you have items that need to be picked for an
outbound source document you want the picking of those items to be controlled by the system. An outbound
source document can be a sales order, a purchase return order, an outbound transfer order, a service order, or a
production order whose components should be picked.
NOTE
Even though the setting is called Require Pick, you can still post shipments directly from the source business document at
location where you select this check box.
If your location is set up to require pick processing but not shipment processing, you use the Inventory Pick
window to organize the picking information, print the picking information, enter the result of the pick, and post the
picking information, which in turn posts the shipment of the items. In the case of picking components for a
production order, the posting of the pick also posts the consumption.
If your location is set up to require both pick and shipment processing, so that you have placed check marks in
both the Require Pick and Require Shipment field on the location card, you use the Warehouse Pick window
to handle the pick. The warehouse pick functions similarly to the inventory pick, except that instead of posting the
picking information, you register the pick. This registering process does not post the shipment, but merely makes
the items available for shipment. As a warehouse manager, you can use a pick worksheets to organize pick
information before creating the individual warehouse pick instructions.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Post the shipment of items directly in the outbound order How to: Ship Items
document because no warehouse features exist. (Works the
same for sales orders, outbound transfer orders, and return
shipments.)
Pick items order by order and post the shipment in the same How to: Pick Items with Inventory Picks
activity, in a basic warehouse configuration.
Pick items for multiple orders in an advanced warehouse How to: Pick Items with Warehouse Picks
configuration.
Pick components for production or assembly in a basic or an How to: Pick for Production or Assembly
advanced warehouse configuration.
TO SEE
Plan optimized pick instructions for a number of shipments How to: Plan Picks in Worksheets
rather than have warehouse workers act directly on posted
shipments.
Pick items technically for a special purpose, such as a How to: Pick and Put Away Without a Source Document
production unit in need of extra components, in such a way
that the items do not technically leave the warehouse.
Split a pick line into multiple lines, for example because there How to: Split Warehouse Activity Lines
are not enough items to take from in the designated bin.
Get immediate access to picks that are assigned to you as a How to: Find Your Warehouse Assignments
warehouse worker.
See Also
Warehouse Management
Inventory
Setting Up Warehouse Management
Assembly Management
Design Details: Warehouse Management
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Ship Items
4/16/2018 • 5 minutes to read • Edit Online
When you ship items from a warehouse that is not set up for warehouse shipment processing, you simply record
the shipment on the related business document, such as a sales order, service order, purchase return order, or
outbound transfer order.
When you ship items from a warehouse that is set up warehouse shipment processing, you can ship items only on
the basis of source documents that other company units have released to the warehouse for action.
NOTE
If your warehouse uses cross-docking and bins, for each line, you can view the quantity of items that have been placed in the
cross-dock bins. The program calculates these quantities automatically whenever the fields on the shipment are updated. If
they are the items that apply to the shipment you are preparing, you can create a pick for all the lines and then complete the
shipment. For more information, see How to: Cross-Dock Items.
1. Choose the icon, enter Sales Orders, and then choose the related link.
2. Open an existing sales order, or create a new one. For more information, see How to: Sell Products.
3. In the Qty. to Ship field, enter the received quantity.
The value in the Qty. Shipped field is updated. If this is a partial shipment, then the value is lower than the
value in the Quantity field.
4. Choose the Post action.
1. Choose the icon, enter Warehouse Shipments, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the New action.
Fill in the fields on General FastTab. When you retrieve source document lines, some of the information is
copied to each line.
For warehouse configuration with directed put-away and pick, if the location has a default zone and bin for
shipments, the Zone Code and Bin Code fields are filled in automatically, but you can change them as
appropriate.
NOTE
If you wish to ship items with warehouse class codes other than the class code of the bin in the Bin Code field on
the document header, you must delete the contents of the Bin Code field on the header before you retrieve source
document lines for the items.
3. Choose the Get Source Documents action. The Source Documents window opens.
From a new or an open warehouse shipment, you can use the Filters to Get Source Docs. window to
retrieve the released source document lines that define which items to ship.
a. Choose the Use Filters to Get Src. Docs. action.
b. To set up a new filter, enter a descriptive code in the Code field, and then choose the Modify action.
c. Define the type of source document lines that you want to retrieve by filling in the relevant filter fields.
d. Choose the Run action.
All released source document lines that fulfill the filter criteria are now inserted in Warehouse Shipment
window from which you activated the filter function.
The filter combinations that you define are saved in the Filters to Get Source Docs. window until the next
time you need it. You can make an unlimited number of filter combinations. You can change the criteria at
any time by choosing the Modify action.
4. Select the source documents for which you want to ship items, and then choose the OK button.
The lines of the source documents appear in the Warehouse Shipment window. The Qty. to Ship field is filled
with the quantity outstanding for each line, but you can change the quantity as necessary. If you deleted the
contents of the Bin Code field on the General FastTab before getting the lines, you must fill in an appropriate bin
code on each shipment line.
NOTE
You cannot ship more items than the number in the Qty. Outstanding field on the source document line. To ship more
items, retrieve another source document that contains a line for the item by using the filter function to get source
documents with the item.
When you have the lines you want to ship, you can start the process that sends the lines to warehouse employees
to pick.
To pick and ship
Typically, a warehouse worker responsible for picking creates a pick document, or opens an already created pick
document.
1. Choose the icon, enter Warehouse Shipments, and then choose the related link.
2. Select the warehouse shipment that you want to pick for, and then choose the Create Pick action.
3. Fill in the fields in the request window, and then choose the OK button. The specified warehouse pick
document is created.
Alternatively, open an existing warehouse pick.
4. Choose the icon, enter Picks, and then choose the related link. Select the warehouse pick that you want
to work on.
If the warehouse is set up to use bins, then the pick lines have been converted to Take and Place action lines.
You can sort the lines, assign an employee to the pick, set a break-bulk filter, if you are using directed put-
away and pick, and print the pick instructions.
5. Perform the actual picking of items and place them in the specified shipping bin, or in the shipping area, if
you do not have bins.
6. Choose the Register Pick action.
The Qty. to Ship field and the Document Status field on the header of the shipment document are
updated. The items you have picked are no longer available for picking for other shipments or for internal
operations.
7. Print your shipping documents, prepare the shipment packages, and then post the shipment.
For more information about picking for warehouse shipments, see How to: Pick Items for Warehouse Shipment.
You can also use the pick worksheet to make several pick instructions into one instruction (for several shipments)
and thereby improve the efficiency of picking in the warehouse. For more information, see How to: Plan Pick in
Worksheets.
NOTE
If you are waiting for particular items to arrive at the warehouse, and you use cross-dock functionality, then Dynamics NAV
calculates on each shipment or pick worksheet line the quantity of the item that is in the cross-dock bin. It updates this field
each time you leave and open the shipment document or worksheet. For more information, see How to: Cross-Dock Items.
See Also
Warehouse Management
Inventory
Setting Up Warehouse Management
Assembly Management
Design Details: Warehouse Management
Working with Dynamics NAV
Service Management
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Providing ongoing service to customers is an important part of any business and one that can be a source of
customer satisfaction and loyalty, in addition to revenue. However,managing and tracking service is not always
easy, and Dynamics NAV provides a set of tools to help. These tools are designed to support repair shop and field
service operations, and can be used in business scenarios such as complex customer service distribution systems,
industrial service environments with bills of materials, and high volume dispatching of service technicians with
requirements for spare parts management.
With these tools you can accomplish the following:
Schedule service calls and set up service orders.
Track repair parts and supplies.
Assign service personnel based on skill and availability.
Provide service estimates and service invoices.
In addition, you can standardize coding, set up contracts, implement a discounting policy, and create route maps
for service employees.
In general, there are two aspects to service management: configuring and setting up your system, and using it for
pricing, contracts, orders, service personnel dispatch, and job scheduler.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Set up Service Management, including fault codes, policies, Setting Up Service Management
default documents and templates.
Manage service pricing, create service items, and understand Planning Service
how to monitor progress.
Create and manage contractual agreements between you Fulfilling Service Contracts
and your customers.
See Also
Managing Receivables
Jobs
Welcome to Microsoft Dynamics NAV
Planning Services
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
With Dynamics NAV, you can set up the standard tasks that you need to fulfill your customer service
requirements. To do this, you must determine what service items and offerings your service organization supports,
and at what price.
Dynamics NAV also provides some statistics tools that you can use to determine how well things are going, and
identify areas where you can improve.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Establish pricing for the services you provide. Managing Service Pricing
Set up and customize service items and service groups. This How to: Create Service Items
includes establishing which skills a service requires and
troubleshooting guidance.
Know how to manage the status of repairs on service orders, Understanding Service Order and Repair Status
and how to identify their priority.
Understand the relationship between the status of a repair, Understanding Allocation Status and Repair Status
and the effect they have on allocated resources, and vice
versa.
See Also
Fulfilling Service Contracts
Delivering Service
How to: Set Up Pricing and Additional Costs for Services
How to: Set Up Service Items and Service Item Components
How to: Set Up Statuses for Service Orders and Repairs
Setting Up Service Management
Fulfilling Service Contracts
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
One way to set up a service management business is to have standard contractual agreements between you and
your customers that describe the level of service and the service expectations. You can create contract templates
that include necessary information, such as customer, start date of contract, and invoice period.
After you set up the template, you can customize the resulting contract to keep track of service hours, or other
items that may vary from customer to customer. You can also set up a contract manually from a service contract
quote. Finally, you can adjust your service pricing to keep track of discounts that a specific customer qualifies for,
by specifying the discount amount in the Service Contract window.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Create service contracts either manually, or from a service How to: Create Service Contracts and Service Contract Quotes
contract quote.
Adjust the annual amount of a service contract or contract How to: Change the Annual Amount on Service Contracts or
quote, so make sure that you invoice the right amount. Contract Quotes
See also
Planning Service
Delivering Service
Setting Up Service Management
How to: Create Service Contracts and Service Contract Quotes
Delivering Service
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Dynamics NAV provides features to help you deliver service according to the contracts that you have created and
the service orders that you have committed to fulfilling. Your service technicians or dispatcher will find
outstanding service orders easy to locate when they use the Dispatch Board. At a glance, the Dispatch Board
shows which orders are in progress and which orders are complete.
Another way to review pending service orders is to use the Service Tasks window. In this view of your service
obligations, you can see where in your service workflow an order is and change that status to reflect interactions
with your customer.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
A service management application must interface with a customer request for service. That service request
usually is translated into a service order. Dynamics NAV provides tools to create an order both directly in response
to a customer request or as part of the contract process, if that is how your application is set up.
If needed, you can manage a loaner program for your customers. You can also determine your pricing structure,
put service pricing offerings into logical groupings, and create price adjustments.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Create quotes that are drafts of service orders, and then How to: Create Service Quotes
convert the quotes to service orders.
Create documents that contain information about a service, How to: Create Service Orders
such as repairs and maintenance, on service items.
Plan the delivery of service by using the Dispatch Board. How to: Allocate Resources
You can also use project management tools in the Jobs
department to help in planning.
Deliver service to customers by performing service tasks. How to: Work on Service Tasks
Post service orders for services, so that your accounting is How to: Post Service Orders and Credit Memos
up-to-date.
Create and post invoices for services that you have delivered. How to: Create Service Invoices or Credit Memos
Keep customers happy by lending them an item while you How to: Lend and Receive Loaner Items
work on theirs.
See Also
Planning Service
Fulfilling Service Contracts
Managing Projects
General Business Functionality
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Dynamics NAV provides dedicated functionality for typical business areas, such as finance and sales. For more
information, see Business Functionality.
To support those business area-specific tasks, you can use a variety of general business functionality, such as
defining extended text for document lines and organizing connecting business tasks in workflows.
The following table lists these general business areas with links to topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Set up standard text codes so you can extend standard text How to: Define Extended Text
by adding extra lines, and set up conditions for use of the
extra lines.
Learn how to work with general journals, which are used to Working with General Journals
post to general ledger accounts and other accounts such as
bank, customer, vendor, and fixed assets accounts.
Archive sales and purchase orders, quotes, return orders, How to: Archive Documents
and blanket orders, and use the archived document to
recreate the document that it was archived from.
View documents that are related to sales order lines and How to: Track Document Lines
purchase order lines, including from archived order lines.
Communicate the contents of business documents quickly How to: Send Documents by Email
to your business partners, such as the payment information
on sales documents to customers.
Schedule a report to run at a specific date and time. Schedule a report to run
Assign permissions to users, modify permission sets, and How to: Manage Users and Permissions
group users per permissions.
Change Dynamics NAV by installing extensions that add Customizing Dynamics NAV Using Extensions
functionality, changes behavior, or gives you access to new
online services.
Set up data exchange definitions to you can send and Exchanging Data Electronically
receive electronic documents.
See Also
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Set Up Extended Item Text
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
You can extend a standard text for items by adding extra lines, and you can set up conditions for use of the extra
lines. You do this from item cards.
See Also
Setting Up Inventory
Working with Dynamics NAV
Working with General Journals
8/13/2018 • 7 minutes to read • Edit Online
Most financial transactions are posted to the general ledger through dedicated business documents, such
as purchase invoices and sales orders. For business activities that are not represented by a document in
Dynamics NAV, such as smaller expenses or cash receipts, you can create the related transactions by
posting journal lines in the General Journal window. For more information, see How to: Post
Transactions Directly to the General Ledger.
For example, you can post employees' expenditure of own money on business-related expenses, for later
reimbursement. For more information, see How to: Record and Reimburse Employees' Expenses.
You use general journals to post financial transactions directly to general ledger accounts and other
accounts, such as bank, customer, vendor, and employee accounts. Posting with a general journal always
creates entries on general ledger accounts. This is true even when, for example, you post a journal line to a
customer account, because an entry is posted to a general ledger receivables account through a posting
group.
The information that you enter in a journal is temporary and can be changed while it is in the journal.
When you post the journal, the information is transferred to entries on individual accounts, where it
cannot be changed. You can, however, unapply posted entries, and you can post reversing or correcting
entries. For more information, see How to: Reverse Postings.
TIP
If you select the Suggest Balancing Amount check box on the line for your batch in the General Journal
Batches window, then the Amount field on, for example, general journal lines for the same document number is
automatically prefilled with the value that is required to balance the document. For more information, see Letting
Dynamics NAV Suggest Values.
NOTE
The following procedure refers to the item journal, but the information also applies to the general journal.
NOTE
If you selected the Save Unit Amount or Save Quantity fields, you should now make sure the inserted
values are correct for this particular inventory adjustment before you post the item journal.
If the inserted item journal lines contain saved unit amounts that you do not want to post, you can
quickly adjust it to the current value of the item as follows.
5. Select the item journal lines you want to adjust, and then choose the Recalculate Unit Amount
action. This will update the Unit Amount field with the current unit cost of the item.
6. Choose the post action.
1. Choose the icon, enter General Journals, and then choose the related link.
2. When you are ready to post the journal, choose the Renumber Document Numbers action.
Values in the Document No. field are changed, where required, so that the document number on
individual or grouped journal lines are in sequential order. After documents are renumbered, you can
proceed to post the journal.
See Also
How to: Post Transactions Directly to the General Ledger
How to: Reverse Postings
How to: Allocate Costs and Income
Finance
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Archive Documents
2/14/2019 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
You can archive sales and purchase orders, quotes, return orders, and blanket orders, and you can use the archived
document to restore the document that it was archived from.
1. Choose the icon, enter Sales & Receivables Setup, and then choose the related link.
2. In the Sales & Receivables Setup window, fill in the fields as follows.
FIELD DESCRIPTION
Archiving Sales Quotes Never to never archive sales quotes when they are deleted.
Question to prompt the user to choose whether to archive
sales quotes when they are deleted. Always to archive sales
quotes automatically when they are deleted.
Archiving Blanket Sales Orders Select to archive blanket sales orders automatically each time
they are deleted.
Arch. Orders and Ret. Orders Select to automatically archive sales orders each time they are
deleted.
1. Choose the icon, enter Sales Orders, and then choose the related link.
2. Open a sales order that you want to archive.
3. Choose the Archive Document action.
The sales order is archived. You can view it in the Archived Sales orders window. From here, you can also use it
to restore the sales order that it was archived from.
1. Choose the icon, enter Archived Sales Orders, and then choose the related link.
2. Select the archived sales order that you want to restore, and then choose the Restore action.
The sales order is restored to the earlier state.
NOTE: An archived version of a sales quote / sales order cannot be restored after deleting an original document.
1. Choose the icon, enter Delete Archived Sales Order Versions, and then choose the related link.
2. In the Delete Archived Sales Order Versions window, select the appropriate filters.
3. Choose the OK button.
See Also
How to: Track Document Lines
Sales
General Business Functionality
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Track Document Lines
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
You can view documents that are related to sales order lines and purchase order lines, including from archived
order lines. Related documents that you can track include quotes, shipments, receipts, and blanket orders. This
helps you to identify documents used to process orders.
1. Choose the icon, enter Sales Orders, and then choose the related link.
2. Open a sales order that you want to track from.
3. Select a line, and then choose the Document Line Tracking action.
4. In the Document Lines Tracking window, select the document that you want to view, and then choose the
Show action to see the related line.
5. To view the entire document for the selected document line, choose the Show Document action.
See Also
Sales
General Business Functionality
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Send Documents by Email
4/16/2018 • 4 minutes to read • Edit Online
To communicate the contents of business documents quickly to your business partners, such as the payment
information on sales documents to customers, you can use the Report Layout feature to define document-
specific content that gets inserted in email bodies automatically. For more information, see Managing Report
and Document Layouts.
To enable emails from within Dynamics NAV, start the Set Up Email assisted setup on the Home page.
You can email practically all document types as attachments to email messages directly from the window that
shows the document. In addition to the attachment, you can set up document-specific email bodies with core
information from the document preceded by standard text that greets the mail recipient and introduces the
document in question. To offer your customers to pay for sales electronically using a payment service, such as
PayPal, you can also have the PayPal information and hyperlink inserted in the email body.
From all supported documents, you initiate emailing by choosing the Send action, on posted documents, or
the Post and Send action, on non-posted documents.
If the Email field in the Send Document to window is set to Yes (Prompt for Settings), then the Send
Email window opens prefilled with the contact person in the To: field and the document attached as a PDF
file. In the Body field, you can either enter text manually or you can have the field filled with a document-
specific email body that you have set up.
The following procedure describes how to set the Sales - Invoice report up to be used for document-specific
email bodies when you email posted sales invoices.
NOTE
If you do not want to specify email settings each time you email a document, you can select the Yes (Use Default
Settings) option in the Email field in the Send Document to window. In that case, the Send Email window will not
open. See Step 4. For more information, see How to: Set Up Document Sending Profiles.
See Also
Managing Report and Document Layouts
How to: Set up Email
How to: Invoice Sales
Working with Dynamics NAV
Working with Reports
4/16/2018 • 3 minutes to read • Edit Online
A report gathers information based on a specified set of criteria, and organizes and presents the information in an
easy-to-read, printable format. There are many reports that you can access throughout the application. The reports
typically provide information relative to the context of the page you are on. For example, the Customer page
includes reports for the top 10 customers and the sales statistics, and more.
You can find reports in the Reports tab on selected pages, or you can use search to find reports by name. When
you open a report, you are presented with a page that let's you specify information (options and filters) that
determines want to include in the report. For example, depending on the report, you can specify a date range, a
specific record such as a customer, or sorting order.
Previewing a report
Choose Preview to see the report in the Internet browser. Point to an area of the report to show the menu bar.
.
Use the menu bar to:
Move through pages
Zoom in and out
Resize to fit the window
Select text
You can copy text from a report, and then paste it somewhere else, like a page in Dynamics NAV or
Microsoft Word. Using a mouse, for example, you press and hold where you want to start, and then move
the mouse to select one or more words, sentences, or paragraphs. You can then press the right mouse
button, and select Copy. You can the paste the selected text where ever you want it.
Pan the document
You can move the visible area of the report in any direction so you can view other areas or the report. This
is helpful when you have zoomed in to see details. Using your mouse, for example, press and hold the
mouse button anywhere in the report preview, and then move your mouse.
Download to a PDF file on your computer or network.
Saving a Report
You can save a report to a PDF document, Microsoft Word document, or Microsoft Excel document by choosing
Send to, and then making your selection.
Printing a Report
When you want to print a report you have to download the report as a PDF, Word, or Excel document first by
choosing Send to. Now, you can either open the report document right-away and print it, or save it and print it
later.
NOTE
As an administrator, you can create and manage the saved settings for reports for all users. For more information, see
Managing Saved Settings on Reports.
See Also
Specify Printer Selection for Reports
Managing Report and Document Layouts
Working with Dynamics NAV
Managing Report and Document Layouts
4/16/2018 • 3 minutes to read • Edit Online
A report layout controls content and format of the report, including which data fields of a report dataset appear
on the report and how they are arranged, text style, images, and more. From Dynamics NAV, you can change
which layout is used on a report, create new layout, or modify the existing layouts.
NOTE
In Dynamics NAV, the term "report" also covers externally-facing documents, such as sales invoices and order
confirmations that you send to customers as PDF files.
See Also
Updating Report or Document Layouts
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Create and Modify a Custom Report or Document Layout
How to: Import and Export a Custom Report or Document Layout
How to: Send Documents by Email
Working with Reports
Customizing Dynamics NAV Using Extensions
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
You can customize Dynamics NAV by installing extensions that add functionality, change behavior, or give you
access to online services. For example, Microsoft offers an extension that provides integration with PayPal
Payments Standard, and several that make it easy to import data from other finance apps.
You manage the extensions in the Extension Management window. You can access this window from Home.
Alternatively, choose the Search for Page or Report icon in the top right corner, enter Extension, and then
choose the related link.
NOTE
If you think you should have access to an extension but you cannot find its functionality, check the Extension
Management window - if the extension is not listed there, you can install it as described in the following section.
Installing an Extension
In the Extension Management window, you can see the extensions that are currently available, and are either
installed or ready to be installed.
NOTE
Extensions might need to be published before they are available in the list. Typically, this is something a Microsoft Partner
helps with. For more information, see How to: Publish and Install an Extension v2.0.
If you choose an extension, you can read about what the extension does, and you can access Help for the
extension to learn more. When you choose to install an extension, you must agree to the terms of use.
When you install an extension, you might have to set it up, such as specifying an account for use with the PayPal
Payments Standard extension. Other extensions simply add fields to an existing page, or they add a new page,
for example.
If you uninstall an extension, and you then change your mind, you can install it again. When you uninstall an
extension that you have been using, the data is preserved so that if you install the extension again, your data is
still available.
All extensions are tested before they are made available to you, but we recommend that you access the links that
are provided with each extension to learn more about the extension before you choose to install it.
Microsoft provides the following extensions:
C5 2012 Data Migration (DK)
Ceridian Payroll
Image Analyzer
Microsoft Pay
PayPal Payments Standard
QuickBooks Data Migration
Quickbooks Payroll File Import
Sales and Inventory Forecast
See Also
How to: Enable Customer Payment Through PayPal
Migrating Business Data from Other Finance Systems
Dynamics NAV Extensions by Other Providers
Welcome to Microsoft Dynamics NAV
Incoming Documents
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Some business transactions are not recorded in Dynamics NAV from the outset. Instead, an external business
document comes into your company as an email attachment or a paper copy that you scan to file. This is typical of
purchases, where such incoming document files represent payment receipts for expenses or small purchases.
From PDF or image files representing incoming documents, you can have an external OCR service (Optical
Character Recognition) generate electronic documents that can then be converted to document records inside
Dynamics NAV.
In the Incoming Documents window, you can use different functions to review expense receipts, manage OCR
tasks, and convert incoming document files, manually or automatically, to the relevant documents or journal lines.
The external files can be attached at any process stage, including to posted documents and to the resulting vendor,
customer, and general ledger entries.
The incoming document process can consist of the following main activities:
Record the external documents inside Dynamics NAV by creating lines in the Incoming Documents window
in either of the following ways:
Manually, by using simple functions, either from a PC or from a mobile device, in one of the following
ways:
Use the Create from File button, and then fill relevant fields in the Incoming Document
window. The file is automatically attached.
Use the New button, and then fill relevant fields in the Incoming Document window and
manually attach the related file.
From a tablet or phone, use the Create from Camera button to create a new incoming
document record, and then send the image to the OCR service, for example.
Automatically, by receiving the document from the OCR service as an electronic document after you
have emailed the related PDF or image file to the OCR service. The Financial Information FastTab is
automatically filled in the Incoming Document window.
Use the OCR service to have PDF or image files turned into electronic documents that can be converted to
document records in Dynamics NAV.
Create new documents or general journal lines for incoming document records by entering the information as
you read it from incoming document files.
Attach incoming document files to purchase and sales documents of any status, including to the vendor,
customer, and general ledger entries that result from posting.
View incoming document records and their attachments from any purchase and sales document or entry, or
find all general ledger entries without incoming document records from the Chart of Accounts window.
TO SEE
Set up the Incoming Documents feature and set up the OCR How to: Set Up Incoming Documents
service.
Create incoming document records, attach files, use OCR to Processing Incoming Documents
turn PDF files into electronic documents, convert electronic
documents to document records, audit incoming document
records from posted sales and purchase documents.
See Also
Purchasing
Working with Dynamics NAV
How to: Set Up Incoming Documents
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
If you create general journal lines from incoming document records, you must specify in the Incoming
Documents Setup window which journal template and batch to use.
If you do not want users to create invoices or general journal lines from incoming document records unless the
documents are first approved, you must set up approvers in the Incoming Document Approvers window.
To turn PDF and image files into electronic documents that you can convert to, for example, purchase invoices
inside Dynamics NAV, you must first set up the OCR feature and enable the service.
When the Incoming Documents feature is set up, you can use different functions to review expense receipts,
manage OCR tasks, and convert incoming document files, manually or automatically, to the relevant documents or
journal lines. The external files can be attached at any process stage, including to posted documents and to the
resulting vendor, customer, and general ledger entries. For more information, see Processing Incoming
Documents.
NOTE
This approval setup is not related to approval workflows. For more information, see How to: Use Approval Workflows.
See Also
Process Incoming Documents
Incoming Documents
Purchasing
Working with Dynamics NAV
Processing Incoming Documents
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
To record an external document in Dynamics NAV, you must first create or complete an incoming document
record. You can do this manually, or you can take a photo of the external document and then create the incoming
document record with the image file attached.
From PDF or image files that you receive from your trading partners, you can have an external OCR service
(Optical Character Recognition) generate electronic documents that can be converted to document records in
Dynamics NAV. For example, when you receive an invoice in PDF format from your vendor, you can send it to the
OCR service from the Incoming Documents window. Alternatively, you can send the file to the OCR service by
email. Then, when you receive the electronic document back, a related incoming document record is created
automatically. After some seconds, you receive the file back from the OCR service as an electronic invoice that can
be converted to a purchase invoice for the vendor.
TO SEE
Create incoming document records manually or automatically How to: Create Incoming Document Records
by taking a photo of a paper receipt, for example.
Use an OCR service to turn PDF and image files into How to: Use OCR to Turn PDF and Image Files into Electronic
electronic documents that can be converted to purchase Documents
invoices in Dynamics NAV, for example. Train the OCR service
to avoid errors next time it processes similar data.
Connect or remove incoming document records for any non- How to: How to: Create Incoming Document Records Directly
posted sales or purchase document and to any customer, from Documents and Entries
vendor, or general ledger entry from the document or entry.
From the Chart of Accounts and General Ledger Entries How to: Find Posted Documents without Incoming Document
windows, use a search function to find general ledger entries Records
for posted documents that do not have incoming document
records and then centrally link to existing records or create
new ones with attached document files.
Get better overview by setting incoming document records to How to: Manage Many Incoming Document Records
Processed to remove them from the default view.
See Also
Incoming Documents
Purchasing
Working with Dynamics NAV
Workflow
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
You can set up and use workflows that connect business-process tasks performed by different users. System tasks,
such as automatic posting, can be included as steps in workflows, preceded or followed by user tasks. Requesting
and granting approval to create new records are typical workflow steps.
In the Workflow window, you create a workflow by listing the involved steps on the lines. Each step consists of a
workflow event, moderated by event conditions, and a workflow response, moderated by response options. You
define workflow steps by filling fields on workflow lines from fixed lists of event and response values representing
scenarios that are supported by the application code.
The generic version of Dynamics NAV includes a number of preconfigured workflows represented by workflow
templates that you can copy to create workflows. The code for workflow templates that are added by Microsoft
are prefixed with “MS -“. For more information, see the list of workflow templates in the Workflow Templates
window.
If a business scenario requires a workflow event or response that is not supported, a Microsoft partner must
implement them by customizing the application code. For more information, see Walkthrough: Implementing
New Workflow Events and Responses in the developer and IT-pro help.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Set up workflow users, specify how users get notified, and Setting Up Workflows
create new workflows. For new workflows for unsupported
scenarios, implement the required workflow elements by
customizing the application code.
See Also
Sales
Purchasing
Managing Projects
Working with Dynamics NAV
Setting Up Workflows
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
You can set up and use workflows that connect business-process tasks performed by different users. System tasks,
such as automatic posting, can be included as steps in workflows, preceded or followed by user tasks. Requesting
and granting approval to create new records are typical workflow steps. For more information, see Using
Workflows.
Before you begin to use workflows, you must set up workflow users and approval users, specify how users receive
notifications about workflow steps, and then create the workflows, potentially preceded by code customization.
In the Workflow window, you create a workflow by listing the involved steps on the lines. Each step consists of a
workflow event, moderated by event conditions, and a workflow response, moderated by response options. You
define workflow steps by filling fields on workflow lines from fixed lists of event and response values representing
scenarios that are supported by the application code.
If a business scenario requires a workflow event or response that is not supported, a Microsoft partner must
implement them by customizing the application code. For more information, see Walkthrough: Implementing New
Workflow Events and Responses in the developer and IT-pro help.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Set up workflow users and user groups. How to: Set Up Workflow Users
Set up workflow users who take part in approval workflows. How to: Set Up Approval Users
Specify how workflow users are notified of workflow steps, Setting Up Workflow Notifications
including approval requests.
Specify when users receive notifications and whether to How to: Specify When and How to Receive Notifications
aggregate notifications in a period to minimize the number of
notifications.
Set up the layout and general content of new workflow How to: Manage Notification Templates
notifications emails, or export, modify, and reimport existing
templates.
Set up an SMTP server to enable email communication in and How to: Set up Email
out of Dynamics NAV
Specify the different steps of a workflow by connection How to: Create Workflows
workflow events with workflow responses.
Use workflow templates to create new workflows. How to: Create Workflows from Workflow Templates
Share workflows with other Dynamics NAV databases. How to: Export and Import Workflows
Learn how to set up a workflow for approving sales Walkthrough: Setting Up and Using a Purchase Approval
documents by following an end-to-end procedure. Workflow
TO SEE
Add support for a business scenario that requires new Walkthrough: Implementing New Workflow Events and
workflow events or responses by customizing the application Responses
code.
See Also
Using Workflows
Workflow
Walkthrough: Setting Up and Using a Purchase Approval Workflow
Working with Dynamics NAV
Using Workflows
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
You can set up and use workflows that connect business-process tasks performed by different users. System tasks,
such as automatic posting, can be included as steps in workflows, preceded or followed by user tasks. Requesting
and granting approval to create new records are typical workflow steps.
Before you can begin to use workflows, you must set up workflow users, create the workflows, potentially
preceded by code customization and specify how users receive notifications. For more information, see Setting Up
Workflows.
NOTE
Typical workflow steps are about users who request approval of tasks and approvers accepting or rejecting approval
requests. Therefore, many topics about how to use workflows refer to approvals.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Set a workflow to start when the first entry-point event How to: Enable Workflows
occurs.
Request approval of a task, as an approver, accept, decline, or How to: Use Approval Workflows
delegate approvals, and send or view approval notifications.
Create workflow steps that restrict a certain record type from How to: Restrict and Allow Usage of a Record
being used before a certain event occurs, for example that the
record is approved.
View workflow step instances of status Completed. How to: View Archived Workflow Step Instances
Delete a workflow that you are sure will no longer be used. How to: Delete Workflows
See Also
Setting Up Workflows
Workflow
Working with Dynamics NAV
Exchanging Data Electronically
4/16/2018 • 5 minutes to read • Edit Online
You can use the Data Exchange Framework to exchange business documents, bank files, currency exchange rates,
and any other data files with your business partners.
Electronic Documents
As an alternative to emailing as file attachments, you can send and receive business documents electronically. By
electronic document is meant a standard-compliant file representing a business document, such as an invoice
from a vendor that you can receive and convert to a purchase invoice in Dynamics NAV . The exchange of
electronic documents between two trading partners is performed by an external provider of document exchange
services. The generic version of Dynamics NAV supports sending and receiving electronic invoices and credit
memos in the PEPPOL format, which is supported by the largest providers of document exchange services. A
major provider of document exchange services is preconfigured and ready to be set up for your company. To
provide support for other electronic document formats, you must create new date exchange definitions using the
Data Exchange Framework.
From PDF or image files representing incoming documents, you can have an external OCR service (Optical
Character Recognition) create electronic documents that you can then convert to document records in Dynamics
NAV, like for electronic PEPPOL documents. For example, when you receive an invoice in PDF format from your
vendor, you can send it to the OCR service from the Incoming Documents window. After a few seconds, you
receive the file back as an electronic invoice that can be converted to a purchase invoice for the vendor. If you send
the file to the OCR service by email, then a new incoming document record is automatically created when you
receive the electronic document back.
To send, for example, a sales invoice as an electronic PEPPOL document, you select the Electronic Document
option in the Post and Send dialog box. From here, you can also set up the customer’s default document sending
profile. First, you must set up various master data, such as company information, customers, items, and units of
measure. These are used to identify the business partners and items when you convert data in fields in Dynamics
NAV to elements in the outgoing document file. The data conversion and sending of the PEPPOL sales invoice are
performed by dedicated codeunits and XMLports, represented by the PEPPOL electronic document format.
To receive, for example, an invoice from a vendor as an electronic PEPPOL document, you process the document
in the Incoming Documents window to convert it to a purchase invoice in Dynamics NAV. You can either set up
the Job Queue feature to process such files regularly or you can start the process manually. First, you must set up
various master data, such as company information, vendors, items, and units of measure. These are used to
identify the business partners and items when you convert data in elements in the incoming document file to
fields in Dynamics NAV. The receiving and data conversion of PEPPOL invoices are performed by the Data
Exchange Framework, represented by the PEPPOL - Invoice data exchange definition.
To receive, for example, an invoice as an electronic OCR document, you process it as when you receive an
electronic PEPPOL document. The receiving and conversion of electronic documents from OCR are performed by
the Data Exchange Framework, represented by the OCR – Invoice data exchange definition.
Bank Files
The formats of files for exchange of bank data with ERP systems vary depending on the supplier of the file and on
the country/region. The generic version of Dynamics NAV supports import and export of SEPA bank files (Single
Euro Payments Area) and a bank data conversion service provided by external provider, AMC Consult. To provide
support for other electronic document formats, you use the Data Exchange Framework.
To export SEPA credit transfers, you choose Export Payments to File button in the Payment Journal window
and then upload the file to process the payments in your bank. First you must set up various master data, such as
bank account, vendors, and payment methods. The data conversion and export of SEPA bank data is performed
by a dedicated codeunit and XMLport, represented by the SEPA Credit Transfer bank export/import setup.
Alternatively, you can set up the bank data conversion service to perform the export, represented by the Bank
Data Conversion Service - Credit Transfer data exchange definition.
To export SEPA direct debit instructions, you choose the Export Direct Debit File button in the Direct Debit
Collections window and then send to your bank to automatically collect the involved customer payments. First
you must set up bank accounts, customers, direct-debit mandates, and payment methods. The data conversion
and export of SEPA bank data is performed by dedicated a codeunit and XMLport, represented by the SEPA
Direct Debit bank export/import setup.
To import SEPA bank statements, you choose the Import Bank Statement button in the Payment Reconciliation
Journal and Bank Acc. Reconciliation windows and then you proceed to apply each bank statement entry to
payments or bank ledger entries, manually or automatically. First you must set up bank accounts. The import and
data conversion of SEPA bank data is performed by the Data Exchange Framework, represented by the SEPA
CAMT data exchange definition. Alternatively, you can set up the bank data conversion service to perform the
import, represented by the Bank Data Conversion Service – Bank Statement data exchange definition.
In addition, the local versions of Dynamics NAV support various other file formats for import/export of bank data,
payroll transactions, and other data. For more information, see the “Local Functionality” Help section in your
country version of Dynamics NAV .
TO SEE
Learn how the Data Exchange Framework works. About the Data Exchange Framework
Prepare to exchange data in a file by reusing the file’s XML Setting Up Data Exchange
schema. Set up data exchange definitions. Set up master data
for electronic document sending. Set up various bank
import/export fields.
See Also
About the Data Exchange Framework
How to: Use XML Schemas to Prepare Data Exchange Definitions
Setting Up Data Exchange
Exchanging Data
Incoming Documents
General Business Functionality
About the Data Exchange Framework in Dynamics
NAV
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
The format of files for exchange of data in bank files, electronic documents, currency exchange rates, and other
with ERP systems vary depending on the provider of the data file or stream and on the country/region. Dynamics
NAV supports various bank file formats and data service standards. To provide support for other electronic
document formats, you use the data exchange framework. For more information, see Exchanging Data
Electronically.
The following diagrams show the architecture of the data exchange framework.
See Also
Exchanging Data Electronically
How to: Use XML Schemas to Prepare Data Exchange Definitions
Setting Up Data Exchange
Exchanging Data
Incoming Documents
General Business Functionality
Setting Up Data Exchange
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
Before you can send and receive electronic documents or import and export bank files, you must set up the data
exchange framework to process the involved files. In addition, you must set up related areas, such as master data
for customers that you send electronic invoices to or the bank data conversion service in case you use the external
service provider to convert your bank files. For more information, see Exchanging Data Electronically.
When Dynamics NAV is set up to exchange data with external files, users can use the setup in common business
tasks, such as sending and receiving electronic documents and importing and exporting bank files.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Set up the preconfigured document exchange service to How to: Set Up a Document Exchange Service
enable sending and receiving electronic documents from and
to Dynamics NAV.
Set up the preconfigured OCR service to turn PDF or image How to: Set Up Incoming Documents
files into electronic documents that can be converted to
document records in Dynamics NAV
Set up one of two preconfigured services for updated How to: Update Currency Exchange Rates
exchange rates to get the latest currency exchange rates into
the Currencies window.
Set up various master data, such as company information, How to: Set Up Electronic Document Sending and Receiving
customers, vendors, items, and units of measure, related to
mapping data in Dynamics NAV
Set up a bank account, a vendor, and a payment journal for How to: Set Up SEPA Credit Transfer
SEPA credit transfer.
Prepare bank account formats, payment methods, and How to: Set Up SEPA Direct Debit
customer agreements for SEPA direct debit.
Set up user authentication and the URL of the bank data How to: Set Up the Bank Data Conversion Service
conversion service provider that is required to have bank files
converted to your bank’s format.
Set up and enable an external service that enables you to How to: Set Up the Bank Data Conversion Service
import bank statements directly as bank feeds.
After the bank data conversion service is enabled, link bank How to: Set Up Bank Accounts
accounts in Dynamics NAV
Prepare to set up a new data exchange definition for a data How to: Use XML Schemas to Prepare Data Exchange
file or stream by using the file’s XML schema to prefill the Definitions
Column Definitions FastTab in the Posting Exchange
Definition window.
TO SEE
Set up the Data Exchange Framework to enable users to How to: Set Up Data Exchange Definitions
receive a new purchase document format, send a new sales
document format, import a new bank file, or other data
exchange.
See Also
Exchanging Data Electronically
Exchanging Data
Incoming Documents
General Business Functionality
Exchanging Data
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
You can exchange data between Dynamics NAV and external files or streams in connection with common business
tasks, such as sending and receiving electronic documents and importing and exporting bank files.
Before you can send and receive electronic documents or import and export bank files, you must set up the data
exchange framework to process the involved data files or streams. In addition, you must set up related areas.
These include master data for customers that you send electronic invoices to and the bank data conversion service
in case you distribute bank file conversions to an external service provider. For more information, see Setting Up
Data Exchange.
The following table describes a sequence of tasks, with links to the topics that describe them.
TO SEE
Convert sales document records in Dynamics NAV to a How to: Send Electronic Documents
standardized format and send them as electronic documents
that your customers can receive into their system.
Send PDF or image files to a provider of OCR services, and How to: Use OCR to Turn PDF and Image Files into Electronic
receive them back as electronic documents that can be Documents
converted to document records in Dynamics NAV.
Receive electronic documents, either from the OCR service or How to: Receive and Convert Electronic Documents
the document exchange service, in a standardized format that
you convert to the relevant document records in Dynamics
NAV.
Import a bank statement file into the Payment Applying Payments Automatically and Reconciling Bank
Reconciliation Journal window as the first step in Accounts
reconciling payments or into the Bank Acc. Reconciliation
window as the first step in reconciling bank accounts.
Export payments from the Payment Journal window to a How to: Export Payments to a Bank File
bank file that you upload to your electronic bank account for
processing.
Instruct your bank to transfer payment amounts from your How to: Create SEPA Direct Debit Collection Entries and
customers’ bank accounts to your company’s account Export to a Bank File
according to your setup of SEPA direct debit.
Use a service provider of currency exchange rates to update How to: Update Currency Exchange Rates
the Currencies window.
View which file elements are mapped to fields in Dynamics Field Mapping When Importing SEPA CAMT Files
NAV when importing SEPA CAMT statement files.
View which fields in Dynamics NAV are mapped to file Field Mapping When Exporting Payment Files Using Bank
elements when exporting payment files by using the Bank Data Conversion Service
Date Conversion Service feature.
See Also
Setting Up Data Exchange
Exchanging Data Electronically
How to: Invoice Sales
How to: Record Purchases
Incoming Documents
General Business Functionality
Business Process Walkthroughs
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
This selection of walkthroughs provides step-by-step, end-to-end business processes that you can perform using
the CRONUS International Ltd. demonstration company. The walkthroughs consist of multiple procedures, some
of which would normally be performed by one user, while others incorporate several different user roles. In order
to simulate the working environment, some of the walkthroughs contain setup steps necessary to complete the
exercises as described. These steps can provide insight into the kind of information users need to share with their
company's IT professionals.
The walkthroughs are complete scenarios, and should be performed from beginning to end for the greatest
benefit. Many are based on Dynamics NAV demonstrations, and enable you to try those procedures yourself, at
your own pace.
To avoid having to log in as many different profiles, navigation steps in the walkthroughs are based on
department menus and not on the Role Centers.
TO SEE
Use prepayments to part of sales orders Walkthrough: Setting Up and Invoicing Sales Prepayments
Set up approval users, when and how the users receive Walkthrough: Setting Up and Using a Purchase Approval
notification about approval workflows, and then modify and Workflow
enable the relevant approval workflow.
Put received items away in basic warehouse configurations Walkthrough: Receiving and Putting Away in Basic
Warehouse Configurations
Put received items away in advanced warehouse Walkthrough: Receiving and Putting Away in advanced
configurations warehouse configurations
Plan supply orders to fulfill demand manually Walkthrough: Planning Supplies Manually
Plan supply orders to fulfill demand automatically Walkthrough: Planning Supplies Automatically
Assemble and ship items that are customized on the sales Walkthrough: Selling, Assembling, and Shipping Kits
order
Plan a project, from start to finish Walkthrough: Managing Projects with Jobs
Understand the costs of a job Walkthrough: Calculating Work in Process for a Job
Pick items for shipment in basic warehouse configurations Walkthrough: Picking and Shipping in Basic Warehouse
Configurations
See Also
Working with Dynamics NAV
Walkthrough: Conducting a Sales Campaign
4/16/2018 • 9 minutes to read • Edit Online
A campaign is any kind of activity that involves several contacts. An important part of setting up a campaign
involves selecting the target audience for your campaign. For this purpose, in Dynamics NAV, you create a
segment, or a group of contacts using filters.
You use these features in Sales & Marketing to carefully plan your marketing activities and to manage your
interactions with contacts and customers. You can create campaigns and set up segments of your contacts for
mailings and other types of interactions with your contacts and prospective customers.
The Campaign and Segment features with their automated processes enable you to plan, organize, and keep track
of your marketing activities. This will increase the chances of winning new customers and retaining existing
customers.
Roles
This walkthrough demonstrates tasks that are performed by the following user roles:
Marketing Manager or Sales Manager
Marketing Staffer
Prerequisites
Before you can perform the tasks in the walkthrough, you must install the Dynamics NAV.
Story
The marketing manager in the Sales department of CRONUS is responsible for planning campaigns and for
executing them. He also makes decisions about which trade shows to participate in and he evaluates campaign
progress.
The marketing staffer in the Marketing department handles producing, distributing, and placing marketing
material.
The company has just launched a new product called the Millennium Server. The product was recently promoted
at a trade show, Computer Futurus. Many customers expressed great interest in the product, and as part of a
promotional effort, customers who bought Millennium Server during a campaign period were offered a special
campaign price.
One of the marketing staffer’s tasks after the trade show is to enter all the potential customers as contacts.
The marketing manager sets up a campaign, creates a segment that contains all the new contacts and then mines
the contact data to select the target audience for the campaign.
The staffer helps send out thank you letters to all the contacts who left their cards with the staff at the stand, and
finally, the manager records all the responses they receive from the prospective customers.
Setting Up a Campaign
As soon as the staffer has entered the business cards received at the trade show, the marketing manager sets up a
campaign card to manage the activities involved in the campaign.
To set up a campaign
1. Choose the icon, enter Campaigns, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the New action to create a new campaign. On the campaign card, press Enter to have a campaign
number automatically inserted.
3. In the Description field, enter a description for the campaign, for example, FUTURUS trade show.
4. Choose the Status Code field, and select a status code from the list that opens in the Campaign Status
window.
5. Fill in the Starting Date and Ending Date fields of the campaign as appropriate.
a. In the Segment window, choose the Segment action, and then choose the Save Criteria action.
b. In the Save Segment Criteria window, enter a code for the segment. In the Description field, enter a
description of the segment criteria.
c. Choose the OK button.
NOTE
If you have to reverse this removal of a group of contacts, you can do this using the Go Back function. In other
words, you can undo your last segmentation.
In the Segment window, choose the Segment action, and then choose the Go Back action.
The contacts that you just removed are added back to the list of contacts.
NOTE
This template consists of more than one attachment document, each of them written in a different language. Example
languages include English and Danish.
4. Choose the Language Code (Default) field to open the Segment Interaction Languages window.
Select a language code and then choose the OK button.
5. You can display the document in the selected language. Choose the Attachment action, and then choose
the Open action.
To respond to the message that requests permission to start Word, choose the Allow for this client
session option.
This opens the attached Word document so that you can inspect it. You can also take this opportunity to edit
and modify the letter. Close Word when you are finished.
6. Enter the subject of the letter in the Subject field, in the language selected for the template.
7. Choose the Log action.
8. Choose the Send Attachments check box to have the attachments printed.
a. Select the Create Follow-up Segment check box.
b. Choose the OK button to start the Log Segment batch job.
9. The attachments are sent. When the process is done, choose the OK button for the message that states that
the segment has been logged.
The letters are automatically printed and the segment is logged. Because the segment has been logged, it is
no longer in the list of segments but is moved to the list of logged segments. To see that list, Choose the
icon, enter Logged Segments, and then choose the related link.
10. After the segment is logged, each letter that is sent is recorded as an interaction, which you can view in the
log.
Choose the icon, enter Interaction Log Entries, and then choose the related link. There is an entry for
each sent letter.
To send an email message to a contact
1. On the Interaction FastTab, in the Interaction Template Code field, select the Business Letter template,
code BUS.
2. In the Subject (Default) field, enter the following example text: Thank you for visiting the trade show.
3. In the Correspondence Type field, choose E -Mail.
4. Specify language settings, as in the previous procedure.
5. Choose the Log action. The Log Segment window opens.
6. Select the Send Attachments check box to have the attachments sent by email.
7. Select the Create Follow-up Segment check box.
8. Choose the OK button.
The letters are automatically sent by email, and the segment is logged. Because the segment has been
logged, it is no longer in the list of segments but is saved in the list of logged segments. To see that list,
Choose the icon, enter Logged Segments, and then choose the related link.
See Also
Relationship Management
Business Process Walkthroughs
Working with Dynamics NAV
Walkthrough: Setting Up and Invoicing Sales
Prepayments
4/16/2018 • 9 minutes to read • Edit Online
Prepayments are payments that are invoiced and posted to a sales or purchase prepayment order before final
invoicing. You may require a deposit before you manufacture items to order, or you may require payment before
you ship items to a customer. You use the prepayments functionality in Dynamics NAV to invoice and collect
deposits that are required from customers or remit deposits to vendors. Thus, you can make sure that all
payments are posted against an invoice.
Prepayment requirements can be defined for a customer or vendor for all items or selected items. After you
complete the required setup, you can generate prepayment invoices from sales and purchase orders for the
calculated prepayment amount. You can change the default amounts on the invoice as needed. For example, you
can send additional prepayment invoices if additional items are added to the order.
Story
Phyllis is an accounting manager. She makes decisions about which customers are required to pay a deposit
before items are manufactured or shipped. Phyllis sets up Dynamics NAV to calculate prepayments automatically.
Susan is a sales order processor. When a customer calls to place an order, she enters the order into the system
while the customer is on the telephone. This way, she can verify prices and payment terms with the customer
immediately, and she can make adjustments to the order while she negotiates with the customer.
Arnie works in the Accounts Receivable department, where he posts invoices and payments.
In this scenario, Phyllis sets up prepayment requirements for the customer Selangorian, based on their credit
history, and gives Susan instructions for how to handle their orders.
When the customer calls, Susan negotiates with the customer until they reach an agreement. She can then choose
to calculate the prepayment in several different ways.
After Susan sends the prepayment invoice, the customer orders an extra item. Susan updates the order and
creates a second prepayment invoice.
Arnie registers the customer's payment and applies it to the invoices, and then sends the final invoice.
Setting Up Prepayments
Phyllis sets up the system to handle prepayments for customers.
Phyllis decides to have the same number series for prepayments as the one used for sales invoicing.
Phyllis sets the program to check if prepayments are required before final invoicing on an order.
Phyllis sets up default values for a required prepayment percentage for particular items and customers.
The following procedures describe how to complete Phyllis' tasks:
To set up number series for prepayments
1. Choose the icon, enter Sales & Receivables Setup, and then choose the related link.
2. In the Sales & Receivables Setup window, expand the Numbering FastTab.
3. Verify that the number series for posted prepayment invoices in the Posted Prepmt. Inv. Nos. field is the
same as for posted sales invoices (Posted Invoice Nos.) and the number series for posted prepayment credit
memos (Posted Prepmt. Cr. Memo Nos.) is the same as for posted credit memos (Posted Credit Memo
Nos.).
To block shipments for unpaid prepayment
1. In the Sales & Receivables Setup window, on the General FastTab, select the Check Prepayment when
Posting check box.
Now you cannot ship or invoice an order that has an unpaid prepayment amount.
By default, Phyllis requires customer 20000 to be invoiced for a 30% down payment on all orders. Therefore, she
will enter a default prepayment percentage on the customer card.
Phyllis requires all customers to be invoiced a 20% deposit for item 1100. Customer 20000 has a poor payment
history. Therefore, she requires a 40% prepayment from customer 20000 for item 1100. The following procedure
illustrates how to set up default prepayment percentages.
To assign default prepayment percentages to customers and items
1. Choose the icon, enter Customers, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the card for customer 20000 (Selangorian).
3. In the Prepayment % field, type 30.
4. Choose the OK button to close the customer card.
5. Choose the icon, enter Items, and then choose the related link.
6. Open the card for customer 1100.
7. Choose the Prepayment Percentages action.
8. Fill in two lines in the Sales Prepayment Percentages window as follows.
Item 1000 1
Item 1100 1
By default, the prepayment fields on the sales line are hidden, so you must display them.
6. Verify that the Prepayment % field on the line with item 1000 contains 30. The default value was taken
from the sales header, which was populated from the customer card.
The Prepayment % field on the line with item 1100 contains 40. This is the percentage you entered in the
Sales Prepayment Percentages window for item 1100 and customer 20000.
For more information, see How to: Set Up Prepayments.
7. Choose the Statistics action.
8. On the Prepayment FastTab, the Prepmt. Line Amount Excl. VAT field contains 1,560. If you create a
prepayment invoice for the order now, then this is the amount that is displayed on the invoice.
In this scenario, Susan has been instructed to suggest a total prepayment of 2000 for the order.
IMPORTANT
Depending on your country/region, the following step might not apply.
9. Change the amount in the Prepmt. Line Amount Excl. VAT field to 2000 and then close the window.
10. Verify the Prepayment % field on the sales lines, and you will see that it has been recalculated to
40.81625.
The recalculation includes all lines that have a prepayment percentage that is greater than 0.
Now the customer asks if the prepayment percent can be set to 35%. Susan's supervisor approves the
change.
11. In the Sales Order window, in the Prepayment % field, enter 35.
12. In the warning that appears, choose the Yes button. A rate of 35% will be applied as the payment
percentage for the whole order.
13. Verify that the lines have been updated accordingly.
NOTE
Susan would select Post and Print Prepmt. Invoice and mail the invoice to the customer.
NOTE
Normally, the shipping department would have already posted the shipment.
Arnie can view the history to verify that the sales invoice was created as intended.
1. Choose the icon, enter Posted Sales Invoices, and then choose the related link.
Next Steps
This walkthrough has taken you through steps to set up Dynamics NAV to handle prepayments. You have set up
default prepayment percentages on customers and items, and you have also used different methods to calculate
the prepayments on an order. You have tried to assign one total prepayment amount to the order, and you have
had the prepayment amount calculated as a percentage of the whole order.
You have also posted a prepayment invoice, created a second prepayment invoice when the order has changed,
and posted the final invoice for the remaining amount.
The prepayments functionality in Dynamics NAV makes it easy to set up and enforce prepayment rules for
customers and items, and it enables you to post every payment against an invoice.
See Also
Invoicing Prepayments
Finance
Working with Dynamics NAV
Business Process Walkthroughs
Walkthrough: Setting Up and Using a Purchase
Approval Workflow
4/16/2018 • 8 minutes to read • Edit Online
You can automate the process of approving new or changed records, such as documents, journal lines, and
customer cards, by creating workflows with steps for the approvals in question. Before you create approval
workflows, you must set up an approver and substitute approver for each approval user. You can also set
approvers’ amount limits to define which sales and purchase records they are qualified to approve. Approval
requests and other notifications can be sent as email or internal note. For each approval user setup, you can also
set up when they receive notifications.
You can set up and use workflows that connect business-process tasks performed by different users. System tasks,
such as automatic posting, can be included as steps in workflows, preceded or followed by user tasks. Requesting
and granting approval to create new records are typical workflow steps. For more information, see Workflow.
Prerequisites
To complete this walkthrough, you will need the CRONUS International Ltd. demonstration company.
Story
Sean is a super user at CRONUS on his own computer.
He creates two approval users. One is Alicia who represents a purchasing agent. The other is himself representing
Alicia’s approver. Sean then gives himself unlimited purchase approval rights and specifies that he will receive
notifications by internal note as soon as a relevant event occurs. Last, Sean creates the required approval workflow
as a copy of the existing Purchase Order Approval Workflow workflow template, leaves all existing event
conditions and response options unchanged, and then enables the workflow.
To test the approval workflow, Sean first logs into Dynamics NAV as Alicia, and then requests approval of a
purchase order. Sean then logs in as himself, sees the note on his Role Center, follows the link to the approval
request for the purchase order, and approves the request.
NOTE
You must set up an approver before you can set up users who require that approver's approval. Therefore, you must
set up yourself before you set up Alicia.
3. Set up the two approval users by filling the fields as described in the following table.
Setting Up Notifications
Specify how and when you are notified of approval requests.
To set up how and when you are notified
1. In the Approval User Setup window, select the line for yourself, and then on the Home tab, in the Process
group, choose Notification Setup.
2. In the Notification Setup window, in the Notification Type field, enter Approval.
3. Choose the Notification Template Code field, and then choose the Advanced button.
4. In the Notification Templates window, on the Home tab, in the Manage group, choose Edit List.
5. On the line for the APPROVAL template, in the Notification Method field, enter Note.
6. Choose the OK button.
7. In the Notification Setup window, on the Home tab, in the Process group, choose Notification Schedule.
8. In the Notification Schedule window, in the Occurence field, choose Instantly.
9. Choose the OK button.
NOTE
Although the notification recurrence is set to Instantly, the note will arrive approximately one minute after Alicia sent
the approval request. This is due to the default recurrence frequency of the Job Queue feature.
3. When the note appears in the My Notifications window, choose the Approval Entry: XX, XX value in the
Page field. The Requests to Approve window opens with Alicia’s request for the purchase order
highlighted.
4. In the Requests to Approve window, on the Home tab, in the Process group, choose Approve.
The value in the Status field on Alicia’s purchase order changes to Released.
You have now set up and tested a simple approval workflow based on the first two steps of the Purchase Order
Approval Workflow workflow. You can easily extend this workflow to automatically post Alicia’s purchase order
when Sean approves it. To do this, you must enable the Purchase Invoice Workflow workflow, in which the
response to a released purchase invoice is to post it. First you must change the event condition on the first
workflow step from (purchase) Invoice to Order.
The generic version Dynamics NAV includes a number of workflow templates for scenarios that are supported by
the application code. Most of these are for approval workflows. For more information, see Workflow Templates.
You define variations of workflows by filling fields on workflow lines from fixed lists of event and response values
representing scenarios that are supported by the application code. For more information, see How to: Create
Workflows.
If a business scenario requires a workflow event or response that is not supported, a Microsoft partner must
implement them by customizing the application code. For more information, see Walkthrough: Implementing
New Workflow Events and Responses in the developer and IT-pro help.
See Also
How to: Set Up Approval Users
Setting Up Workflow Notifications
How to: Create Workflows
How to: Use Approval Workflows
Workflow
Walkthrough: Picking and Shipping in Basic
Warehouse Configurations
4/16/2018 • 4 minutes to read • Edit Online
In Dynamics NAV, the outbound processes for picking and shipping can be performed in four ways using different
functionalities depending on the warehouse complexity level.
COMPLEXITY LEVEL
(SEE DESIGN
DETAILS:
INBOUND WAREHOUSE
METHOD PROCESS BINS PICKS SHIPMENTS SETUP)
Roles
This walkthrough demonstrates tasks that are performed by the following user roles:
Warehouse Manager
Order Processor
Warehouse Worker
Prerequisites
To complete this walkthrough, you will need:
CRONUS International Ltd. installed.
To make yourself a warehouse employee at SILVER location by following these steps:
1. Choose the icon, enter Warehouse Employees, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the User ID field, and select your own user account in the Users window.
3. In the Location Code field, enter SILVER.
4. Select the Default field.
Make item LS -81 available at SILVER location by following these steps:
1. Choose the icon, enter Item Journals, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the default journal, and then create two item journal lines with the following information about
the work date (January 23).
3. Choose the Post action, and then select the Yes button.
Story
Ellen, the warehouse manager at CRONUS, sets up SILVER warehouse for basic pick handling where warehouse
workers process outbound orders individually. Susan, the order processor, creates a sales order for 30 units of item
LS -81 to be shipped to customer 10000 from the SILVER Warehouse. John, the warehouse worker must make
sure that the shipment is prepared and delivered to the customer. John manages all involved tasks in the
Inventory Pick window, which automatically points to the bins where LS -81 is stored.
LS_81 SILVER 30
Proceed to notify the warehouse that the sales order is ready for warehouse handling.
4. Choose the Release action.
John proceeds to pick and ship the sold items.
See Also
How to: Pick Items with Inventory Picks
How to: Pick Items for Warehouse Shipment
How to: Set Up Basic Warehouses with Operations Areas
How to: Move Components to an Operation Area in Basic Warehouse Configurations
How to: Pick for Production or Assembly
How to: Move Items Ad Hoc in Basic Warehouse Configurations
Design Details: Outbound Warehouse Flow
Business Process Walkthroughs
Working with Dynamics NAV
Walkthrough: Receiving and Putting Away in
Advanced Warehouse Configurations
4/16/2018 • 6 minutes to read • Edit Online
In Dynamics NAV, the inbound processes for receiving and putting away can be performed in four ways using
different functionalities depending on the warehouse complexity level.
COMPLEXITY LEVEL
(SEE DESIGN
DETAILS:
INBOUND WAREHOUSE
METHOD PROCESS BINS RECEIPTS PUT-AWAYS SETUP)
Roles
This walkthrough demonstrates tasks that are performed by the following user roles:
Warehouse Manager
Purchasing Agent
Receiving Staff
Warehouse Worker
Prerequisites
To complete this walkthrough, you will need:
CRONUS International Ltd. installed.
To make yourself a warehouse employee at WHITE location by following these steps:
1. Choose the icon, enter Warehouse Employees, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the User ID field, and select your own user account in the Users window.
3. In the Location Code field, enter WHITE.
4. Select the Default field.
Story
Ellen, the warehouse manager at CRONUS International Ltd., creates two purchase orders for accessory items
from vendors 10000 and 20000 to be delivered to WHITE warehouse. When the deliveries arrive at the
warehouse, Sammy, who is responsible for receiving items from vendors 10000 and 20000, uses a filter to create
receipt lines for purchase orders arriving from the two vendors. Sammy posts the items as received into inventory
in one warehouse receipt and makes the items available for sale or other demand. John, the warehouse worker,
takes the items from the receiving bin and puts them away. He puts all units away in their default bins, except 40
out of 100 received hinges that he puts away in the assembly department by splitting the put-away line. When
John registers the put-away, the bin contents are updated and the items are made available for picking from the
warehouse.
Proceed to notify the warehouse that the purchase order is ready for warehouse handling when the delivery
arrives.
4. Choose the Release action.
Proceed to create the second purchase order.
5. Choose the New action.
6. Create a purchase order for vendor 20000 on the work date with the following purchase order lines.
See Also
How to: Put Items Away with Warehouse Put-aways
How to: Move Items in advanced warehouse configurations
Design Details: Inbound Warehouse Flow
Walkthrough: Receiving and Putting Away in Basic Warehouse Configurations
Business Process Walkthroughs
Walkthrough: Planning Supplies Manually
8/13/2018 • 10 minutes to read • Edit Online
This walkthrough demonstrates the process of planning supply orders to fulfill new demand. You can initiate
supply planning at fixed intervals, for example, every morning or every Monday, or when you are notified by sales
or production, depending on the type of demand. In this walkthrough you will use the Order Planning window, a
simple supply planning tool that is based on manual decision-making instead of parameter-based automatic
planning.
Roles
This walkthrough demonstrates tasks performed by the following user roles:
Production Planner
Purchasing Agent
Sales Order Processor
Prerequisites
Before you begin this walkthrough, you must install the Dynamics NAV. The following modifications must be
made to the database:
Delete all existing sales orders for bicycles.
Create one sales order for 10 bicycles at BLUE location.
Delete all planned and firm planned production orders. Do not delete started orders with entries that are
already posted.
As a rule, use the suggested data in this walkthrough because this data has the necessary records.
Story
Eduardo, the Production Planner of a small manufacturing company, is about to plan production and purchase
orders to fulfill new sales demand.
Because the products have few BOM levels and the flow of orders is relatively low, Eduardo uses the Order
Planning window to manually create supply orders, one product level at a time.
In a more complex manufacturing environment, the planning worksheet is used to plan supply based on item
parameters such as rescheduling period, safety lead time, reorder point, and batch calculations of consolidated
demand from all product levels.
NOTE
If the components have a default vendor number set up on the item cards, the lines will be preset.
3. Choose the Available for Transfer field to open the Get Alternative Supply window.
4. Choose the OK button to book the ten items that are available.
NOTE
In the demand line, the suggested purchase has been exchanged with a transfer from GREEN location. The Make
Orders function creates a transfer order from GREEN to the demanded location. The Substitutes Exists field works in
the same way.
5. Choose the Make Orders action. The Make Supply Orders window opens.
6. On the Order Planning FastTab, in the Make Orders for field, choose the The Active Order option.
7. On the Options FastTab, in the Create Transfer Order field, select the Make Trans. Orders option.
8. Choose the OK button to create the transfer order to supply the sales order.
The transfer order is now created and saved in the list as the last order in the list of open transfer orders.
13. Choose the icon, enter Firm Planned Prod. Orders, and then choose the related link.
In the Firm Planned Prod. Orders window review how start times and end times of individual orders are
scheduled according to the product structure. The lowest-level components are produced first. Therefore,
you must plan multilevel orders as demonstrated in this planning workflow.
See Also
Business Process Walkthroughs
Walkthrough: Planning Supplies Automatically
Walkthrough: Planning Supplies Automatically
8/13/2018 • 14 minutes to read • Edit Online
Phrases like “run planning” and “run MRP” refer to the calculation of the master production schedule (MPS ) and
the material requirements plan (MRP ) based on actual and forecasted demand.
MPS is the calculation of a master production schedule based on actual demand and the production
forecast. The MPS calculation is used for end items that have a forecast or a sales order line. These items
are called "MPS items" and are identified dynamically when the calculation starts.
MRP is the calculation of material requirements based on actual demand for components and the
production forecast on the component level. MRP is calculated only for items that are not MPS items. The
overall purpose of MRP is to provide time-phased formal plans, by item, to supply the right item at the
right time, in the right place, in the right quantity.
The planning algorithms used for both MPS and MRP are identical. The planning algorithms use netting,
reuse of existing supply orders, and action messages. The planning system process examines what is
needed or will be needed (demand) and what is available or expected (supply). When these quantities are
netted against each other, action messages are displayed in the planning worksheet. Action messages are
suggestions to create a new supply order, change a supply order (quantity or date), or cancel an existing
supply order. Supply orders can be production orders, purchase orders, and transfer orders. For more
information, see Design Details: Supply Planning.
The planning result is calculated partly from the demand-supply sets in the database and partly by the
setup of stockkeeping unit cards or item cards, production BOMs, and routings.
Roles
Production Planner
Purchasing Agent
Prerequisites
To complete this walkthrough, you will need:
The CRONUS International Ltd. demonstration company.
To change various item setup values by following the steps in the “Preparing Sample Data” section, later in this
walkthrough.
Story
The customer, Cannon Group PLC, orders five touring bikes for shipment on 02-05-2014 (February 5).
Eduardo, the production planner, performs the routine supply planning for the first week of February 2014. He
filters on his own location, BLUE, and enters a planning interval of the work date (01-23-2014) to 02-07-2014
before he calculates an initial supply plan.
The only demand that week is for the Cannon Group sales order. Eduardo sees that none of the planning lines
have warnings, and he proceeds to create supply orders without changes for the suggested planning lines.
The next day, before any of the initial supply orders are started or posted, Eduardo is notified that another
customer has ordered ten touring bikes for shipment on 02-12-2014. He recalculates to adjust the supply plan
according to the change of demand. The recalculation gives you a net change plan that suggests changes to both
time and quantity of some of the supply orders created in the first run.
During the various planning steps, Eduardo looks up the involved orders, and uses the Order Tracking feature to
see which demand is covered by which supply.
LOT ACCUMULATION
REORDERING POLICY SAFETY STOCK QUANTITY PERIOD RESCHEDULING PERIOD
Lot-for-Lot Blank 2W 2W
4. Repeat steps 2 and 3 for all SKUs in the number range between 1100 and 1300.
This completes the preparation of sample data for the walkthrough.
SELL-TO CUSTOMER
NAME SHIPMENT DATE ITEM NO. LOCATION QUANTITY
4. Accept the availability warning and choose the Yes button to record the new demand quantity.
To create a regenerative plan to fulfill demand at location BLUE
1. Choose the icon, enter Planning Worksheet, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the Calculate Regenerative Plan action.
3. In the Calculate Plan - Plan. Wksh. window, fill in the fields as described in the following table.
CALCULATE PLAN STARTING DATE ENDING DATE SHOW RESULTS: LIMIT TOTALS TO
CALCULATE STARTING DATE ENDING DATE SHOW RESULTS: LIMIT TOTALS TO:
4. Choose the OK button to automatically create all the suggested supply orders.
5. Close the empty Planning Worksheet window.
This completes the initial calculation, analysis, and creation of a supply plan for demand at location BLUE in
the first week of February. In the following section, another customer orders ten touring bikes, and Eduardo
must replan.
3. Accept the availability warning and choose the Yes button to record the demand quantity.
4. Proceed to replan to adjust the current supply plan.
5. Choose the icon, enter Planning Worksheet, and then choose the related link.
6. Choose the Calculate Net Change Plan action.
7. In the Calculate Plan - Plan. Wksh. window, fill in the fields as described in the following table.
CALCULATE PLAN STARTING DATE ENDING DATE SHOW RESULTS: LIMIT TOTALS TO
See Also
Business Process Walkthroughs
Walkthrough: Planning Supplies Manually
Design Details: Supply Planning
Walkthrough: Selling, Assembling, and Shipping Kits
8/13/2018 • 20 minutes to read • Edit Online
To support just-in-time inventory and the ability to customize products to customer requests, assembly orders can
be automatically created and linked as soon as the sales order line is created. The link between the sales demand
and the assembly supply enables sales order processors to customize the assembly item and promise delivery
dates according to component availability. In addition, assembly consumption and output are posted automatically
with the shipment of the linked sales order.
Special functionality exists to govern the shipping of assemble-to-order quantities, both in basic and in advanced
warehouse configurations. When workers in charge of assembly finish assembling parts or all of the assemble-to-
order quantity, they record it in the Qty. to Ship field on the warehouse shipment line, in advanced configurations,
and then choose Post Shipment. The result is that the corresponding assembly output is posted, including the
related component consumption, and a sales shipment for the quantity is posted for the linked sales order. This
walkthrough illustrates the advanced warehouse process.
In basic warehouse configurations, when an assemble-to-order quantity is ready to be shipped, the warehouse
worker in charge posts an inventory pick for the sales order lines. This creates an inventory movement for the
components, posts the assembly output, and the sales order shipment. For more information, see the “Handling
Assemble-to-Order Items in Inventory Picks” section in Inventory Pick.
Roles
This walkthrough demonstrates tasks that are performed by the following user roles:
Sales Order Processor
Planner
Assembly Worker
Picker
Shipping Responsible
Prerequisites
Before you can perform the tasks in the walkthrough, you must do the following:
Install Dynamics NAV.
Make yourself a warehouse employee at WHITE location by following these steps:
1. Choose the icon, enter Warehouse Employees, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the User ID field, and select your own user account in the Users window.
3. In the Location Code field, enter WHITE.
4. Select the Default field.
Prepare WHITE location for assembly processing by following these steps:
1. Choose the icon, enter Locations, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the location card for WHITE location.
3. On the Bins FastTab, enter W -10-0001 in the To-Assembly Bin Code field.
By entering this non-pick bin code, all assembly order lines are ready to receive their components in the bin.
4. In the From -Assembly Bin Code field, enter W -01-0001.
By entering this pick bin code, finished assembly items will be output to the bin.
Remove the default lead time for internal processes by following these steps:
1. Choose the icon, enter Manufacturing Setup, and then choose the related link.
2. In the Manufacturing Setup window, on the Planning FastTab, remove the value in the Default Safety Lead
Time field.
Create inventory for assembly components by following the "Prepare Sample Data" section in this walkthrough.
Story
On January 23, Susan, the sales order processor takes an order from The Device Shop for three units of Kit B,
which is an ATO item. All three units are customized and must contain the strong graphics card and an extra RAM
block. The disc drives are upgraded to DWD because the CD drives are unavailable. Susan knows that the units
can be assembled immediately, so she leaves the suggested shipment date of January 23.
At the same time, the customer orders fifteen units of Kit A with a special request that five units be customized to
contain the strong graphics card. Although Kit A is typically an assemble-to-stock item, the order processor
combines the sales line quantities to sell ten units from stock and assemble five customized units to the order. The
ten units of Kit A are unavailable and must first be supplied to inventory by an assembly order according to the
item’s assembly policy. Susan learns from the assembly department that Kit A units cannot be completed in the
current week. She sets the shipment date of the second sales order line, for the mixed ATO and inventory quantity,
to January 27 and informs the customer that the 15 units of Kit A will be shipped four days later than the three
units of Kit B. To signal to the shipping department that this sales order requires assembly processing, Susan
creates the warehouse shipment document from the sales order.
Eduardo, the planner, runs the planning worksheet and generates an assembly order for ten standard units of Kit A
with an internal due date of January 27.
Sammy, who is responsible for shipping, gets three warehouse shipment lines for the sales order: One line for the
three pure ATO units, one line for the five ATO units on the mixed sales order line, and one line for the ten ATS
units on the mixed sale order line. He creates a warehouse pick document for all the assembly components that are
needed to assemble the total of eight ATO units on the warehouse shipment document.
John, the picker, retrieves components for all the ATO quantities on the warehouse shipment document and brings
them to the assembly area. He enters the quantity to handle and registers the warehouse pick.
Linda assembles the three ATO units of Kit B. The components are already picked, and she does not record output
and consumption quantities or post the order, because both of these actions are performed automatically through
the related warehouse shipment lines.
Sammy records the assembled quantity on the warehouse shipment line and posts the shipment of the three units
of Kit B. The first line on the sales order is updated as shipped. The linked assembly order remains open until the
sales order is fully invoiced. The two warehouse shipment lines, one ATO and one ATS, for Kit A with due dates on
January 27 remain open.
On January 27, Linda processes two assembly orders for Kit A. The first order is the ATO order for five units, which
she processes differently than the ATO order for Kit B that she processed on January 23. On this order, she is
authorized to access the warehouse shipment line herself to record the completed assembly work. The needed
components are ready in the assembly department, as they were picked together with components for Kit B.
The second assembly order is the ATS order for ten units that were created by the planning system. On this ATS
order, Linda performs all involved actions from the assembly order. She creates a warehouse pick document for the
assembly components that are needed to assemble the ten units. When the PCs are assembled, Linda posts the
assembly order and thereby signals that the items are available in inventory and can be picked for shipment.
Sammy creates a warehouse pick document for any quantities that remain before the warehouse shipment can be
posted. A pick document is created for the ten units of Kit A that have just finished. The components needed to
assemble the five units of Kit A to order where picked on January 23.
John brings the ten units of Kit A from the warehouse to the specified shipping area, records the quantity to
handle, and then registers the pick.
Sammy packs the ten ATS units with the five ATO units that Linda assembled earlier in the day. He fills in the
quantity to ship on both lines and then posts the last shipment for The Device Shop. The related assembly order
for five units of Kit A is automatically posted. The second line on the sales order is updated as shipped. Two linked
assembly order remains open until the sales order is invoiced and closed.
When the sales order is later posted as fully invoiced, the sales order and the linked assembly orders are removed.
4. On the Home tab, in the Registering group, choose Register, and then choose the Yes button.
Next, synchronize the new warehouse entries with inventory.
5. Choose the icon, enter Item Journals, and then choose the related link. The Item Journal window
opens.
6. On the Actions tab, in the Functions group, choose Calculate Whse. Adjustment.
7. In the Calculate Whse. Adjustment window, choose the OK button.
8. In the Item Journal window, on the Actions tab, in the Functions group, choose Post, and then choose
the Yes button.
Creating the Assembly Items
1. Choose the icon, enter Items, and then choose the related link.
2. On the Home tab, in the Manage group, choose New.
3. Create the first assembly item based on the following information.
FIELD VALUE
NOTE
Kit A is typically supplied by assembly to stock and therefore has a reordering policy to make it part of general supply
planning.
4. On the Navigate tab, in the Assembly/Production group, choose Assembly, and then choose Assembly
BOM.
5. Define an assembly BOM for Kit A with the following information.
Item 80001 1
Item 80011 1
Item 80209 1
Resource Linda 1
FIELD VALUE
7. On the Navigate tab, in the Assembly/Production group, choose Assembly, and then choose Assembly
BOM.
8. Define an assembly BOM for Kit B with the following information.
Item 80005 1
Item 80014 1
Item 80210 1
Resource Linda 1
QTY. TO ASSEMBLE TO
TYPE DESCRIPTION QUANTITY ORDER SHIPMENT DATE
NOTE
The following availability issue exists for the sales order line for Kit B:
Assembly component 80210 is not available. This means that the three specified units of Kit B cannot be
assembled, indicated by 0 in the Able to Assemble field in the Assembly Availability window.
The following availability issue exists for the sales order line for Kit A:
The ten units of Kit A are not available. This indicates to the planning system that the quantity must be
assembled to inventory.
Item 80203 1
Item 80203 1
Next, change the shipment date of the second sales order line according to the assembly schedule.
15. On the sales order line for 15 units of Kit A, enter 01-27-2014 in the Shipment Date field.
16. On the Actions tab, in the Release group, choose Release.
17. On the Actions tab, in the Warehouse group, choose Create Whse. Shipment.
18. Close the sales order.
Planning for the Unavailable ATS Items
1. Choose the icon, enter Planning Worksheet, and then choose the related link.
2. On the Action tab, in the Functions group, choose Calculate Regenerative Plan.
3. In the Calculate Plan window, set the following filters.
NOTE
In this section, the person who is responsible for shipping is in charge of recording the completed ATO assembly work
on the warehouse shipment line. This workflow may occur in environments where the assembly work is performed by
the person who is responsible for shipping or by assembly workers in the shipping area.
In this section, actions on the assembly order are performed indirectly from the warehouse shipment line. For more
information about how to process an assembly order directly, see the “Assemble Items to Inventory” section in this
walkthrough.
2. Open the most recent warehouse shipment that is created at WHITE location.
Notice the three warehouse shipment lines: One line for the ATO quantity of Kit B, due on January 23. One
line for the ATO quantity of Kit A, due on January 27. One line for the inventory quantity of Kit A, due on
January 27.
The Assemble to Order field specifies the assembly method.
Next, create a pick document for all the ATO assembly components that are needed on the warehouse
shipment.
3. On the Actions tab, in the Functions group, choose Create Pick, and then choose the OK button.
Next, perform the picker’s task.
4. Choose the icon, enter Picks, and then choose the related link.
5. Open the warehouse pick document that you created in step 3 in this section.
Notice the value in the Source Document field and that all the pick lines are for assembly components.
Next.register the pick without changing the default information.
6. On the Actions tab, in the Functions group, choose Autofill Qty. to Handle.
7. On the Home tab, in the Registering group, choose Register Pick.
Return to performing the shipping tasks.
8. Reopen the Warehouse Shipment window.
Notice that the Qty. Picked field is still empty on all lines. This is because you still have not picked the items
to be shipped, but only the components needed to assemble the ATO quantities.
Proceed to review the related assembly order.
9. Select the shipment line for three units of Kit B.
10. On the Lines FastTab, choose Line, and then choose Assemble to Order. The Assembly Order window
opens.
Notice that several fields on the assembly order are unavailable because the order is linked to a sales order.
Notice on the assembly order lines that the Qty. Picked field is filled. This is due to the pick that you
registered in step 7 in this section.
11. In the Quantity to Assemble field, try to enter any value lower than 3.
Read the error message explaining why this field can only be filled through the Qty. to Ship field on the
related shipment.
The Quantity to Assemble field is editable is to support situations where you want to partially ship an
inventory quantity instead of assembling more units to the order. For more information, see the
“Combination Scenarios” section in Understanding Assemble to Order and Assemble to Stock.
12. Close the Assembly Order window to return to the Warehouse Shipment window.
13. On the shipment line for three units of Kit B, in the Qty. to Ship field, enter 3.
14. On the Actions tab, in the Posting group, choose Post Shipment, and then select Ship.
Along with this warehouse shipment posting, the full consumption and output quantities of the related
assembly order are posted, and the Remaining Quantity field is empty. The sales order line for Kit B is
updated to show that the three units are shipped.
Warehouse activities to fulfill the first sales order line by January 23 are completed. Next, fulfill the sales
order lines that are shipping on January 27
Assembling and Recording the Second ATO Quantity
1. Choose the icon, enter Assembly Orders, and then choose the related link.
Notice that the ATO order for shipped units of Kit B is still in the list, although the Remaining Quantity is
empty. This is because the linked sales order is still not fully invoiced.
NOTE
In this section, the assembly worker is responsible for recording the completed ATO assembly work on the warehouse
shipment line. This workflow may occur in environments where the assembly work is performed in a separate
assembly department and assembly workers are authorized to change the warehouse shipment line.
5. Choose the icon, enter Picks, and then choose the related link.
6. Open the warehouse pick document that you created in step 4 in this section.
Proceed to register the pick without changing the default information.
7. On the Actions tab, in the Functions group, choose Autofill Qty. to Handle.
8. On the Home tab, in the Registering group, choose Register Pick.
Return to the assembly order to perform the last assembly task.
9. In the Assembly Order, on the Actions tab, in the Posting group, choose Post, and then choose the Yes
button.
Notice that the assembly order is removed from the list of open orders.
Shipping the Remaining Items, Partly from Stock and Partly Assembled to the Order
1. Choose the icon, enter Warehouse Shipment, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the most recent warehouse shipment that is created at WHITE location.
Notice on the line for ten units of Kit A that the Qty. to Ship and Qty. Picked field are empty.
Next, pick any remaining items.
3. On the Actions tab, in the Functions group, choose Create Pick, and then choose the OK button.
Next, perform the picker’s last task for this warehouse shipment.
4. Choose the icon, enter Picks, and then choose the related link.
5. Open the warehouse pick document that you created in step 3 in this section.
Notice that this pick document is for assembly item, not for assembly components.
Next, register the pick without changing the default information.
6. On the Actions tab, in the Functions group, choose Autofill Qty. to Handle.
7. On the Home tab, in the Registering group, choose Register Pick, and then choose the Yes button.
Return to the warehouse shipment to perform the last task.
8. Reopen the Warehouse Shipment window.
In the Warehouse Shipment window, on the line for ten units of Kit A, notice that the Qty. to Ship and
Qty. Picked fields now contain 10.
9. On the Actions tab, in the Posting group, choose Post Shipment, and the choose Ship.
The warehouse shipment document is removed, which indicates that the involved warehouse activities are
completed. Next, verify that the sales order has been processed.
10. Choose the icon, enter Sales Orders, and then choose the related link
11. Open the sales order for The Device Shop.
Notice that the Quantity Shipped field contains the full quantity on both lines.
When the The Device Shop pays for their receipt of the 18 PCs from CRONUS, the sales order and its
linked assembly orders are removed.
See Also
Understanding Assemble to Order and Assemble to Stock
How to: Assemble Items
How to: Pick Items for Warehouse Shipment
How to: Sell Items Assembled to Order
How to: Assemble Items
Design Details: Assembly Order Posting
Design Details: Internal Warehouse Flows
Design Details: Outbound Warehouse Flow
Walkthrough: Planning Supplies Automatically
Walkthrough: Managing Projects with Jobs
8/13/2018 • 18 minutes to read • Edit Online
This walkthrough introduces you to the project management features in jobs. Jobs are a way for you to schedule
the usage of your company's resources and to keep track of the various costs associated with the resources on a
specific project. Jobs involves the consumption of employee hours, machine hours, inventory items, and other
types of usage that you may want to track as a job progresses.
This walkthrough covers the setup of a new job in addition to some common tasks such as handling fixed pricing,
making payment by installments, posting invoices from jobs, and copying jobs.
Roles
This walkthrough includes tasks for the following roles:
Project Manager
Project Team Member
Prerequisites
Before you can perform the tasks in the walkthrough, you must do the following:
Install the CRONUS International Ltd. demonstration database.
Create sample data by using the steps in the following section.
Story
This walkthrough focuses on CRONUS International Ltd., a design and consultancy firm that designs and fits new
infrastructures, such as conference halls and offices, with furniture, accessories, and storage units. Most of its work
is project oriented. Prakash is a project manager at CRONUS. He uses jobs to give him an overview of each
ongoing job that CRONUS has started, as well as the jobs that are completed. He is usually the one who sets up
deals with customers and enters the core of the job, which is task and planning lines in addition to prices, into
Dynamics NAV. He finds that creating, maintaining, and reviewing information is straightforward. Prakash also
likes the way Dynamics NAV enables copying jobs and payment by installments.
Tricia, a project team member who reports to Prakash, is responsible for monitoring the job day-to-day. She enters
her own work in addition to the work performed by technicians on every task. She records the items that they
have used and the costs that they have incurred.
Setting Up a Job
In this scenario, CRONUS has won a contract with a customer, Progressive Home Furnishings, to design a
conference and dining hall. The customer is based in the United States and the project will require special software.
The project manager reaches an agreement with the customer and creates a job that covers the agreement.
To set up a job
1. Choose the icon, enter Jobs, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the New action to create a new card.
3. On the General FastTab, enter the following information:
Description: Advising on conference hall setup
Bill-to-Customer No.: 01445544
4. On the Posting FastTab, enter the following information:
Status: Order
Job Posting Group: Setting Up
WIP Method: Cost Value
5. On the Duration FastTab, type today's date into the Starting Date and Ending Date fields. These dates
will help apply currency conversions when the job is invoiced.
6. On the Foreign Trade FastTab, set the currency code to USD. If you select USD in the Invoice Currency
Code field, then the job will be invoiced in U.S. dollars and planned in the local currency of CRONUS only.
You can customize the pricing for customers on a per job basis, depending on the agreements you have set
up. In the next procedure, the project manager specifies a cost for Tricia’s time, sets the price for the
required software, and adds in the travel costs that the customer has agreed to pay.
To customize pricing
1. From the job card, choose the Resource action.
2. In the Job Resource Prices window, enter the following information:
Code: Tricia
Unit Price: 20
3. Choose the OK button to close the window.
4. Choose the Item action.
5. In the Job Item Prices window, enter the following information and customized price:
a. Item No.: 80201 (Graphic Program )
b. Unit Price: 200
6. Choose the OK button to close the window.
7. Choose the G/L Account action.
8. In the Job G/L Account Prices window, enter the following information and the cost of travel, for which
the customer has agreed to pay cost plus 25 percent:
a. G/L Account: 8430 (Travel)
b. Unit Cost Factor: 1.25
9. Choose the OK button to close the window.
The final steps in setting up a job are adding the job tasks and the planning lines that are part of each task.
The planning lines determine what is invoiced to the customer.
To add job tasks
1. On the Job card for the new job, choose the Job Task Lines action.
2. The following table describes the information that you should enter in the fields.
3. To show that some tasks are subcategories of other tasks, on the Actions tab, in the Functions group,
choose Indent Job Tasks.
A planning line can be one of the following types:
Schedule: Added to the schedule, but not invoiced.
Contract: Invoiced, but not added to the schedule.
Both Schedule and Contract: Invoiced and added to the schedule.
In this walkthrough, the project manager uses Both Schedule and Contract. He creates three planning
lines for task 1010, and two planning lines for task 1020.
To create planning lines
1. Select line 1010, and then choose the Job Planning Lines action. Enter the following information:
Line 1
Line Type: Both Schedule and Contract
Planning Date: (today’s date)
Type: Resource
No.: Tricia
Quantity: 40
Line 2
Line Type: Both Schedule and Contract
Planning Date: (today’s date)
Type: Resource
No.: Timothy
Quantity: 40
Line 3
Line Type: Both Schedule and Contract
Planning Date: (today’s date)
Type: G/L Account
No.: 8430 (Travel)
Quantity: 2
Unit Cost: 400
2. Choose the OK button to close the window. The totals are updated in the Job Task Lines window.
3. Select line 1020, and then choose the Job Planning Lines action. Enter the following information:
Line 1
Line Type: Both Schedule and Contract
Planning Date: (today’s date)
Type: Resource
No.: Tricia
Quantity: 80
Line 2
Line Type: Both Schedule and Contract
Planning Date: (today’s date)
Type: Item
No.: 80201 (Graphic program )
Quantity: 1
4. Choose the OK button to close the window. Totals are updated in the Job Task Lines window.
Copying Jobs
Prakash has reached an agreement with a customer, Selagorian Ltd, to set up 10 conference rooms. The agreement
resembles an earlier job. Therefore, it will save time to copy that earlier job.
In the Copy Job window, you can select the job and task lines that you want to copy. You can also select to copy
the source job ledger entries, which creates planning lines based on actual usage, or you can copy the source job
planning lines, which copies the original planning lines to the new job. You can then choose what planning line or
ledger entry line type that you want to include, selecting only what is relevant to this new job. Finally, you can
select the job that you want to copy to and define whether prices and quantities should be copied as well.
To copy a job
1. Choose the icon, enter Jobs, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the New action to create a new job. Enter the following information:
Description: Setting up 10 Conference Rooms
Bill-To Customer No.: 20000
3. Choose the Copy Job Tasks from action.
4. In the Copy Job Tasks window, enter the following:
Job No.: Guildford
Job Task No. From: 1000
Source: Job Planning Lines
Incl. Planning Line Type: Schedule + Contract
To Job No.: GuildfordSetting up 10 Conference Rooms
Select the Copy Dimensions and Copy Quantity fields.
5. Choose the OK button to copy the job and then choose the OK button to close the confirmation window.
By comparing prices, job task lines, and job planning lines for the two jobs, you can see that the information
was successfully copied.
5. In the Job Task Lines window, select task 1000, and then choose the Job Planning Lines action.
6. Create a planning line with the following information:
Line Type: Contract
Planning Date: (today's date)
Type: G/L Account
No.: 6630
Quantity: 1
Unit Price: 5000
Choose the OK button to close the window.
7. In the Job Task Lines window, select task 2000, and open its Job Planning Lines.
The following table describes the planning lines that you will create.
Choose the OK button to close the window. In the Job Task Lines window, you can see the schedule
amounts have been updated.
8. In the Job Task Lines window, select task 3000.
9. Create a planning line with the following information:
Line Type: Contract
Planning Date: a future date
Type: G/L Account
No.: 6630
Quantity: 1
Unit Price: 5000
Choose the OK button to close the window.
10. Create a similar planning line entry for job task 4000.
Now that the task and planning lines have been entered, Prakash creates an invoice for the first payment.
He does this from the job task lines to make sure that the invoice only contains the lines for the first
payment. You can open the sales order from the planning lines or the task lines.
To create an invoice
1. In the Job Task Lines window, select line 1000, and then choose the Create Sales Invoice action.
2. In the Create Sales Invoice window, set today’s date as the posting date, specify Per Task, and choose the OK
button to create an invoice with the default information. Choose the OK button to close the confirmation
window.
3. Choose the Sales Invoice/Credit Memo action. On the sales invoice, you can see that only the down payment
is included in the invoice. You can now send this to the customer as agreed.
Next Steps
This walkthrough has taken you through some of the basic steps of working with jobs in Dynamics NAV. You have
learned about how to create a new job, how to copy a job, and how to handle payments. Also, you have seen a
demonstration of how to track hours and create invoices.
See Also
Business Process Walkthroughs
Setting Up Project Management
How to: Use Resources
How to: Monitor Progress and Performance
How to: Invoice Jobs
Working with Dynamics NAV
Walkthrough: Calculating Work in Process for a Job
8/13/2018 • 8 minutes to read • Edit Online
With jobs, you can schedule the usage of your company's resources and keep track of the various costs associated
with the usage of resources on a specific project. Jobs involve the consumption of employee hours, machine hours,
inventory items, and other types of usage that have to be tracked as a job progresses. If a job runs over a long
period, you may want to transfer these costs to a Work in Process (WIP ) account on the balance sheet while the job
is being completed. You can then recognize the costs and sales in your income statement accounts when it is
appropriate.
Roles
This walkthrough uses the project team member (Tricia) as the persona.
Prerequisites
Before you can perform the tasks in the walkthrough, the Dynamics NAV must be installed on your computer.
Story
This walkthrough focuses on CRONUS International Ltd., a design and consultancy firm that designs and fits new
infrastructures, such as conference halls and offices, with furniture, accessories, and storage units. Most of the work
at CRONUS is project-oriented and Tricia, a project team member, uses jobs to have an overview of each ongoing
job that CRONUS has started and also the jobs that are completed. Some of the jobs can be very lengthy and can
run over months. Tricia can use a WIP account to record the work in process and to track the costs throughout the
job.
Calculating WIP
CRONUS has taken on a lengthy project that has now extended across reporting periods. Tricia, a project team
member, calculates the work in process (WIP ) to make sure that the financial statement of the company will be
accurate.
During this procedure, Tricia will select a specific group of tasks that will be included in the WIP calculation. In the
Job Task Lines window, she can specify these lines in the WIP -Total column.
The following table describes the three options.
FIELD DESCRIPTION
Total Defines the range or group of tasks that are included in the
WIP and recognition calculation. Within the group, any job
task with Job Task Type set to Posting will be included in the
WIP Total, unless its WIP-Total field is set to Excluded.
Excluded Applies only to a task with Job Task Type of Posting. The
task is not included when WIP and recognition are calculated.
In the following walkthrough, Tricia applies the Cost Value method, her company standard, to calculate WIP. She
specifies what part of the job will be included in the WIP calculation by assigning WIP -Total values to various job
task lines.
To calculate WIP
1. Choose the icon, enter Jobs, and then choose the related link.
2. In the Jobs list, select the Deerfield job, and then choose the Edit action. This will open the job card in edit
mode.
WIP can be calculated based on Cost Value, Sales Value, Cost of Sales, Percentage of Completion, or
Completed Contract. In this example, CRONUS uses the Cost Value method.
3. On the Posting FastTab, choose the WIP Method field, and then select Cost Value.
4. Choose the Job Task Lines action and set the following values in the WIP -Total field.
The following table describes the values.
1130 Excluded
1190 Total
1210 Excluded
1310 Excluded
5. Choose the WIP action, and then choose the Calculate WIP action.
6. In the Job Calculate WIP window, you can select a job that you want to calculate WIP. On the Job FastTab,
select Deerfield in the No. field.
7. In the Posting Date field, enter a date that is later than the work date.
8. In the Document No. field, enter 1. This creates a document that you can refer to later for traceability.
9. Choose the OK button to run the batch job. A message is displayed. Choose the OK button to continue.
Close the Job Task Lines window.
NOTE
The message states that there are warnings associated with the WIP calculation. You will review the warnings in the
next procedure.
10. On the Job card, expand the WIP and Recognition FastTab to see the calculated values. You can also see
the WIP Posting Date and the values that have been posted to the general ledger, if any.
Notice that the value for Recog. Costs Amount is 215.60 in the To Post column. This reflects the total
costs of two of the items in the group of job tasks 1110 – 1130. The third item was set to Excluded, and
therefore is not included in the WIP calculation.
To review WIP warnings
1. Choose the icon, enter Job WIP Cockpit, and then choose the related link.
2. Select the Deerfield job, and then choose the Show Warnings action.
3. In the Job WIP Warnings window, review the warning associated with the job.
After the accounting period ends, Tricia has to recalculate the WIP to include completed work to this point.
To recalculate WIP
1. On the Job card, choose the WIP Entries action to view the WIP calculation.
The Job WIP Entries window shows the WIP entries that were last calculated on a job, even if WIP has not
yet been posted to the general ledger.
2. You can follow the steps in the procedure that explains how to calculate WIP to recalculate WIP. Every time
WIP is calculated, an entry is created in the Job WIP Entries window.
3. Close the window.
NOTE
Work in Process and Recognition is only calculated. It is not posted to the general ledger. To do so, you must run Post WIP
to G/L batch job after you have calculated the WIP and Recognition.
NOTE
Suppose Tricia calculated and posted WIP for a job with incorrect dates. Following the method that was discussed
earlier, she can reverse the incorrect postings, correct the dates, and repost to the general ledger.
Next Steps
This walkthrough has taken you through the steps of calculating WIP in Dynamics NAV. In larger jobs, it may be
useful to transfer the costs to a WIP account periodically while the job is being completed. This walkthrough has
shown you how to exclude task lines from a calculation. It also shows you when you would have to recalculate. And
finally, this walkthrough demonstrates how to post the WIP to the general ledger. An example of how to reverse a
WIP posting to the general ledger is also included.
See Also
Business Process Walkthroughs
Walkthrough: Managing Projects with Jobs
Understanding WIP Methods
Monitor Progress and Performance
Working with Dynamics NAV
Walkthrough: Picking and Shipping in Basic
Warehouse Configurations
4/16/2018 • 4 minutes to read • Edit Online
In Dynamics NAV, the outbound processes for picking and shipping can be performed in four ways using different
functionalities depending on the warehouse complexity level.
COMPLEXITY LEVEL
(SEE DESIGN
DETAILS:
INBOUND WAREHOUSE
METHOD PROCESS BINS PICKS SHIPMENTS SETUP)
Roles
This walkthrough demonstrates tasks that are performed by the following user roles:
Warehouse Manager
Order Processor
Warehouse Worker
Prerequisites
To complete this walkthrough, you will need:
CRONUS International Ltd. installed.
To make yourself a warehouse employee at SILVER location by following these steps:
1. Choose the icon, enter Warehouse Employees, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the User ID field, and select your own user account in the Users window.
3. In the Location Code field, enter SILVER.
4. Select the Default field.
Make item LS -81 available at SILVER location by following these steps:
1. Choose the icon, enter Item Journals, and then choose the related link.
2. Open the default journal, and then create two item journal lines with the following information about
the work date (January 23).
3. Choose the Post action, and then select the Yes button.
Story
Ellen, the warehouse manager at CRONUS, sets up SILVER warehouse for basic pick handling where warehouse
workers process outbound orders individually. Susan, the order processor, creates a sales order for 30 units of item
LS -81 to be shipped to customer 10000 from the SILVER Warehouse. John, the warehouse worker must make
sure that the shipment is prepared and delivered to the customer. John manages all involved tasks in the
Inventory Pick window, which automatically points to the bins where LS -81 is stored.
LS_81 SILVER 30
Proceed to notify the warehouse that the sales order is ready for warehouse handling.
4. Choose the Release action.
John proceeds to pick and ship the sold items.
See Also
How to: Pick Items with Inventory Picks
How to: Pick Items for Warehouse Shipment
How to: Set Up Basic Warehouses with Operations Areas
How to: Move Components to an Operation Area in Basic Warehouse Configurations
How to: Pick for Production or Assembly
How to: Move Items Ad Hoc in Basic Warehouse Configurations
Design Details: Outbound Warehouse Flow
Business Process Walkthroughs
Working with Dynamics NAV
Walkthrough: Tracing Serial-Lot Numbers
8/13/2018 • 13 minutes to read • Edit Online
When product defects occur, the errors must be identified and affected items must be prevented from leaving the
company. If defective items have already been shipped, you must trace who received them and, if you need to,
recall the items.
The first task of defects management is to investigate where the defective items came from and where they were
used. This investigation is based on historic data and is made easier by searching through item tracking entries
using the Item Tracing window.
The second task of defects management is to determine whether the traced items are planned for in open
documents, such as non-posted sales orders or consumption journals. This work is performed in the Navigate
window. You can use the Navigate feature to search all kinds of database records.
Roles
This walkthrough demonstrates tasks that are performed by the following user roles:
Quality Controller
Warehouse Manager
Order Processor
Purchasing Agent
Prerequisites
To complete this walkthrough, you will need:
The Dynamics NAV company.
To create new items and several business transactions by following the "Prepare Sample Data" section, later in
this walkthrough.
Story
Ricardo, the quality controller, is acting on a sales return of item 1002, Racing Bike. The customer, Selangorian Ltd.,
complained that the frame has cracked welding seams. Quality control engineers have confirmed that the racing
frame of the returned bike is defective. The quality controller must now determine:
Which lot of racing frames was faulty.
On which purchase order the faulty lot was received.
From the sales department, the quality controller knows that the returned racing bike, item 1002, had the serial
number SN1. By using this basic information, he must determine where the finished racing bike was last used, and
then he must trace backward to the earliest origin to establish which lot number the faulty component, the racing
frame, came from.
The results of this first item tracking task identify which racing frames were defective and which vendor supplied
them. Afterward, but in the same overall tracking process, the quality controller must find all the sold racing bikes
that contain racing frames from the faulty lot so that those orders can be stopped or recalled. Lastly, the quality
controller must find any open documents where the faulty lot is used so that no additional transactions are made.
The first two defects-management tasks are performed in the Item Tracing window. The last task is performed in
the Navigate window in integration with the Item Tracing window.
NOTE
To enter the base unit of measure, choose the New button, and then select PSC in the Item Units of Measure
window.
4. All other fields have acceptable default data or do not have to be filled in.
5. Choose the OK button to create the first new item card, 2000.
6. Choose New.
7. In the No. field, enter 1002, and then proceed to fill in the following fields.
2000 10 LOT1
4. To enter the lot number, choose the Item Tracking Lines action.
5. In the Item Tracking Lines window, fill in the Lot No. and Quantity (Base) fields, and then close the
window.
6. In the Vendor Invoice No. field, enter any value.
7. Choose the Post action, select the Receive and Invoice option, and then choose the OK button.
Next, purchase racing frames from Coolwood Technologies.
8. Choose the icon, enter Purchase Orders, and then choose the related link.
9. Choose the New action.
10. Create a purchase order for vendor, Coolwood Technologies, by filling in the following line fields.
2000 11 LOT2
11. To enter the lot number, on the Lines FastTab, in the Line group, choose the Item Tracking Lines action.
12. In the Item Tracking Lines window, fill in the Lot No. and Quantity (Base) fields, and then close the
window.
13. In the Vendor Invoice No. field, enter any value.
14. Choose the Post action, select the Receive and Invoice option, and then choose the OK button.
Next, produce two racing bikes, SN1 and SN2.
To produce end items
1. Choose the icon, enter Released Prod. Orders, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the New group.
3. Create a new released production order by filling in the following fields.
1002 2 SN1
1002 2 SN2
4. Choose the Refresh Production Order action, and then choose the OK button to fill the line.
5. To enter the serial numbers, choose the Item Tracking Lines action.
6. In the Item Tracking Lines window, fill in the Serial No. and Quantity (Base) fields, and then close the
window.
Next, post consumption of racing frames from LOT1.
7. In the Released Production Order window, choose the Production Journal action.
8. In the Production Journal window, select the consumption line for item 2000, choose the Item Tracking
Lines action.
9. In the Item Tracking Lines window, choose the Lot No. field, choose LOT1, and then choose the OK
button.
10. Leave all other defaults in the Production Journal window, and then choose the Post action.
Next, produce two more racing bikes, SN3 and SN4.
11. Choose the icon, enter Released Prod. Orders, and then choose the related link.
12. Choose the New action.
13. Create a new released production order by filling in the following fields on the header.
1002 2 SN3
1002 2 SN4
14. Choose the Refresh Production Order action to fill the line.
15. To enter the serial numbers, choose the Item Tracking Lines action, and then the numbers on two lines in
the Serial No. field in the Item Tracking Lines window.
Next, post more consumption of racing frames from LOT1.
16. In the Released Production Order window, choose the Production Journal action.
17. In the Production Journal window, select the consumption line for item 2000, choose the Item Tracking
Lines action.
18. In the Item Tracking Lines window, choose the Lot No. field, choose LOT1, and then choose the OK
button.
19. Leave all other defaults in the Production Journal window, and then choose the Post action.
You have produced four racing bikes, SN1 to SN4, and consumed four of the ten racing frames from LOT1,
two frames in each production order.
20. Close the production journal and the production orders.
Next, sell racing bikes. First sell the racing bike with SN1 to Selangorian Ltd..
To sell the end items
1. Choose the icon, enter Sales Orders, and then choose the related link.
2. Choose the New action, and then, create a sales order by filling in the following fields.
3. To enter the serial number, choose the Item Tracking Lines action, and then the number in the Serial No.
field in the Item Tracking Lines window.
4. Choose the Post action, select the Ship and Invoice option, and then choose the OK button.
Next, sell the racing bike with SN2 to The Cannon Group PLC.
5. Choose the icon, enter Sales Orders, and then choose the related link.
6. Choose the New action, and then, create a sales order by filling in the following fields.
7. To enter the serial number, choose the Item Tracking Lines action, and then the number in the Serial No.
field in the Item Tracking Lines window.
8. Choose the Post action, select the Ship and Invoice option, and then choose the OK button.
Finally, sell some racing frames separately. The Cannon Group PLC. also orders four separate racing frames
for their own assembly line.
9. Choose the icon, enter Sales Orders, and then choose the related link.
10. Choose the New action, and then, create a sales order by filling in the following fields.
11. To enter the serial number, on the Lines FastTab, in the Line group, choose the Item Tracking Lines action,
and then the number in the Serial No. field in the Item Tracking Lines window.
NOTE
Do not post the last sales order for five racing frames.
This completes the preparation of data to demonstrate the Item Tracing and Navigate features.
NOTE
Do not make any additional modifications to the trace result, as you will use it in the next section.
This completes the first defects-management task using the Item Tracing window. The quality controller
must now determine whether other posted documents have processed racing frames from LOT1.
See Also
How to: Work with Serial and Lot Numbers
How to: Trace Item-Tracked Items
Business Process Walkthroughs
Design Details
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
This content contains detailed technical information about complex application features in Dynamics NAV.
Design details content is aimed at implementers, developers, and super users who need deeper insight to
implement, customize, or set up the features in question.
TO SEE
Learn about the design for storing and posting dimensions, Design Details: Dimension Set Entries
including code examples on how to migrate and upgrade
dimension code.
Learn how the planning system works and how to adjust the Design Details: Supply Planning
algorithms to meet planning requirements in different
environments.
Understand mechanisms in the costing engine, such as costing Design Details: Inventory Costing
method and cost adjustment, and which accounting principles
they are designed for.
Learn about central principles behind advanced and basic Design Details: Warehouse Management
warehouse features and how they integrate with other supply
chain features.
Learn about historic and the current design of item tracking Design Details: Item Tracking
functionality and how it integrates with the reservation system
to include serial/lot numbers in availability calculations.
Learn about the General Journal Posting Line feature, Design Details: General Journal Post Line
including recent simplifications to the design of codeunit 12.
See Also
Planning
Managing Inventory Costs
Warehouse Management
Setting Up Complex Application Areas Using Best Practices
Working with Dynamics NAV
Design Details: Dimension Set Entries
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
This documentation provides detailed technical insight into the concepts and principles that are used to redesign
the dimension entry storing and posting feature in Dynamics NAV. The documentation starts by describing
conceptual overviews of the redesign. Then it explains the technical architecture to show how the redesign is made.
Finally, it provides code examples to prepare you for dimension code migration and upgrade.
In This Section
Dimension Set Entries Overview
Design Details: Searching for Dimension Combinations
Design Details: Table Structure
Design Details: Codeunit 408 Dimension Management
Design Details: Code Examples of Changed Patterns in Modifications
Design Details: Supply Planning
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
This documentation provides detailed technical insight to the concepts and principles that are used within the
Supply Planning features in Dynamics NAV.
It explains how the planning system works and how to adjust the algorithms to meet planning requirements in
different environments. It first introduces central solution concepts and then describes the logic of the central
mechanism, supply balancing, before proceeding to explain how inventory planning is performed with the use
of reordering policies.
In This Section
Design Details: Central Concepts of the Planning System
Design Details: Reservation, Order Tracking, and Action Messaging
Design Details: Balancing Demand and Supply
Design Details: Handling Reordering Policies
Design Details: Planning Parameters
Design Details: Planning Assignment Table
Design Details: Demand at Blank Location
Design Details: Transfers in Planning
Design Details: Inventory Costing
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
This documentation provides detailed technical insight to the concepts and principles that are used within the
Inventory Costing features in Dynamics NAV.
Inventory costing, also referred to as cost management, is concerned with recording and reporting business
operating costs.
In This Section
Design Details: Costing Methods
Design Details: Item Application
Design Details: Cost Adjustment
Design Details: Expected Cost Posting
Design Details: Average Cost
Design Details: Variance
Design Details: Rounding
Design Details: Cost Components
Design Details: Inventory Periods
Design Details: Inventory Posting
Design Details: Production Order Posting
Design Details: Assembly Order Posting
Design Details: Reconciliation with the General Ledger
Design Details: Accounts in the General Ledger
Design Details: Revaluation
Design Details: Warehouse Management
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
This documentation gives an overview of the concepts and principles that are used in the Warehouse
Management features in Dynamics NAV. It explains the design behind central warehouse features and
how warehousing integrates with other supply chain features.
To differentiate the different complexity levels of the warehousing, this documentation is divided into two
general groups, Basic and Advanced warehouse configurations, indicated by section titles. This simple
differentiation covers different complexity levels as defined by product granules and location setup. For
more information, see Design Details: Warehouse Setup.
In This Section
Design Details: Warehouse Overview
Design Details: Warehouse Setup
Design Details: Inbound Warehouse Flow
Design Details: Internal Warehouse Flows
Design Details: Availability in the Warehouse
Design Details: Outbound Warehouse Flow
Design Details: Integration with Inventory
Design Details: Item Tracking
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
As the flow of goods in today’s supply chain becomes more and more complex, the ability to keep track of items is
increasingly important to the companies involved. Monitoring an item’s transaction flow is a legal requirement in
the business of medical and chemical supply, but other businesses may want to monitor products with warranties
or expiration dates for customer service reasons.
An item tracking system should provide a company with easy handling of serial and lot numbers, considering each
unique piece of merchandise: when and where received, where stored, when and where sold. Dynamics NAV has
gradually expanded its coverage of this business requirement and today provides application-wide functionality
and a solid core on which to develop extensions.
In This Section
Design Details: Item Tracking Design
Design Details: Item Tracking Posting Structure
Design Details: Active versus Historic Item Tracking Entries
Design Details: Item Tracking Lines Window
Design Details: Item Tracking Availability
Design Details: Item Tracking and Planning
Design Details: Item Tracking and Reservations
Design Details: Item Tracking in the Warehouse
Design Details: General Journal Post Line
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
This documentation provides detailed technical insight into the concepts and principles that are used to redesign
the general journal posting line feature in Dynamics NAV. The redesign makes codeunit 12 simpler and more
maintainable. The documentation starts by describing conceptual overviews of the redesign. Then it explains the
technical architecture to show the changes that result from the redesign.
In This Section
General Journal Post Line Overview
Design Details: Posting Interface Structure
Design Details: Posting Engine Structure
Codeunit 12 Changes: Mapping Global Variables for General Journal Post Line
Codeunit 12 Changes: Changes in General Journal Post Procedures
See Also
Working with General Journals
Australia Local Functionality
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
The following topics describe local functionality that is unique to the Australian version of Dynamics NAV.
In This Section
Australian Business Numbers and Adjustment Notes
Business Activity Statements
Tax
Addresses
Electronic Funds Transfer (EFT)
Calculating Distribution Amounts
How to: Determine Sales Price by Cost Plus Percentage
How to: Print Income Statements
How to: Print Balance Sheet Reports
How to: Compare Bank Cash Flow
How to: Print Deposit Slip Reports
How to: Print Bank Account Reconciliation Reports
How to: Create Check Installments
See Also
Working with Dynamics NAV
Austria Local Functionality
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
The following topics describe local functionality that is unique to the Austrian version of Dynamics NAV.
In This Section
VAT Reporting
How to: Print General Ledger Setup Information
How to: Block Shipment for Negative Inventory
How to: Copy Existing Items to New Items
How to: Print Sales and Purchase Orders During Batch Posting
How to: Print Vendor Payments List Reports
See Also
Working with Dynamics NAV
Belgium Local Functionality
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
The following topics describe local functionality that is unique to the Belgian version of Dynamics NAV.
In This Section
Belgian Electronic Banking
Belgian Intrastat Reporting
Belgian VAT
Enterprise Numbers and Branch Numbers
How to: Set the Work Date as the Posting Date
How to: Create Financial Journals
How to: Export to Accon
How to: Apply and Unapply General Ledger Entries
How to: Limit the Posting Period
See Also
Working with Dynamics NAV
Canada Local Functionality
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
The following topics describe local functionality that is unique to the Canadian version of Dynamics NAV.
In This Section
How to: Work With GIFI Codes
How to: Set Up Use Tax and Purchase Tax
How to: Set Up Unrealized Sales Tax and Sales Payment Discounts
Reporting Sales Tax in Canada
How to: Manage Customer Credit Information
How to: Create Deposits
How to: Print Troubleshooting Reports
See Also
Working with Dynamics NAV
Denmark Local Functionality
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
The following topics describe local functionality that is unique to the Danish version of Dynamics NAV in Denmark.
In This Section
OIOUBL Electronic Invoicing Overview
EAN Location Number
Payments and Reconciliations (DK) Extension
FIK Details in the Payment Reconciliation Journal
VAT-VIES Reporting
How to: Print VAT Reconciliation Reports
C5 2012 Data Migration
See Also
Working with Dynamics NAV
Finland Local Functionality
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
The following topics describe local functionality that is unique to the Finnish version of Dynamics NAV.
In This Section
Automatic Account Codes
Electronic Banking in Finland
Posting Depreciation Differences
SEPA Credit Transfer Payments
VAT-VIES Declaration in Finland
See Also
Working with Dynamics NAV
France Local Functionality
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
The following topics describe local functionality that is unique to the French version of Dynamics NAV.
In This Section
General Ledger
Fiscal Periods and Fiscal Years
Accelerated Depreciation
Payment Management
Simulation of Entries
See Also
Working with Dynamics NAV
Germany Local Functionality
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
The following topics describe local functionality that is unique to the German version of Dynamics NAV.
In This Section
Process for Data Access and Testability of Digital Documents (GDPdU )
Physical Inventory Documents
VAT Reporting
Currency Exchange Rates
How to: Print General Ledger Setup Information
How to: Set Up Reports for VAT and Intrastat
How to: Post a Negative Entry
How to: Copy Existing Items to New Items
How to: Block Shipment for Negative Inventory
How to: Include Company Registration Numbers on Sales Reports and Purchase Reports
How to: Export and Print Intrastat Reports
How to: Print Sales and Purchase Orders During Batch Posting
How to: Print Vendor Payments List Reports
See Also
Working with Dynamics NAV
Iceland Local Functionality
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
The following topics describe local functionality that is unique to the Icelandic version of Dynamics NAV
In This Section
Icelandic Tax Regulations of Conditional Discounts
Electronic Invoicing Requirement: Issuing Single Copy Invoice
Deleting Posted Invoices and Credit Memos
How to: Print VAT Summary Information on Documents
Special Data Output and Reports for the Tax Authority
See Also
Working with Dynamics NAV
Italy Local Functionality
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
The following topics describe local functionality that is unique to the Italian version of Dynamics NAV.
In This Section
Vendor Payments and Customer Bills Overview
Fiscal Inventory Valuation
Italian Fixed Assets
Italian VAT
How to: Print Withholding Reports
How to: Set Up Journal Templates and Batches
How to: Set Up Company Information
How to: Define Debit and Credit Amounts
How to: Close a Fiscal Year
Reversing Journal Entries
Italian Subcontracting
See Also
Working with Dynamics NAV
Mexico Local Functionality
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
The following topics describe local functionality that is unique to the Mexican version of Dynamics NAV.
In This Section
How to: Set Up Use Tax and Purchase Tax
How to: Set Up Unrealized Sales Tax and Sales Payment Discounts
Reporting Sales Tax in Mexico
Electronic Invoicing
Tax Identification Types for Mexico
VAT Recalculation
How to: Manage Customer Credit Information
How to: Create Deposits
How to: Print Troubleshooting Reports
See Also
Working with Dynamics NAV
Netherlands Local Functionality
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
The following topics describe local functionality that is unique to the Dutch version of Dynamics NAV
In This Section
CMR Notes
Dutch Electronic Banking
Electronic Tax Declarations
General Ledger
Single EURO Payments Area (SEPA)
See Also
Working with Dynamics NAV
New Zealand Local Functionality
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
The following topics describe local functionality that is unique to the New Zealand version of Dynamics NAV
In This Section
Addresses
Calculating Distribution Amounts
How to: Determine Sales Price by Cost Plus Percentage
How to: Print Deposit Slip Reports
How to: Print Bank Account Reconciliation Reports
See Also
Working with Dynamics NAV
Norway Local Functionality
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
The following topics describe local functionality that is unique to the Norwegian version of Dynamics NAV
In This Section
How to: Apply General Ledger Entries in Closed Periods
How to: Import Payroll Transactions
EHF Electronic Invoicing in Norway
Electronic Banking in Norway
Electronic Payments to Vendors in Norway
Norwegian Sales Documents
Norwegian VAT Reporting
Recurring Orders
See Also
Working with Dynamics NAV
Russia Local Functionality
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
In Dynamics NAV, there are Russian-specific features that you can use to track and manage your business. For
example, you can use the local functionality features in Dynamics NAV to calculate VAT due based on Russian VAT
rates and regulations.
TOPIC DESCRIPTION
Account Schedules Overview Enables you to define information for statutory reports by
creating user-defined rows and columns.
Bank and Cash Management Enables you to manage petty cash and amount differences.
Bank Management Enables you to create bank directory structures to keep bank
reference information in one location, create budget
classifications, and print and post required documents.
General Ledger Correspondence Enables you to create, view, and print account turnover
information.
How to: Set Up Responsible Employees and Advance Enables you to print and view information about payments
Statements made to and from employees.
Payables and Receivables Enables you to manage your payables and receivables reports,
prepayments, agreements, and cards.
Statutory Reports Enables you to import and export data for electronic tax
reporting and other documents required by law.
VAT Enables you to set up, calculate, and pay VAT amounts based
on Russian VAT rates and regulations.
See Also
Russian Chart of Accounts
Russian Receivables Reports
Russian Payables Reports
Spain Local Functionality
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
The following topics describe local functionality that is unique to the Spanish version of Dynamics NAV.
In This Section
Calculating Due Dates
Cartera Module
Electronic Payments – AEB N34.1
Transaction Numbers
Corrective Invoices
How to: Enter CCC Codes
How to: Enter NACE Codes
How to: Ignore Discounts in General Ledger Accounts
How to: Indent and Validate Chart of Accounts
How to: Export Account Schedules to ASC Format
How to: Print Account Book Reports
How to: Print Sales and Purchase Invoice Books
How to: Print Intrastat Reports
How to: Set Up and Close Income Statement Balances
How to: Set Up Payment Days and Non-Payment Periods
VAT Reports
Report 340
Report 347
Report 349
See Also
Working with Dynamics NAV
Sweden Local Functionality
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
The following topics describe local functionality that is unique to the Swedish version of Dynamics NAV.
In This Section
Automatic Account Codes
How to: Import and Export Data in Standard Import Export Format
How to: Print Balance Sheet and Income Statement Reports
How to: Post Preliminary Invoices by Using Inward Registration
How to: Reverse Preliminary Invoices by Using Inward Registration
How to: Set Up EU Third-Party Purchase Transactions
See Also
Working with Dynamics NAV
Switzerland Local Functionality
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
The following topics describe local functionality that is unique to the Swiss version of Dynamics NAV.
In This Section
Swiss Electronic Payments
Swiss Value Added Tax
Swiss Inventory Management
Swiss General Ledger Accounts
Swiss Purchase Documents and Sales Documents
How to: Print General Ledger Setup Information
See Also
Working with Dynamics NAV
United Kingdom Local Functionality
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
The following topics describe local functionality that is unique to the United Kingdom version of Dynamics NAV.
In This Section
How to: Enter Statutory Information
How to: Set Up the GetAddress.io UK Postcodes Extension
How to: Set Up a Posting Date Warning
How to: Change VAT Setup in Journals
How to: Define Accounting Periods for Straight Line Depreciation of Fixed Assets
How to: Enter External Document Numbers
How to: Localize Intrastat Reporting
How to: Print Checks for APACS
How to: Print Remittance Advice
How to: Print Direct Sales and Purchase Details Reports
How to: Print VAT Audit Reports
How to: Print VAT Reports
How to: Set Up Reverse Charges on VAT
See Also
Working with Dynamics NAV
United States Local Functionality
4/16/2018 • 2 minutes to read • Edit Online
The following topics describe local functionality that is unique to the United States version of
[!INCLUDE [d365fin]../../(includes/d365fin_md.md)].
In This Section
How to: Set Up Use Tax and Purchase Tax
How to: Set Up Unrealized Sales Tax and Sales Payment Discounts
Reporting Sales Tax in the US
Reporting Transactions as 1099 Liable in the US
How to: Manage Customer Credit Information
How to: Create Deposits
How to: Print Troubleshooting Reports
See Also
Working with Dynamics NAV